The
Concept Of Tomorrow
by
Brendan Lee Sprague
Chapter
One: DNA Activation, and Spiritual Awakening
"We
all evolve at some point."
Spirituality
is a journey with no end in sight, such that we shall find answers
that only lead to more questions, and yet, somehow, we have arrived
at a pivotal point in human history, and we have incarnated at this
-- the midnight hour -- to see the world changed by Light.
"We
are all born from the same Source" -- no matter what title,
name, or deducement: -- there is only One Spirit moving through
everything.
We all have a name, an identity, a personality, an
ego, and various uniqueties that set us apart from mankind, but in
essence, as we are all born from the same Source, and the living
Source Field invariably binds us, infinitely draws us together. Such
that we are all in event -- toward a return -- to the Source from
which we came -- perceiving the beginning of time as the "big
bang" -- approximately 13.75 billion years ago -- and the "end
of time" -- the times in which we are now living, as the
perceived return to the Source.
All life and evolution is in
event and order toward the eventual return to unity,
one-consciousness of which many souls operate as One, bound by the
primordial spark, the radiating fount of Light that is known as the
Source. Thus we perceive a start, and an end, but what lies between
is the imagination -- where learning takes place. Here, we are
discovering the power of our thoughts, the concept of epiginetics,
and the self-controlled environment. We are learning how to evolve.
Now we are finding the next step in human evolution lies within the subconscious mind.
Bruce Lipton in "The Biology of Belief" writes that we can alter our RNA proteins resulting in a shift in our genetic structure, in a process known as "epiginetics", of which the expressed control over the environment results in a change in our RNA proteins, causing a shift in our genetic structure. This belief suggests that thought and environment are entangled, and by thus altering the environment, we alter our thoughts.
Philip
K. Dick, the afamed sci-fi writer, describes enlightenment, referred
to as "phylogenic memory packets" that contain complex DNA
information -- to which these packets are disinhibited -- induced to
“fire” -- and fire off, in due time, depending either on
synchronized inner biological clocks or on pure chance stimuli. Such
that one road is found in the catalyzation by the intake of certain
information, that in a linear flux from one source to the next, we
find ourselves within the recess of the "dream of awakening."
The dream of awakening contains direct symbols that wake up our
subconscious mind, and invite us to believe that the Light has
entered the filaments of our DNA helix. In this spontaneous
occurrence, we are awakened to feel that a change has occurred within
us. We feel "different" -- renewed, vitalized, and wholly
enamored with a certain spark of mysticality. We have entered the
initial stages of Lightbody, and here all aging, dis-ease, and
illness ceases in the process to which we are renewed, bodily, by the
presence of Light/Information within our DNA.
In this, we are
becoming our perfect avatar self, and live the highest conceivable
life, in full control over our environment, and all inhibitors
(people, places, and events) that step into our lives. We have
succeeded in shifting our RNA proteins through the control of the
environment, in what is known as the living environment -- always in
flux between thought and environs, finding that through the
achivement of our Lightbody -- information arrives instantaneously,
and we find the revelatory state easily achieved -- that through our
meditations, we endeavor to communicate with the subconscious mind,
and there is where all the Light resides.
The subconscious mind is the right-brain hemisphere of the human brain which operates on feeling and emotion.
It is the "imaginative" half of our brains, to which William Blake would refer to the imagination as the "body of God" and Einstein himself has said "the imagination is more important than knowledge."
As we have found ourselves in the New Age with the close of the Mayan calendar, and many strange events occurring in the lives of many a Lightworker, from events to the extrasensory, to the profound experience of UFO sighting, abduction dreams, and visitations -- we perceive that the humans have reached a pivotal point in their cosmic growth, and there is a "plan" hard-wired into our collective DNA.
As
the phylogenic memory packets release complex DNA information into
our minds through the event of the "dream of awakening" --
the Light, which is theoretically being projected from the brightest
star in our night-sky -- the North Star -- located in the
constellation of Canus Major, known as Sirius, to which New Age
belief suggests that "Light" is being projected from the
Vortex of Sirius, coursing through space like a river of iridescence,
to end up within the filaments of our DNA. Enlightenment as found
through the symbolic encodements found within the dream of awakening
as projected by the Vortex of Sirius, endows us with a new body, the
body of Light -- and here, we are finding ourselves ceasing to age,
and immortal in due result. The Vortex of Sirius has been open for
quite some time, and has been infecting us with revelations, and
mystical dreams. Sirius has been projecting high-frequency waves into
the filaments of our DNA for years now, as the vortex has opened, and
this is all in accordance with the plan, although not sure of its
entire details, we know that it makes sense, and however patternless
the array, we know things will "add up" in the final
analysis.
Originally,
the human race was a divine race of creatures endowed with
twelve-strand DNA.
Scientists
refer to the unused strands as "junk DNA" -- but this is in
truth the ninety percent of our brains we haven't been using. I of
course lack the scientific evidence to back up this claim -- it is
simply understood that the DNA helix is like a dimmer switch, and we
can raise this at will . . .
As Light projected from Sirius
inhibits us with the dream of awakening, and we are endowed with
"living information" -- as the deducement will resound:
"Light
is information, information is the matter which composes the
universe, information is alive, and this living information will
travel and be expressed as a natural result of the life-force
possessed.” We
are learning at a faster rate, certain divine thought-text seem to
occur instantaneously within our psyches, and we feel wholly enamored
through the matrix of cognition, the ability to think at all. In
activating our DNA through epiginetics, we start to tap into that
previously unused portion of our brains, with a growth in the pineal
-- the pineal which is referred to as the spiritual part of our
brains, where the soul-energy both comes and goes, as transceiver,
becomes fully employed. Once the Light has entered ones body, it
absolutely never goes away; this is a permanent change in the DNA
structure. The only possible future is divination, and nirvana.
In
the book "Welcome To Planet Earth" by Hannah Beaconsfield,
it is described that a certain symbol is tied into the energy of
Sirius.
"There are two mythic images carried in your
global subconscious that in some aspects have held the promise of
this return: the snake and the bird. Many of the Sirius-related
images combine these into one image. The caduceus. The symbol carried
by the medical community, is one such image, of course, this is not a
coincidence but a true reflection of Sirius' support for the healing
of human misery. These mythic images are the dream symbols that rose
from the human subconscious to remind you of your Sirius connections.
Even more important, they hold the promise of a return to an
integrated state and the healing of humankind through balance."
My
dream of awakening occurred in an instantaneous event given to me
through the media of the specifically symbolic dream-sequence. The
dream involved the symbol of the Caduceus, to which I took flight,
and felt as though I was
the
Caduceus. At first, in the dream, I was hearing a voice asking me if
I were “ready” to which I replied that I was. Then I
heard a million different thoughts roaring in static drone through my
entire right-brain hemisphere, I took flight, and found myself
hovering in the kitchen mirror, to which I soon awoke. I believe that
my subconscious mind recalled skimming across the table of contents
of the book, and was inhibited with the symbol of the caduceus. As a
result of being primed, the caduceus -- I would become the caduceus,
in my dream of awakening, to which my entrance into the world of
spirit is directly symbolic, and seems directly linked to the chapter
in the book, which seems to have a life of its own. This, it would
seem, as pure evidence of enlightenment to be found in such a direct
symbol for spiritual awakening as the symbol for balance, the
caduceus. It would seem that through my own course of evolution, I
have been given the symbol -- only to read about in the book later
on, and find that I was awakened by the dream.
The dream
occurred immediately after I lied flat down on my stomach, leaving no
room for rest or the usual alpha-state processes, I was catapulted
into the dreamstate instantaneously after lying down. Thus, I
perceive through the endurance of the Light through my crown
chakra/pineal gland, the phylogenic memory packets would release
complex DNA information, as a result of the subconscious activated by
the Light/Information, inviting me into the world of spirit -- a
world I would never leave or depart from -- I was twenty-three years
old, and I was enlightened with the symbol of the caduceus.
And
I would look at it now and then, the interesting covery, the
interesting title. "Many Lives, Many Masters" -- a book I
would calmly look at prior to reading, and honestly tell myself "this
is the book that will change my life."
I
would read each chapter, and feel the conclusion of each one nearing
toward the end, and wholly enamored with the words contained. Brian
L. Weiss wrote an amazing book about past-life regression, and it is
greatly suggestive that we have all lived before. The subject,
Catherine, repeatedly goes back in time, to perceive all of the lives
that she has lived, and the book contains messages from spirit-guides
while Catherine is in the in-between state, the bardo otherwise known
as purgatory. Here, we find the words of the poet-master,
echoing:
"Patience and timing . . . everything comes when
it must come. A life cannot be rushed, cannot be worked on a schedule
as so many people want it to be. We must accept what comes to us at a
given time, and not ask for more. But life is endless, so we never
die; we were never really born. We just pass through different
phases. There is no end. Humans have many dimensions. But time is not
as we see time, but rather lessons that are learned. Everything will
be clear to you in time."
In time, through whatever
processes involved, enlightenment is the end-result of all self-aware
growth.
In
my case, the concept of past-life regression was the catalyst for my
spiritual growth, and it all began with the book. Further, I was
influenced by The Biology of Belief" by Bruce Lipton, which I
read only enough of, to 'believe' -- the book about belief,
suggesting the concept of epiginetics, and RNA protein shift through
expressed control of the environs. It made enough sense to me. I read
enough of the book to believe in epiginetics, and I have come to find
that Bruce Lipton is a genius. He was entirely correct in his
revelation about the biology of belief, and he is a pioneer in the
world of New Thought. I must also attribute much of my growth to
Harry W. Carpenter who wrote "The Genie Within: Your
Subconscious Mind, How It Works, and How To Use It." This book
concluded with a chapter on God, referred to as the Universal Mind.
This, the Universal Mind, I would discover is a living, thinking mass
of many minds which seemingly operate together. A dog will walk from
state to state all the way to where his owners have re-located, as
bound by the natural subconscious force which was left as a residue
in their tracks. A person will instantaneously know when a loved one
is in trouble, etc. We are bound by the Universal Mind, the mass
aggregate of all subconscious thoughts otherwise referred to by Jung
as the "collective unconscious". Names, titles, and
deducements -- essentially just different names for the same
thing.
So we become enlightened, it would seem, through the
linear intake of certain information. One text, one guide, leads to
the next, in a linear slope of growth which for some may run as such:
"body -> instinct -> subconscious mind -> past-lives ->
god -> enlightenment." This was the slope of learning that I
found, which started with an understanding of tension referred to as
TMS by John E. Sarno in "Lower Back Pain: The Mind-Body
Connection." Which led up to the next book about instinct, and
selection reduction "Blink" by Malcolm Gladwell. I would
read this, and enter into the world of the subconscious mind. An
interest that became fully manifest upon the endurance of The Genie
Within, with the chapter concluding about God, and thus catalyzing my
belief in Spirit. In Many Lives, Many Masters, I would discover the
true nature of reality, and incarnation, and the belief in the
existence of the masters -- that life is like a school of which karma
bases and determines our growth through the continuum. As I learned
from one source, it only led up to the next, and the information was
gathered, collected, and inhibited upon my mind in the most fluid,
natural, linear, and effortless way of which I would devote much time
every day toward concentrated, meditative reading. I was searching
for the answers, and through the dream of awakening to which I
"became the caduceus" I am wholly enamored with the thought
that I am undergoing the ascension process, to this day.
"At last, the answer came . . ."
I was awakened by the Light, and I now possess a genetic mutation that is known as the De Novo mutation.
At a research study performed at McClean hospital in 2009, it was discovered that I possess a permanent genetic mutation that is known as the De Novo mutation. Derived from the Latin meaning "fresh, to start anew" De Novo is a "new mutation" which scientists are still trying to understand, and has often been linked with schizophrenia. But so it goes, most religious zealots are schizophrenic, and many spiritualists are decreed as such as well. We are often reduced to a label in order to make sense in the minds of the logical, but where is the logical deducement for the answer to the question I would ask the doctor himself, as I had experienced drug-induced telepathy earlier in 2009 with a group of friends at an LSD party, telling me "yes, telepathy has been known to occur more with people who have the De Novo mutation."
Direct
non-local thought-transferrence, otherwise known as telepathy, is the
sharing of sentience unto a mass mind, the mind at large, to which
all subjects seem to "think together" and thoughts travel
through words without the use of the vocal registers. I will go into
greater detail about this later on in the text, as it bears some
pertinence to the greater scheme of things, and how information is
alive, to which it travels by the volition of its own life-force thus
possessed. In this life, I have come to find that mysticality has
always followed me, and the many coincidental avenues I have found
myself walking, only lead me to believe that I have a purpose in the
world, has invariably led up to my self-evolution. My family may not
support the belief that I am endowed with Light in my DNA, resulting
in such things as telepathy, but the evidence is mounting that a
number in the millions are in Lightbody at this time -- such that I
am one within the matrix of all, a singular facet of the primordial
spark to which this all began. I am no better than the reader of this
text, and for the idealism I possess, and the hope for mankind, I
perceive that absolutely anyone can become enlightened, and activate
their DNA.
Chapter
Two: Diagnosis: Enlightenment
Arise,
shine, O children of Light!
For my Light is come upon thee,
And
thou shalr make the Glory of the Law
To rise upon the new
earth!
As
an individual evolves, it is perceived in the eyes of some as a form
of illness. Whereas the Light once cast into the DNA is a process
that once begun, never ends until full divination has occurred -- we
see that as certain people who used to control us, lose their grip,
they will run to their diagnoses in order to validate the change in
the individual. Often it will seem we require certain outlets, such
as a spiritual mentor, within which it is safe to talk about
evolution, DNA activation, and spirituality, because the person is
open minded, doesn't judge, but perceives our purpose, and our goal
of divination.
Here, we find the listener open minded, and
perceiving we are on the right path. They believe in us -- that we
have a soul, and the soul will be expressed freely without the
expectation of judgment. If one has a spiritual family member, this
may be pivotal in our growth. We may find some outlets, and in our
ascension process start building planetary advocacy groups, and
forming a spiritual network. We will learn, verily, that others in
Lightbody exist, further, others with permanent genetic mutations
exist, and we are not the sole-experiencers of the
extrasensory.
Perceived as "ontological terrorists"
for the powers that we possess, namely telepathy (direct non-local
thought-transferrence) -- it is thus seen that certain people will
work very hard to reduce the Lightworker to their own label, and
diagnosis. As my mutation is both tied into telepathy, and
schizophrenia,
it would seem the choice is mine -- to perceive myself as ill, or
enlightened. There are two roads before me, and the obvious choice is
ascension and the divination of my existence. Such that we endeavor
to "live our Light" -- express our beliefs with kind,
open-minded sources, allowing us to learn from other peoples unique
hue regarding the One Spirit, and how we essentially believe in the
same things.
We can never truly learn unless we are willing to
be changed by our fellow man -- and "it only takes two seconds
to believe in someone." There are many different styles,
classes, and archetypes of the human race -- and however born from
the same Source, it shall seem our oscillations into indifference
only make the journey back to the Source all the more worthwhile.
As
we may share details of our enlightenment with the wrong people,
finding the diagnosis, and the label used to reduce us to something
logical within their minds; we see they do not believe in the concept
of enlightenment, nor are they comfortable with the concept of DNA
activation. So it goes, in the spiritual life, we are to surround
ourselves with high vibrations which resonate with us at the highest
frequency -- and we inhibit ourselves with certain information, from
divine works of art, to the many enlightening texts that exist. We
endeavor to surround ourselves with "beauty and
information".
We shall find that there are safe places to
put our thoughts, and we will not always be judged for our
evolvement. There are sources that exist, within ones own location --
often in close proximity without realizing it. Interpolating our
thoughts into anothers mind, for the experience of a reaction that
will affect us in due process, we are always learning from one
another, and as it shall come to pass, that as we evolve, and come to
learn certain things, our greatest sources for knowledge will be our
fellow man.
"This
path is not walked in vain."
It
is to be expressed that as our vibration rises, and certain people
who used to control us lose their grip, we are entering into the life
of the perfect avatar self -- our actualized, most divine existence.
Here, within the enlightened thoughts that we possess, we are
enamored, feel "the presence" and can tell that we are
producing worthwhile memories, in the life of the self-divined soul.
As we are now in the New Age, at a pivotal point in human history, we
are coming to see that many are enlightened to that new strand in
DNA, and the controlling forces, our male-oriented society, which has
reigned supreme for so long, is in for a paradigm shift. Eventually,
we find a civilization of intuitive right-brain thinkers who operate
as based upon the Light that lies within, which is a logical
eventuality. People will not fear the expression of their beliefs,
but be open in their quest toward the highest Light, and we will
serve the "inner Light" -- the master that lies within, as
independents, as self-created individuals.
Through our own choice to see ourselves divined by the Light, in the New Age, we have incarnated at this hour to see ourselves enlightened by the concept of the life of value and purpose. There is always choice over what occurs in our life -- such that through the endurance of our Free Will, we will activate ourselves, writhing through proactive animation -- to rise in vibration through the power we possess -- and see to it that the environment is totally controlled, from crystal grid, to sacred objects.
In the sacred space, where we designate as our place for learning and self-renewal, it will be found that certain books, films, and works of art, further catalyze our growth, and further enamor us with a sense of confidence, and hope. We endeavor to "stay enamored" in a world of beauty and information -- always willing to flip to a random page in a book, and purposefully inhibiting ourselves with the Light of other souls. As we may find power in certain labels such as writer, or artist, or simply Lightworker, or evolutionist -- many titles and labels exist, but there is only One Spirit moving through us all -- and this is especially realized in light of the experience of telepathy.
As
seen through the ontological expressions of our power through such
means as telepathy, or telekinesis, we are regarded with fear, and
held in the minds of the consensus reality, as too much to
comprehend. We find that however unique we may be, it was through
solitude that we arrived at the same genius thoughts realized by so
many geniuses before us -- and we humbly realize that we are all the
same.
Yet through tones of uniqueness and indifference, the
purposeful individuating process, setting ourselves apart from the
rest of mankind, this oscillation into indifference only makes the
journey back to the Source all the more worthwhile. Through
uniqueness, we are brought closer to God, that through the profound
use of our imaginations to provide a world of uniqueness, and our own
special tint of Light in reference to All That Is, we are to see that
through creativity, and self-expression as artists, writers,
Lightworkers, evolutionists, and we grow as a result of our own
ability to teach ourselves. Become our own masters, educating
ourselves through the concept of a higher self, a soul, a spirit, a
"guide" -- we perceive, some of us, that there is an
archetypal energy associated with our evolution, and we can tap into
the higher self -- communicate with our soul directly, and find the
future is realized, and equalized into -- through the endurance of
our own prescient machinations -- that we are in the future tense,
set goals, and always feed the crockpot of our subconscious minds
with divine texts, art, and information -- ever-enamored with the
radiance of the unconditional Light.
The living environment,
of which thought and environment are entangled, we see that through
the inhibition of certain things, ranging from the comforting words
of a close friend, to the information found in channeled text -- that
we are always on a quest toward the fullest divination, and we hope
to activate ourselves, our natural inborn process of evolution,
through the inhibition of the concept of the living environment. It
shall be seen that through the Light which radiates through every
cell of our body, reality is directly manifested, and divine
knowledge just seems to come to us, instantaneously.
Many who
are in Lightbody experience the geometric shapes and patterns that
lie at the root of all human existence. As the subconscious mind is
most powerfully expressed through symbols, it may come to pass that a
symbol such as the caduceus, our own sigil, will come manifest
through the many processes involved. We will find a specific symbol
to relate to our evolution.
As some will not be pleased to
perceive your entrance into the world of the divine, but see a path
that accrues to grandiosity, and narcissism, they deduce that you are
not enlightened, but under the influence of a fabrication invented by
the mind. They believe, in their own logical deducements, that the
"dream of awakening" was merely a product of the
imagination, validating his or her own reality through the "belief"
in enlightenment. Through the invention of ones own perceived
entrance into the world of the divine, and the grip certain people
will lose on us -- watch as they run to their diagnoses. As the
consensus, and the church doesn't want to see people praying to the
master that lies within, but desire they rely on their own preset
systems of thought -- it is to be seen how threatening the concept of
a Lightworker/evolutionist is to some people, and how evolution in
itself seems to stand in the way of most organized thought. As we are
bound through a certain independence, of which we only serve
ourselves, as writhing through the proactive animation of our
indelible Free Will, it shall come to pass that our evolution is no
fabrication, and many of us including myself have experiences in the
extrasensory to validate the apparency of our genetic change.
Events
of the extrasensory, ranging from telepathy to telekinesis, we see
that it is to be found that through the interpolation into other
peoples thoughts -- as endowed with the living information, the
Light, our genetic mutation allows us to broadcast our thoughts into
the mass psyche through what is known as direct non-local
thought-transferrence. Here, thought is shared unto a singular
sentience, and all subjects "think together." In this
event, of which matter is obviously entangled, and thoughts travel by
the natural life-force thus possessed through the concept of living
information, as information is alive, it travels invariably. This
only blooms into further events such as teleportation which I will
describe later on.
Telepathy, as a result of the life force of
the living information that binds us, will come to be seen as
something we all used to do -- that the thought "remember,
remember, remember" was repeated in the mass psyche preceding my
first event of shared thought, suggesting that telepathy is an
archaic ability that all humans used to possess.
As I have experienced direct non-local thought transferrence about a dozen times, with three outstanding examples that stand out from the rest of the experiences, I have come to believe that as a result of my genetic mutation, that once unused ninety percent of my brain is now being activated. In the highest levels of Lightbody, to which it is theorized that there are a total of twelve levels to Lightbody -- we all find these powers, I believe, and I theorize that telepathy is going to become the future in communication. Here, as we are to be seen as pure, idealistic, and hopeful, safety resides in the concept of shared thought knowing our inclinations are geared toward the highest Light, and the ontological expression of thought-transferrence, as an ability we all used to possess -- this may be an interaction of a drug mixed with that of ones mutated DNA -- but my most profound experience in telepathy was experienced in Two Cats restaurant, in 2011, with a pair of total strangers, without the influence of any drug.
I enjoyed having my thoughts read, and I soared through my most natural, imaginative creativity -- entertaining the two girls with my thoughts. Once they were "finished with me" thus inhibiting me with the belief that the changes I am awareized in the mind of other Lightworkers -- and through the experience with the two girls to whom I refer to as "angelworkers" I am invariably guided to believe that the extrasensory is a result of my activated DNA, and I am awareized in the minds of others to whom are in Lightbody.
Tapping into the unused portion of the brain, thus employed, we are to see the change in our genetic structure is given evidence of the thought that the changes are real, in light of the extrasensory, and we are truly are evolving.
There is a perfect counterpart to every soul, the greatest conceivable relationship for ones soul-growth, and this relationship will come manifest through the endurance of believing it to occur. Synchronized into existence through the admission of believing in ones self, and knowing that we are all worthwhile players in the show of evolution -- we all have a purpose, a unique Light to relay back to the Source -- and we shall find our place, and it will come to pass that we find ourselves involved in the highest relationships, surrounded by fellow believers, and fully under the belief that these changes within our DNA structure are real.
Events of the extrasensory work to solidify our beliefs, as these which are direct evidence of the change will only serve to catalyze, ontologically, the growth in others. As enlightenment is not a concept that has truly reached the masses, it will come to pass that as we are moving into the Age of Aquarius, a time for learning and self-renewal, that we have much to learn from our fellow Lightworker, and these stellar souls are the next step in human evolution, our link toward future advancement. As we are entering into a re-vitalized civilization of intuitive, right-brain thinkers, of which there will be no fear in sharing of ones beliefs, but it shall come to pass that many are enlightened by the knowledge -- of the living information -- that we are One, a collective, moving together into the world of the new; enlightenment is a blessing, not a disease, and it is the reason we all came to be alive.
It
will come to pass that many are enlightened by the ontological
expressions, and the powers of the extrasensory only serve as
evidence of the change. Through our right-brained thinking society of
dreamers and evolutionists that shall come to pass in time to come,
it will seem that the events of the extrasensory become a widespread
phenomenon, as many are tapping into the formerly unused ninety
percent of their brains. This is human evolution, a process of which
is catalyzed by the expressions of those we know -- that there is
an
indelible, pure, universal system behind all of this, and we may tap
into the same enlightened thoughts once reached by so many an
ascended master before us. Energy is infinite, it recycles itself,
and travels from one body to the next through the powers of our
expressions -- and as we are all energy, producing electricity with
our thoughts affecting our bodies made of water, we are always
manifesting our own realities with the thoughts that we possess. In
Lightbody, our reality becomes more directly manifested by the
thoughts which we possess, and our karma becomes active.
Our
Light will come to be expressed, we will have no fear in sharing our
beliefs, and it will come to pass, as understood by the masses, as
witnessed through events of the extrasensory, that enlightenment is a
reality -- it occurs invariably, and it is the purpose and goal of
all human life. This is a blessing, a gift, of which we shall see our
ontological expressions catalyze the shift in other minds -- as we
all guide one another, invariably, we are all guides to some degree.
We work for the sake of evolvement through the continuum, the
endurance of power found in the collective, and the final belief
system of Light and universality. In our future civilization of
right-brained intuitive thinkers, we will come to share our deepest
vacillations, and self-concepts for the benefit in growth in others.
It will be expressed, that we are imaginative, and creators of
infinite, machinetic grace -- we are creators of our own destiny, all
in event toward the final return to the Source. Perceiving the
beginning -- the big bang -- to the end -- the return to the Source
-- and what lies in-between, the infinitude of the human imagination.
Evolution invariably occurs as a direct result of the natural
processes of time, and this is eventually realized by all of us. We
all have the capacity to tap into the unused portions of our brain,
to find powers of the extrasensory, and know, verily, that we are the
shift -- we are the prophecy, and evolution is found by the power of
the Light that lies within.
Chapter
Three: The Free Endless Resource
Up!
Rise up and roll along!
Thou immortal, shining,
Swift-steeded
Angel of Sun!
Above the mountains!
Produce Light for the
world!
What
is a Lightworker..?
A Lightworker is simply someone who cares
about the planet, the living Earth, and works toward the greater good
of the catalyzed awakening of his fellow man. In a sense, we are all
Lightworkers who believe in divination, and human evolution. This
which is just a label, which is simply used to align ourselves with
the power of our beliefs -- we simply employ the label as means for
activating the theme of our beliefs into the form of what expressions
we have come to see. It is my belief that through the Light we are
become telepathic, and in the highest levels of Lightbody, I humbly
realize may be a great stretch of the imagination -- but as I am
governed by experience, and I have experienced it in a near-death
experience, I believe through the endurance of the Light, we are also
become capable of teleportation.
As this "new resource"
is nothing new at all, but simply energy that has always existed --
we know that our bodies are made up of a majority of water, a
conductor, and our thoughts produce electricity which effect our
bodies in turn. Through the endurance of a risen DNA strand, in which
we find the powers of the extrasensory, it will come to pass that
these new abilities are something we all used to possess, and once we
have tapped into the formerly unused ninety percent of our brains, we
shall see the endless, free energy resource of the energy generated
by our souls.
Fueled by the soul, living in symbiosis with
the planet Earth, we are become a class 3 civilization, and thus
potentially re-integrated into the Cosmic Family, with all the many
races that exist within the universe. The future which lies in store
as a result of our divination, as a result of re-discovering the free
endless resource of the photons emitted from our DNA, it shall come
to pass that a convert is employed which transfers the soul-energy,
directly, into the body of the Earth, creating a frequency between
thought and environment -- which only results in the risen vibration,
that our home, the living Earth, mother Gaia, is moving into a higher
dimension, taking all her inhabitants with her.
Theoretically,
we will use portals to teleport from one end of the Earth to the
next, and as I have already achieved teleportation once, in this
life, I am primed to believe these events will reach the masses in
time to come.
The
teleportive event, which was a near-death experience, involved being
nearly hit by a car, of which I was walking alone at night on a
spiritual quest, with no money and no plan, anchoring my ability to
see through the headlights of the passing cars. This is a stretch of
the imagination, but the reader is nonetheless expected to believe
that it was totally instinct to run in the direction of the car that
was coming towards me -- I felt as though I were in my body the whole
time, but it would seem I was not always in the path of the moving
vehicle. I found myself in a new location, safe from the crazed
driver, and entirely enamored with a certain catharsis of awareness,
because I knew I had just been re-located through the teleportive
event. Of course, others perceive it was a memory lapse, or
hallucination -- only I know the truth.
Through this, and the
realized concept of "Light convergence”. As I teleported
near-collision, and re-materialized, bodily, to which I believe I was
a few yards from the car, the "convergence of Light" -- of
my illumined DNA, in convergence with the Light emitted from the
headlights of the car, merged, causing the time-space continuum to be
folded, and thus teleport, time-travel further up the street, safe
from the crazed driver, survived by the Light of my mutated DNA. I
have come to discover one method for teleportation through experience
alone. And it is Light convergence.
I know this is hard to believe, but I expect only open-mindedness, that I am not making this up, my story involving teleportation occurred almost a year ago to this day, of which one beliefs are invariably tested -- we see this may be the future in transportation, as found through self-contained vehicles that travel through the convergence of Light. Here, we perceive the teleportation machine as based upon a track, of which a spotlight is attached to a cart at the opposite end of the track. The subject is located on the opposite side, which will move along with the opposite Light at a relative speed, going from about forty miles per hour, to a complete stop, at a stopping distance of approximately one foot. This resulting in the convergence of Light, the bending of the time-space continuum, and thus: teleportation.
This
which is to be seen as the future in human transportation, is to be
found that we are self-contained vehicles, and once all humans are
endowed with the primordial ability of teleportation, we will be
teleconnected, the entire Earth brought together, in which we are
able to be in one place, with a certain group of friends, and then to
the very opposite end of the Earth, somewhere else, with another
group. We will be “teleconnected” through this, and as
such, find that our connection with one another is wholly
improved.
This may strike the heart as profound, or simply far
into the future -- but I believe teleconnection of the human race is
possible, and that through the free endless resource of the Light of
our illumined DNA, we will fuel ourselves, our bodies, the Earth,
with the energy of the Light -- that the soul-body will shine
through, and we are living the greatest conceivable life imaginable.
Teleportation is not as rare as people think, as there are many
reports from ex-government officials, especially regarding the
Philadelphia Experiment, that teleportation is achievable, and this
power is something many Lightworkers in the highest levels of
Lightbody, are starting to uncover. Through the concept of "Light
convergence" I believe that we can teleport, and through the
near-collision of the convergence of Light, of that of our illumined
DNA, in conjunction with that of the oncoming Light, re-location
occurs instantaneously, and here, we imagine ourselves in the new
location -- for example: from Bar Harbor, Maine, in the United
States, to Chiba City, Japan.
The imagined destination is held
within the mind -- and we "imagine ourselves into the new
location." An XYZ Locator may be employed, which is a crystal
perhaps amethyst or rose quartz, which is held up to the brow
chakra/third eye, and programmed with the destination. This crystal
is either held or worn around the neck, and will be carried with us
in our travels . . . I perceive, through the advent of shutting down
the space program, potentially in light of how the universe is in
essence just a massive hologram -- teleportation is something NASA,
and various other researchers, are coming to find is going to become
a widespread reality in all futurity to come. As I have already
teleported through my body alone, such that the clothes I was
wearing, and all objects I was holding, teleported along with me --
it is thus theorized that teleportation, as a result of Light
convergence, discovered through instinct, the concept of "running
towards the Light" was realized through my own intuition, and
was
entirely instinctive, and this is no fabrication.
“Through
teleportation, telepathy, and the teleconnection of the human race as
bound by the free endless resource of the Light of our DNA, we will
be self-fueled, self-contained vehicles for travel, expression, and
proactive animation.” This
may lie far into the future, but as the writer of this text has
himself already experienced the events of telepathy and
teleportation, as well as one instance of telekinesis, the evidence
is mounting that one is not alone in this quest, but other
Lightworkers are discovering the same truth about the free endless
resource.
As the Lightworkers are the fuel, and belief is our
mode for self-advancement, finding ourselves self-actualized to the
perfect avatar self, once we become teleporters, collectively, and
all humans are brought together -- teleconnected -- all races, all
civilizations, all cultures, will be brought together under One
Unitive Light -- the great party of souls realized, as we find no
more need to work for energy, or rely on limited resources, but exist
as based upon the photons emitted from the Light of our DNA.
As
I am one of the few believers in this idea, of which I have reached
the deducement through experience, the concept of Light convergence,
I am only under the belief -- the faith -- that this will come to
pass as a future of which teleconnection presents only deeper
possibilities, through our human advancements; and that through
harnessing the Light of the photons emitted from our DNA, we will
live in symbiosis with the Earth, outmode the use of certain physical
technology, and find ourselves within the deepest conveivable future
as a result. The free endless resource is a matter that lies within,
of which we fuel ourselves -- by the Light -- and Light it shall come
to pass, is the true energy which has always been lying beneath the
diaphanous walls of the third dimension -- as something we were bound
to tap into, discover, and realize, as the free endless resource.
This is one belief within the plethora of many, and I am merely
presenting a possibility as based upon direct experience.
Chapter
Four: Aliens Among Us
"Oh!
that my young life were a lasting dream!
My spirit not awak'ning
till the beam
Of an eternity shall bring the morrow.
Yes! tho'
that long dream were of hopeless sorrow,
'T were better than the
cold reality
Of waking life, to him whose heart must be,
And
hath been still, upon the lovely earth,
A chaos of deep passion,
from his birth.
-- E. A. Poe
As we are now in the New Age, and the human race is advancing, it is coming to our awareness of a certain influence that has come to us, seemingly, from a foreign source. What are known as starseeds, and walk-ins, have come to arrive on the scene with their universality, and seemingly natural understand of reality and how it works. Wearing the human body, as the soul is amorphous and can take on any form, the body is used as a vehicle for their expression. They have come to incarnate on the Earth at this pivotal point in human growth to act as guides and catalysts for change. Often bound by a "mission of the mind" they are bound by a certain purpose which is born from the soul, and the goal is human evolution. The many races that exist, are many, but as we have come to find, there are some specific groups that are now working with us. Hannah Beaconsfield claims to have had multiple extraterrestrial souls inhabit her body, and many reports of extraterrestrial souls, as experienced on other worlds, are greatly detailed in the book "Other Worlds, Other Lives" by Brad Steiger. In the book, it was found in past-life regression therapy, that with some subjects, their history extends beyond the Earth.
Philip
K. Dick who wrote about the phylogenic memory packets released upon
enlightenment, was a starseed, and was even so bold as to suggest he
came from a race that "crash landed" to Earth in the past.
He openly suggested that he was born from a foreign source, and much
of his beliefs are contained within the Exegesis of Philip K. Dick.
-- As Philip K. Dick had a natural understanding of the universe, and
was a prophet to some degree, and we see clear evidence of his genius
contained within the works, the evidence is found within his
high-charged thought-patterns. As starseeds have existed throughout
history, and it is theorized that DaVinci himself was an
extraterrestrial, as well as many other artists, writers, and
renaissance men, it has come to pass that we have been influenced by
the E.T.'s throughout history, that we are invariably "guided"
by their influence, and they have always been here, pointing us in
the right direction.
In 1987 during an event referred to as
the "Harmonic Convergence" which was an event prophesized
by the Mayans, a time when the human race would, collectively, on a
subconscious level, acknowledge the existence of other life. I was
two years old at this time, had seen no movies, read no books, and
heard nothing about the concept of extraterrestrials. I barely had an
identity, yet, in the "abduction dream" which recurred in
my infancy, I would find myself in a very strange place, a massive
dome-like auditorium . . . and a mysterious figure in the distance.
Upon noticing the figure, he/she would teleport right in front of me,
the pale, expressionless, noseless face nearly touching my own,
staring endlessly into my infant eyes. I would wake up from the
"dream" feeling as though it were entirely real, and I have
been haunted by that "face" for the entirety of my life.
Allegedly, a subconscious agreement is made prior to abduction, and
ones free will is never taken advantage of. As I was only two years
old, only fresh into my human existence, I must have been in a state
for which my subconscious was in the most open, and accepting state
at that perceived window of my life. Needless to say, the dream
occurred, I was inhibited, and I have shared this information with
very few people. Where is the logic in such a thing..? Who is truly
responsible..?
The mystery resounds, and I continue to wonder,
but I do have some inkling of the truth . . .
A race known as the Zeta Reticuli, I theorize, were responsible for my abduction. They are a mass mind of clones who refer to themselves as "one people" who all look, act, and behave the exact same. In the book "Visitors From Within" it is heavily detailed how involved the Zeta's have been in our advancements, and it is theorized that they exchange technology with our government, in exchange for experimenting on certain humans. As their civilization ended due to their lack of individuality, they would travel to the Earth, eventually, and come to learn from the humans, and how to become more individualistic. The Zeta Reticuli are probably one of the most well-known races of extraterrestrials, and it is theorized that their evolution, and ours, is tied together. Much can be learned from this concept of a race of clones, who all think and operate the same, suggestive that the universe will work to produce reflections of the primordial spark of universality, and sameness, that would result in such a race as the Zeta Reticuli.
As we are now in the recess of the New Age, at this seemingly pivotal point in our growth and understanding, it has come to pass that many are now endeavoring into what is known as "channeled writing." Here, we see through such channels as Tuella, Eric Klein, Beaconsfield, Rachele, Royal, and Marciniak, that information which seems to bear a universal tone, come from sources ranging from Pleiadian, to Sirian, all the way to the concept of a race who live on Venus, that we are not aware of as they exist at a higher vibratory frequency than us. In "stepping down their vibrations" it is found that transmissions from these races will come to be expressed through certain individuals. The Zeta Reticuli, who channel much in the book "Visitors From Within" allegedly communicate through a computer, that translates their thoughts into the English language, and is thus transmitted into the psyche of the channel. Referred to as a matter of telepathy, certain hosts for higher dimensional frequency will, through meditation, often in group meditations with others present, delve into the cosmic Source, of which we are capable, theoretically, of channeling any one of the many ascended masters, and accordingly, through belief, anyone in Lightbody is capable of channeling.
In
the book "Archangels and Ascended Masters" by Doreen
Virtue, a complete list of many of the channeled guides is given, and
the text details how these energies can be called into our waking
life. It is possible, however perceived as far-fetched to perceive we
would be guided by a voice that is transmitted through the ether;
much discernment must be utilized, and there are a number of channels
who only channel low, sub-astral thought-forms, who believe they are
channeling divine wisdom, but in truth are merely recyling the matter
around them into the illusory conception of being something new,
while in truth they are merely channeling a thought form. Thought
forms are energy aggregates left in the environment through the
densification of a thought that is repeated. Through the energy
aggregates left behind, it has come to pass that the ideas, beliefs,
and notions once cogitated leave an etheric residue in the
environment which can be channeled into the open, revealing
everything from details of the future, to totally worthless
information. As there are people who claim themselves to be channels
for divine wisdom, who are merely transferring thought forms from the
environment, we result in the class of people for which are only
taking the New Age for their own selfish gain, and I have seen much
of this.
Perceived, many refer to the book "Opening To
Channel" by Sanaya Roman, which is used by many to reach into
the higher dimensions. Here, a channeled text that is in itself about
channeling, we invite the possibility of contacting a guide (to which
every soul has a guide associated with) -- often finding a certain
name to attribute to this energy, and through the name, thus, draw
the energy out. Here through meditation, we will endeavor to either
write, or type, in a effortless manner that is continuous,
streaming-consciousness. As we do this, eventually, we may find a
certain universality to our thoughts, of which we are now capable of
channeling divine principle. The book "Cosmic Continuum" by
Ernest L. Norman was entirely dictated, meaning recorded through
voice first, and then translated into text. The text refers to energy
as waveforms that travel through the continuum, and does much in its
offering of universality to suggest that we can tap into the Akasha,
a guide, or some universal source, through effortless dictation, and
thus produce amazing, evolutionary works. The book "Eureka"
by Edgar Allan Poe was also dictated, and is based upon his lectures
on the universe. The text represents some of the earliest form of
channeling, and does much to invite us to believe Poe was aligned
with certain E.T. influences.
Jane Roberts, who channels the
spirit-entity known as Seth, has produced over a dozen books that are
channeled, and has represented one of our most humble modern mystics,
who would through seance, communicate with Seth, and transfer divine
cosmic principles regarding everything from the nature of reality,
the nature of the soul, to our relationship with mass events, and the
true nature of the psyche. Seth represents one of the first guides to
arrive on the scene, which took place mostly in the seventies. His
wisdom is infinite, and the many books channeled by Roberts, namely
"Seth Speaks" are a well-spring for universal
information.
The "Starseed Transmissions" by Ken
Karey, is one stellar example of some of the earliest channeled text,
which is not entirely descriptive of the source to which the
information arose, but I have my theories it is extraterrestrial.
Written just before 1980, it represents one of the first well-known
channeled documents, a short and easy read, that may be the right
channeled text to open ones self to that world. Later, we would
eventually find some people who wish to remain anonymous, that
channel a space-entity referred to as Ashtar.
Tuella
is the primary channel for Ashtar, and these beings who allegedly
exist at a higher vibratory state, who use Venus as their home-base,
are within several starships which exist at a higher vibration, such
that our machines and technology aren't capable of detecting them. I
draw much Light from the concept of the Ashtar Command, but I have my
doubts. The information is generally uplifting, but the doom and
gloom of some channeled text causes us to veer away. In the book
"Project World Evacuation" by Tuella, channeled through
Ashtar, is suggestive of many things, and as the title suggests,
which seems to run along the same lines as the rapture -- strikes
most hearts as fantastical, and hard to believe. However, Project
World Evacuation still contains deep insights, and is not to be
ignored however "much" it may strike the heart. Other books
by Tuella, such as Cosmic Telepathy, are rife with some of the most
profound universal principles, and much can be learned. Other books
such as Portals and Corridors by the Whitneys, suggest a plethora of
advanced races, and seems to even possess aesthetic depictions of
some of the many creatures. In the end, we must use discernment, and
not all can be appreciated as enlightened thought.
Channeled
text, as born from many who are in Lightbody, is a result of our
evolution. This subconscious primer, the belief thus germinated with
the seed of the evidence of their divine thought-patterns, we are
preparing ourselves . . . we are readying for integration. There will
be a time in our human history, when we find ourselves in league with
the plethora of advanced souls. What I refer to as the "Cosmic
Family" otherwise described as the galactic federation, is the
joining of many ascended masters, E.T.'s and evolutionists, all
working toward the collective end of peace, and harmonic convergence.
We seek to be a part of the council, to have our say in the universe.
Further, we hope to explore the deepest reaches of outer space, and
employ our own volition, and free will, to act as extraterrestrials
in our own right. In a sense, we are alien to them, just as they are
alien to us. However, we are all
born
from the same Source, and this truth which shall infect many minds
with the concept of the One Spirit, is clearly evidenced in
thought-transferrence. As I was under the influence of the altered
state, transmitting my thoughts telepathically, I would channel in my
own right, the spirit of one of my past-lives, and describe how the
universe is a "unisphere" with curved walls that "fluctuate
with our attainment of new information." The channeling was
detailed, and hopeful, and I would discuss much about cells, and how
the "unisphere" is made up of them. I channeled that humans
are all unique "styles" and the concept that it is through
our indifference, and uniqueness, that essentially brings us closer
together in the end.
The world of channeling is still new to
us, and for what information may be drawn from the many entities,
extraterrestrials, and ascended masters, we are learning of
information that seems to agree, from one source to the next, as
bound through a certain universal tone of knowledge. Personally, my
favorite channeled book I have ever read was "The Prism of Lyra"
by Lyssa Royal, which details heavily into the history of many races
within the universe, starting with the Lyrans, who were theoretically
the first settlers of the Earth, to the development of other races as
the Sirians, Pleiadians, and Zeta Reticuli. The Prism of Lyra is
written with a factual tone, and states things as though they are
entirely real. The universal tone of the text, and message contained,
is invariably uplifting, and through the knowledge we learn through
such channeled text, we are being invited, prepared, for communion.
Communion,
intervention, the "landing of the ships" -- God knows -- we
have so many fictions, and fabrications, that it is almost impossible
to grasp the concept of a real living, actual "space entity."
We have been desensitized to believe that aliens are only a figment
of the imagination, however miraculous the collective gravity of our
triad sun, moon, and Earth, arrangement, with the Earth seemingly the
perfect distance from the sun -- how this world could come to exist
so marvelously, and be the only one, is nothing short of absurd. We
can't
be alone, there must be a meaning to life, and the thought of other
life existing in the universe only gifts us with the furtherance of
belief, hope, and the idea that life has meaning -- that we have much
to learn from the many races that exist. As we become a class 3
civilization that lives in symbiosis with the Earth as governed by
the free endless resource of the Light of our DNA, it shall come to
pass, verily, that we find integration, and are finally re-united
with our brethren from the stars.
Chapter
Five: Universality
"Father,
put your words in order before me."
The
concept of universality, absolutes, and the belief that there is an
underlying cosmic truth, behind all things, is invariably tapped into
by the Lightworker. Here, we endeavor to think in terms of
universality, that our thoughts are the same thoughts once cogitated
by many an ascended master, and we are aligned with the energy of the
higher self.
Through our own natural prescience, and ability
to project the mind into the future -- through tones of universality,
it shall come to be seen that we are able to peer into the Akashic
Records -- the Akashic Records -- which is the metaphysical
storehouse of all thoughts and events within a given locale. A
profound concept, and Einstein, who was a high-charged thinker,
received his knowledge about relativity in an instantaneous burst of
insight which I believe to have been born from the Akashic Records.
Edgar Cayce, who was known as the "sleeping prophet" would
actively delve into the Akashic Records, finding the records of a
subjects soul, view them, and thus relay them back to the group. As
the principle will resound . . .
"Light
is Information, Information is the matter which composes the
universe, Information is alive, and this Living Information will
travel and be expressed through a natural result of the life-force
possessed.”
As
a natural result of timing and synchronicity, the world of absolutes
will find the Lightworker. Here, through universality, operating in
terms of which we are aligned with cosmic principle, we may channel a
guide, or otherwise peer into the depths of the Akasha. Anyone who
dreams, or has an imagination, is in relationship with the Akasha,
and many who find themselves elocuting beautiful words, and speech,
will actively channel things from the Akashic Records without even
realizing it . . . as information is alive, and we see clear evidence
of this in the experience of thought-transferrence. I would operate
through tones of universality, in my own right, as a Lightworker, the
depths of information thus peered into, it would become natural for
me to channel information about cells, and the physical universe, the
image of the whole perceived as what I refer to as the "unisphere"
because I was operating through universal principle.
Through
the creative act of writing, and other forms of self-expression, it
will be evidenced that we are able to perfect our thoughts in the
form of lyrics, poetry, and prose, by truncating the lines,
re-working the thoughts, and thus re-shaping our cogitations to that
which we most prefer. As the title of "writer" in reference
to how conscious thought is composed of words, is a powerful title to
wear, we see that through the theme of such a title, that it affords
us the ability to channel universal principle, and we are aligned
with our soul-energy. Scribe is another powerful title that ties into
conscious thought. In essence, the soul wants to breathe and flow
effortlessly, and whence we are aligned with the energy of the soul
-- it will come to pass that universal principle is natural to us.
There is
an
inborn, Akashic truth to all things -- there is
a
universality -- further, there is only One Spirit and thus, only one
real belief system. Finding the inborn truth of the nature of things
is possible for anyone in Lightbody, and as we move into the highest
levels of Lightbody, to which there are allegedly twelve different
levels, it will come to pass as natural that we start to operate
through universal principle.
In finding universality to our
thoughts, we are to see that there is a certain unique rhythm behind
our cogitations. Here, we move into the world of study of ones
thoughts as reduced to a number -- through the concept of thought
syllabation. In this, a thought will naturally occur, and then we
will count up the syllables of the thought which just occurred,
arriving at a certain number, for example: eight. Here, we will
imagine the number in our minds eye, and potentially repeat it in our
heads -- in order to solidify, and densify into a more tangible
matter. In densifying ones thoughts through the concept of thought
syllabation, we will find a certain self-awareness, and control over
our thoughts as reduced to a mere number. This will be used in
meditation, that naturally-occurring thoughts possess a certain
syllabic intonation, to which all thoughts are invariably reduced to
a number within our minds. Thought syllabation, a matter of
understanding ones thoughts through syllabic tones -- is one form of
self-awareness that will come to pass as one of the many means for
understanding the natural rhythm of ones thoughts.
The
concept of word-vibrations is to be found through the natural adding
up of the numerical values for each letter, such that A = 1, B = 2, C
= 3, etc. As the subconscious mind is a natural adding machine, we
already pick out the vibrations naturally, but understanding how this
works will only enhance our subconscious processes. The subconscous
mind naturally picks out the vibrations of the patternless array, and
is always reading into the natural vibration of a thought just
cogitated. Here, with a thought such as "I am divine Light".
For each letter is a number, and we add up the numerical values of
each letter, as such: 9 + 1 + 13 + 4 + 9 + 21 + 9 + 14 + 5 + 12 + 7 +
8 + 20 = 132, to which the subconscious mind naturally adds the
resulting numbers of the number 132, to 1 + 3 + 2 resulting in 6,
which is divided into three, leaving the phrase of “I am Divine
Light” which a vibration of “three.”
Through
the natural understanding of how the subconscious mind naturally adds
things together, resulting in the thought-vibration, this process
naturally operates through its own volition, and it is simply
believed that by understanding the vibration-deducing adding machine
of the subconscious mind, we better actualize ourselves toward the
understanding of our thoughts. As all thoughts produce the energy
aggregates known as thought forms, it shall come to be seen that
through the repeated endurance of the new, a seemingly "new
thought" that is unique unto itself, we writhe through the
natural poetics, and vibrational frequency of the new thought. In the
world of universality, it shall come to pass that the future is in
our hands, and we are always manifesting our realites through the
thoughts that we possess; as we work for the collective evolution of
the human race -- by existing for the collective, we are rewarded
with certain things. As universality will be found in our enlightened
thoughts, to which we pray to the Akasha, and dredge cosmic truths
from the recordbook of our souls, we are in the process of existing
in the highest Light -- finding the perfect avatar self through the
understanding of absolutes, that there is a permeating truth behind
all matter, and this universality will be understood.
Through the subconscious mind, and the goal-oriented processes involved, we are always "deducing" our way through reality, as the subconscious mind is an adding machine which always resides in the present tense; -- such that the subconscious mind literally has no sense of the past or future, but resides infinitely in the now. Here, within the recess of the "living moment" -- we endeavor to feel the presence of God, and know that our thoughts are the most Light-based cogitations.
Just as Einstein received his knowledge about relativity in an instantaneous burst of insight, it shall come to pass that the same experience of cosmic truth finds itself integrated into the life of the Lightworker. Universal principle, as repeatedly endured through history through so many shamans, and mystics, is a thought which has already been cogitated by many an ascended master, as there is really only One Spirit -- and only One Truth -- that of the incarnation system, the system of karmic responsibility, and the cycling of matter through the continuum. All of these things, and more, that there are simply some truths that never change -- and whence found in Lightbody, we start to become in touch with these cosmic truths.
So
we perceive the concept of universality, that there is an underlying
truth through the One Spirit which moves through everything. Belief
in the existence of the Akasha, and the thought that we can peer into
the radiant depths of human history, as a universal source, can be
learned from. Through the endurance of high-charged thought-patterns
of universality found in some meditations, it is to be discovered
that we peer into the depths of the universe, and draw Light from the
universal source of the Akashic Records. "A
metaphysical storehouse of all events and thoughts within a given
locale", living
information, which travels through the force of its own Light. As all
thoughts are energy, and we invariably gravitate new knowledge into
our lives with each passing day, we are always learning, always
growing, through the epiginetics, and belief in belief itself -- we
find that the concept of universality affords us a sense of peace,
fortitude, and longevity. That through the Akashic, we can peer into
the depths of human knowledge, and come to produce divine
masterpieces of enlightened thought. Enlightened thought, as a result
of our evolution, as bound by universal principle, as mystics, we
continue to search -- and this search will absolutely never end . .
.
Chapter Six:
Thought Forms and Thought Vibrations
"Before
there was language, there were numbers."
As
suggested, all thoughts, through repetition, produce the energy
aggregates known as "thought forms." The residue of thought
left on the environment, which lingers like a ghost, to which we may
find ourselves performing tasks, and living, as based upon
pre-conceived thought forms. With the evolution of thought, we hope
to produce thought forms that are so powerful, they act like standing
waves the emanate through the environment. Invariably, one thought
leads to the next -- "in-var-i-ab-ly
one-thought-leads-to-the-next" -- eleven symbols, we thus repeat
the number, imagine it within our minds eye, and densify the thought
through the syllables thus contained. This method, psychologically
suggestive of a certain power over ones thoughts through the concept
of an underlying rhythm as found through syllabation, we are always
"intonating" thoughts within our minds, always gravitating
things toward us through the thoughts that we possess. As we are all
unique reflections of the One True Light, invariably separate through
the astrological, cognitive, and spiritual archetypes -- we each
represent a "style" -- we each represent an important part
of the mass hologram, such that as within every cell of the human
body contains the holographic image of the whole, so it shall seem
all Lightworkers are microcosmic reflections of the holographic
totality of God. This may strike the heart as profound, but as we
move through this life -- and human evolution, always continuing to
grow, always continuing to learn, we perceive the end -- the return
to the Source -- and the beginning, the big bang -- 13.75 billion
years ago -- that there is a middle ground which is governed by the
imagination, and so it goes, studies have proven that when a subject
is hooked up to an EEG and sees an image directly, and then shuts
their eyes to imagine the same image -- the same parts of the brain
light up, suggesting that the imagination/subconscious mind can not
tell the difference between what it sees and what it remembers. We
truly define our own realities. And our present choices actively
create the future.
As we come to produce thought forms through
the theme of evolution, and continuous growth, we are going to find a
meaning to the numbers, the syllabic intonations, and very much as
seen through the reference as ones self as a writer, or artist,
creator, or simply "expressor" -- through such a theme,
such a title, we relate our conscious thoughts to the
word-vibrations, intonations, syllabations, and the unique rhythm
found therein. I believe through the simple act of referring to ones
thoughts as numbers as found through the simple act of counting the
syllables of thoughts which naturally occur, we enter into a certain
rhythm, that the consequenting thought such as "this is a new
thought" -- five syllables, we repeat the thought, become
enamored with its syllabation, find ourselves enamored with the
living moment, residing in perfect cognitive rhythm, and accordingly,
we all have a certain rhythm, and certain intonations that most
benefit our growth.
Through my own experience with thought
syllabation, I find a certain self-awareness in the act of reducing a
thought to a number -- a symbol that glows within the mind. Before
there was language, there were numbers, and theoretically we
originally communicated through intonation, and syllabic tones alone.
There is a primordial rhythm, essentially, behind all thought -- a
certain metronomic ticking which exists behind all thought -- that we
perceive there is
a
rhythm to our thoughts, and we can tap into it through syllabation.
Through the addition of the numbers, by the natural goal-oriented
processes of the subconscious mind; and the belief in numerology; and
word-vibrations, we hope to understand the conclusion we invariably
reach through this rhythm, and we are always working toward some form
of conclusion.
The
subconscious mind is goal-oriented, and is like a crockpot always
working on certain ideas, always working toward some goal, or
realization. In finding the unique rhythm to our thoughts through the
endurance of counting the tones, the syllables of the thought, and
finding that number to which the rhythm is found, what thought occurs
next, in due consequence, will also be reduced to a number -- and all
of these numbers exist in a living matrix which is governed through a
natural mathematical force of which vibrations, and frequencies
relate through their own unique design. We invariably deduce meaning
through the adding machine of the subconscious, we will arrive at
certain truths, certain knowledge, and be enlightened by our own
unique ability to cogitate a rhythmic thought-pattern. We are always
providing ourselves with conclusions, and the ever-realized "final
analysis" of which through acts of meditation, and the
understanding of the rhythm of ones thoughts, we are to become
actualized to the greatest rate, the greatest frequency, and rise,
rise, rise, in vibration, until at last, we are unto the greatest
rhythm, we "ride our thoughts" and feel wholly enamored by
the primordial rhythm.
We all possess a certain understanding
of the meaning of each number, and through the endurance of
self-awareness and the reduction of ones thoughts to a mere number, a
certain rhythm, it will come to pass that we learn of the meaning,
behind the natural rhythm of our thoughts. Ever-computing the
numbers, the rhythm, counting the intonations of our thoughts, we
become enamored with the universal rhythm, and find the power of
synchronicity, timing, and the goal-oriented processes involved, to
always be leading up to a new, never-before-cogitated thought. Such
that "the walls of the universe fluctuate with our attainment of
new information" -- to the even deeper conclusion that thought
and environment are entangled, and if there is an inborn rhythm to
our thoughts, there must be a rhythm to the environment as well.
The
Earth revolves around the sun, the moon revolves around the Earth,
and within the center of our galaxy lies the blackhole of Sagittarius
A. Our galaxy is a spiral, which is governed through its own
celestial rhythm, of rotation, centrifugal force, and gravitation --
that our planet is alive, moves, breathes, undulates, and flows
through the natural rhythm it possesses -- is a movement that is held
up through the triad -- of Earth, Moon, and Sun -- and through the
triad, and the movements of the heavenly bodies, that the Earth is
rotating at 70 miles per hour -- we do not feel this, and yet, the
rhythm of the planet continues on, as there is a rhythm to our
thoughts, there is a rhythm to the environment, and our clocks are
based upon the rise and fall of the sun. On a more deeper, profound
level, in relationship to the concept of the rhythm of the galaxy,
the Mayans who were mathematical geniuses, observed this rhythm in
the procession of the equinoxes, and the 26,000 year cycle governed
by what are referred to as baktuns, specified units of time that
relate to the totality of movements of the heavenly bodies, in
relationship to our evolution, and growth within the universe.
Finding the rhythm, and tapping into the natural heartbeat of the
galaxy, the Mayans were aware that their calendar would end, and
start all over again, eventually, and they consciously mapped out the
time when this would occur.
As a result of the prophecy, the starseeds, Lightworkers, and walk-ins have arrived at the ecliptic hour -- and we are seeing that through epiginetics, the rhythm of our thoughts, and the concept of the living environment -- we are evolving into a certain rhythm, and we are learning that there is a natural rhythm to all things. As such, there is a rhythm to human evolution through the cycles of time, that we are infinitely renewed, all in event toward the realization of one-consciousness, nirvana, and the eventual return to the Source.
I refer often to the "return to the Source" but what is really imagined, when we endeavor to produce such a thought..? Through the return to the Source, the return to unity, and one-consciousness, it is perceived that we are divined, body, mind, and soul, to the most profound rhythm that exists, which is of the creator gods, Elohims, governing the entirety of the universe. Theoretically, in our return to the Source, becoming One with God, we create entirely new universes as a result of our evolution. Such that for everyone, there is a universe, and accordingly, several billion different universes.
The rhythm of the universe -- something we will know through eventuality, as One with God, and creator of new universes. Eventing our way into the deepest imaginable future in direct relationship to ones karma as expressed, found, and realized, by the final incarnation as lived within the recess of the New Age; we find that evolution invariably occurs as a natural result of timing, and synchronicity, and the dream of awakening, activation of ones DNA is an eventual process that is realized by all human beings in the recess of the "final incarnation."
The
final incarnation is realized as a result of having found ourselves
within the recess of the New Age. We are becoming "actualized"
-- equalizing into the perfect avatar self as a direct result of
timing, and synchronicity. The Mayans knew, verily, when we would
evolve, and their assumption was correct. Of course, people have been
enlightened preceding the New Age, from Father Enoch, to Philip K.
Dick -- many have entered into the final incarnation, to become
ascended masters, timelessly, before us. The universal thought
patterns of the ascended master have produced lingering thought forms
in the environment, which are invariably realized through the
cogitations of another finalized incarnation. Through these
aggregates of enlightened thought thus committed to the environment
of the third dimension, and so many mystics reaching divination
throughout history, it is theorized that through the understanding of
absolutes, universality, and the inborn rhythm to our thoughts -- we
are
self-divined,
and wholly enamored with the Light of the final incarnation, as an
eventuality, a probability that was hard-wired into our DNA prior to
incarnation. When we die, theoretically, we meet a trio of angels,
who guide us to a screen, in which we directly view the matrix of
incarnations. A soul will review their karmic relationships in the
perceived "life tape" and thus base the following
incarnation off the life-tape. In the final incarnation, we become
immortal, and do not die, so all conscious memory is in active
production of the final film. We are always "working on our
film" and as such, through meditation, and the endurance of
divine images, and symbols, we are able to awaken our subconscious
minds to the awareness of the final life, a life of great worth,
value, and importance to the rest of the race -- that we are actively
producing the life-tape in the final incarnation, and we realize that
some
day, it
will be viewed, as the "final film" of which we imagine an
ethereal movie-theater, with seats filled by every ascended master,
and we together witness the many karmic relationships, details,
lives, and incarnations of which we realize; -- as one-consciousness
invariably found, that "we are all of these people" -- and
we have been guiding our own self, remembering, dreaming, and
activating our awareness to the realization that we are God, we are
responsible for all of this, and once the credits roll, and the final
film seems to bear a logical conclusion, there will only be one name
within the cast, that of the totality of One, the One True Spirit.
The events that follow shall be entirely new -- that the Akashic
Records are revised by our evolutionary movements through the
continuum -- and we continue to return to the Source -- incarnate --
and return to the Source -- in a process that never ends, but is
infinitely recycled through the continuum.
Viewing the "final
film" -- as a collective race of ascended masters, is
imaginable, and seems to be a logical counterpart to the
pre-awareized notion of viewing ones life-tape after death, but once
we "ascend" it is a great party of souls, a great re-union
of people who would share their stories of life on Earth, and what it
was like to be a human being. Much will be learned, many stories
shared, and it shall come to pass that through the futurity of
technology as found within the concept of the psycho-imaginarium, to
which a mind is hooked up to a computer that projects ones thoughts
onto a screen for all to view, it will come to pass that many minds
are wired into the machine, and great visual-audio-sensory
representations are given for the entertainment, and education of the
masses. Further, we imagine the "Akashic Computer" of which
it is theoretically possible (and the Pleiadians allegedly possess
this technology) -- to view any point in human history, on a
holographic representation. Here, we may observe the Mutiny On The
Bounty, to the death of Christ, to histories from Lemuria, to
Atlantis.
In viewing such films, we see that our guides, and
humble masters have always been with us, guiding us, like angels,
toward the invariable future -- which was probable -- of which the
final film is viewed, "all
history contained, and all knowledge relayed back to us -- through
the matrix of incarnation." We
realize that our karma is shared through multiple existences, and
however patternless, the theory will result in a logical accord in
the finalysis.
Re-incarnation makes sense, if there is true meaning to life. That there is a cycle to everything, just as the seasons bring the seed of flowers back to life in the Spring. In essence, we have lived before, in many different times and places, however scientifically unproven the concept of re-incarnation may be, we just know that energy once expressed, creates karma, and returns to itself, in the end. There are cycles to everything, and there is even a rhythm to the matrix of incarnation. As one life will end, another begins, but what lies in between is the "imagination." In the book "Life Between Life" by Whitten, it is heavily detailed, and suggested, that we do review our lives in the bardo, the in-between state, and the whole concept of films, movies, and cinematic representations seem to hold some great truth in reflection to the true nature of reality.
So
it goes, we find the rhythm to our thoughts; we writhe through
proactive animation; we accept this is the final life of greatest
importance and value to the rest of the race, and we work toward
producing an example out of ourselves, as unitized, for the sake of
learning and growth on the part of all to whom we know and effect. We
accept that the world is changing, and we may be directly
responsible. Upon realizing that rhythm of the final life to which we
perceive the totality of value to our thoughts, and the rhythm of our
cogitations -- toward the deeper concept of the rhythm of
incarnations -- we see evidence of motion, rhythm, gravitation,
centrifugal force, and the constancy of matter through the vivacity
of the very Earth we live upon, and as the sun will rise again, as
there is invariably a new day, we are always moving into the future.
We know that we are evolving. And the rhythm must be found.
Chapter
Seven: Manufactured For Control
"We
were all created in the image of God."
As
all humans were originally endowed with twelve-strand DNA, It would
come to pass, through genetic alterations were being made to the
human DNA, such that certain races known simply as the "reptilians"
were interested in employing their Free Will, to reduce the Free Will
of others. As control of the humans means control of the universe, it
has come to pass that we have been fed off of -- as slaves, for the
energy we produce. The double helix was, created, as a measure
towards control. Through the highly limited double helix, we are cut
off from the spirit unless employing the subconscious mind,
meditation, or reverie. Otherwise, we are lost, and seem to reside
within a world of hardset logics, and undeniable walls of a prison
that was built around us, because humans are originally the divine
reflections of the Godhead..
"What
goes on here on the Earth will affect the entire universe as a
result."
As
control of the humans means control of the universe, the controlling
forces -- the genetic scientists, and manipulative darker forces,
would work very hard, tirelessly in their labs, perfecting the
"perfect" genetic strand for which enslavement, and energy
drawn out as a result. It would come to pass that the human race
would live through a prolonged period of darkness, and blindness to
the soul, through a number of incarnations, only to find ourselves
within the recess of the New Age, the final incarnation, and our
essential returning to grace as an ascended master. We have come a
long way in our journey, and some of us have incarnated so many times
we are now "professionals" at the self-created reality. The
power is returning to us, as the dimmer switch of our DNA is
activated to that new strand, and we find through the linear intake
of certain information -- that the dream-sequence containing the
symbols that would awaken our DNA -- and leave us enlightened by our
own capacity to think -- and leave us wholly "enamored"
with the Light of our true being -- the perfect avatar self . . . we
know this quest now possesses a logical end.
As the double
helix was invented in their labs, the seemingly "perfect"
encodement for which we would be controlled, and fed off of, the
controlling forces would see to it that we operate through fear, and
as the Egyptans were influenced, as the Dogons were influenced, as
the Mayans seem to have been influenced, they would, through certain
manifestations, integrate themselves into their own experiment, and
actively feed off of certain people for the existence of their own
power, and selfish gain. This has come to pass through various world
leaders, ranging from Caligula, to Hitler. As the world, presently,
remains in a sad state of affairs -- as rape, killing, genocide, and
murder, are things that actively occur in our society -- and even in
my tourist town of Bar Harbor, suicides, and murders, occur just next
door. The "fear level" of the human race, is profound, such
that only a few years ago, when a satellite is a great distance from
the Earth, a resounding, emanating "scream" was picked up
being projected from our blue star. Thankfully, our fear energy is
now being transmuted through the Light, and the emanating scream has
transformed into something else . . .
In Blink: The Power of
Thinking Without Thinking, by Malcolm Gladwell, it is suggested that
we are
more
able to choose when our selection of choices is reduced. Tragically,
the world has so many religions, belief systems, and organizations of
hardset thought and belief, that we are essentially, "flooded
with so much information, that the ability of choice is
lost."
Thankfully, in finding universality, and the
natural inborn rhythm to our thoughts, that dimmer switch activated,
we are returning to our primordial grace. Certain aristocrats,
capitalists, and high-standing figures in the corporate world of
politics and social organizations, presently through their own
wealth, are -- in many covenants and secret societies -- ruling the
world -- and this insidious plot of control over the masses, through
the separation of belief, production of fear-energy, and seemingly
manufactured for control -- they are not sure how to react to the
telepath, nor are they quite sure how to deal with the teleportive
event. As my life was to be threatened by the crazed driver, and my
family are unable to believe I had an attempt on my life, but it was
a fabrication invented by my imagination -- my family refuse to
accept that an attempt on my life was made, but are more comfortable
perceiving that I am schizophrenic. Needless to say, they are not me,
they do not know what it is like inside my head, and I am the only
one who truly knows.
As we are now returning to our primordial grace, and the percieved "dark forces" are accordingly vast in number in contrast with the evolutionists, the numbers are growing in the way of the Light, and the "dream" of the third dimension is verily starting to break down, and re-form into something new. We are changing, actively, and we writhe through proactive animation. We actively express control over the environment, and we are aware that "the shift" lies within us, within the human individual -- a singular spark of Light to be relayed back to the Source -- through one person, the world is saved -- the power lies within the individual -- and it shall come to pass that through our indifference and uniqueness, we are only brought closer to Godliness. As there are many names for the One Spirit which moves through everything, and even the "controlling forces" are born of the same matter that composes our own reality, indifference, separation, titles, and deducements -- many names for the same thing -- and it shall come to pass that once we are in the recess of direct non-local thought-transferrence, thus tapped into the mind at large, and sentience is shared, it is apparent -- the One Spirit -- the power of One -- and these ontological expressions are manifesting day by day, hour by hour, minute by minute, second by second, thought by thought, ever-realizing ourselves as the future of the human race -- we are the evolutionists, and calm eventors into the radiant depths of the deepest imaginable future.
As
we are now in the recess of the New Age, living the final
incarnation, the "karma system" becomes active. I know this
because I once had direct non-local thought-transferrence,
originally, with a group of nonbelievers who don't possess genetic
mutation. Described as an "ontological terrorist" -- and
looked at with fear in reflection toward my power, it would come to
pass, at Two Cats restaurant, that I would become the subject of
ontological terrorism, and have my own mind read, seemingly against
my will, through the perceived intervention. I was humiliated, and
yet it was nothing short of the most amazing experience in my
life.
"We
were all created in the image of God."
As
Earth is allegedly the most "dense" planet within the
universe, and the humans are accordingly -- originally -- the most
profound reflections of God, we are all created in the image of the
deity, and we are all essentially living within the body of Christ.
What we bring upon ourselves, will be brought upon the world, just as
gossip over someone will result in gossip towards ones self, as "what
goes around, comes around" -- as the karma system becomes active
through the endurance of the final incarnation, we are to be very
careful in our choice over what thoughts enter our minds, because we
know these are memories that will be carried with us until the end --
as ascended masters -- all the way into the final film, which we may
actively view once the technology is afforded to the us -- seeing the
history of the Earth on the Akashic Computer -- the living, cinematic
bible -- a source for which we will draw infinite Light, learning,
and supercognitive advancement.
As in my own life, I have been
intervened with, starting with a stranger on the bus who knew all
about me, the evidence is mounting how the many forces involved are
not interested in seeing the humans serve the inner master, but want
them to serve the chaos machine -- such as to integrate themselves
into certain peoples realities, through the proxy of a total
stranger, and thus inhibit us with the thought -- that -- they "know"
about us.
Philip K. Dick, in his own process of enlightenment,
possessed great paranoia at one point in his life, that people were
"after him." In the world of the evolutionist, surrounded
by nonbelievers, it shall seem at times that the whole world is
against us, and our quest is not worth endeavoring into for the
profound difficulty in finding Light in other souls . . . the thought
of the controlling forces -- knowing about us -- for most, only
inspires confidence, and that is the case with me. However perceived
as a ontological threat, or a perceived "one man army" -- I
enjoy the difficulty of imagining the controlling forces, as I
struggle to figure with the concept of evil -- I realize there is no
true separation between us, and we are all only equal; only the
same.
The two girls at Two Cats restaurant who would read my
thoughts in the company of my family, a scene feeling as though
staged, and something out of the works of science fiction -- has come
to serve as evidence that the world is changing, intervention will
invariably occur, and I share this knowing it may not be fondly
perceived by my family, and most friends, as the question of humility
invariably arises -- if they intervened in your life, at the rife age
of twenty-five, how come they have never intervened in my life, why
are some of us -- chosen -- for intervention...?
The question
resounds, and so it will seem that we are never chosen, but have
personally elected ourselves for intervention. It was our own choice
to be dealt with on a karmic level, and our humiliation only works to
produce new thought as a result of the evidence of a living, “human
God.”
Chapter
Eight: The Free Will Universe
"Anyone
can save the world."
This
entire universe, you are now invited to believe, was all just a
massive "experiment" from the start. As begun so many
billion years ago, the Light burst in all directions, and our
universe was born -- the Elohims and original Creator Gods would form
worlds, star-systems, and planets which would exist to house races
that exist as reflections of their Light.
Once enough was created out of the matter of the primordial spark, it became logical for the existence of time to be invented, as part of the experiment, as well as the dense third dimension.
We would live as a race of equals, the primordial twelve-strand human race, for some time. All was beautiful in the universe. And then the the genetic expiriments began, as this universe is governed by Free Will, and anyone can take the power all for themself. It was found that the human race would be enslaved by the Free Will of another, and this great experiment would be darkly-illumined for quite some time.
In
the world of the subconscious mind, things are patternless, but
always operate through a natural goal-oriented process. Through the
endurance of the Light, and our awakened Lightbodies, we are coming
to find that although patternless this reality, things always "add
up in the end." Invariably, sense is found in the hopeful mind
-- and the science of everything from re-incarnation, to
enlightenment, is invariably going to be understood in time to come.
We are in the New Age, living out our final incarnations -- and it
was all leading up to this pivotal point in our cosmic history, from
the start.
We are nearing the great showdown.
I often
tell myself "getting closer, getting much closer now . . .”
all in nearing toward the union of my greatest opposing force.
With
the death of Christ 2,000 years ago, and such atrocities as
Hiroshima, and the collective trauma we have endured as a race, we
have been hurt very deeply through betrayal of expectation -- now we
have "reality shows" where people are showing off their
drug addictions, celebrity lifestyles, and profound misuse of power.
We have nuclear weaponry, not only this, we have alien technology
gifted to us by the Zeta Reticuli. We have a seemingly limitless
amount of power over one another, and yet, this was all planned out,
and conceived in the mind of God, from the very start. As I have had
multiple attempts on my life, in this life, and I realize how fearful
some people are, of my own power, as a unique individual -- I realize
how threatened some people are by the concept of self-evolution, and
the concept of serving a master that lies within.
God knew a
universe would be created that would breed the most unique and
original souls. This has all been a process of discovery, of the
concept of the New, and all power realized upon the endurance of
realizing our own oneness with God. The creator wanted us to become
equal, and reflect The beauty back to the Source. This universe was
created through the desire to find the most unique, original, and
evolutionary thoughts. My favorite writer Edgar Allan Poe describes
life as having certain "difficulties" and it is through the
endurance of certain "difficulties" -- the great challenge
of discord, and being hard-wired for control -- it has been a great
test of our Free Will, to see if we could accept our responsibility,
and admit we know that we are wholly responsible for all experiences
we have ever had. We all chose to incarnate here, this is the Free
Will universe -- and choice always exists over what one wishes to do
with their existence.
As the genetic alterations were going on, perceived by the Sirian Council, there was one man who stood up to proclaim his disapproval. This one man, who stood up, and employed his own Free Will to ensure that enlightenment would find His beloved creatures, was a unique individual, and would leave the council, and renounce his place, so as to incarnate into the third dimension with the rest of the humans -- to seed them with the concept of a messiah -- a saint -- and produce the goal-to-be-realized, of a race of ascended masters, a race of self-Christed individuals, who are all saints, masters, and saviours of the world. With Christ, as well as Buddha, and others, the human race was seeded with the concept of a one-man-army, and we have now come far in our journey to realize ourselves as equal with Christ. We have come to produce some of the most stellar writers, artists, and deep thinkers, from artists Pollock to Alex Grey, from writers Joyce Carol Oates to Bob Dylan, from deep thinkers Stephen Hawking to Bruce Lipton, the Free Will of the human race in the Free Will universe has come to produce some of the most beautiful, amazing, and incredible minds.
Power
which only leads to more power, Light which only leads to more Light,
life which only leads to more life, we see that growth is endless,
and the extensions of our Free Will never cease to place us within
the recess of the deepest imaginable future. We are alive in the New
Age, we have chosen to incarnate at this pivotal time in human growth
and understanding, and we are all Light as born from the same Source,
and we are all, in essence, equals, however unique and different we
may seem -- through indifference the return to the Source is only
more worthwhile, and as we come to produce new universes to live
within, as a direct result of our Free Will, it shall come to pass as
inevitable that the conceivable climax of all matter within the
continuum realizes a veritable end, the final life, the final
incarnation, the only life which matters now: the life of the
ascended master.
Chapter
Nine: The Final Incarnation
"For
I am the first, the last, and always."
Re-incarnation,
not a widely discussed matter, is a growing theory which is beginning
to hold some validity in reference to the concept the natural cycles,
seasons, and processes of life on the planet Earth. We have lived in
many different times and places, through many different identities,
as many different people. The face, name, family, friends, and
relationships change, but I possess the belief that the imagination
remains intact. In "The Case For Re-Incarnation" by J.
Allan Danelek it is heavily detailed with evidence born through
certain individuals, how the scenery will change, but the purpose of
the soul seems to remain intact. The best evidence for
re-incarnation, which has stood the test of time, would, however,
seem to be "Many Lives, Many Masters" by Weiss. In "Many
Lives, Many Masters" Catherine is regressed, from one session to
the next, as having lived many different lives, spanning from culture
to culture, ethnicity to ethnicity, but it would seem the gender has
remained intact, as well as the imagination, and purpose of ones
life.
Living as a servant to a male-oriented society,
Catherine would incarnate through many different lives, only to
finally find herself in the office of Brian L. Weiss -- peering back
in time, at the many lives she's lived. She would learn how the roles
are switched around, and some of her family members are re-incarnated
loved ones from a past life. It would seem that people incarnate in
groups, that there is a "group karma" of which certain
individuals are tied together by experience. Through experiencing one
another, countlessly, repeatedly through the recess of the
incarnation system, it would eventually be realized, life within the
New Age (which started in the late sixties), and the concept of the
final incarnation. As this was all planned out from the start, it
would seem that the incarnation system has been a sort of experiment,
in itself, that energy once committed to the third dimension,
invariably returns. We see, through the evidence as found through
past-life regression, and self-hypnosis, that we can
travel
back in time, we can
"view"
the details of not only how a previous life was lived, but how that
life passed on, and how it relates to the present incarnation.
Just by being aware of the incarnation system is the first step toward rising above it.
Entire
books have been written on the subject, but it is to be found, that
just be committing ones self to the belief they have lived before, we
needn't live again. Lightbody and the ascension process points to
immortality, and the teleportive event is only further evidence.
Through the resounding evidence of the self-mutated Lightworker, we
have evidence of the final incarnation, and we humbly perceive we can
be equal with the many ascended masters that already exist, outside
of time. Yes, I honestly perceive that immortality is achievable, and
that the "final body" of which we presently know, whatever
health, figure, or physical demeanor we possess, can be changed, and
we can even reverse aging. Through Lightbody, all illnesses are
cured, and it is to be found that we are not going to die.
Living
out the final incarnation on the planet Earth in the New Age, we have
arrived at the radiating Light at the end of the tunnel -- and "just
by being aware of the incarnation system is the first step toward
rising above it." As we have incarnated countless times, through
the identities of many different people, we have learned much in our
travels through the incarnation system, manufactured for control
through the double helix, and every time we re-incarnated, we were
blind to the energy of the soul, living as "clean slate."
Through blindness to the soul only reachable through the
subconscious/imagination (the body of God) -- we have been fed off of
for the energy we output, through our fear-based thought forms
believing we have no control over our lives, and thus commit
ourselves to some "higher being" of which we are enslaved.
The true path is to serve the Light that lies within, and as Light is
information, information being the matter which composes the
universe, it shall seem through the endurance of the Light, our
future is endless, and we see the future, imagine what we desire, and
then equalize into it instantaneously. With the karma system become
active through our daily lives and expressions -- whatever we think,
whatever acts once committed within the life of the ascended master,
will relay back to us instantaneously, finding the world of
synchronicity -- and how things all work in natural accord with one
another, "like attracts like" and it shall come to pass
that many miracles are performed, and the world is changed by the
power of the individual.
Theoretically,
the soul both enters and leaves the body through the pineal gland,
and when we die twenty one grams of our body weight seems to vanish
into thin air. When we die, a flooding of the naturally occurring
psychadelic known as DMT courses through our veins, and there is,
veritably, a white Light, angels, and the after-realm is,
theoretically, as beautiful as we imagine. Here, we event our way
toward the screen, to which we view the life-tape with our archetypal
guides. Usually, three. The next incarnation is based directly off
the previous, and we re-incarnate (at our own Free Will) into the
newborn child, as the soul allegedly hovers above the to-be-born
child, and enters the childs body directly previous to birth, which
suggests that abortion is not killing, as the soul doesn't enter the
body until directly prior to giving birth. In this, we are born as a
clean slate, ignorant of our past on the Earth, and often go through
the exact same experiences we have already gone through before.
Thankfully, knowledge has now come to afford us with awareness of the
incarnation system, and we have the capacity to rise above it through
knowledge alone.
Immortality, the life of the ascended master
endowed with the original twelve-strand DNA, and wholly enamored with
the power we possess, we see our effect on the world is direct, and
thus that choice-point is realized: do we continue to effect the
world, or do we calmly accept that observation alone effects matter,
and we need only "exist" through certain relationships,
within our present locale..? . . . Perhaps we exist through the given
environment, leaving our effect on the world focused to a select
locale, and select relationships. The question is: do we change the
world, or do we accept that our effect on the world will occur
invariably, so we now thus step back, and take a look at things from
the periphery. We come to wonder how we ever came to be so powerful,
and we start to realize (some of us) about our inner selfish drive.
Now we endeavor to see our fellow human empowered by the Light. We
write books, produce art-work, and share our story with the world. In
the end, we open ourselves up to judgment, we consciously wish
judgment upon ourselves, we consciously wish to see how we are
perceived -- as we have become an immortal ascended master in the New
Age -- we realize our power is directly evidenced by the
extrasensory, and we consciously realize that the world truly is
affected by our Light . . . we realize that we have an effect on
people, and certain relationships, and we thus realize -- who are we
to save the world..? So we really begin to look at ourselves, and all
concepts of the notion of humility. What makes us so worthy of such
great a task..? How can we be so powerful, and why, in Gods name, did
any of this happen..? Who is truly responsible..? The question
resounds, and where blame could be placed, we now find there is only
peace and understanding -- that we know we are alive in the New Age
-- that we know we are becoming immortal -- that we know our place
within the rows of all human life is invariably found by the final
incarnation -- and we know, verily, that we do
have
an effect on the world . . .
"You
are well aware that, as no thought can perish, so no act is without
infinite result. We moved our hands, for example, when we were
dwellers on the Earth, and, in so doing, we gave vibration to the
atmosphere which engirdled it." -- E. A. Poe
We
effect the environment with our thoughts, and the environment effects
our thoughts in due frequency. We have effected the environment of
the Earth with our expressions, and we learn, through the final
incarnation, of how direct our effect on the world, the ether, the
universe, has been.
Future
tensory thoughts, of which we are bound by a certain goal, and
operate through a mission of the mind; we may employ what is known as
a "dreambook" for the commitment of thought into the
tangible form of written text, and review the dreambook daily,
sharing it with no one (as the Art of War suggests sharing our plans
with a third party only produces unnecessary judgment) -- we will
invite certain things into our life by reviewing the dreambook daily,
and contain within the things we most desire in life. In the final
life, it will come to pass that we surround ourselves with the most
powerful relationships, vibrations that resonate with our own.
Certain low-vibrations will be cycled out. As we find ourselves
endowed with the Light, becoming immortal, and synchronized into the
future tensory thoughts that carry us through time, some people will
view
your evolution as dangerous, perceive you as a threat, and work very
hard to lower your vibration. Thus, the right guides, friends,
outlets, and relationships become necessary in the final life, as we
know all relationships and memories that exist in the final life are
carried with us into the future, as ascended master, we see, verily,
that some people who are opposed to enlightenment, and evolution, who
are often religiously-inclined or embroiled in preexisting
belief-patterns, what is "most safe" they gravitate to,
because they are in essence fearful of change, and only seek the path
which is plainly laid out before them.
In
the final life, we are finding the natural inborn "Light-based
cogitations" of the ascended master, and essentially enlightened
by our own unique ability to cogitate a thought, which emanates into
the surrounding environment, that the sacred space is to be employed,
and there will be a designated locale for our greatest advancements
to be found. In the final incarnation, the final life -- the last
incarnation we will ever know, it is to be seen through the free
endless resource as the energy found within the Light of our DNA,
theoretically, evident in my own case with the teleportive event --
that we become ascended masters who seem to harness the time-space
continuum, and are in synchronized into the natural movements of the
collective.
"It's all changing now."
So
let it be.
We are in the future, and our technology is
advancing. As we evolve, thought evolves, and as we change, the
people around us begin to change as well. We are impressed by one
another, we see one anothers growth and it catalyzes growth in our
own beings. Inspired, influenced, impressed, we grow through guidance
directed towards one another, and no one would learn unless it were
for some
teacher
or guide, propelling them in the right direction. Ever-eventing our
way into the deepest imaginable future; finding ourselves there,
peering back at the world, and knowing, verily, that we are Home. We
have arrived in the future, peering back at how things used to be . .
. now we are evolving, time as harnessed, and all powers of the mind
seen fully utilized -- the Earth is brought together by a
teleconnected race, and we finally live in perfect symbiosis with our
home, the planet Earth.
Chapter
Ten: The New Earth
"Question
me then, my Oinos, freely and without fear,
Come! we will leave to
the left and loud harmony of the Pleiades,
And swoop outward from
the throne into the starry meadows beyond Orion,
Where, for
pansies and violets, and heart's-ease,
Are the beds of the
triplicate and triple-tinted suns."
-- E. A.
Poe
Imaginable,
at this time, the world is covered in ethereal Light. The planet
Earth, is rising in vibration, as enamored with the network of Light
produced by the Lightworkers, a grid-work of iridescence. Beneath the
Noosphere lies the biosphere, and around this resides the
technosphere, but all energies are merging into the final environment
of the New Earth. Here, we find expressed control of the living
environment, ever-aware that by altering the environment, we alter
our thoughts, and vice versa. The frequency between thought and
environment, to which the Light that is now covering the Earth, in
frequency with the Light of our illumined DNA -- is a high-charged
frequency, a vibration which causes the transition from third
density, into the fifth octave. We see the Light coursing through us
-- sent from the outer space -- into our DNA -- and we perceive the
Light is emanating through our bodies, coursing through every fiber
of our existence, enamoring every six trillion cell of our existence.
The DNA filaments contain the memories of past-lives, and cosmic
information, and anyone can tap into their soul -- anyone who
consciously wishes to continue growing and learning through the
movements of the living universe, to which we are a part -- as a
unique reflection of One -- we have a purpose, we have a Light worth
sharing with the world, and we know "the book has already been
written" -- "the masterpiece already perfected" -- our
time machine has already been constructed in the future, and all
things have in essence already been achieved. It is simply a matter
of imagining this through.
We
perceive the beginning, middle, and end. We see that the walls of the
universe fluctuate with our attainment of new information, and we
know that the environment is changing. We are the vehicle of the
final body, the final incarnation alive within the New Age. Awareized
to the self-created reality, we wake up in the morning -- the sacred
time -- and write down our dreams, record our thoughts in meditation,
gravitate toward creative acts, actively organize objects within the
given environment, and thus, continue to effect ones self through the
spontaneity and radiance of a continuously changing environment.
The sacred space will be used for our highest learning, and the highest sense of ones expression of Free Will. Here, we are free to think and cogitate any thought -- be creative, write, poeticize, make music, learn, have fun, enjoy life, live in frequency with the environment -- reach for a random book, flip to a random page, and guide ourselves through intuition.
Finding
thought which is entangled with the environs, that these thoughts --
that are based upon an understanding of the natural feng shui and
circuitous flow of energy within the sacred space, of which we are
awareized to our effect on the space, we extend this environment to
that of the Earth . . . seeing ourselves divined by the Light such as
to be teleconnected as a race that operates in symbiosis with their
blue star . . . that the environment is further extended to the
curved walls of the theorized "unisphere." And here, as we
know we affect the environment, the Earth, the universe, with our
thoughts, affecting the Source, to which our energy is infinitely
relayed, a new frequency of growth that seems endless, and continuing
for as far as the universe is explorable; as the Pleiadians have come
to find: the universe is endless, there is no "edge" of the
universe, however imagined the curved walls may be seen within the
mind -- as we search the outer reaches of the universe, it would seem
that our search in itself only yields further growth in the
environment, and we shall come to see, that through the times which
lie ahead such as to terraform other planets with human life, and
live everywhere from Venus to Mars, we know that our rocket ships are
equipped with the present technology to take us to the nearest
planets, and it is theorized that Venus, which is much like the
Earth, is a future environment that the humans will terraform with an
atmosphere, and make liveable for human life.
As the free will
universe was an experiment, it would come to pass as probable that
the manipulative would have their day. But this time will be nothing
more than a fleeting memory in the matrix of all memories -- that we
were once separated, and disagreeing with many different names,
living in a time of darkness with the highly limited double helix, as
we have come to remember the Light, and recall our divine place
within the orchestra of all human life. It shall come to pass that
time is infinitely revised, history re-written, and the world of the
new realized by our Light-based cogitations, and endurance of
high-charged, genius thoughts. As we revert back to our true
intelligence, and writhe through powers of the extrasensory, causing
an ontological shift in the perceiver, as the karma system becomes
active -- living the final incarnation -- all thought becomes -- all
thought manifests -- all reality is thought -- and we always have
control over our thoughts . . . in this very moment, we can take a
walk, we can call a friend on the phone, we can write a letter to a
someone, we can perform a kind act toward another soul, we can share
our beliefs with an open-minded source, we can learn, verily, that
things are not as separate as they once seemed, but we have simply
given many different names, for the same thing, the One True Spirit
which moves through everything.
We are to see ourselves as expressors of Divine Light, who are aligned, body, mind, and soul.
Divine Light, which will emanate through us, from chakra to chakra, permeating throughout the bodily frame. We "feel" our cells, we imagine they each contain the holographic image of the whole, and the whole is a healthy, high-functioning, and proactively animated form. Allegedly, humans are made up of six trillion cells. In imagining the body as the environment, and acknowledging the power of the goal-oriented subconscious mind, we enamor ourselves with the thought of an eclipsing of our cells -- to the holographic image of the perfect avatar.
As
we grow, we have much to believe, and so it has been suggested we are
more able to choose when our selection is reduced -- so we find the
limited array of choices -- the select matrix of possible
probabilities, of which we view -- perhaps a selection of eight
choices -- one mode will be followed, one path of the most deepest
imaginable future will be realized, as we find ourselves on the
track, converging with the oncoming Light, arriving at the imagined
destination. We are now in the process of building a time machine, a
time machine which lies within the mind. As theoretically the Earth,
according to New Age belief, is moving through the most
densely-electromagnetically-charged part of the galaxy at this time,
referred to as the photon belt, or the rings of Alcyone, of the
Pleaides -- the Pleiades which is connected to an entirely other
universe, and is reported by many sources, to be heaven. So we
perceive that the Earth is transitioning to a new state -- "Heaven
on Earth" -- and here, within the recess of the New Age, divined
by our creative expressions, and the self-controlled environment, we
find that our home is alive, Mother Gaia, and she has always been
directly affected by the thoughts of her inhabitants. As twenty-one
grams seems to mysteriously vanish from the body when we die, it is
thus imagined that spirit bears some weight, and the weight of the
spirit thus contained within the body of the final incarnation --
shall affect our home directly, in a symbiotic relationship that is
frequented, occasionally, with journeys to other planets, and other
dimensions.
Here within the final reality we will ever know,
through a symbiotic relationship with the planet, and
ecosphere/biosphere -- as we will project our thoughts such as to
imagine the iridescent Light that is now covering the blue star in
hyper-dimensional radiance. We are always revising the Akasha, with
each day that passes, such that history is being actively written
now, and these days to which we are now found living within the New
Age -- in the final life -- are memories to be the shape and form
that results in our highest divination, such that we may look back on
Earthlife, all the relationships, and experiences, and reflect that
it was all leading up to an eventual return to the stars. As the
human race becomes interstellar travelers, potentially terraforming
Venus with a biosphere, and proving we are capable of creating a new
environment, as Jonathon Ray Spinney theorizes in "The Last
Eclipse" that the human race will
survive
the geological changes, and perceived pole shift that may occur in
time, that our futurity may lie within Venus -- and that is where our
new home will be found. Presently, we possess the technology to make
it to Venus, and it is a growing possibility that human life will
spread
to such planets as Venus, and Mars, in our given lifetimes. Just as
it was originally unimaginable that "astronauts will travel to
the moon" -- we never had photographs of the Earth prior to the
sixties, and now, as our technology, evolution, and advancements are
carrying us into the deepest imaginable future, of interstellar
travel, and the terraforming of new worlds, with an atmosphere such
as to give life to the new environment, it is my perception that the
human race can
save
themselves, we needn't be whisked away in space-ships by a foreign
party, but we are, within our own human capacity, capable of saving
ourselves.
As
we move to Venus, and terraform the planet with oxygen, and a living
atmosphere, it will come to pass that our new home will be a land of
peace, unity, renewal, and understanding. Theoretically life already
exists on Venus, the beings referred to as the Ashtar Command, and we
will theoretically be in union with these enlightened souls, as well
as the many ascended masters who exist outside of time. Referred to
as the "galactic federation" or simply the Cosmic Family,
we will find integration -- the eventual equality, and sharing of
knowledge with the many races that exist in the universe. Already, it
is suggested that Sirius has higher-vibrating life-forms who convene
in the Sirian Council, and oversee human evolution. As this universe,
and planet, was all an experiment from the start, to see if it would
be possible for a race to live in darkness for a period of time, only
to become more pure and spiritual and Godly as a result -- they
perceive the experiment now has a life of its own, and the creations
all stem from One are some of the brightest, compassionate,
beautiful, and creative souls. The Sirian Council has been observing
human evolution from the start of the experiment, and as it has
occurred, it only took one man to change the world -- the shift is
found within -- we are
the
prophecy -- we are everything, and nothing, flowing endlessly by the
pulse of the heart divine. It only takes two seconds to believe in
someone, and it only takes one individual to change the tides of
history.
So we perceive that researcher, that scientist who
believes -- and the technology to reach fruition in all futurity to
come.
The New Earth, allegedly to be found on Venus, to which
is terraformed, and seeded with life, is our potential future, in
order to survive the prophesized "Earth changes" that lie
ahead. According to many sources, the Earth is as though being held
up by atlas, by ascended masters, in our to maintain its equipoise,
and not tilt off the axis. Pole shift is theoretically already
occurring and there is also much evidence of climate change as a
result of the profound weight of the human race. Such that allegedly
certain land-masses will be submerged, and others risen to the
surface. The evidence is mounting, whatever the cause, that the Earth
is upset, and working towards balancing herself out.
As such,
we lived in darkness for a period of time in order to be greater
empowered by the Light, such that our oscillation into darkness has
only been a test of our Free Will, to see if we could remember
ourselves, and verily, we are starting to remember ourselves.
The
further we explore, only more deeply do the depths of the universe
grow, that we know the universe is affected by our actions, and
everything that happens on the Earth is being learned from by the
children of different universes. Many stories about life in the free
will universe are circulating, and many are endeavoring to live in
this place -- the free will universe -- for the extension of their
own Light, in order to realize their own power as ascended
master.
We came here in order to become more powerful, and our
power is apparently endless. That choice-point realized, do we
continue to change the world, or do we reside within the status of
equipoise, of transparency, and simply "exist" -- the world
affected by our observation alone..? Just by existing in the Light,
the world is changed, just by perceiving ones self as enlightened to
finding deep pride in ones Light-based cogitations: we change the
world. As it will come to pass that some stellar individuals expose
themselves as Lightworkers, and express through supernal expressions
of their powers of the mind, as telekinesis has already been
evidenced with Uri Gellar, we are learning that matter does
transcend
reality, and this dimension known as the third is in truth just a
hologram, with rules hardly in place. As evidenced through thought
transferrence, the One Spirit comes alive, and thought is shared, and
we know, verily, that we are moving into a heightened
vibration.
Life on Venus will probably be a civilization to
which we find the greatest leaders, and live in resounding peace. I
of course have no scientific evidence, nor am I in any way in touch
with how a rocket ship could carry us to Venus -- I simply deduce
that it may be a possibility in all futurity to come. As the ship is
referred to as the "Noahs Ark" it will carry all humans
through hypersleep/cryosleep, to the New Earth, and once arrived,
citizens will wake up from the prolonged dream of hypersleep, and
find themselves living in a totally new world. As I have come through
a certain understanding that the Earth is going to experience some
changes ahead, and we are in great need of preparation, to which our
survival may rely on life on Venus. Through what sources I have
gleaned, it is greatly perceived as possible the human race will find
a new home on Venus, and as Venus is already much like the Earth,
already theoretically housing life that exists at a higher vibratory
frequency.
We
have evolved to the point of channeling streaming consciousness
dictations from a higher source, books like "The Prism of Lyra"
are sure evidence the information that is presented, through its
factual tone of universality, is the truth, and we are learning from
the most direct and pure sources of information. As the channeled
text is priming us for the changes that lie ahead, we are readying
for life aboard the ship -- preparing for hypersleep -- knowing that
once we wake up, we will have arrived at our new home, as terraformed
with an atmosphere capable of housing life. We will build new homes,
build a new civilization, and the foundation of The New Earth will be
focused on a soul-oriented, spiritual basis. This will extend our
former Earthlife into the expanded civilization, the only culture,
thus, the only government, and only one belief system -- through the
power of singularity, and oneness, the concept of universality, and
all escape from the ways of the old Earth, of duality and separation,
we will be One.
The reason we must move to Venus is now to be
discussed, and no fear, as scary the concepts may seem, the human
imperative for survival and evolution towards the highest Light is an
invariable process that always produces a formidable result. The
reason why we must move to Venus, is already evident with tsunami,
and global warming, and the prevailing geological changes as a result
in the tilting axis. As suggested, the entire face of the planet will
be re-shaped, to which it is theorized our humble blue star will be
unliveable for a duration of seven years.
"And
the wheat shall be separated from the chaff."
As
a result of the shift in the magnetic poles, causing the Earth to
tilt on its axis, and thus earthquakes and tsunami a natural result,
it becomes imperative, as a race, that we either make a call -- if we
are not able to save ourselves, and move to Venus at our Free Will --
we may thus require assistance from the ascended masters and ET
presence. This is a humble act that may require a certain world
leader, but a possibility none the less.
"Venus is the brightest star in the morning and evening skies. It's there at those magical times of transition between the conscious and unconscious dream-state to remind us of the love that our Creators have for us and that we should have for each other. Venus is there to instill peace and faith in our hearts. She represents the eternal Goddess and we are moving towards her." -- Jonathon Ray Spinney, The Last Eclipse.
Life
on Venus seems to be the most probable future, and we endeavor to
imagine this event will occur in our given lifetimes, because once we
are immortal, the future is endless. As the ship moves toward Venus,
and all passengers are in hypersleep, only to wake up once we have
arrived, upon the terraformd New Earth, it will be like a rebirth of
the Essene brotherhood, and we will
live
in the direct midst of the many ascended masters, who have always
been with us, like guardian angels. Teleconnected, in symbiosis with
our new home, such that memory of the old Earth will remain as a mere
fleeting thought, of the darkness that once was. Our Free Will shall
writhe through beautiful expressions, and we will see beauty in the
details of the smallest grain of sand -- as we come to walk the
surface of the New Earth. Wholly enamored with the Light of our DNA,
become ascended masters, the New Earth will rise like a phoenix from
the ashes of the old, and we shall know, verily, that we have
arrived.
Chapter
Eleven: God-Consciousness
And
God said "Let there be enlightened DNA filaments."
And
there were enlightened DNA filaments.
In
the final incarnation to which we are now living, we are moving into
what is known as God-consciousness. Here, within the natural rhythm
of our enlightened thoughts, we feel our reality is directly
manifested by our sentience, and we are wholly enamored with the
overwhelming power of Love that permeates through all cells of the
enlightened host, and this body which is our vessel -- is the body of
Christ -- whatever thoughts and actions we wish upon ourselves, will
be karmically relayed back to us through experience. In
God-consciousness, we are finding the world of synchronicity, timing,
and rhythm. Here, within the true rhythm of our being, we hope to
create spaces to be filled, new universes to be learned from,
entirely new star-systems for other life to flourish, grow, animate,
and evolve.
All is to be found as ones own, as all is
connected, that we are God -- we know this, and we express our
Godliness through the creatures to which we gift with life, that
shall be reflected back to us. Our many creations, fragmentations,
and dispensations of life throughout the universe of ourselves, will
reflect Love, beauty, and kindness. It will be impossible to deny the
permeating Love of the creator -- that Zeus would commune with his
creations, so one shall commune with those of whom have been created
in our image. Our world, our rules -- a universe to which we may
refer to as ours, forever, safe within the recess of the life of God
-- that we know
we
are God, and we have always been. God-consciousness is not a state of
mind, but a state of being, body, mind and
soul
-- a unitive, integrative whole that functions in balance with the
outside environment, which is the universe of ones own. Here, within
the recess of ones own universe, that we are God over all matter
within this space -- as the Free Will universe was an experiment from
the mind of One, that all reality is a dream, that the third
dimension is a hologram, that things like thought-transferrence and
teleportation seem to suggest that the rules of this reality are
hardly in place, and we are invariably starting to realize our place
of primordial power.
Once we realize that we are God, and
this reality has always been controlled by our own singular facet of
the permeating essence, and we realize our effect on the world has
been direct, that everything we have ever done, every element, piece,
and fragment of our total existence -- adds up to a unitive whole --
we know our place of responsibility -- as a creator of ones own
destiny, a calmly perceived future, and all-endowed with the
prescient eyes that peer endlessly into the radiant depths of the
multiverse. We shall know, verily, that there is no power beyond our
own -- that as God we possess total control -- we know we possess
full control, that the karma system is active through the recess of
the final incarnation, and this path is walked, in assured steps,
toward the Thetaverse, to which we seem to be capable of communing
with the highest Source -- as we exist within the matrix of universes
known as the multiverse; the aggregate network of all incarnated
universes; our universe will serve a purpose -- as there is a
universe designated for each ascended master . . .
Here, where the rules are personally determined by the creator alone, we may witness events that were never expected, and our life-force which is manifest through the many fragmentations and dispensations of our Light, will be reflected back to us through the creation of equals -- that as Adam would create eve from his own body, our essence thus given life to the elements resulting in the manifestation of sentient life-forms, will realize their own God-consciousness, and as a result of our own, become equals, as such, their own universe, their own world, their own place of power, Light, longevity, and evolution. That we have been responsible for this process all along, is known, and we realize, verily, that our life-essence is infinite, it never ceases to fragment and incarnate into new forms.
Through the graduation of the third dimension, to which we have risen to the fifth octave, and realized as ascended master, once returned to the Source, and wholly divined by the radiating Light -- this is far into the future, far beyond Venus, that we eventually find our way into the universe of our own creation. But a time that exists for us nonetheless. Here, we reign supreme, it is our world, for our own thoughts to be reflected into the many creatures we will manifest, and nothing may invade, no force of any horror or magic can possibly affect us now, as we are God, we are the Light, we are the beginning, the middle, and the end. We are the fluctuating walls of our own universe, our life-force exists in all matter within our universe. And we see, verily, counting a number in the billions, that as there are now many incarnated universes governed each by their own Creator -- we shall have much to learn, still, as we have become God, the movements of the multiverse continue on -- and animation, life, seems to continue into the concept of tomorrow, the belief that no matter how hard we try, nothing is ever totally understood -- even unto the mind of God. In this, we may reach far into the depths of possibility, and potentially find ourselves going through the same process experienced on Earth, in our own world. For whatever reason, we may see the same process as what has occurred in this universe. Recyling matter into new forms, creating new entities, we learn from our creations, and lovingly observe as they begin to take on a life of their own.
As
Christ would wish we become equals to His Light, and God is an energy
which permeates through all living things -- as all is born from the
same Source, all is connected, all is entangled within the mind of
God. And within the mind of God, where we will find residence, it is
as though our consciousness is self-actuated to a supernal, endless
stance of which is infinitely renewed by the natural cycling of the
elements, atoms, and sub-atomic particles of our universe. As there
are six trillion cells that make up the human body, each cell is a
reflection of ones Godliness, and each cell composes the holographic
image of the whole. So it goes with our universe as a hologram, that
within one element contains the essence of the whole, thus, we deduce
that God exists through all living matter -- all living matter which
is connected as having been born through the same smashed stardust,
and particles, recollected, and re-gathered over time. As originally
fragmented into a seemingly vast array of many different pieces, God
would disperse The energy unto the masses, for the Christing of the
human race. One perceived that the humans would become equals, and
thus, we are all made in the image of God. God-consciousness,
supernal understanding, soulful animation -- an existence which seems
at the pinnacle of its growth, of which we verily see ourselves as
the very heart of the universe -- we are the Source -- the Source
emanates in all directions, and we emanate in all directions. Our
energy flows, cycles, and renews itself through the infinite process,
and as we come to find a universe of our own -- so it has been --
that this
universe
was just an experiment within the mind of One, and we were created by
someone who was at first a mere fleeting thought -- a simple particle
within the totality of All . . .
. . . and then existence
would prevail as found within the recess of growth, enlightenment,
ascension, God-consciousness, finding this being, become God, and
thus, created the Free Will universe, at the expense of His own Free
Will. Our universe is merely a thought in One mind, a thought -- a
fleeting thought which is only seen as infinitely realized through
the process of the continuum. However found within Godliness, still
yet another lesson to be learned. We continue to grow, even once we
have entered into God-consciousness, as we will create new worlds,
and new environments for our energy to be fragmented into. Through
fragmentation, and the dispensation of our God-essence, given life to
the ether, life which seems to have come from our mind alone -- we
produce life, vast, glorious civilizations, and we integrate our
energy into the incarnation system, as saint, mystic, and cosmic
guide -- for the endurance of the thought to be held within the mind
-- God exists in the human body -- we realize, verily, that as our
creations become equals with us, they too will head out into the
world of the multiverse, create their own universes, and thus, become
our equals. All of this was planned out from the very beginning of
all existence.
From one mind alone.
The plan,
subconsciously known, was to create masters out of the human race.
This plan as being hard-wired into our DNA, was the originally
seeding of the Earth with Light, the spark thus ignited through time
to result in enlightenment, and the return to Godliness.
Enlightenment is the highest achievment any human can find within
their life -- that to become "One with God" suggests the
end to what began 13.75 billion years ago, will reach a veritable
climax upon the endurance of our highest levels of Lightbody. The
experiment of the free will universe would progress through the
existence of time, many souls would be awakened to their true Light,
their true purpose, their true mission, and realize their effect on
the world is direct. Here it is realized that the world changes when
we acknowledge that we possess the power -- to change the world --
and we realize that the change often starts with friends, and the
most direct social ties, relationships we possess. We all have the
capacity to become One with God through enlightenment, and however
far I may be projecting into the future by even suggesting the
concept, of God-consciousness, I merely see this as a logical
eventuality within the scope of the greater scheme of which it is
only natural, right, and logical, for equality, reciprocity, and
humility to exist. That what once began at the perceived beginning of
time, must realize some form of conclusion in the thoughts of
Godliness. Our fall from grace, through the genetic alterations
resulting in the double helix, manufactured for control, was just the
Free Will of one sole individual, who decided within their heart, for
whatever reason, to control us. This control, as found to be
expressed within the Free Will universe -- was all planned out from
the start, however ill-conceived the notion may resound -- that God
knew the Light would return, just as many prophets have been able to
deduce and foresee.
We
were seeded with the spark for enlightenment prior to incarnation,
and we knew
the
probability of reaching God-consciousness. It was
all
planned out from the start, in this great art project, this great
experiment known as the human race. God knew all along that his
creations would find themselves in a world of darkness for a period
of time, only to realize the cure-all Light at the end of the tunnel.
God knew his experiment would be productive of the brightest souls,
artists, thinkers, and writers -- and with great success, we now have
conceivably, the most divine artists -- from Alex Grey to Josh Voke
-- and some of the most divine music, text, and films. We have come
to produce a great number of bright, powerful souls . . . and it is
truly amazing to behold. We have come a long way in our journey
through separation and ignorance, but at last, the Light is being
realized by many individuals, and people are waking up from the dream
with every day that passes now. We feel the world is changing. Like
the wind of November passing through our body, we feel the mystical
catharisis, the knowledge, that this, is, entirely amazing
. . .
Chapter
Twelve: The One True Belief System
"A
law is valid in the vertical as well as the horizontal
direction.
That is, if a law is valid on one level of
consciousness,
it has to be valid on all levels. A law is
universal."
-- H. W. Carpenter, The Genie Within
Organized religion is the greatest downfall of humankind. Through the separation of belief, conditioning of our children, and the forcing of ones beliefs onto another, through methods of manipulation, in order to reside within what is "most safe" to the consensus reality, we have gone far into the depths of ignorance and human malaise. We have even gone so far as to produce the thought that we are alone in the universe.
Through
the separation of belief, and attaching many names to what is
essentially the same thing, through bastardization of the One True
Light, into the fragmentation of multiple belief systems, to which
Christianity reigns supreme, it would seem we have made a real mess
out of something which could have gone much differently. As history
records that Christ died on the cross, of which our calendars begin,
there are other theories that suggest Christ ever died at all, but
became immortal, and ascended with his physical body.
As we
now see evidence that a good majority of ministers and priests are
sexually repressed, and operate through the lower chakras, that they
represent some of the most troubled people -- as we see young
evangelists in their early twenties on television, recycling the same
ideas which have been spoken countlessly before them, by other "men"
-- I have often turned on the TV to find someone talking about how
they are a professional in belief, and their way toward God is the
only way -- that these "professionals in God" are the exact
opposite, who are in fact regressing, going backwards, and through
the recycling of dead thoughts, they are essentially hapless drones,
conduit for the energy of other men.
As we see that the bible
is probably one of the worst books that has ever been written, and
yet, many of us seem to pray to it as though it were the Akashic
Records itself. It condescends other books with its girth, its
weight, and its mass, an obese collection of contradictions, repeated
mention of human slavery, profound violence, and killing. Verily, the
text is becoming obsolete with the information of the New Age.
How
far into the depths of ignorance does the human race need to go,
reducing themselves to mere followers, mere drones, until the
re-discovery of ones Free Will, and the eventual apostasy of
Christianity -- into the final admission into the world of
universality..? There is only One True Light, only One True Spirit,
only One True Belief System. As such, there are many ascended
masters, but there is only One Source to this universe, and we are
all born from the same Source. So it goes, we have incarnated a
number of times into this male-oriented society that is seemingly
governed by organized religion, cults, and covenants, and secret
societies -- much insidious manipulaton, greed, selfishness, and
thought-control has come to pass in our present century, and the
human race has suffered through ignorance, the separation of belief,
and the overmasculinity of the human race. Females are more naturally
intuitive, we see they are the dominant ones in nature, with wolves,
and yet, our society has a great vacancy for female creators,
leaders, and thinkers.
There
is only One True Belief System.
As
clearly evidenced through telepathy as having occurred countlessly in
my life, with the three outstanding examples, it is thus perceived,
that there is
only One Spirit moving through everything. Whence
mind is One, and all subjects are tapped into that higher dimension
-- to which direct non-local thought-transferrence takes place, we
are to find that as our thoughts merge into a singular sentience, God
is realized in the event of telepathy as the Source Field, or
Universal Mind -- but in essence, the One True Spirit which we have
given many names . . . there is only One True Spirit behind the
movements of all matter within the universe, and it is all headed in
a logical, and hopeful direction, whether we like it or not; order
prevails.
Through the re-distribution of wealth thus gifted to
the masses through the gift of Light, and the body endowed with the
Light to which we are made immortal and thus the original image of
Godliness which was always hard-wired into our DNA, we are aligned
with the One True Spirit. Here, within the world of absolutes and
universality, we writhe through akashic propensity, the living
universe -- that what we know is understood, and what is understood,
we believe, and what we believe, manifests, and what manifests,
progresses, endlessly, infinitely, for as long as matter exists in
the continuum -- which is forever. As the Pleiadians endeavor to
search the deepest recesses of the universe, they are only coming to
find that the universe is endless, and only seems to grow the further
we endeavor into exploring it. As the universe is endless, infinite,
to which we may attach some image to the imagined curved walls -- the
unisphere -- we may never reach the edge in our travels, but the
walls of the universe only grow the further we endeavor to explore.
As the human race moves into the space age, and we become frequenters
of Venus, the perceived New Earth -- the final One True belief system
will come to be understood through tones of universality, absolutes,
and natural mysticism. Here, in our final civilization to which peace
resounds, infinitely, a rebirth of the Essene brotherhood, our
greatest leaders found, and the highest souls of Light learned from
directly -- as we convene with the many ascended masters -- become
Godly, and ascending in our own right -- this process which is
infinite, shall only lead everdeepening into the imaginable future.
That we can only imagine so far into the future, however prescient we
may be, is evidence that there is still something new to learn, and
thus, we are enamored with the concept of tomorrow, that we see
although immortal ascended masters having reached the end of time --
the movements of the universe continue, as matter is infinite, here,
we find ourselves in control of the weather, the elements, and all
natural aspects of the planet. In our Godliness, as governed by tones
of universality, we are to harness matter, time, and the continuum.
Entering
into the One True Belief System -- words only boldly capitalized to
represent the thematic tone, of which is simply that of the universe
-- and continuous growth, we are entering into the mind of God -- the
thoughts of the one -- true -- belief -- that there is only One. Here
we are able to view the universe in its entirety. Which is a sphere
with glowing walls -- a glowing sphere -- to which is found the
center of the aggregate of universes -- ours -- in the matrix of
universes; which we see plainly with our enlightened eyes, in the
informative current of fluctuating energies found within the
endurance of the thought of Godliness, -- that all universes are
connected, and they exist as a multitude of cellular constructs,
mechanized through the centrifugal force held up by the multisphere,
which is the outer surrounding force which rotates on the axis, to
which all the universes are governed by a number of energy-points,
and ley-lines across the network of the cellular constructs. The
imagination -- which is the body of God -- projects itself into the
emanating recess, and here lies the holographic nature to which there
is one universe located within the center of the aggregate of
universes, that is the Free Will universe, where the night falls, and
the sun rises, and the moon governs the tides, and the natural
elements work toward a continual eclipse of self-renewal that occurs
every Spring, as well as through each cycle of the procession of the
equinoxes, and only continues to renew herself through the Light born
through the complex DNA information cast into the humans who live
there.
This universe which emanates Light to all other
universes, is where the artists are born.
The
Free Will universe is based on creative force, and constant
creativeness that is used, and employed, as energy to fill the
envirothoughts, and Light-based cogitations that emanate Light to all
other universes within the aggregate, and this network of illumined
unispheres, glowing, permeating, fluctuating, accellerating, and it
shall be that vibrations rule the void -- and these Lights travel
from universe to universe, in riverlight fashion, manufactured by the
mind of One, that apex of the universes, the Thetaverse, which is
wholly mysterious, and something of which seems to be learned from in
its own function, that of which lies at the apex, the pinnacle of all
universes within the total structure, of which as cellular mechanisms
the universes rotate around one another, around the central universe
which is ours -- the Free Will universe, where geniuses, artists,
creators, and mystics are born such as to produce Light for the
entirety of the multisphere. Our location within the whole of the
structure seems to change, and we are not really sure of the Earths
location within the whole. This it would seem, however mysterious, as
the Earth is referred to as the Living Library, a sort of cosmic
college system of which souls learn and share the energy and Light
that was always buried within the filaments of their DNA. This is
information, and information is the matter which is just a
translation for Light is the matter which composes the universe, this
information is alive -- the living information flows through Akashic
propensity, and it is learned invariably through the existence of
time -- incarnation -- the re-integration of matter -- and a sort of
learning that is only going to become self-evident in language used,
the words employed, the semantics understood, the intonations
syllabated, the syllables counted, the tones recurring, the
frequencies building, the vibrations awakening, the DNA -- bursting
-- a spontaneous supernova within the mind, -- which upon the
enlightenment of one cell within the structure, causes a vibration
that emanates causally to the outer walls of the unisphere -- this
will theoretically infect all other universes with Light, and thus --
fuel them -- which now leads us to the final concept of referring to
humans as simply energy.
We all are made of water, of cells
that are all come from the same Source, conducting energy that
crystallizes the water within us into a pattern of which our bodies,
minds, and souls, equalize into the radiance to which we see water
and Light -- illumined water -- perhaps a lake, a great, vast, body
of water -- and the Earth is composed of seventy percent water. So is
the human brain:seventy percent. Our bodies conduct electricity, and
we are fueling the rest of the universes with our Light -- we are the
energy of the universe -- the energy that fuels the aggregate -- the
mass of which rotates upon its own centrifugal force, and continues
to be energized by the Light which is transmitted through the Source
-- and the Source which is the center that is everywhere, and
circumference is nowhere -- that emanates Light in all directions,
and seems to project itself through the holographic nature of each
dimension that is encoded through each level of the aggregatal
Lightbody of the whole. As the Lightbody of the Free Will universe
will be imagined as the shell of a glowing circumference, we can
imagine, thus, that there is Light at the end of the tunnel, and that
is what the Pleiadians are finding.
The energy that we produce which emanates from our crown chakras, an imagined river of Light, pouring out of us, into the surrounding walls of the unisphere, emanating, glowing, flowing endlessly as it only seems to continue growing in size, and it surrounds us, the unisphere, the curved walls of the universe -- whatever room, sacred space, or environment we are in. And our energy, which -- emanates -- flowing out of us, into the ones we pray for, and are to be found thus able to channel through seance once we are in the fifth octave . . . one hopes to believe through whatever occurring thought-patterns that lead us into the channeled state, it is possible, and this may even lead to the holographic avatar, or detura-like form, that is seemingly tangible. This only leads to the further belief that as matter is entangled, what once was, will exist again -- in some shape or form, whether it be spiritual avatar, or life somewhere else in the universe. It is theorized that if we do not compete our karmic responsibilities in the incarnation we now know, we will be transferred to another place, to re-learn of our power, our effect on the world, and where we stand in the totality of all universes. And this process of which is continual and infinite, goes on, the further people are not completing their missions as examples for their fellow man to follow, and fail to justify their present moment actions, through whatever environment, family, location, face, name, or identity.
Prior
to the final incarnation; as we were existing within the bardo --
perceiving the details of our previous lies, the matrix of
incarnation, we have viewed the entirety of all the lives we have
lived -- to which we are awareized to our own energy, perceive our
effect on the world is direct, and we thus witness ourselves as
expressors, univeralists bound by universal law. We know that we have
lived before, that we possess a karma with other individuals, and it
is our mission to seek being enamored with the One True Spirit, that
we know there is only "one real truth" and that is the
concept of One. That there is only one person who needs to read this
book. That there is only One True Belief System, and universality is
to be wholly understood -- that there is an inborn logic to the chaos
theory of the universe -- we know that however patternless the
matrix, it always leads up to a righteous conclusion, to which we
know, verily, that we have lived before, and through awareness of the
incarnation system, we need not live again; -- but find ourselves
within the recess of the life of ascended master, discovering that
all matter is connected as born from the same Source, that there is
only One Source to the universe, and this to which is found within
the concept of the all-encompassing living circuitry referred by
Wilcock as The Source Field -- through entanglement, we are found as
One, connected, and it shall come to pass that telepathy is only
further proof of the concept of One -- that when all minds are merged
unto a singular sentience, and it would seem that we are thinking
together, we writhe through the akashic poetics of thought, and we
know, verily, that the information is alive . . .
Through the
life-force possessed by the living information, as all has come from
the same Source, information that is universal; here, we project the
mind such as to imagine the Source Field covers the body in a
luminescant shell of holographic information -- this shell of
holographic information, to which the body is bound, by the living
information, we imagine that the information which composes the body,
is universal, as the One True Light -- and we believe that this
universal information will be understood, in its own forms of Light,
and essence. That we inform ourselves through certain guides and
creators, of the most desirable information, and as suggested,
surround ourselves, and live, in a world of beauty and surprise. We
endeavor to stay enamored, to remain informed, knowledgable, and
intelligent. We are all inherently genius minds only distorted by the
consensus reality to believe otherwise -- that we are all
primordially, geniuses, is the truth that will find us in the final
analysis; that whence found within the recess of divine thought --
universal Light-based cogitations -- we are enamored with our own
capacity to produce a new thought, we see our future clearly, and we
know it can be changed at all times. Yet we also know that more
questions only lead to answers that only lead to more questions --
and for this unknowing, this which the imagination can only peer so
far into the depths of the future, we are to imagine the "apogee
of awareness" -- the ability to step back and look at the
universe from the periphery. Here, at her curved glowing edges, we
see the many things that occur, and how it is all invariably
entangled by the living information. We see ourselves within the
orchestra, and how we were involved. Realizing our genius was always
existent, merely distorted through limitation and the illusion of
separation to believe otherwise -- we see our place within the
multisphere, and we observe that we are merely energy.
Within
the viewing of the universe from the periphery, extended to the
macrocosm to the imagined aggregate of universes, to which the apex
is the governing point, and exists as though a body, in itself, as
fueled by the Light of the center. We imagine the universes, perceive
them visually, the multicellular constructs, which all move, flow,
and circulate through their own gravitation, and centrifugal force.
As we know this
universe
is endless, to which we are only capable of "imagining" the
outer sphere; we thus realize that the growth process of all
incarnated universes must be invariably growing; that however capable
of perceiving the aggregate, we are not sure if this matrix of
universes is the only aggregate, but must exist within a mirroring of
universes, that extends from the perceived center; of which there is
perceived another sphere which encompasses the aggregate, and thus a
growing multitude of multispheres. That we can further our thoughts
to imagine the concept of multiple multiversal aggregates, is almost
as deep as we can imagine -- that here within the perceived matrix of
aggregates, there is yet another governing body which contains this,
a cell within a cell, to which extends endlessly into the outer
sphere which only seem to continue to grow. In the totality of form
which is thus imagined, we now perceive cellular constructs composed
of aggregates, of spheres within spheres, that going from the
microcosm -- of thought -- to the macrocosm, of imagination, we
endeavor to provide ourselves with the furthest extension of
possibility -- to imagine that this is an endless matrix of spheres,
all collected, and gathered through the multiform process of which
all bodies surround the nucleus, which is our universe.
As the
Free Will universe is the fuel, and all humans are in essence energy
that is being used to power the entirety of the aggregates, located
at the imagined center, we are thus found the most important race
within all the universes -- that control over the humans means
control over everything -- and we have been as though slaves, through
the incarnation system, for many years. As we start to wake up with
the perceived spontaneous occurrence of DNA activation, to which the
Light enters our body -- we become the true fuel, as opposed to fear,
pure Light -- which is what really fuels all matter. As fear has
existed for quite some time, it would seem that the emanating scream
coming from our blue star has infected the entirety the multisphere,
that it would become naturally imperative for intervention of other
races from Pleiadian, to Sirian, to step into our reality, guide us,
and thus cause the remembrence of our true divinity, such that we are
aligned with the Light, the One True Light -- know that our effect on
the environment is direct, that control of the environment results in
evolution, and the totality of all environments which is the
perceived outer housing body, is imagined as energized by our Light
-- that we are the fuel -- we are the energy -- and the human race is
vital towards the evolvement of many, many lives.
As we are as
vital as the imagination will allow itself to be projected into the
conceivable future, as we are as alive, energized, and powerful as
the mind believes, our Godliness shall grow evident -- that we calmly
realize our true encodement is twelve-strand DNA, and however
scientists may refer to this as "junk DNA" -- there is a
purpose for the enlightened helix, that it will turn unto a new
strand through epiginetics, and grow like never before. We germinate
the seed with Light, and watch it grow. In our given environment, we
germinate the Earth with the seed of the imagination, as artists,
writers, and free-thinkers (evolutionists) -- changing the world one
person at a time. As we become enlightened cells, unique microcosms
of individuality, we are being learned from by beings in other
worlds, and much is being learned from the human race. We now further
the concepts to what is known as the Akashic Computer.
Chapter
Thirteen: The Akashic Computer
"The
imagination is the body of God."
-- William Blake
In
the free will universe to which we know, we have lived through a
matrix of incarnation all leading up to the final one. Found within
the recess of the New Age, we believe in a life of purpose and value
to the rest of the world. We hope to understand, through delvings
into the Akasha, and the living recordbook of the soul, we can be
educated by the information, and learn of certain things. Here, we
endeavor toward the thought of one of the greatest technologies that
exist in the free will universe. The Akashic Computer is able to tap
into any point in human history, and project the visual-audio-sensory
projection of the "film" that we view, of any location
within the continuum, to educate the viewer of things past. Here, we
see everything from the mutiny on the H.M.S. Bounty to the alleged
last days of Christ -- and learn from history as directly as can be
conceived.
The Akashic Records is alive, bound by living
information, and what we learn from our own future employment of the
Akashic Computer, will be seen as a device that is able to read into
natural probabilities, and theoretically peer into the future.
One
tape is put into the machine, is viewed, and then another tape is put
into the machine; another life, another soul, and through the Akashic
Computer it is like a movie-show that presents the details of that
file in selection. As this technology already exists with the
Pleiadians, and is being actively used to monitor human
probabilities, the Akashic Computer is theoretically a technology
that already exists.
Used for good or for ill, we are being
actively viewed on the screen. Our file exists on the computer, and
it is being read, and perceived by the "higher dimensionals"
the ascended masters. We are being viewed, actively, for the final
life that we are to know, as the final incarnation. The story of the
earth is possessive of astronomical proportions, and it has taken a
long time for us to re-realize the primordial Light. Finding the One
True Spirit, the life of the last incarnation we shall ever know, a
life of great value and importance to the rest of the world, as an
ascending master, that we are worthwhile creatures with a story to
tell, and a viewer for each subject -- a guide associated with each
soul -- that we are being viewed, and monitored, through the
probabilities which would result in the eventual "stepping out
of the screen" -- to which we reach the future such as to meet
our cosmic observers, and learn that they were with us all along.
Just as when we die, we are theoretically greeted with a trio of
soul-guides to which we view our life-tape, in the theory of the
Akashic Computer, we can theoretically tap into any one incarnation
that has existed in the past, and perceive the cinematic depiction
for which this life can be learned from, and utilized for the
present. We see the karmic relationships, the roles that have been
switched around over time, and the naturally recycling ang
re-integration of matter into the matrix of existence. We see the
matrix of existence, and learn directly from the images thus viewed.
As the imagination is the "body of God" -- and it is
through the imagination that we provide a reality for ourselves, the
theory of the Akashic Computer as operated by the living information,
is simply suggestive "if we can imagine it, it must
exist."
Just as if one were to construct a time machine,
we have in a sense already built the machine in the future, and we
are already time travelers. Just by imagining in the existence of the
Akashic Computer, we manifest the device into existence. Eventually
The Akashic Computer will be constructed, and used for
self-education. A cinematic bible, the living information that is
bound through images, words, and Light. As Light is information, and
the Akashic Records is just that -- information -- we perceive that
as information is alive, it will travel and be expressed naturally.
We are nye to learn from the most direct source, and through the
eventual construction of the device which lies in our near future, we
will be able to directly view any point in human history.
We
find the date, location, and time, and we enter it into the Akashic
Computer. The file of which is contained the historical details will
be presented in a linear fashion, to which we perceive the karmic
relationships, and witness ourselves in history. We are able to view
past-lives directly, able to see the totality of our human existence,
as already possible through the movie presented in the mind during
past-life regression, movies and films hold great truth in regard to
the true reality -- of which in this present moment, we are being
viewed on the Akashic Computer. God is omniscient, all-aware, and
everything is seen, understood, and perceived by the Universal Mind.
The collective unconscious of the human race is geared toward
evolution, and we are all -- as born from the same Source -- equals
in Light of our origins, that the past -- from the very beginning of
the free will universe, leading up to the present, is available
through the Akashic, to be learned from. As the Akashic Records can
be peered into by anyone, and we see evidence it was used much in the
life of Edgar Cayce, this universal Source -- is omniscient -- all is
seen, witnessed, and perceived. As we may endeavor into the
meditation of imagining a building that represents the hall of
records, and we ascend the staircase of files, films, and Akashic
media -- the many histories contained. We find the file of our own
life, our own matrix of incarnations, enter the file into the
computer, and view a certain time within the continuum. We now move
toward one form of meditation that relates to delving into the cosmic
storehouse of information:
I
am ascending a staircase. I see the many files. I perceive the hall
of records. I witness the glowing screen. Ienter one file into the
computer. The entire history of my life is contained within the file,
and I am able to peer into the past directly. I see my life clearly
on the screen. Some numbers suddenly show up, and they are my present
age. I see the numbers. Suddenly they start counting down, second by
second, and I see my life from age to age, going down, from one age
descending to the previous, only to find
ten-nine-eight-seven-six-five-four-three-two-one-zero-negative
one-negative two-negative three, etc. I learn from the most direct
Source, and I witness the details of my matrix of incarnations on the
screen. I take out another file, enter it into the machine, and
perceive yet another life. I see the roles are switched around, that
I am now living the life of someone else, and how energy is
transferred from one life to the next. I realize we never die, but
merely re-locate. I realize this has gone on for several millennia. I
know that the Akashic Records is alive, can be learned from, and
utilized for my soul-growth. I continue to ascend the great hall of
records, the files lead endlessly into the heavens. There seems to be
no end to the information, and I am utterly enamored with the
infinite power of the many presentations, and I realize these are now
leading up toward probabilities. I am now able to view the probable
future from each file, and I peer calmly into the depths of the
possible future. I see one future clearly. Taking out this file, and
replacing it with another, I view another possibility, and eventually
take one of these possible probabilities -- as the final choice --
step into the screen -- merge with my future self, and become one
with the probability, take this future as my own; and find myself
within the recess the moment, I realize I am alive in the New Age,
that my purpose is hard-wired into the collective DNA, and my story
is a beautiful matter. I can "think any thought" -- believe
anything I want -- because the imagination is the body of God -- I am
Light -- I am information -- and I create my own reality. I realize
that this was all a choice to begin with, that I chose to live here
in the Free Will universe, on the planet Earth, in this present age,
at this present hour, at this present minute, down to this very
second.
“The
imagination is the body of God.”
We
all have the capacity to imagine ourselves somewhere, and then
equalize into that existence. We all have the capacity, within our
subconcsious minds, to program ourselves, and choose what we want out
of life. We determine this, reality is owned by the imagination, and
the imagination can not tell the difference between what it sees and
what it remembers. We decide what is and is not real, whatever the
consensus reality may be, we are always in control, we always have
choice over what thoughts enter our heads, and we are all active
creators of the future. We are capable of imagining the future into
existence, and the powers of the mind in this respect are limitless.
As the universe is endless and only continues to grow the deeper we
endeavor to explore her outer walls, so knowledge is infinite, so the
universe is infinite, so the imagination must be infinite as well.
The imagination is our means for time travel, and through the
imaginative capacities we possess through visualization, or whatever
theme song resides in our psyche, we are always moving into the
future; always imagining ourselves there, and finding the inevitable
feeling of deja vu -- that we have been
here before. Somehow, we know this was all planned out, however
mysterious the thought may resound.
Through
the concept of inevitable probability, that we would be self-divined
unto the final incarnation, as a direct result of time, that the
imagination survives through expectation, and we are all bound
through what we expect out of life. Once conceptions ought to be
geared toward open-mindedness, a natural right-brain intuitive sense
of which we are always learning, and take it upon ourselves to
believe "in belief itself" -- that our theme of belief in
itself is suggestive that beliefs may change, but we still possess a
belief. We always have some belief, guiding oureslves, through the
natural theme of its imaginative projections -- and we equalize into
expected situations through the belief-patterns that we possess. As
belief is the matter which governes our reality, the belief in
Godliness, or an inevitable return to the Source -- may create a
future of which we are in either heaven or hell, that we possess
choice over which road, and the easiest choice is toward divination.
We hope to create our own reality through God-consciousness, and
universality, the natural understanding of absolutes, to which we
realize, calmly and carefully -- that this moment -- the present,
living moment -- the now -- is all we really have, that time does not
really exist . . . yet the subconscious mind is goal-oriented, so we
must feed it things that we expect to occur in the future. Whether we
like it or not, time only moves in one direction, and we may watch
the ticking clock -- and we may see the moving clouds -- and we may
pace, assuredly, through life, from one event to the next, knowing
that we are always possessive of Free Will, and control over the most
probable future that can be re-written through our understanding of
the Akasha. There are many things we can do, and the law of
attraction is no secret anymore, most people are smart enough to
already have a pretty self-modulated environment, and matrix of
relational inhibitors, from fellow friends, to teachers and guides,
we all must learn . . . . we all seek to learn of infinite knowledge,
and therein lies the power of absolutes.
So, "the imagination always resides in the present tense, yet is goal-oriented." And time only moves into the future, so we are always working towards some goal, and it shall seem that the concept of "new thought" and new knowledge, through whatever source, guide, or inihibitor.
Finding
the living moment, of which we reach the now-point of awareness,
finding the alpha wave patterns of the meditative state, here, we may
endeavor to meditate with the storehouse of knowledge -- punch a
certain date into the machine, and watch as the tape re-winds. We
view, actively, perhaps, a past-life, to something even deeper which
may have been a life on a different world. We view the Akashic
Records, and we may take this tape out, and put it another one at any
time. Each tape is a file in human history, and contains all the
karmic elements that progress from one tape to the next. All is
connected. We see, in the film, certain choice-points, and turns we
have made in life. Here, we may activate the "probability factor
mechanism" to which the machine will project the multitude of
most probable futures for a given tape. We will see each one --
whichever probable future we wish to view, through the many
possibilities, and personally choose which one we most desire. Here,
we program ourselves with the destination -- insert the tape into our
own soul-code, and wire it into our being. We tell ourselves what
will happen, and become equalized into this future.
The
machines possibilities are endless, and we see that knowledge is
endless in light of the concept of the ever-revised Akashic Records.
Through whatever imagination we possess, we can reside in a place
that is most productive of the greatest conceivable future. We
activate the future, we activate the goal, we activate through
proactive animation, and conscious future-based thought. This is
through the many possibilities of the device, able to fast-forward
into probable futures of each tape, and that future viewable as we
could have experienced, thus educated by the parallel reality.
Through whatever force of the imagination -- just by awareizing to
the Akashic Records is one way to begin a communique with it. Through
knowledge of its existence, we are primed to learn from the cosmic
Source. We perceive that history is in the making, as we are always
creating the future in logical relationship to the past. Riding the
wave of probabilities, we will view one future over another, find
favor in this locale, and integrate it into existence.
In
our ability to choose the future, we may eventually ambition to a
certain sight, that which is only destined so far. As the future is
endless, and we can very well watch ourselves grow aged and
wisdomatic through a certain future probability, in whatever parallel
reality, on the screen, through the Akashic Computer, that we are
able to program a future into ourselves through the endurance of
desiring one certain future the most; but we only peer so far -- we
can not, or at least choose not to watch the tape for very long, that
we choose a probability through a selection of about eight
probabilities, to which our ability to choose is the most
instinctual, we shall find this address, the XYZ info, and complex
details for which the event is programmed into ones psyche. In the
concept of the Akashic Computer, a computer that is hooked up to a
metaphysical storehouse of all human knowledge, thoughts, and events,
within a given locale, that we can tap into to view the future of a
certain probability, and thus choose one out of a selection of eight
-- God knows how far the possibilities may extend in light of the
concept. We find that reality is totally possessed and owned, and
ruled by the living, riverlight of the imagination. Interpolated into
the datasphere of knowledge, through every waking second, through the
concept of the now, to which we see the clock-hands move, and see our
eyes shift from point to point, and locate within ourselves that
inner core, the center, and see this as emanating Light -- we view
the screen -- full of information -- that courses outward through the
body, in Akashic propensity, and only grows in frequency the further
we imagine such things as the soul, and the Akasha, to exist.
The
universe, as made up of informational Light, is essentially built
around the records of the Akasha, and universal concepts found
therein. We imagine scenario's in our heads every day. We plan things
out, very often . . . the Akasha seems to be something we may be
using without realizing it, as it is simply infinite universal
information, and anyone who has an imagination can learn from this.
So we see it as evident with many writers and musicians, and artists,
and intellectual deep thinkers. We often may remain in a creative
state -- as some tend to -- and it only furthers our imaginative
capacities. So it goes, we continue to learn, we continue to grow,
and we continue to imagine the future through our incarnational
matrix which is understandable, and we see -- through our minds eye
-- what the perfect avatar self looks like, how this person is
behaving, and where they end up through their actions. Causally
entangled, all things, that we are all counterpart to one anothers
reality -- we continue to connect and learn from one another -- and
the actions we commit to the datasphere.
Chapter
Fourteen: The Universalist
"When
one has been totally possessed by God,
one finds that God is so
perfectly Lord over ones life
that one can no longer do anything
but what God pleases."
-- Madame Guyon
The
concept of absolutes, and universal principle, as derived from the
Akasha -- we may through meditation or hypnosis communicate with the
higher self, and the soul is always available to be learned from. We
all possess one, and we are all bound in existence by certain
uniqueties that set us apart from one another. As the oscillation
into indifference only makes the journey back to the Source more
worthwhile, it shall seem that as universalists, this journey is only
made into a proactive effort, but our individuality prevails. We
ambition to succeed through our universal belief-patterns, that we
are cogitating the same thoughts once cogitated by many a genius
mind, and we perceive there is
a
universality to human knowledge, that certain laws exist, irrevocable
laws which emanate from the heart divine -- for which are realized
through uniqueness -- paradoxically enough.
The concept of new
thought must leave us feeling enamored, that we perceive that, as
mystics, there is always something to learn. The spiritual quest is
neverending, that the questions which find answers only lead to more
questions. We perceive a “return
to the Source, as inevitable, but what lies between is the
imagination.”
As originally emanated from the heart of the universe, into human
life as governed by universality, only for a return to the Source to
relay back to God all that we have learned. As we do not know "when"
or "how" the return to the Source will be, we simply
imagine this future exists, that what once began -- shall end -- that
there is a conceivable climax to all human life, that knowledge ends,
and there is a point . . . where matter recycles, is renewed, and yet
still -- we realize we are still wholly ignorant in spite of our
knowledge, and realize that we have only brushed up against the tip
of the ice burg. What lies beneath the water is a mass of
astronomical proportions, a vast body of information that is all
future probabilities, and living matter -- that has always existed,
through the Akasha, and tones of universality -- as what lies beneath
the water is far more worthwhile than anything, and we endeavor to
search through the water, to view the entire body, and travel through
the Light-floes of information.
“As
we rise in vibration, the world rises in vibration, and we effect
everyone we know.”
The
path of Spirit, it shall seem, is like a continuum of realizations.
That through universality we can arrive at certain thoughts which
were once cogitated by so many genius minds, we hope to tap into the
universal fount of knowledge of the Akasha -- and we perceive,
through the endurance of such beliefs, that the world has a place for
us. We shall find that through a certain sense of indifference, and
uniqueness, we are only paradoxically brought closer together. As the
reality of evolution is the concept of "ascension to the highest
conceivable vibration" -- and this is reached through an
understanding of the absolutes. An absolute is a hard-grained fact, a
universal law which is backed up by repeated evidence. So we are
saying “we
shall find that through uniqueness, and indifference, and the
evolution of thought -- proving ourselves as unique sparks of Light,
self-contained vehicles for the concept of which is the collective
end eventually realized by all minds -- that however unique, the
end-result of evolution remains the same, and the end-result of
evolution is invariably reached over time. We always evolve. We
always reach nirvana.”
"The
end of thought are hard-set ideas . . . amorphous flow, belief in
belief itself, is the true one reality."
As
the universe is endless, so our environment must seem endless -- that
existence on other stars, or simply the other side of the Earth, we
can express our environment as something we know to be infinite,
through a continual progression of travel to one locale to the next,
as reduced to the minute activities of going from one space to
another, within ones own dormatorial cell. The home, the structure,
the cellular construct -- the glorious apparition, the hologram we
know as the third dimension, a fragile dimension, with a few static
rules. One is that matter is entangled with thought, and will travel
telepathically under the right circumstances. It will also be
affected telekinetically.
As we enter into the final life,
become ascended masters, and these powers of the extrasensory only
continue to remind us of our Godliness, “we
are involved in the life of greatest importance to the rest of the
world,”
that our thoughts are valuable in relationship to the total image,
the realized power that we possess, over our realities, and as we
find ourselves within the highest levels of Lightbody, we are found
"synchronized" -- found in experiencing events that are
seemingly lined up, and built around our furtherance of growth. In
the final life, we are involved in finding there is a natural order
to things, no such thing as coincidences, but all is seemingly "lined
up." And so it goes, whence found through tones of universality,
we are most aligned with the inner Light, and as such, our evolution
only continues to build, grow, advance, and flourish.
Chapter
Fifteen: Evolution Of The Soul
"No
thinking being lives who, at some luminous point of his life of
thought,
has not felt himself lost amid the surges of futile
efforts at understanding
or believing that anything exists greater
than his own soul."
-- E. A. Poe
First
we imagine the thought -- occurring within the phrenology of the
skull, of which our soul-essence vibrates within us, through the
thought. Then we imagine the body, of which thought is connected --
and move -- animate -- and activate through our own Free Will. Then
we imagine the containing space, the given room to which we reside,
which is to be found as an extension of the mind. All objects within
the room are thoughts, and they are moveable, and organizeable
through the endurance of our Free Will. Then we progress to imagine
the structure, the home, made up of many rooms to which we are able
to travel from one room to the next as governed by our own flow. Then
we progress to imagine the neighborhood, or surrounding environment,
and connexive flow of human life as found within a given locale. We
are able to travel this given enviroment, from one life to the next.
Then we imagine the aeriel view of the landscape, the mass of life as
committed to one given locale. We see the circuitry of all human life
that is all geared toward the most probable future. Then we progress
to imagine the total environment of the Earth, to which we are
teleconnected, and know ourselves to be One through our ability to
move from place to place. We further this imagining, to the total
image of the galaxy, progressed to the total containing image of the
universe, made up of curved walls, one universe amid the plethora of
all incarnated universes -- the Free Will universe which lies at the
center of the aggregate, fueling all of the other universes with our
creativity, and Free Will. The fuel emanates from the living library
of the Earth, and enlightens the totality with our advancements
through the continuum. We have come to imagine the original thought
-- the One True Belief -- thought of a thought in itself -- and we
writhe through this power of the endured creativity of ones
flexability of thought. Thought, within the given space, stretched
out to the macrocosm of the universe, we see All in a split second,
and nothing in the next pulsing of the heart divine.
As we
will imagine the soul -- how it may appear, the imagination provides,
most typically, auroric nebulous images, or a sort of orchestra of
Light. The evidence that twenty one grams of body weight seemingly
vanishes into thin air is suggestive that the soul bears some mass,
and as allegedly entered into the body through the pineal/crown
chakra, it is here where the soul-transmissions find their way into
our DNA. With the Light that is emanating, coursing through space in
the imagined riverlight -- that travels through the conduit of
Sirius, from the Source, into our DNA, resulting in the releasing the
information, and we learn our place, and we realize we are now
entered into the final incarnation. Here, within the recess of the
final life, it shall seem that through teleportation and immortality
-- that we are the shift -- we are the change -- we are the prophecy
-- and the concept of Lightworkers, evolutionists, and universalists,
is no figment of the imagination -- we are fueled by the Light of our
DNA, we calmly realize the free endless resource is something which
lies within -- and we are unique microcosms of Light within the
plethora of all existence. We calmly realize that the life of the
ascended master is one of great importance to the totality of all
incarnated universes. Our Light emanates, into all other universes,
gifting the many who exist with our great story of astronomical
proportions -- and we are the Light of the Free Will universe.
As
we are capable of imagining the totality of universes, with ours
located at the center, we imagine the soul -- the ascended master, as
able to travel from one universe to the next. Here, as interversal
travelers, we shall find other places where ignorance rules, seed the
star with our own Light, and thus continue the divine mission of the
soul imperative to provide Light where only darkness has formerly
reigned supreme. This is either done through avatar forms or the
process of incarnation. As darkness must always exist in reciprocity
to the Light, and we are learning that we never truly die, but
re-locate, we see that energy once expressed will continue to be
expressed, infinitely renewed by the Source -- and we are learning of
our place, and we are seeing how vital the human race is toward the
evolution of all universes. As we exist at the center of the
aggregate, and produce Light for the many universes, as the Free Will
Universe is like an energy-source, in its own right, we are the fuel,
we are the change -- the change that lies within the subconscious
mind, and all goal-oriented processes involved. Through the crockpot
of the subconscious mind, we are always working toward future
evolution -- and we know, verily, that our present thoughts will
carry us into the future, that we perceive ourselves as existing at
the periphery, the very conceived edge of the universe, if that is
possible. Perceiving all matter from the periphery, as endowed with
the original God-consciousness, we see our influence, and we know
ourselves to be worthwhile players in the total orchestra of human
life. We see our place, verily, and we understand that our effect on
the world, on the universe, on the multiverse, is direct. Through our
expressions of the Light/Information, the cosmic universal principles
-- and cosmic Law of incarnation -- that this dimension is merely a
hologram, and we are all capable of re-working the image to our own
specific fashion.
Present tensory thoughts of the "I Am"
-- to now-point realized, we shall see, that through "staying in
the moment" and the alpha-wave patterns of the meditative state
proving us most programmable, we are wholly empowered by our
Light-based cogitations, and writhe within the power of the living
moment.
Thought
is alive, and what we think, becomes.
We
were all born at a certain date, in a certain locale within the
universe, to grow up, evolve, and learn about our place. As we all
have a special place that is unique to us, we perceive the end of all
things -- the return to the Source, but calmly realize before the
return is finally made, we must writhe through the final life of the
ascended master; bound by the Light of the living imagination. We are
divine to be unique, and originality is something we all strive for
to make ourselves stand out from the rest. However entangled and born
from the same Source, we would never learn if it weren't for genius
minds like Einstein and Tesla and Edison to be integrated into the
datasphere of knowledge, through their own independent Free Will and
originality. As the concept of originality is in itself intriguing,
energy exists, it will always exist, and the probable future is
invariably realized. Such that the concept of a time machine thus
known and understood -- theoretically the time machine has already
been constructed in the future, and we are only realizing what has
already come to exist; as there is no real such thing as time in this
patternless, goal-oriented media known as reality, through the
operating system of the soul, that we actively choose what we want to
believe -- and we all possess the Free Will to believe in anything we
want . . . we all have the freedom to think any thought at any given
time -- to count the numbers of the thought just cogitated -- and
find ourselves within our own unique rhythm. However unique, the
inner genius always leads up to the same principles, that
paradoxically through indifference we essentially learn the same
things once learned by so many ascended masters before us. This
profound thought, that through uniqueness and originality, we
eventually tap into the world of universality, is suggestive that
energy which exists and will always exist, is simply represented
through a certain tint of Light, in one expression, as one
possibility, when the truth lies within the cosmic, universal
principle, such as re-incarnation, or the return to the Source. We
know these things to be logical in counterpart to the reality we have
found, and however unique, there are some principles that we
invariably follow which will never change -- guided by principle, and
universal law -- that our life as governed by experience, in especial
with experiences in the extrasensory, will work to suggest certain
principles such as "matter transcends reality" and "God
exists in the human body."
Matter
transcends reality.
Evidence
of this is seen in direct non-local thought-transferrence.
God
exists in the human body.
Evidence
of this is found in thought-transferrence experienced with total
strangers.
There
is only One True Spirit moving through everything.
We
reach eclipse in the final incarnation, the last life that we will
ever know -- one life -- one mission -- one goal -- one purpose --
One Spirit.
The
concept of a self-contained vehicle for Light is imaginable.
We
shall see, through the final incarnation, that reality as directly
manifested, proving ourselves self-contained vehicles for divine
Light, proxies for the energy of One. Through the endurance of
intuitive thought, and a certain effortlessness in our actions, we
find that as interpolated into the collective reality; our thoughts
are being shared, experienced, and felt by other people -- knowing we
effect people, that we are impressionable, and it only takes two
seconds to believe in someone, we would not learn if it were not for
some Source or guide -- such that we may pray to the ideals of
certain leaders, and people to whom we admire. Through the idealized
self, the perfect avatar self which is living in reciprocity with our
many masters -- we equalize into a life of great value and purpose;
as found within the final incarnation -- the only life that matters
-- the only reality which will project itself into the future.
We
are all vital elements in the evolutionary process, and as described
in the following chapter; I imagine a world of creators and
existentialists, people whose beliefs are based upon experience. Who
work to produce the suggestion in other minds that Light exists -- it
has always existed, and what will seem to be the future resource, the
free endless resource of the inner Light -- we shall see how the
future is growing -- is vast -- and clearly, infinite. We can stand
back, view reality from the periphery, and see ourselves within the
grand scheme of things. The evolution of the soul, as reaching the
final incarnation, is an inevitable occurrence through the existence
of time within the third dimension -- that everything which once
began, possesses the conceivable end of a return to the Source, we
perceive ourselves as betwixt the past and future -- with the present
tense our mode for future-manifestation. We realize the power of the
present, living moment, and we are able to cogitate any thought --
form any belief-pattern, and thus, provide whatever reality for
ourselves that we so deem fit for our evolution.
Chapter
Sixteen: Writers In The Free Will Universe
"Light
is Information."
As
Light is information, the matter which composes the universe, and
this living information will come to be expressed through timing and
synchronicity, that in the recess of the final life, a life of great
importance to the rest of the world, we may derive power from the
title of "writer."
As conscious thought is made up
of words, and words are essentally abstractions when repeated so many
times, and the subconscious mind operates in a patternless machinery,
that we infinitely reside in the present tense -- great power is
found by wearing this label as conscious thought is words, and
information expressed through words thus committed to the third
dimension through the written word -- we endeavor to view our
thoughts -- to construct them through rhythm and versification.
Before
physicality we were pure amorphous spirit-energy that could take on
any shape and form. Through such labels as writer, creator, or artist
-- within the Free Will universe -- our power is found in a creative
flux, and as we may channel from the higher self, guiding ones self
through the inner Light -- it may come to pass that seemingly
everyday individuals cast into the world of spirit start expressing
themselves as creators, and writers within the free will universe. We
see their Light, and we are inspired to express our own. We are
inspired by one another through our expressions, and energy once
expressed invariably leaves the residue of a thought form -- that in
the endurance of "new thought" or a unique turn of
cogitation, we may produce thought-forms of the highest value, and
focus our energy, thus, carefully and calmly, into the media of the
written word.
We
each possess a self-contained "uni-verse of thought-text."
A
concept which suggests that our thoughts possess a sort of
"thought-text" made up of letters, words, sentences, and
paragraphs. We may have entire paragraphs of thought arrive from the
mind through Akashic insight, and somewhat "manifest"
paragraphs within the mind. As thought is alive, and we find
ourselves committing our thoughts to the written word, as viewable
thought can be, here we perfect our thoughts through rhythm and
truncation, cutting down from line to line in a consecutive, often
rhyming flow. Rhyme will be employed at times in self-aggrandized
thought-patterns, that we are musical in our thoughts and express our
Light through lyrical cogitations. As we go from line to line, from
thought to thought, we will punctuate and add rhythm to words, "words
with rhythm" -- such that it is to be imagined that the
uni-verse of thought-text is inherently a masterpiece that already
exists, just as the time travelers time machine has already been
built and used in the future. The masterpiece exists in its entirety
as fully completed, within the subconscious mind, and writhing
through intuition we come to express this perceived masterpiece,
piece by piece, until our thoughts are constructed in such a way that
reflects the inner beauty of our soul.
We work to produce a legacy to some regard, whereas great power is obviously found in the spoken word as well, and through eloquent dictation we can easily channel the Akasha. Often streaming consciousness expressions are evidence of the universal thought-patterns, and in this we view the paragraphs of thought, work to perfect our cogitations. The uni-verse, in reference to the concept that Light/Information is the composing matter of the "unisphere" (physical body) -- in contrast with the “uni-verse.” (metaphysical body). The verse, in reference to the definition in reference to poetry, "metrical composition; poetry, especially as involving rhythmic form." We perceive each line as a thought, in a succession omnilinearly from one thought to the next, which may rhyme and flow through its own internal structuring. Truncation is the point to which one line stops, and the other begins, with the space found on another line, beneath the previous. We go from one thought leading up to the next in a seemingly logical succession. So it goes, the title of "writer" (it shall seem) is a powerful label to wear as it ties into the matter of our conscious thoughts, which are essentially words and semantics.
There
is
a rhythm to our thoughts, and as we may find through the reduction of
though to five, six, seven, eight, nine, and ten syllables -- the
root base syllabic rhythms, of which most thoughts will occur in
usually no less than thirty syllables. Our thought-text as occurring
in bright paragraphs that glow within our minds -- thought-text which
is all based around a natural rhythm of its own, we believe that the
universe is made up of Light/Information, so words -- within the
verse -- names -- titles -- artists and writers -- in the Free Will
universe, self-empowered by our expressions, and thus interpolated
into the datasphere of knowledge by our legacy of Light, that are
built into the far-but-realizable future of a return to the Source,
and the relaying back to God all that we have learned through our
creative expressions, and Free Will.
"One
is a writer in the Free Will universe."
Through
the label of writer, we will be divined to a uni-verse of
thought-text that is divine in the sense that our "world of
thought" is contained of a certain vocabulary, certain words,
and thoughts which upon repeated use only serve to empower us. As
writers, we will come to express our beliefs through the imagination,
using our favorite words, thoughts, and phraseology. It not only
gives us confidence in the belief we can share our thoughts, but that
thought in itself -- upon principle -- is worthy of being shared at
all. In a world where duality seems to be hard-wired into us, and
many beliefs and ideas separated through the many labels that exist,
it shall come to pass through time, in all conclusion of events, that
there is only One Spirit -- only one life -- only one mission -- only
one masterpiece of thought. And universal principle is reachable
through the subconscious mind. Our society will concern themselves
more with the intuition, and focus on the powers of the imagination.
The label of writer will empower us to express our thoughts; and
through the sharing of our beliefs, we only inspire others to share
their own. Thought flows, as a river, into the ocean of the
datasphere, infinitely integrated through time, that we are
transceivers, both capable of inputting and outputting energy;
oscillating from "input mode" to "output mode" --
and we are always shifting from one creative media to the next, one
room within our environment to the next, one focus, one idea, one
thought, one belief, in whatever medias that will form through time.
We shift from one creative media to the next, and we may go from
writing, to something visually focused, we writhe in a world of
beauty and surprise, spontaneity, and a continual self-renewal of
learning and evolutionary growth that never ends but only continues
to build and rise in frequency and vibration through all matter
within the continuum.
Of course we wear many labels, but there
is only One True Spirit behind everything, and so it shall seem
attaching a name is one specified form of self-limitation employed
for a means of better growth. A name to what is otherwise simply
referred to as Light, energy, or information. Writers, artists,
creators, manifestors, self-expressors, evolutionists, universalists,
mystics, Lightworkers, many labels are empowering to us, and as we
are amorphous, we may thus shift from one label to the next in the
entire scope of our evolution. I personally draw Light from the label
of writer, as I see this tied into my own obsession with words --
that I am a writer, in my soul, and as such, I perceive the title as
empowering through the relationship to the expression of my thoughts,
and I have a perceived audience -- some who are willing to read my
text, thus, I am inspired to share the information I come to believe
over time. Shifts through the title worn, the focus shifted, and we
are empowered from one label to the next, that we know ourselves to
be amorphous -- as such, the label of “shape shifter” is
one mode of theme for which the writer may realize. As
shape-shifters, or simply evolutionists, believers in belief itself
-- the concepts thus endured, the label thus worn, the theme thus
focused upon, the result eventing toward conclusion; the conclusion
logically realized, and the uni-verse of thought-text seemingly
divined through its own glowing vocabulary, punctuation, and rhythm
of verse.
As there is truly only One Spirit behind everything,
we thus perceive the word: "Spirit" -- a concept in the
mind, simply in reference to the ethereal, metaphysical realm.
Something which lies in the depths of the imagination, as a concept
we attribute our faith-patterns in reference to the holographic
totality -- we are all born from the same Source, our thoughts will
travel telepathically under the proper circumstances, and we all
learn of the true reality of the One True Spirit that moves through
everything, in time. This belief that there is only one life -- one
belief -- one mission -- one goal -- we are activating our awareness,
our capacity to live through the inner genius, as one perceives a
world of geniuses and writers, many titles exist, but there is only
One True Spirit -- and we are thus found as just that -- Spirit, as
born from the same Source, eventing toward an eventual return via
one-consciousness. Universality is real, there are some things with
the third dimension such as the seasons and rebirthing of life, that
would never change if it were not for our movement into the New Age,
and the final incarnation. Here, we perceive the zero hour, the end
of the third dimension, in transition to the fifth octave, where
time is harnessed, and we are wherever we want to be; utterly
synchronized, and wholly enamored with the self-created reality. This
is a probable future that we all incarnated on the Earth to
experience the divination of our souls toward the final life as
ascended master. Naturally, ascended master is just another label --
we may wear a certain title, a certain name, even changing our names
in some cases, that we are however born from the same Source,
uniqueties who writhe on tones of ones own unique hue of expression,
we are made divine through our uniqueness, as God is unique -- now
incarnated into the system with the rest of us as the multitude of
angelworkers, various unique God-embodiments, made divine through
their indifference; guiding the mass flow through
integration.
Angelworkers, yet another label, they are simpy
Spirit -- One People -- God-embodiments (another label), expressions
of the primordial Light. Lightworkers, it will seem, is another
empowering label, we work to express Light, and transmute matter from
one form into the higher octaves through the natural adherence to the
universality and Akashic principles of the One True Spirit.
Lightworkers are essentially evolutionists who work toward the
furtherance of belief, concept o fepiginetics, and the rebirth into
the final life. Angelworkers are in many cases ascended Lightworkers
who reached their hightest levels in Lightbody, and graduated the
third dimension, entered into the higher octaves, thus existing
"outside of time, outside of the matrix" -- acting as guide
and catalyst for certain people to be intervened with through the
mission of universality that is possessed, and they all operate as
One. The deducement that "God exists in the human body" in
reference to the angelworkers, is eventually found in the recess of
the final life; and as our karma manifests as more direct, and
thought creates reality -- through tones of the Light -- and living
information -- within the living environment -- we are rising in
vibration body, mind, and soul; all energies eclipsing toward the
highest conceivable frequency thus eventing toward the graduation
from the third dimension, and integration into the higher octaves
such that we ourselves become an angelworker/ascended
master.
Graduation from the third dimension through the
ascension process, and evolution of ones physical being through
Lightbody, as integrated into the rows of the ascended masters, it
will seem that we become true missionaries for the Light, and work to
spread information where only darkness and ignorance has stood
before. As darkness must always exist in reciprocity to the Light, we
will always have work to do, and places to interpolate our knowledge
into those spheres of knowledge. As guides, another label, we are
catalysts for change, another label, but essentially, individuals --
uniqueties -- thoughts -- names -- titles -- information -- we
are all information -- as
we are found in Lightbody, we are in a sense informed, physically
through our enhanced pineal, and risen dimmer switch of the DNA
activated to that new strand. It is a physical change, into the
status of "informed" -- and we will channel, many of us,
divine cosmic principles, as bound through tones of universality, and
the One True Spirit.
The New Age, the time for learning, peace, longevity, and self-renewal -- the Cosmic Spring of the universe -- as we are the energy -- we are the fuel that regulates all other universes through the experiment of Free Will. Our Light changes the world, as we are world-changers. We perceive, as universalists, or simply praying as informational Light governed by the One True Spirit -- proxies for information -- catalysts, artists, writers, many things, but essentially One: the collective aggregate, the totality of all human existence -- as the mind of God -- the God-consciousness that is eventually realized through the transition into the final life, the final incarnation. "We are alive in the New Age" -- a powerful thought to endure, that we came to this Free Will planet to learn about ourselves, and see how able to express ourselves, and thus change the world through our own self-contained vehicle, we have come here with a purpose, a mission in mind, and we writhe through the focus of our beliefs -- we see the themes -- the message -- and we focus this message into the fraze, the unique thought, thus made more Godly through uniqueness -- living the final incarnation, the one true life that matters, our greatest life, our masterpiece of existence. Writhing through supersentience, and God-consciousness, we eventually find ourselves within the final title of God, in itself. As we reach God-consciousness, and we are thinking the thoughts of God, we are thus identified with the energy of the Source -- transmit information actively, and calmly walk through the midst of the unknown, knowing that the future is new, and each day is a new opportunity; that however once all seems to have been learned, the movements of the heavenly bodies, and matter of the dimensions, continue on -- we find ourselves in control of the weather -- we find ourselves telekinetic, hyperenvironed, in the recess of the new -- that we have reached the seemingly now-point, but the movements of matter continue on -- as matter is infinite -- we thus work to produce the future of our own choosing.
As
our energy is infinite; our mission is divine, and we are divine
Light, we are informational, cosmic believers, evolutionists, and
active creators of the future -- co-creators. We are One, in the
final analysis, responsible for all of this. They attributed our
energy with a name, referred to as God. Many refer to the totality of
All That Is -- the Source, and all that has come from the emanating
fount of Light, through informational tones, and frequencies, and
vibrations, and super-strings, as God -- otherwise perceived as the
Universal Mind -- the Source Consciousness -- the nirvanic conclusion
of all human thought . . . this is it, we realize, the final analysis
. . . we calmly accept our place . . . we realize our effect on
reality has been direct . . . and we know that we are alive in the
recess of the final life.
In the recess of shared thought,
what is a very Godly experience, our beliefs are wholly re-shapen by
the profundity of shared sentience, that the host of the event who is
in Lightbody, will transmit his thoughts non-locally through
transferrence, and thus tap into the "mind at large" -- the
primordial God-consciousness that lies in the root of every human
soul.
In my case thus channeling information about the unisphere, cells, and how the entire universe is made up of cells, that telepathy is possible with subjects who are not in Lightbody, through the projection of the One True Spirit -- the perceived host -- is a suggestion that One is all that is necessary for collective change. In what is referred to as "ontological suggestion" we place the thought within the minds of the subject, that we are enlightened, we exist through universality, as eventually realized as God-consciousness, within the recess of the final life. Our life matters, we can change the world through our one existence, all that is required is one person -- as it would be it only took one man to stand up when the genetic alterations were being made to the human race, and much love associated with the concept of a messiah. We all are saviours, healers, and guides -- eventually to be found within the ascended life of the angelworker -- guiding certain people -- integrating ourselves into certain peoples realities, to inform them that they are awareized within the mind of One, the caretaker for the planet Earth. Such that we event our way toward the final conclusion that God exists in the human body; God is aware; through the Akashic Computer; and we are invariably learning from the most direct and universal Source -- of the Light that lies within -- the complex DNA information released upon the firing off of our phylogenic memory packets; and the Lightbody of the ascending, final life of the ascended master. The most worthwhile, important, and vital element within the grand totality of All That Is -- great purpose resides within that One; we are all unique sparks of the original One True Spirit, as seemingly holofractal bits and pieces that work in collective orchestra toward the finalmost realizations.
Finding
the rules of the third dimension are changing with belief, that the
extrasensory events we have begun to experience are suggestive that
matter is entangled, and the movements of the universe will continue,
and all future thought, all concept of the new, will leave us in a
permeating stasis of grace, a certain presence of awareness, a
certain power over all things -- that we see other worlds in trouble,
and thus come to the plea of the ignorant soul, and take it upon
ourselves to act as angelworker. Otherwise, we remain in the stasis
of divine thought, reside in existence alone, and humbly observe --
as our effect on the universe is found in observation alone -- we
perceive that through this, our creations will only continue to
further themselves through the process of evolution, and return to us
in due time. We perceive that all the life we have produced through
the One Spirit we possess, has been fragmented into the illusion of
separation, and may require our intervention in order to guide our
creations back into the proper path of Light. So we see other worlds
in a period of darkness and duality, act as ascended master on those
worlds. The self-contained vehicle of Light, we find that we are only
one person -- who is responsible for everything, and goodness lies in
the heart of one who believes himself capable of changing the
world.
It
only takes two seconds to believe in someone.
As
this is so, and many of us are impressionable enough, it is theorized
that we never truly learn unless we are willing to be "changed"
by our fellow man. As the next revelation would suggest that the
highest act is connection with another, we see that we can not learn
unless there is some source. Here, we will pray to certain people for
our existential growth-process, and learn of human nature, behavior,
and psychology. We thus "expect to be changed" just as we
may admire the cover of a certain book, and tell ourselves that the
text will change our life. We
expect to be changed.
As
we are always moving into the future, and time only moves in one
direction, our learning and growth is infinite, and never ceases to
flow. Continually interpolated into the Akasha with our own unique
hue of Light, we are in self-contained vehicles for Light -- cosmic
individuals -- individuated by our own unique beliefs, however, it
shall come to pass through evolution, DNA activation, and
epiginetics, that the final One true belief, is belief in belief
itself. To which we never continue to learn of new possibilities,
only to find the final graduation from the third dimension. In the
end, we realize our place as God -- as the One True Spirit -- as
wholly responsible, and calmly aware that we were influential, we
have an effect on the world, and we remember where we have been, and
where we wish to go.
Chapter
Seventeen: Acknowledging The Shadow
"Let the past, present, and
future, eclipse . . ."
In this to which is the final
life we will ever live as a human being, never to incarnate here
again, but take this One body with us, immortalized, as integrated
into the final life of the ascended master. We must rid ourselves of
the demons of the past, and dredge certain things into Light in order
to reach greater awareness. The past exists to be learned from, and
as alleged, it is now possible to regress to the imaginetic
representation of a past-life once lived on the Earth, and how it
relates to the present.
In
this, we perceive the karmic relationships, and awareize that we all
affect one another, and where great power resides in the life of the
mystic recluse, God knows, we can not all survive via occlusion, but
seem to require some assistance from others in order to grow and
learn. So we see, through the matrix of incarnations, that the
shadow, the fear, the doubt, and questioning of ones self-worth has
existed in the past, as experienced with certain relationships. We
have some mistakes made in this life which we feel are perhaps
unforgiveable, and thus writhe through guilt and shame that we are
not worthy of divination. But of course we are worthy of divination,
the past may be absolved by the future we create -- and we know that
all sins, crimes, and ill-behavior, will be reckoned with, in time,
by the final judge of the ascended master, or angelworker, through
divine intervention. Here, we find that God does not hate us, but
decrees us worthy of existence within the Universal Mind. Perceived
as worthwhile, a vital element for the totality of the whole, one
holofractal piece of the entire matrix of All That Is -- as we come
to find through expressions of uniqueness, and individuality, we are
to find ourselves through tones of creativity, and creative
thought-patterns, able to "transmute the darkness into Light"
-- that we may reduce a thought to mere syllables is one thing, but
to take a thought, and translate it into something else is a great
power which is like a software within the mind, which we use to
program ourselves toward the highest degree of sentience, and
self-awareness.
Transmutation
is the reformation of matter from one form into another.
Through
spontaneity, and obfuscation, we can decrypt our thoughts via
poetics, and creativity, and reside within the safety of the
transmuter, the transmuter which is the imagination. As one thought
may dampen our spirits, the consequenting thought may not be as so.
We can count the syllables of the ill thought, reduce it to a mere
number, and thus find ourselves rhythmic, beatific, unitized to the
bits and pieces of thought recessing from one form into another,
repeatedly, through transmutation. Autosuggestion and affirmation are
other powerful tools, that the thought "I like myself"
repeated a hundred times a day will result in a more successful
individual. We hope to surround ourselves with beauty and
information, keeping ones self enamored to a world of surprise, and
all thought revolving around the perceived future -- time is the
great healer, and no past mistake can not be fixed over future
choices, and better steps taken toward the eventual reunion with the
Source. In acknowledging the fear, and admitting that we are at times
fearful of the unknown, of the future -- we realize, there is yet
another thought, and time, and animation is the great healer.
Animation is life, and we will writhe through proactive animation,
organizing the environment, and always staying enamored with the
beauty and information. The shadow will come to be acknowledged as an
old thought, transmuted into a rhythm, and reduced to a simple
understanding. The thought is possessed, owned, by our conception of
reality. With the belief shaped by experience, and the experience
invariably divine as embroiled in a world of beauty and Light -- we
know that the future is rife with endless possibilities for new
choice-points to be realized, and new relationships to make up for
failed ones. The past -- as re-writeable, and transmuteable, as
understandable once committed to the mind of another, that we know
for everything there is a safe place -- and we do not need to fear
the occlusion, or solitude we sometimes possess.
We are
converters of darkness into Light, and we see the meaning behind what
is before us, that there is a meaning to all things, and we can
perceive this with our minds eye. The past is learned from, and it
will be learned from through past-life regression and meditations.
And it will be learned from through our experiences with other
people. As new relationships are formed in correction of past
mistakes, and we form new union with higher vibrations, we find
vibrations that resonate with our own; we shall grow through the new
relationships formed, and learn from one another toward realizing the
most radiant probable future. The shadow will be acknowledged as what
was, but not what must become. It is merely a thought, a memory, a
fleeting memory within the totality of All That Is -- that one
mistake, that one crime, that one sin -- in contrast with the
totality of All That Is -- is a mere fleeting memory, and will be
washed away in time. The future is infinitely realized, and God
knows, if we are truly to become teleporters in harnessing of time,
it will seem that all past mistakes are rectified by a future of
which we actively create our own destinies, and karma is instant, and
thought directly manifests -- further, through what new relationships
are formed in the final life, we know, calmly and carefully, that we
are home within the eyes of another.
Let
the shadow be dredged from the abyss, studied, and learned from, in
order to be transmuted into another form, over time. Let time eclipse
to the recess of which we are teleconnected, and able to create
reality directly. Let new relationships be formed that reflect our
inner Light, and let the new relationships form act as primers and
catalysts and guides and suggestions toward the highest conceivable
vibration. Let us learn from the past such as to never repeat it; let
the mind entertain us with the cinematic bible of the Akashic
Records; and let our every cell be eclipsed to the final thoughts of
self-awareness, divine Light, information, and continual
growth.
Chapter
Eighteen: Divine Intervention
"When
a man has come to this point in his pilgramage to the center of God,
his cross will be most severe.
God will keep him under the most
abject humiliation; that, despite the fact that the Lord will find
great delight in that man.
The Lord will cause this one to appear
very feeble and very ordinary."
--
Anonymous
What
are referred to as angelworkers are ascended masters,
God-embodiments, who will intervene as guides, or cosmic messengers,
into the lives of certain people. Through divine intervention, the
path of certain suicidality and self-destruction, is avoided through
intervention. What once was darkly-inclined, and only able to
ill-perceive the rest of the world, is now re-awakened to the truth
that God exists. And not only this, God exists in the human body.
Angelworkers are like the adjustment bureau imagined by Philip K.
Dick -- who work "outside of the matrix" -- outside of
time, teleporting shape-shifters who are telepathic, telekinetic, and
able to manifest matter seemingly out of thin air. These
God-embodiments are the most powerful men and women who exist on the
planet Earth.
In, or around, I believe, September of 2011, I
had my life intervened by a pair of angelworkers.
As
suggested previously in this text, I was at the restaurant in Bar
Harbor -- Two Cats restaurant, and felt as though the entire event
was staged. I would see a young asian girl eating dinner with an
older man that reflected a failed relationship of my own with a
Japanese girl. I calmly cogitated the thought "I want to die"
-- fully believed in it, and then I noticed the strange behavior of
the two girls sitting across from me. "Ideal!" one said,
"Ideal!" the other replied, in congenial agreement with
whatever they had been talking about. The girl furthest from me made
a comical "brr'ing" sound that sounded like my name, and I
would be startled by their laughter. It was not long until direct
non-local thought-transferrence had me having my thoughts read by the
two girls, in an event of shared thought that began with the words
"telepathy is one thing, but flying! . . ." to which they
would each reach down, and pretend to be petting an invisible cat, as
though it were me. The whole thought of "if this is possible,
then maybe this is possible" tends to occur when telepathy takes
place, and I have only achieved telekinesis once, while on LSD, but
we see through the evidence that it is a resounding truth, if
telepathy will occur, then other things like teleportation and
telekinesis must occur as well. As the girls were reading my
thoughts, I was urged to "go, go, go," as I soared through
my most creative and imaginative thought-patterns, a certain
lyricality that would never cease. The girls would read my thoughts,
and react with laughter, and say things in direct response to the
thoughts I was broadcasting. They were totally reactive to my
thoughts, and repeatedly made the point to inihibit me with the
thought that I am known, within the minds of the angelworkers. As the
two girls were reading my thoughts, I refused to make eye contact,
and was very nervous when it was my turn to place my order. Once they
were "finished with me" they got up and walked out, for me
to never see them again.
In this life, to which I have had an
abduction dream at the age of two, I have been "intervened with"
-- it would seem -- countless times. That my reality is shaped by the
inhibitions of outside forces is only evidenced in my experiences
with the angelworkers. One feels somewhat terrified upon reflecting
on the event, and requires an outlet to share the details with. I
have my outlets, but they are not enough. There must be some
scientific explanation for how God works, and I believe that the
humans are capable of finding this out. As much as I am faith-based,
I have beliefs essentially shaped by experiences in the extrasensory,
I know that science is going to be understood in reflection toward
telepathy and teleportation, some day. I know that there must be some
scientific explanation for these events.
In September of 2012,
I nearly got hit by a car, and died.
I was walking alone, as
described earlier in this text, with no money and no plan. I saw the
symbol of the caduceus in a dead bird, and then a dead snake coiled
up in the road. I was about ten miles into my walk when I was
anchoring my ability to see through the coming headlights. One car
finally came, but it did not pass me by; it slowed down to a halt,
geared itself in my direction, and then took off so as to run me down
. . .
My reaction was purely instict.
I "ran
towards the Light."
Upon near-collision, I found myself
standing further up the street, watching as the car veered from left
to right into a sliding halt. I had teleported, physically, from one
point to the next, in the mere blink of an eye. As a result of being
amid what is evidently the highest levels of Lightbody, God, the
collective unconscious, the Universal Mind, or simply "the
universe" -- chose to intervene that night, and save my life
through the other-wordly, and reality-bending event of physical
re-location. I remember, and I destinctly recall that I felt like I
was in my body the whole time. I was aware the whole time, and it was
no memory lapse, nor was it a hallucination. As the mind will
gravitate toward the safest deducement, and I had myself hospitalized
following the event, we realize, these things do
happen,
and it is all a result of being in Lightbody.
In mythology, it
is suggested that birds will sometimes land on the heads of
saints.
One day I was with my family walking in the park,
deeply hungover, when I was holding my aching head, watching only the
ground beneath me. When I heard my name "Hello Brendan"
spoken by the girl I was presently in love with, walking
synchronistically in the opposite direction. I looked up and saw her,
and my headache went away immediately. The next day I was outside,
having a smoke, when I heard what sounded like purring -- a bird
neared, and then swooped up, and landed on my head. When I went
outside to tell my friend Josh what had happened, he was surprised
and told me he had never heard of them doing that. I went outside,
and resumed smoking, when another bird (or the same one) came and
landed on my head again.
Just as I would see the caduceus in
the dead bird, and the coiled snake, the very day of my teleportive
event, it would seem that the universe has intervened countless times
in my life, through abduction dream, UFO sighting, experience with
the angelworkers, to the odd experience with the bird.
But
to imagine we are being watched over is one thing -- to actively
"expect" intervention is another thing. One can expect
their way through life, naturally, and we are often found in a world
of synchronicity and magic when we are truly in touch with the
universe.
As intervention, from God, has occurred in my life,
from telepathy to teleportation, I am "enamored" -- I feel
the presence, and I know that God has incarnated into the system with
the rest of us. God is multiform, and wears many faces. The
angelworkers, our perceived "adjustment bureau" -- (I
believe) see life from the apogee, from the periphery as residing
outside of the shell that covers the Earth -- peering through the
translucence, into the lives of certain people, seeing the
probabilities of a certain life, will personally intervene -- and
integrate their existence into the memory of the subject, thus
inhibiting them with the belief that God exists in the human
body.
The science behind this event must relate, somehow, to
certain technology that is employed. Through whatever mainframe or
database, our file exists on the computer, and our existence is
presently being viewed on the Akashic Computer. They see you reading
my book, and they see the probability of where the dream of awakening
may take you. They see your process in evolution, and they see that
it is good. But they also see you ripping out the pages, and burning
the book down to its binding. They also see you writing your own
book, and proving that you can put such thoughts into more better
text than what already exists. They also see the future where you
exist in union with them, during what we loving refer to as the
"Great Show" -- a great reunion of souls. They see many
futures, and the probabilities are being viewed. Existing in league
with the greatest conceivable ships, computers, and technology, from
portals to holocells, the angelworkers are so technologically
advanced they can view future probabilities via their own computer
system, and integrate themselves into the lives of certain people who
are on the path of destruction.
I was suicidal in the very
moment I saw the asian girl with the older man, and I fully believed
in the thought "I want to die." I have had three near-death
experiences in this life, and I know that intervention must have
occurred each time. I would not be alive to write this text if it
were not for divine intervention saving me from deletion from the
matrix, and thus forced to re-incarnate, perhaps, somewhere else, and
try again . . . fortunately, I am still alive on the planet Earth; my
life intervened with, and cosmically entangled with the perceived
angelworkers and ascended masters. As I have had the abduction dream
in my infancy at the age of two, and am forever-haunted by that pale
noseless expressionless face, I know that divine intervention is
something that occurs, and has occurred, countlessly through history.
Just as the Dogon tribe were informed by the Sirians about the
existence of Sirius B, the blackhole, well before any scientist or
astrophysicist had discovered it, and just as the pyramid of Giza was
theoretically built with ET influence, intervention has been
occurring countlessly through history -- that the Free Will universe
-- would be a place where there are no laws, and thus, no rules
declaring us incapable of intervening in certain peoples lives.
For
the humiliation, and the reduction of ones reality to that of another
-- through intervention, we are somewhat forced into belief in a
human God. Some people are just amazingly powerful, or simply
geniuses, it would seem. That we imagine a group of hackers who are
using computers to watch over us is one thing, but to actually find
ourselves intervened with, directly, providing direct evidence of
their existence -- is another. The angelworkers probably do employ
certain technology that allows them to watch over us, omnisciently,
through their own extensions of Free Will. As our world is presently
dystopian, many run in circles over money, and often we are unable to
walk the spiritual path due to an excess of too many choices, thus
preventing our ability to choose. In the self-limiting to a select
array of choices, we will find the highest life, and be in union with
the ascended masters, however, and connection and integration is the
final realization. For the mystery that surrounds the two girls
simply perceived as modern mystics, or "witches" -- we see
that it is possible they are simply extraordinary individuals who
just "happened to be able to read my mind." Of course we
know there are no coincidences, all is invariably set up staged and
synchronized. “Just
as the timer traveler has his time machine fully constructed in the
future, and knowledge of how it works is enough to ellicit
time-travel,” we
see that just by knowing the technology exists, it must be actively
employed by someone
who
holds the cards.
"But
it did happen."
I
imagine that the fields of energy produced by our telepathy -- was
seen, on some computer that detects fifth-dimensional energy, and
thus the "controlling forces" were alerted to the event
that took place in October of 2009. Ontologically terrorizing my
friends through broadcasted thought, I would produce the karma for
myself that this would end up coming back to me -- having my own
thoughts read, by the angelworkers. As I am in Lightbody, and I am
aware of this through the symbol of the caduceus sent to me in my
dream of awakening -- I realize that my karma is now direct, and what
choices I now make in this which is my last incarnation, will be
carried with me until the end, if an end could be imagined. As I
would fall into desperate times, and start shoplifting alcohol for my
own desperate gain. One day, I was getting high with some friends in
the company of an indigo child. The indigo child who was present that
one night we were getting stoned -- would speak in a strange
language, and then look at me and say "you steal!" Through
the proxy of the Indigo, the angelworkers have intervened again. How
did the little girl know that I was a shoplifter..? And what was
that
language..?
Great mystery resounds in light of the event; but
my most profound experience with the angelworkers was with my
autistic cousin, who seemed to be channeling, with altered vocal
registers . . . the voice of his father, and sister, who were
discussing world domination.
They
were talking about world domination, these "two" ruling
forces, a male and a female, the father and daughter, and somehow, I
was related to their grand scheme. Many odd statements would be
spoken, and it would seem that my uncle and cousin were planning
world domination. As I would lie awake in the bedroom hearing the
voices of my uncle, and his daughter . . . it was my autistic cousin,
in a channeled state, relaying the voices of the "two"
controlling forces who presently rule dominion over the Earth, and
human life. Through the proxy of my autistic cousin, the two ruling
forces were channeled, as I have had only one other experience in
perceiving their discussian, I perceive these were the present rulers
of the Earth.
Once, under the effect of some very potent
marijuana coupled with the effects of a horrible mood stabilizer, I
was cast into a fearful state and had drug-induced psychosis for a
brief period of time. I heard, at first, the page of a book blowing
in synthetic wind in my bedroom, and then, I heard them.
They
were talking about me, of all people, and as before, were discussing
world domination. Their voices were whisperry, and seemingly
reptilian. It sounded like a pair of "creatures" -- and I
have had experiences with panic attacks that resulted in hearing
static
in
my head. At one time, after a drug-induced panic attack, I would hear
a static loop in my head, with a perfect skip at the start of each
loop. Was this the machinery, the whirring of the computer that is
used by the angelworkers to watch over me..?
Philip K. Dick
would go far into the depths of paranoia in his own spiritual quest.
He would at one time fear that people were out to get him. As I have
had two outstanding attempts on my life, with one involving imagining
myself dead -- that resulted in the "manifestation" of a
tiny adhesive bandage on the top of a lightbulb that would have
exploded if I hadn't unplugged it in time. The other attempt on my
life was with the crazed driver. Such that his life and mine are now
entangled, whoever he was, I am sure when I blipped out of sight, and
his perceived victim vanished into thin air, left him with his own
notions regarding the concept of a human God; that is my own
existence.
As we move through this life, advancing as we will,
it will become our own task to act as God.
The
responsibility over all the world, and the universe, will be ours
alone. We take it upon ourselves to change the world. We think the
thought "I am human evolution." And we cogitate the belief
with surety in our words. We are the change. We are the shift, and
the shift lies within us. Our hopes toward a better life, the highest
existence, as equalized to the same status of divinity as the many
ascended masters -- will carry us into the future -- and as I have
been guided, so you may be reckoned with, by the existence of the
human God. Walk this road with grace, and know that your file exists
on the computer. Someone is in control, two people, imaginable . . .
like the double helix, we are seemingly governed by a world of two's,
and duality. We seem to be manufactured for control. So it has come
to pass that the experiment would reach a logical conclusion found in
the harnessing of matter, and time, living the final life of an
ascended master. We are nye to become that angelworker intervening in
the life of the suicidal, making it our personal responsibility to
act as guide; the interventionary measure expressed for the sake of
the Earth, and the collective.
As the chance encounter with a
stranger will be a guide, and we all guide one another, it shall come
to pass through the evidence of direct experience that we are
being
monitored, and our thoughts exist on the computer. The Akashic
Computer, for better or for worse, is being used by the perceived
angelworkers, and they see probabilities through the matrix of
relationships, that is directly productive of the future. Integrating
themselves into certain peoples lives, such as the man on the bus,
one I met on the internet, and the two girls at the restaurant, it
would seem that this reality is staged, things are more synchronized
than we could imagine. There is a natural order to all things, and
the angelworkers are simply a logical counterpart to the infinitude
of the imagination. If we can imagine it, it must exist, somewhere,
somehow. Just as the world of Star Wars is in a theoretical world of
its own, that is lightyears away from our own star-system, it is thus
imagined that the story -- in its omnilinear scope of evolution, is
like that world, of which the fictions are realities, and the Gods
commune with their creations, integrated into the art project of the
Free Will universe, as Zeus, as guides, and catalysts for the
furtherance of the ascension process toward the realization of the
final life.
The
guides are real, they exist, and we are learning from them, many who
claim to be channeling a certain guide directly. Through the
resounding evidence in UFO sightings, crop circles, visitatations,
and the universal tone of most channeled text, it is clear that we
are not alone on this humble star -- but much life exists that are
simply invisible to the human eye. As we rise in vibration, it
becomes eventual that we are in the recess of which we can perceive
the angelworkers directly, with our eyes. Many souls will be
re-united in the fifth dimension, that those discarnate souls who
existed in the bardo of the fourth dimension, will be perceivable in
the fifth, and many lost loved ones will thus be re-united with their
karmic families. The Great Show, a theoretical event of which all
souls that have ever walked the Earth, or been associated with the
Milky Way, will be witnessed on the ethereal screen -- the entire
history of all histories, and karmic relationships that have ever
existed on the Earth. As this cinematic bible theoretically already
exists, and is being used to study the probabilities of all human
life, right now, in this very moment -- we are being viewed,
observed, and learned from, right
now.
In
an experience on LSD, the one and only time I ever tripped on the
drug, I would experience hell. This was seeing myself in a room
watching TV with another individual who was a total stranger. We
would sit in this room, and see ourselves on TV -- in the room --
watching ourselves, on TV, in an endless stream of imagery that seems
to never end, not until the drug has worn off. The event was hell, in
all conceptualizations of the concept, and it was being viewed on a
screen. That night, I would become possessed by a dark spirit, and
nearly threaten the reality of everyones lives. I performed a
stigmata on myself, unconsciously, to which I now have a scar in the
center of my left palm. The night we tripped was in October of 2009,
the event my entire life was leading up to. There was a poster of
Obama on the wall. My art-work was scribbled on the wall. My parents
were out of town. I had an art display the next day. My dealer had a
whole blotter sheet of acid. It seemed perfect. The perfect time to
trip on drugs with my friends.
As they would subject me to
judgment as a result of my Light; In order to retain my sanity, I
traveled through the alphabet, going from letter to letter; a thought
starting with each letter. As I have memorized the alphabet, and we
all have, the symbols are thus encrypted into my subconscious mind,
and through what I refer to as the "living alphabet" we can
soar from letter to letter, in order to preserve our sanity whilst we
are under the throes of drug-induced psychosis. It worked, and I
survived, to say the least. I have no recollection of performing the
stigmata on myself, but my friends remember, and I am no longer
associated with them anymore.
Reality
is owned.
As
the subconscious mind can not tell the difference between what it
sees and what it remembers, we personally define our own realities.
The imagination is the body of God, our vehicle for divination. Here,
we will project our thoughts into beliefs as based upon faith or
experience, and find our awareness further activated through
expressions of our self-created reality. "On this day, at this
time, I will have a cosmic revelation." For instance, shall we
say, tomorrow. The time will be 11:11:11 A.M. We write this down in
our dreambook, study the words, and weigh them heavily upon our mind.
Thus primed, the subconscious crockpot will begin stewing, and
processing the details of the revelation. The masterpiece of thought,
the divine awareness as found upon the revelation, is already
complete, it is now all just a matter of equalizing into the
awareness. We may expect a certain person, individual, or angelworker
to enter into our life as well. Priming ourselves with the thought,
the expectation for the divine occurrence to take place, we hope for
the best, put the ingrediants into the cauldron, and watch as it
whirls like a galaxy into the luminous depths of the future.
There
is still a new day . . . the sun will rise again . . . we continue to
seek, we continue to journey and quest . . . we realize the universe
is infinite . . . we realize energy is infinite . . . we realize that
we
are energy . . . and
as such, we are infinite. All is eventually realized in the
revelation, and we shall expect this to occur. Otherwise, guided by
the angelworker directly. Coming directly from the soul-guide, or
Akasha, we will be guided through expectation manifesting into
experience. We all learn eventually our place within the mind of God,
and this eventual realization is always found within the recess of
the final incarnation. Angelworkers exist, they are real, and they
are actively monitoring us. We will meet them in person some day. For
now, we have faith, and we believe the future exists as radiant, and
a bright, loving place for peace, sharing, and longevity. The
perceived Utopia -- the great party of all souls who have ever walked
the Earth. In the final life thus found, the life of the ascended
master/angelworker, we see our place is divine -- that we have a
place within the rows of all divine life that has ever existed on the
Earth -- and our place shall be known as ascended master.
Chapter
Nineteen: Serving The Great Machine
All
machines
Pray to the sun
The fire burning
Only one.
We
all serve some master. Be it Christ, or simply the energy we refer to
as God. We have learned from someone, somewhere, somehow, and we
attribute our growth to this source. No one could learn if it were
not for someone out there who was willing to stand out from the rest,
and change the world. We see repeated evidence of heroes throughout
history -- people who stood, as outliers, out from the rest, through
their own uniqueness, genius, and mystical traits. The mystic, it
shall seem, is someone who has had spirit follow them for their
entire life, haunting them with dim memories of something better
which lies everbeyond their grasp. The mystic realizes, calmly and
carefully, that what they see, what they experience, God sees, and
God experiences. The mystic is a subject, a proxy, for the energy of
God. A living example for how life should be for the rest of us.
Subjected, through the machine -- the great machinetic workings of
God that are responsible for all of this. The mystic archetype, as a
natural occurrence, will find itself wearing the final label of
Lightworker, evolutionist, or in the end: prayer to the unknown.
Believer, in the endless recess of the future, calm eventor through
reality. We feel the wind of November blow through us, ventilating
our bodies with divine catharsis. We know that our quest is endless,
and we are calm eventors into the future of which lies yet to be
known, yet to be discovered.
As we invariably pray to the
human God -- that we perceive the angelworkers are no figment of the
imagination, but are actively causing a rise in our vibration to meet
them at the same level of cosmic resonance. We perceive the reunion,
the final relationship forged through time, of the mystic, and the
angelworker. Finding the bridegroom, unitive life of which we are
creators -- the perceived caduceus -- joining of dark and Light -- we
writhe through the bardo of the in-between, and we writhe through a
certain transparent neutrality that governs our existence. We are
transparent, that dark energy simply passes through us, with the
imagined sphere around the body everprotecting us from the low
vibration. We are always in a world of beauty and information.
Enamored with the presence, feeling the Light of God within our
veins, we know this life matters, this which is to be the final
incarnation -- our last stand at a human life. We take this task with
kind heart, and open eyes, and peer into the radiant depths of the
future knowing not what lies in store, but praying to the unknown
with open heart and mind, seeking justice, seeking rectification of
all past mistakes through the judgment that will find us.
The
great machine, which we imagine is of the collective, that we evolve
together, and co-create the future. We perceive what Jung coined as
the collective unconscious, the mass connection of all minds as
governed through tones of One, this we serve, the collective, toward
the final end of self-divination. We perceive that enlightenment, and
the ascension process, is the reason we incarnated into the New Age,
and we came here to serve the great machine, the God-embodiments, the
ascended master. We pray to a guide, a confident leader, and we
imagine this leader into existence. As we are finding ourselves in
the New Age, the time for learning and self-renewal, the cosmic
spring of the universe, it may come to pass that certain people will
unviel themselves as ascended masters, and we will live in direct
conscious relationship with the many ascended masters in time to
come. As Drunvalo Melchizedek is in league with Thoth, the perceived
recordkeeper of the Akasha, and many others such as Anka claim to
channel the energy of another being, we perceive the ascended masters
-- that they are real and exist outside of time. They perceive the
universe from the periphery, and witness the probabilities of human
life on the Akashic Computer. We lovingly realize the future is
created by our hands, and we are fully responsible, fully
God-conscious of our power over the collective stream of reality, and
probabilities.
Through
ontological expressions of our Light, we produce a radiance that
covers the world in iridescence.
Just
as the universe is endless, so the imagination is endless, there is
always another question to which the answers yield. We find, as
existential mystics, Lightworkers, evolutionists, creators of our own
reality, whatever title we may wear as individuals, that we endow
ourselves with a changing environment, and know that as the
environment changes, we change in due reciprocity.
Everything we do matters, and all is interpolated into the datasphere of knowledge, continually, in a process that is infinitely renewed by its own life-force -- which writhes through tones of synchronicity -- and exists through the primodial rhythm of the Source Field. As we are capable of imagining the Source, our body illumined by the radiating vortex, wholly enamored with the thoughts of God, perceiving the universe from the apogee of awareness, thus become interversal travelers -- we perceive the total aggregate of all incarnated universes, the aggregate of matrical existence -- a vast aggregate of cells that move as planets move, and all revolve around the central star. The Free Will universe is the fuel, and we have many stellar souls on the planet Earth which illumine the entirety of all incarnated universes. Our Light emanates from the pineal, the crown chakra, filling the universe with iridescence -- that we flow as rivers through the imagination, continually interpolating ourselves into the Akasha which is ever-revised through each new passing day. “We calmly event our way into unique, "new thought" -- and as so lovingly suggested, we know that the universe grows, flexes, and undulates with our attainment of new information.” The concept of the new, once all has been seemingly realized, that the movements of the heavenly bodies continue to be animate; we find ourselves in control of the weather, our body that of the unisphere, and our mind that of the verse.
Just
as teleportation is direct evidence of the intangability of matter,
and we realize the One Spirit through non-local thought
transferrence, however perceived that our universe began
approximately 13.75 billion years ago with the big bang, life must
have existed before our universe, in entirely different worlds, and
there were always other universes preceding the existence of our
own.
As the center of all universes was always alive, the
construction of the Earth and physicality was just an experiment. In
our collective fall from grace, finding ourselves manufactured for
control through the double-helix, the entirety of all universes, it
would seem, were affected by our fear emanations, and as a result of
our darkness, came, as interversal police through the manifestation
of God-proxies, ascended masters, in reciprocity to the
darkly-illumined road we found ourselves walking. It became necessary
to intervene. Already, with the atomic blasts of Hiroshima and
Nagasaki, certain ascended masters have taken it upon themselves to
become integrated into our reality; as this great experiment seems to
be nearing self-destruction. As the radiation from a nuclear blast is
damaging to the soul itself, we perceive that such misuse of power
could damage the entirety of universes, and as such, intervention
would become a natural necessity. The present male-oriented society
we now know, with so many beliefs separated through organized
religion -- calls for the existence of a universalist, and the
believer in a final singular belief system, of a race that unites
under One Radiant Light -- and supports the thought of future
evolution, for the sake of our childrens children.
As we find
ourselves within the final life, it shall seem that our thoughts
manifest into action as directly as conceivably possible, and we are
found within the original grace of the thoughts of the ascended
master. We are world-changers, a singular facet of One -- One Unique
Cell -- One Spirit -- One Life -- through the incarnation to which
our entirety of incarnations would reach eventual eclipse.
We observe that as matter is entangled, and as we move into the fifth dimension, it is wholly acknowledged that matter transcends reality, matter is invariably connected, and acts of telekinesis shall only further our ontological expressions to the highest conceivable degree of awareness. Reality directly manifested, the objects within the given space merely extensions of the mind -- we control the objects -- we control the space -- we control the Earth -- we control the unisphere -- we control reality. As expressors of divine Light operating through tones of universality, we shall find that our life possesses purpose, and worth, to the entirety of all life within the universe. The return to the Source, as inevitable, we perceive this locale within the continuum exists, and we shall see, verily, the infinitude of the matrix of universes. That ours is not the only one, but exists as one perhaps amid a vast plethora of cells -- we perceive, that as we are the fuel, we are the power-source, and many stellar artists, writers, and inventive thinkers have come to writhe on the planet Earth -- our Light shines, iridescently, and it fills all the universe with radiance.
We are vital toward the evolution of many different life-forms.
The imagined "Noosphere" of higher-dimensional electromagnetic energy which is presently encompassing the Earth, in the network of iridescence, causes the risen vibration to which we meet the ascended master in person, and learn from the most direct and pure source. We serve the Light of the collective, the great machine of the matrix of angelworkers, the totality of all human thought as found within the Akasha. We "work for the universe," we are servants to the Source, that to which we seek an eventual return, and this is a conscious expectation. Self-contained vehicles for global mind change, ontological warriors, psychonauts, and ultrabelievers. In the end, only One -- a vast collective serving the great machine of the Milky Way, One Life that matters in relation with all the rest -- we have all lived before -- that we are servants for the Light is evident in our expressions, and our expressions contain the holographic image of the whole, to which we are enamored with "the presence." We are the collective serving the great machine of human evolution, we find that through DNA activation, and the cosmic memory sparked into awareness, we writhe through tones and frequencies of informational Light, that we have been informed is evident, and we realize that we are consciously evolving.
The thought "I am human evolution" thus endured, we perceive the living example -- the body of Christ, that whatever we wish upon ourselves is thus wished upon others. That in this body to which we know, our final existing body of the ascended master, whatever thoughts we think, whatever actions undertaken, and whatever experiences accrued through the infinite scope of human life -- are being experienced by the mind of the Source, the Godmind, as such, all that we wish upon our own realities are invariably affecting the realities of others.
As
we come to serve the great machine of human evolution, working
towards the eventual goals that make up our reality-stream,
everpriming ourselves, and eversurrounded with beauty and information
-- we come to find that the given space is to be found in itself an
extension of the universe, that we imagine we are writhing in the
Light of the Source now, in the present moment, as invariably
intertangled through the radiance of the Source Field, or Universal
Mind. The future has already been created, the time machine already
built, the ability to be wherever want to already realized. We take
it upon ourselves to know that the living moment is an extension of
the universe, and whatever environment we find ourselves in,
changeable, is to be found as the "final environment" for
our furtherance of evolution to occur.
The final environment
where our evolution, meditations, and revelations take place, is a
sacred space. Potentially ones own bedroom, studio, or creative
workspace. Here, we organize the props and scenery to our own
specific liking, built for our evolution, and everprimed with images,
words, and thoughts that operate at the highest levels of resonance.
As we could not learn if it were not for some educator, guide, or
teacher, within our life, we all require some source to learn from.
Here, we may place the inhibitor -- a film, a book, a divine thought,
in its proper place, and thus impress ourselves with the
informational Light -- of the life-force thus contained. The
inhibitors, ranging from books, films, music, art, and other forms of
media, shall be, God knows, reflections of our own beauty -- that we
are all inherently artistic and creative is found -- and we surround
ourselves with these things -- we remain informed -- we keep
ourselves in a permanent state of creative catharsis, knowing that
these present moments are that of the final life. Here, activating
our Free Will to the highest conceivable degree of proactive
animation -- we imagine the future into existence. We learn, grow,
evolve, and continue on through this which is the final reality, the
final incarnation, and we are working toward a masterpiece -- the
life of greatest worth and value to the rest of the human race.
We
are evolving.
It is a matter of the present tense.
Just as we may flip to a random page of a random book, and thus surprise ourselves with spontaneous insight, we can always affect matter with our thoughts that eventually eclipse into new awareness, and a new thought. We hope to be continually surprised, as we work toward the collective end of evolution of the masses, and all vibrations risen to the highest conceivable vibratory fluctuation. We continue to writhe through spontaneity, everpraying, everrhyming, musical and lyrical in our interconnexive thought-patterns -- ever-realizing, through the goal-oriented processes involved, the final environment, the final life of greatest importance to the evolving masses -- the great machine -- this we lovingly serve, as our master is the universe itself, and we pray for the collective.
We
are to be found as one uniquet facet of the primordial Source-energy,
a manifestation of one possibility within the scope of infinity. Our
Godliness is projected through uniqueness, which as suggested only
makes the return to the Source more enjoyable. We are all the same,
in essence, no different and no better -- and we continue to learn
from one another in the grand scope of continual change and rebirth.
We are always learning from one another, always have an assortment of
leaders, guides, and masters to whom we serve. We endeavor to find
the highest masters; surround ourselves with their Light, and remain
endowed with a constant sense of indelible creativity, and
Light-based cogitation. Knowing this life to be our final Earthly
existence; our importance enhanced; our thoughts vibrating and
resonating at that highest frequency --
Here, within the
recess of the final life; everything matters in this life. Nothing is
forgotten. We are vital elements of the total picture,
holographically containing the essence of the whole. As we are like
holofractal bits of information that accord with the totality of All
That Is -- our place is invariably found as leader, guide, and
catalyst, in our own right -- that we evolve through the continual
beauty and surprise -- that we grow and learn through our own
inhibition of certain guides and masters . . . we see the
connectivity of all things, we perceive our place; and we are wholly
renewed by the concept, the thought, and the belief; that once all is
seemingly known and realized . . . there is still a new
day.
Chapter
Twenty: Cosmic Transmission
The
Akashic Records is the living storehouse of all information within a
given locale.
The Records are infinitely revised by the
co-evolution of many races.
We enscribe our names into the
skein of Time, and we imagine existence --
We peer into the depths
of the infinite, and we discover iridescence.
We send our
prayers to the Akasha --
The living information --
And we pray
to cosmic Law --
To the Light, the Source-station . . .
The
Akasha is a living matter. That information is alive is easily found
in the recess of telepathy. According to New Age belief, we can
receive transmissions -- cosmic transmission -- from a higher
vibrating source such as a guide, master, or archangel. In the book
"Archangels and Ascended Masters" by Doreen Virtue, a
complete list of all the names is given, from Kuthumi, to Sananda,
and it is perceived that we can call any of these guides into our
lives. We may set a date and prime ourselves -- that -- at twelve
o'clock P.M. tomorrow "I
will receive a cosmic transmission." With
the primer laid down, and the mind formulating what will come through
the revelatory state, the transmission is to be projected from the
Source, as traveling through the conduit of Sirius, into the crown
chakra, the pineal, the psyche, and thus radiates, emanates
throughout the mind. Here we may learn from the most direct source of
the Akasha, and find details from our history in the universe, to our
past that has been lived on the Earth.
Through the date set,
the primer of 12 o'clock, high noon of the next day, we will be ready
with pen in hand, or computer keyboard a'ready, prepared for the
cosmic transmission to manifest into words as directed through the
mind. As the subconscious mind is (as repeatedly suggested)
goal-oriented, the power of priming ones self with a certain set time
when information will come to us, is activating of the natural
processes involved; that the subconscious is like a crockpot always
working on certain goals, and so it shall be found that through the
focus of one transmission -- we reduce ourselves to one singular goal
-- the information we know that will come to us -- and we expect,
consciously, to be educated by the information.
It may be much to imagine, or simply too much to comprehend -- that information through cosmic transmission is possible, that in my own experience, the symbol of the Caduceus, as a direct symbol for spiritual awakening, was transmitted into my subconscious.
This was projected by Sirius, which is a conduit for the Source, just as the Light of the sun reflects off the moon.
The Source is essentially where the information comes from, in Akashic propensity, this is living information that is based around cosmic law. All energy is infinite, and through the cinematic bible of the Akashic Computer, we refer to various scenes, various choice-points and realizations that led up to the life of the ascended master. The imagination is the true tool for divination, and as however perceived that our transmissions are merely fabrications invented by the mind, we shall see, verily, how much of the information that comes from the Akasha, is universal, and relates from one person to the next.
In
the final incarnation lived within the recess of the New Age, we
learn of our place within the totality of All That Is -- and through
expressions of uniqueness that is based upon creativity -- creativity
in itself -- that creation is universal, and we are made Godly
through our creative thought-patterns. That through uniqueness we
reach universality is a profound concept, but we shall see, that
through the mystic archetype, one who is naturally in touch with the
energies of the universe -- that however unique -- this person exists
essentially toward the concept and unification of One.
In
receiving cosmic transmission, from the main-vein of the Akashic
Records, we may invite certain lucid dreams, of divine experiences
into our lives. We may expect the future, and watch from outside of
the matrix as it takes place in our reality. We may use the dreambook
to prime ourselves with dates and set-times when transmissions will
be received. As twelve o'clock is the universal time for which we
pray to world peace, it is allegedly the most energetic and
high-charged part of the day, such that midnight at twelve A.M. is of
heightened energy as well. Further, we may become more susceptible to
telepathy when it is a full moon, or the night directly preceding a
full moon. All is connected, all is relative, and all energies
essentially work together toward that eventual conclusion -- the
masterpiece of thought -- the paragraph of cosmic wisdom that seems
to manifest directly in our minds-eye. Here we see certain things,
discover certain knowledge, often things we would not have expected.
In streaming consciousness writing, otherwise referred to as automatic writing -- we may channel, think as we write -- and watch as thought occurs naturally through the creative process involved. If we can watch as the words manifest into the string of sentences and interconnexive phraseology, we perceive that there is an inner logic to the chaos theory of our thoughts, which are goal-oriented, and are always working toward some conclusion, or revelatory state. Channeling through dictation, it shall seem, that we writhe through a mantra in order to activate the transmission -- we may also achieve much through meditation, that in the endurance of thinking about thought itself -- that the subject is the subject -- and we shift from one subject to the next, we may ride a certain theme, and discover that the transmission is unwound through the endurance of finding the theme, the perceived subject and message of focus. As much channeling is done in group settings, we may have our dictations heard, and recorded through a tape recorder, and thus transfer the energy of the Akasha into that of the group setting, for which is recorded, and transcribed later on. We believe that there is such a thing as cosmic principle, just as we believe there is only One True Belief System. We see that through uniqueness we are made equal, and we all eventually come "full circle" in the end. What has begun, will conclude, but what lies in between is the imagination.
Universality,
and cosmic principle, as invariably realized through originality,
uniqueness, and inviduality -- that a road walked in solitude is
realizatory of the same cosmic truths found by so many genius minds,
paradoxically as this may seem. As this is Light, born from the same
Source, and Light is information -- it is containing of cosmic
principle relating to the body of the universe as referred to as the
unisphere, the concept of re-incarnation, the infinitude of the human
imagination, and the belief that the universe is endless. The
universal principles resound, and they will not be forgotten this
time. As we progress into the feminine intuitive right-brain
function; we work to suggest that we can all become ascended masters
through the endurance of our own special, and unique quest for
information.
Opening ones self up to cosmic transmission, may
be through the endurance of the Akashic Computer of ones own
imagination. We shall see the screen of which we enter our request,
for certain information to be brought to us, we are not sure what the
information may be, we simply expect that it will be relative to our
present incarnation. So we see this screen within our minds, as
connected to the hall of records, many books, many texts, seemingly
endlessly towering into the heavens and then back to Earth. We shall
invite the cosmic principle to flow within us, naturally, through an
effortless process that is governed by the imaginations capacity to
perceive the beam of Light -- that courses through space -- from the
Source, into Sirius, through the Light-waves, into the mind of the
Lightworker, and enamoring the subject with new information.
"I
am aware of myself." -- infinity is realized in the thought of a
thought.
We
are perceived as more Godly through our self-awareness. In
meditation, we may focus on the words of our thoughts -- in a mantra
that is repeated in the mind until a new thought arrives. We event
our way through the mind, the inner hall, the many corridors, and
synaptic connections, for new thought, a fraze, a unique thought, to
arrive within us, and leave us enamored with a sense of having been
informed by the Akasha. As we are peering into the depths of not only
human history, but galactic history, that many races live within the
Free Will universe, and many of them have chosen to convene on the
school of the Earth. It would seem that through cosmic transmission,
we are learning that came here to learn about ourselves, and relay
our Light back to God. As all concepts of infinity are found in the
subject as the subject, and the thought of a thought -- the entire
concept of cosmic transmission, however far-fetched, is a growing
belief within the masses, and it would seem that many artists,
writers, geniuses, and right-brained thinkers are in direct
connection with the Akashic Records.
Chapter
Twenty One: Teleportation
And
my instinct, was to "run towards the Light."
As
I have come to discover how teleportation is achieved through Light
convergence, I have a theory that may result in the eventual
construction of a time machine . . . it was only a near-death
experience, and was not a matter of anything other than survival that
re-located from the path of the crazed driver. And my instinct, was
to "run towards the Light." Through the Light emitted off
the photons of my DNA, in convergence with that of the oncoming
headlights, through near-collision, and I destinctly recall, that I
was about one yard away from the car when I re-located, and
re-location was instantaneous.
The teleportation machine will
work as follows . . .
A track is placed that is about 50 yards
in diameter. At the far-end of the track is a cart with a bright
spotlight attached to it. On the opposite end is a cart which holds
the Lightworker. At a stopping distance of exactly one foot, the two
carts will nearly collide, going from about 40 miles per hour, to
zero, at the point of convergence -- the stopping distance which is
theoretically one foot in distance between each Light. As it was my
instinct, and entirely beyond my natural will, but an imperative
toward survival, that I "ran towards the Light" -- I had
been stewing on this already, that I already had some inkling of how
to teleport, and it would only reach manifest through the endurance
of instinct, and pure instinct, at that. So we perceive the track,
and the Light at the opposite end, that through near-collision, and
the stopping distance of about one yard, the destination a fixed
point within the mind -- we converge, the Lights merge into that of
One, and we shall imagine our way into the desired destination.
This
is theoretically one form of teleportation, but can not be achieved
by someone who is not in Lightbody. Theoretically we must be gifted
with the highest levels of Lightbody, that teleportation is
achievable, so it must seem that the writer of this text has, very
likely, about three-strand DNA. One finds that they are merely a
proxy for the energy of One. Near-death experience involving
teleportation is reportedly rare, and as some doctors know of my
case, they perceive it as something new. Just as my genetic mutation
is a new mutation, so teleportation and telepathy are things I never
expected to experience in this life. As a mystic, I peer through
rose-colored glasses; I see beauty in all things. As a transmuter, I
convert what was once one form, into another, through tones of
creativity -- and I am almost always
in
a creative state of mind. I survive through my creativity, and I
reflect on the teleportive event as the work of the higher-ups,
angelworkers, that my life was saved by a higher force, re-located
through certain technology that is beyond my human awareness, that
somehow, for whatever reason, I was kept alive, and would retain the
memory of re-location. I destinctly recall feeling as though I was in
my body the whole time, and I was also able to use my voice when I
teleported to the safe location.
Great mystery resounds in
light of the true science of the event, we simply know that the
convergence of enlightened DNA, and that of the high beams of a
moving vehicle, are one set of variables that will apparently result
in teleportation. As my beliefs are shaped by experience, and I have
had experiences in the extrasensory, to which great mystery truly
does resound in light of what the science of these things may be --
we have some inkling of the truth, and it seems to relate to the
ascended masters holding some relationship toward the experience of
the event. One has been re-located through instinct, survived through
Light convergence, and is now alive to share the story.
If
this were a more hard-set world of rules and logic, I would be lying
in my grave in this very moment, but for whatever reason, I was
survived through instinct to re-locate a distance up the street,
watch as the car veered from left to right into a sliding halt, and
then re-materialize right beside the illumined sign of an auto sales
building. I was at first waiting for a car to come in the pitch black
night, and whence the crazed driver arrived to kill me, I ended up
somewhere else, in a totally different location.
Finding
that there is only one life -- one existence -- one experience -- one
goal -- one realization . . . we realized that God would save us if
we were idealistically-inclined toward the betterment of the world.
And as we are servants of the universe, as writhing through the Light
of our illumined DNA, it shall come to pass that whence we are in the
highest levels of Lightbody, the power of teleportation, and
convergence of Light, as one possibility, will prove our undying
immortality.
Chapter
Twenty Two: The Levels of Lightbody
"The
Earth would be considered in its planetary relations alone.
A man,
in this view, becomes mankind;
mankind a member of the cosmic
family of intelligences."
--
E. A. Poe
There
are twelve different levels of Lightbody, and this information is
universal. Through my research, I have come to find how these levels
operate, and what the reader may expect upon the endurance of their
own Lightbody. In our studies, we see that biological changes come
with enlightenment. Lightbody is a state of physical being, for which
the subject is entered into the final life, and is becoming
immortal.
The
first level of Lightbody.
I understand the chemical process may take some time to understand; but as these changes are real, and they now possess some scientific background, I will suggest through my research the biological processes involved in the first level of Lightbody.
“Through
the release of complex DNA information found within the dream of
awakening, we have entered into the first level of Lightbody.”
Here, the new cellular activity is the amount of adenosine
triphosphate (ATP) in the cells. Energy was primarily shuttled back
and forth, prior to Lightbody, between adenosine diphosphate
(ADP) and adenosine triphosphate.
Adenosine triphosphate is energy compounds stored within the cells,
and within mitochondria, food is converted into energy for renewal of
the cells, which then arrives within the ATP. There is a chain of
three phosphate groups which are projected out of the molecule, and
when ATP molecules lose the outermost phosphate group, it is turned
into an ADP molecule. Energy is released in the breaking of the
chemical bond, for the function of the cell to be carried out,
forming proteins, and the revitalization of the cellular
structure.
In the mutation of the first level of Lightbody,
ones cells are directed to recognize Light as the primary energy
source. Old memories, traumas, and pain once endured is cycled out
and released from the Lightbody, and there may be some flu-like
mutational symptoms in the initial entrance into Light. New synapses
are forming through our endurance of the Light, and the pineal and
pituitary glands are duly mutated, and changed in shape.
As
the pineal is theoretically where the soul both enters and leaves the
body, it would seem that through the endurance of the Light, this
spiritual part of our brains starts to grow, and become transformed
over time. Once found in Lightbody, we will know, and verily,
remember. Our cells are being re-worked into the pefect avatar self,
we are now involved in the final life as lived within the New Age --
a very special time our self-evolution.
The
second level of Lightbody.
In
the second level of Lightbody, ones karmic incarnational details are
becoming organized, and we may find ourselves in meditations
realizing the details of our galactic history. In this level, we
start to question identity and purpose in relationship to the
universe. We are utterly enamored with the world of spirit, feel our
soul-energy flowing through us, and calmly realize that this is the
final incarnation. Fourth-dimensional structures begin affect the
geometric spinrate of ones mental, emotional, and spiritual bodies,
eclipsing into a unitive whole. One is beginning to change very
rapidly, requires less sleep, less food, but seems to writhe almost
solely upon the energy of ones own self-illumined DNA.
Naturally,
the physical changes can
be exhausting, and we may require much rest. This is an important
level of Lightbody in that it brings the initial changes of ones own
self-awareness toward being an ascended master in the final life. One
is really starting to perceive the true nature of reality.
The
third level of Lightbody.
In
the third level of Lightbody, we are starting to manifest reality
more directly. We find our senses amplified. Most of what is
occurring becomes very centered on the physical body, as we begin to
activate the natural transducive functions of the Lightbody.
Undifferentiated Light from the soul will activate the
fifth-dimensional axiatonal lines, and the fifth dimensional
axiatonal system begins to unfold. The axial system then activates
the every spinpoint found within the physical body. Each cell has
Light focused into it through the axial system.
The
mitochondria that usually recognize this Light as "food"
produces more ATP. As the cell receives Light as the useable
energy-source, less of the ATP turns into ADP. The spin-points of the
axial system begin to produce Light and sound frequencies which
affect the atomic spin of the cells molecules, particularly in
hydrogen atoms. A new functioning begins to emerge as the atomic spin
in the ATP molecule increases. The three phosphate groups that form
the base of the ATP molecule start to act as antenna for
undifferentiated Light, as the symmetrical apex acts like a prism,
which breaks down the Light into subtle color spectrums that are now
useable by the dormant DNA encodements.
Prior
to the endurance of Light, the RNA proteins (ribonucleic acid) in the
cells were acting as a one-way messenger. Directives were carried out
from the then active 7% of the DNA, writhing in other parts of the
cell for execution, such as what proteins were to be synthesized.
Now, in the third level of Lightbody, ones RNA becomes a two-way
messenger. As projected into the DNA strands, Light was broken down
into the color frequencies of the prism. Through the natural
epiginetics of activating our Lightbody, the RNA proteins are fully
activated for the renewal of the helix, and axial system.
In
the third level of Lightbody, great amounts of complex DNA
information are being projected into us, and as the information is
alive, it would naturally come to us through the cosmic transmission.
Each successive level of Lightbody has its own color association, and
as the RNA proteins change, and the color variations are embedded
into ones being, the body and soul are merging into a unitive whole.
We become a Lightworker, an evolutionist, a self-contained harbinger
for human evolution. The Light which is information has come to
writhe within our DNA, and the information seems to be coming to us
at an accellerated rate. We calmly and carefully realize that we are
evolving.
As we come to writhe through karmic details, the
creative fluctuation of energies, as transducer, will come to pass as
the Light manifests, and continues to mutate the body. Informational
Light as flooded into the filaments of ones DNA, contain ones karmic
details, and once the Light enters ones body, it never goes away --
the only choice is to ascend -- and rise into the highest levels of
which the future is being actively created by the Lightworker.
The
fourth level of Lightbody.
In
the fourth level of Lightbody, the natural electromagnetics and brain
chemistry are changing. The etheric blueprint starts to shine through
as fifth dimensional connections are made within the Lightbody. And
the hemispheres of the brain are starting to communicate with one
another more directly. This may cause us to feel out of sorts at
times, through the transition into the fifth octave. In this level,
we are starting to follow Spirit more directly, and we align with the
higher self. We start to feel more connected and empathic with
people, and really begin to perceive the details of the matrix of
reality.
Non-linear thinking is one event that starts to occur
as the hemispheres begin to merge, that the subconscious mind is
non-linear (patternless) but bound by the chaos theory in its
goal-oriented functioning, we start to activate certain goals into
fruition perfectly, and we are in the process of joining the
hemispheres of the brain, tapping into that formerly unused ninety
percent. We may have fleeting clairvoyance, telepathy, or past-life
recall. We feel that some people start to matter very much, and begin
to focus our energy on certain priorities of certain spiritual, and
evolutional value. We see the purpose, the design, and the hope, and
we realize our purpose in the world exists, and start to operate
through our own unique mission of the soul.
The
fifth level of Lightbody.
In
this level, our thoughts are becoming more holographically oriented.
Such that within one thought will contain the energy of the whole,
and we start to writhe through non-linear thinking. It may be
disorienting at first, as we start to shift from the
overtly-conscious left-brain, into the more naturally intuitive, and
non-linear right-brain. To a degree, we may become somewhat manic
depressive as a result of the mutation, and shift into more
non-linear thinking. It may take some getting used to at first, but
time will afford us comfort, and one is not the only person
experiencing these things.
Ones purpose, identity, and
overall goal of existence is begun to be focused upon, and we really
start to align ourselves with Spirit. Biologically, we are mutating
into a new strand in DNA, and this can be much to deal with in
relationship to the previous reality of the highly-limited double
helix. In the fifth level of Lightbody, as we start to tap into the
hologram, and perceive the many parts and pieces that make it up --
the universe is more easily perceived, as something which we are a
part of, and possess a unique purpose in relationship with, in due
result. We start to see our place within the totality of All That Is,
and we are now reforming our reality, inhibitors, and environment,
toward the highest frequency.
The
sixth level of Lightbody.
The
sixth level of Lightbody is alleged one of the most painstaking, and
many struggle at this level of Lightbody, as our purpose on the Earth
is questioned, again, as with the fifth level of Lightbody, and the
mutation is only going to progress. Ones view of reality is changing
at this level of Lightbody, and we may start to perceive ourselves as
translucent, or nonphysical. We are, becoming more Light, through the
risen vibration. At this level of ones evolvement, certain
relationships are cycled out, and new ones are born into existence.
We may start to connect with other Lightworkers, and share what we
have learned through the experience of being human.
In this
level, the veils of reality are lifting, and we are starting to
become more telepathic. One starts to become wholly enamored with the
living moment, of the present, and writhes through synchronicity. At
this level in Lightbody, so much is brought into question -- that we
may exit the body, and allow another soul to enter, or leave the
Earth entirely. It is through the fifth and sixth levels of Lightbody
that people seem to struggle the most, and will often go into a sort
of spiritual remission, in order to re-learn certain things.
Nevertheless, we find that we are truly mutating, truly changing,
from what was once wholly physical, into something that is becoming
more spirit-oriented, and etheric. Our vibration is rising, that we
project energy out of ourselves is evident in the experience of
telepathy, and as it will come to pass, the mutational symptoms will
continue, and the DNA continues to evolve.
The
seventh level of Lightbody.
In
the seventh level of Lightbody, one starts to merge with the
emotional body. We feel the energy of the Earth, and perceive
ourselves as living in symbiosis with our environment. Blocks in the
emotional body will be cycled out as we become more empathic, and
certain things will be brought into light. As we seek the fullest
divination, and Informational Light, our old human ways are not going
to run in accord with the Lightbody we now possess. We realize
certain things, from people, places, and events, were only result of
limitation, as experienced through ignorance -- and it would only be
through the endurance of the Light, that we would evolve into a more
worthwhile, and beneficial life-stream.
At this level, we may
start to work on certain relationships with certain people, as we
begin to perceive the true purpose of the relationship. We are
becoming more emotional, more intuitive, and more in touch with the
spirit of the Earth (Gaia). Ones heart chakra begins to open up. We
are moving toward multidimensionality, through the eclipsing of our
natural biogenic field. In this level, the heart chakra starts to
reign supreme. The way most chakras are portrayed is conical,
narrowing at the center, and spinning -- these energy-points are
mutating along with the rest of the body. First become
spherical-shaped, they start radiating Light in all directions at
once.
The pineal and pituitary glands are starting to open
up, and one may experience pressure in the brow chakra or back of the
head. Theoretically, when the pituitary gland functions at the
highest level, we can not age, and we are become immortalized. People
in Lightbody at this stage who cease to age will appear very young in
spite of their age -- it is simply the Lightbody that is pure,
energetic, and vitalizes ones entire being. As we move through the
levels of Lightbody, we are eventing our way toward the process for
which we cease to age, and are wholly renewed; body, mind, and soul,
by the Light.
As we start to perceive the totality of
existence through the perceived living matrix, we start to become
more aligned into certain experiences and events, that we are growing
like never before, and things just naturally "start happening."
Sense of ego dissolves as we begin to align with our true mission,
and we start operating through our own unique spiritual identity --
we are cycling out old patterns, and all the shame and guilt that
once existed in perceiving ourselves as separate from God. Such that
we may be upset the world isn't changing instantly, but we seem to
now require help from other people in Lightbody to make this
transition more worthwhile. We begin to form new "spiritual
connections" and some may become very evolved in the rhythm of
their thoughts. One is beginning to operate outside of the matrix,
perceiving reality from the periphery. We are cycling out old
patterns to make way for the new, and our bodies are being totally
transformed.
The
eighth level of Lightbody.
In
the eighth level of Lightbody, ones pituitary and pineal glands are
continuing to evolve and change shape. With some this may result in
mutational headaches, to which we may request the masters to reduce
our mutational symptom, and ease our transition into the Light. As
the pineal grows, it will feel as though there is pressure in the
brow, as a result of the mutated gland. Certain geometric patterns,
and cosmic principle will start to flow through us as we are moving
into the highest levels of Lightbody, and are thus seeded with
certain information. Ones brain chemistry and functioning begin to
think and act on terms of geomtries, and tones. Often this will take
the form of symbols, or certain designs that we perceive. In this
reception, we may ask of the masters to translate the symbols into
understandable language.
In this level, one is starting to
operate more through tones of love, and pure Light. We truly care for
the Earth, our civilization, and the evolution of the masses. Certain
new pathways in the brain are being forged where old ones only
reigned supreme before. Through the new pathways and synaptic
connections, we are becoming Informational Light -- enamored with the
living information, and a regard for our home, the planet Earth. For
some, it is theorized that we move into the eighth level of Lightbody
through a new relationship, potentially with the opposite gender. And
here, it may be found that whence we transition into the next level,
we will destinctly "feel" this transition, as we are now
rising in vibration such as to perceive ourselves as
multidimensional, much more than human. We are becoming superhuman.
Here we perceive the hologram of reality, and start to witness the
true fragility of this dimension, and how the rules are to be found
under our control.
At
this level, we are starting to operate solely through the higher
self. We perceive the all-importance of life on the planet Earth as
survived by tones of the Light, and as we are shifting from
physicality into nonphysicality, one is wholly renewed, and continues
to grow and evolve by the living information.
Allegedly, this
is amid one of the most transformative levels in Lightbody, what I
refer to as the Love-level. Time will seem to be speeding up, and we
are beginning to writhe through tones of synchronicity. Ending up in
all the right places at all the right times. Spiritual encodements
are being transmitted directly into ones DNA through
information-floes, and this is also a mutation of the nervous system.
Such that the system is being re-worked to handle the new information
that has come to us. One is truly being put to the test, to endure
lots of information at once, and still remain in focus over the
end-result, the goal, which is nirvana -- found at the highest level
of Lightbody -- the total divination of all humans on the planet
Earth.
The
ninth level of Lightbody.
In
the ninth level of Lightbody, information seems to arrive in tones
and syllabic intonations.
We
perceive certain geometric patterns that hold encodements within
them. Here, we are starting to perceive the matrix of reality -- the
inborn shapes, patterns, and tones that make it up. These are
sixth-dimensional structures which are used in forming the template
for the fifth-dimensional Lightbody. The seventh-dimensional
structures are aligning with the soul. One is finding themselves
aligned with the crystalline structure of the Lightbody. The
pituitary gland is opening moreso, and is productive of more growth
hormones. One may feel exhausted or depressed as a mutational
symptom, but remain grounded, know that you are in Lightbody, these
events are entirely real; and you are evolving.
In this level,
we are really starting to merge with our perfect avatar self, truly
begin to perceive the totality of All That Is -- and verily, perceive
our place within the great totality. We start to regard ourselves
less with what other people think, lose certain relationships with
low vibrations, and are starting to operate almost wholly as based
upon Spirit alone. In this, we are becoming a proxy, One with God,
and the totality of All That Is. We follow the mission, as related to
the "plan" which is hard-wired into our DNA. We see that
Spirit defines everything, we chose to take part in this shift, and
we have a special unique purpose on the planet Earth, as a
Lightworker/evolutionist/creator/genius/world-changer. In this level
we are starting to integrate our identity into that of the
collective, that we work toward the divination and enlightenment of
the masses, through the Light-floes that we possess. We see our
purpose, plan and clearly, and we know, verily, that this road is not
walked in vain.
As
we are moving into the highest levels of Lightbody, we shall be
productive of a network of Light, connecting with other Lightbodies,
and sharing stories about our evolution in the great spiritual
network that we are now in the process of building.
In the
ninth level, we are becoming ecstatic, utterly enamored with the
world of Spirit. We are following Spirit without hesitation. We are
effortless in our actions, writhing through proactive animation, and
our thoughts are evolutionary, on all levels. In levels seven, eight,
and nine, we are projecting Light like we have never done before, in
the entirety of our lives. We are utterly enamored with the
primordial essence of the Source, and we know that we are on our way
back home. We realize this is only leading up to the eventuality of
things which were wholly unexpected. In the end, we are starting to
wake up, from the dream
of
the third dimension.
In this level, we are starting to merge
with the Christ oversoul, and truly know our purpose on the Earth. We
start to live within the I Am presence of that fateful now-point to
which we writhe through spiritual catharsis, and feel the Light
within our DNA as entirely real. There is a certain descension that
takes place on the level of ego and identity, as we transition into
the tenth level of Lightbody. Referred to as the "spiritual
levels" of Lightbody, we now move into the final states of
awareness that are only going to find us immortalized by the
informational Light. One is aligned with the Christ-presence,
utterly, in every conceivable sense of the concept, we exist, we are
immortal bodies of Light -- multidimensionals, moving into the fifth
dimension.
The
tenth level of Lightbody.
In
the tenth level of Lightbody, ones perfect avatar self starts to show
through.
We are becoming self-actualized, the highest level of
Maslow's hierarchy of needs; that all other needs are met, and we can
focus purely on spiritual evolution. In this level, our DNA is about
3.5 strands, and the experience of teleportation is reported to
occur, along with apportation, and matter manifestation. We are
finding the Godmind, through the perfect avatar self, the greatest
human being that we can possibly become. We are truly involved in a
life of great importance and value to the collective; the final life,
the last incarnation. Here, within the recess of the tenth level, the
body is forming a fifth-dimensional strand in the center of the
helix, and we are in the process of building the "merkabah
vehicle."
This self-contained vehicle is used to travel
from one dimension to the next, capable of bending space and time. We
may use this to travel to other systems within the universe. All in
event toward the final realization of the Source, and our eventual
nirvanic return. What is known as "one-consciousness" is
the eventuality, it would seem, of all human life. The axes of ones
many functions are aligning, which is forming the noosphere, or
planetary Lightbody. In the network of iridescence produced by the
collective Light of the Lightworkers, we are producing a merkabah
vehicle out of the Earth itself. In this, we raise the planets
vibration through the endurance of Light on our own part.
Through
evolving at the individual level, in one life, the only life we will
ever truly know which shall be seen as the final one -- we are
working on a symbiotic relationship with our home, and the eventual
re-integration into the Cosmic Family. As we move into the highest
levels of Lightbody, telepathy, clairvoyance, teleportation, and
telekinesis will start to occur as a result of our transformation. We
are becoming Christed. Entering into the final stages of the highest
conceivable existence. In essence, we are returning to Source, but we
must first recall our place as God in order to achieve the fullest
divination. We realize we are God, we know
that
we are evolving. The changes are entirely real, and we are living
examples, catalysts for change.
The
eleventh level of Lightbody.
In
the eleventh level of Lightbody, in the course of ones mutation, a
whole new fifth-dimensional circulatory system is being built. One
was reorganized at the molecular level through cellular regeneration
of axiatonal spin-points in the merkabah vehicle, and we are being
integrated into the final body. Here, we are found stepping outside
of the matrix, able to teleport, and be wherever we want, at any
given time. We are aligned with the Spirit-self, we serve the Light
that lies within, and our hope is for the betterment of the planet
Earth.
Here, we find we are capable of cogitating any
thought, performing any action, and we are wholly enamored with the
power and vivacity of our Free Will. We are capable of anything we
want, we can do anything we want, and we are wholly enamored with the
Light that has come to fill our filaments of DNA. We writhe through
the recess of the final life, and we are now working toward the
betterment of planet Earth, as a symbiotic race of peace-loving
equals.
There is no longer any separation from God, concept
of duality, or limitation. We are free to live as we please, to put
our energy where we decree it necessary to be placed, and are
integrating into the final life. In this level of Lightbody, we are
creating a heaven out of Earth, producing the New Earth out of the
ashes of the olde. We are found in the recess of New Eden, the
perceived rebirth of the Essene brotherhood. A world of peace-loving
equals who pray for the goodness of the planet Earth.
The
twelfth level of Lightbody.
Here
we are at the highest level of Lightbody, in touch with the
primordial Source-energy, and wholly enamored with the presence of
God.
One-consciousness, nirvana, the telepathic joining of all
life unto the singular Light of One -- is to be found as
God-consciousness. In this level of Lightbody, we are fully
telepathic, fully able to teleport, and wholly governed by the free
endless resource of the Light of our illumined DNA.
We know
that "what goes on here on the Earth will affect the entire
universe as a result." So it goes, we are that vital toward the
collective of all life that exists within this realm. Our purpose is
toward evolution, our thought is toward enlightenment, and our
actions are committed through Spirit alone. We are become One with
All That Is -- omniscient, Godly, all-aware. We are wherever we want
to be, whenever we want, and we wear many different names, and we are
Light -- and we are indelible -- and our Light is endless -- it is
incredible.
Here, we are possessive of the full twelve-strand
DNA, become "super-terrestrial" -- superhuman -- a
self-contained vehicle for global change. We have come to reach the
final analysis of all human existence -- the enlightened thoughts of
the ascended master. As we come to live in symbiosis with the Earth,
our future, it would seem, lies within the pews of the many races
that exist in the universe.
We seek integration.
We
seek a reunion with all souls that have ever walked the Earth, and as
we are Pure Love -- we seek to be judged.
We know that this is
it, the climax of all conceivable thought -- we have returned to the
Source -- we are consumed by her all-consuming fire, and we know,
verily, that there is still a new thought, still a new day, somehow,
animation continues on -- and we see ourselves as part of the many
universes, that we exist, is endlessly proven through the matrix of
incarnations -- we have lived before, but we needn't live again
through the blindness, limitation, and duality of another incarnation
on the planet Earth. We know the final incarnation is all we may ever
truly need, and as a God-embodiment in full control over his or her
reality, we shall see that our growth, and evolution, is only
infinitely re-worked through the existence of life and matter within
the many incarnated universes. As we return to the Source, and reach
one-consciousness, we look back on human life, and reflect on what it
was to live through the trials of pain, trauma, and separation. We
realize no life was lived in vain -- that we were a collective, and
we all prayed for evolution. In the final analysis, we know that we
are alive in the New Age -- the timecode of the New Earth integrated
into our reality -- living the final incarnation.
And this
life matters to the collective flow of Light. And we have a purpose,
a design, a mission, and intent.
We evolve through the present
tense, the now-point, and any human being with an imagination is
capable of realizing immortality.
These are the twelve levels
of Lightbody, as described, to be understood as biological changes.
Lightbody is
a
reality, and anyone with an imagination capable of self-awareness can
activate their DNA. In the final life to which we realize our
Lightbody, only purpose and Light is found. We possess a unique hue
of purpose toward the collective, and we are regarded as One within
the totality of All That Is.
Chapter
Twenty Three: The Re-Integration Of Matter
"In
saying, generally, that the radiation proceeds in direct proportion
with the squares of the distances,
we use the term radiation to
express the degree of the diffusion as we proceed outwardly from the
centre.
Conversing the idea, and employing the word
'concentralisation' to express the degree of the drawing together
as
we come back toward the centere from an outward position, we may say
that ;concentralisation proceeds
inversely as the squares of the
distances. In other words, we have reached the conclusion that,
on
the hypnothesis that matter was originally radiated from a centre,
and is now returning to it,
the concentralisation, in the return,
proceeds exactly as we know the force of gravitation to proceed."
--
E. A. Poe
On
the re-integration of matter, of which the soul is re-entered into
existence through the manifestation of the human vehicle; the soul
wil hover above the body in the delivery room, and enter into the
human host directly prior to birth. Based upon the details of the
previous life, the final incarnation will come to manifest in the
body of the ascending soul. One perceives ones place within the grand
symmetry of All That Is in this life, for which we are able to
perceive this universe as the center of the multicellular
construct.
We may call this the center universe as the
unisphere, a bright space of a spherical body, that lies -- as the
"experimental" energy source of a unisphere entirely
governed by Free Will, containing inhabitants of the brightest most
conceivable value, the energy source of informational Light --
emitted from that central core, to which the concentralisation of all
universes seems to revolve around us, and our consciousness. Finding
the rebirthing process of entrance into the final life, all in event
toward unity, and the return to the Source -- of which this is what
all living matter is eventing toward in the succession of its own
logilinear growth through the continuum -- to realize ones place as
God. And know our place is right, logical, and hopeful in alignment
with the Light of All That Is.
Matter is re-integrated into
the human form, in the recess of the final life, to live out our
final days on the planet Earth, and perceive our future seems to lie
within the stars. We take these memories with us until the end, and
we look back on how life used to be.
Matter as infinite is
re-worked, we shall see, through the matrix of incarnations. Here
within the recess of the final incarnation as transformed into
ascended master, the future of the human race; we have incarnated
perhaps a hundred times only to equalize into the final life -- that
matter is re-integrated into the new host over time, and we writhe as
a proxy for the divine. We serve God alone, that we are God, and we
serve our own energy -- we realize our place is infinite -- we see
that the universe is only continually growing -- we see through the
infinitude of matter, that matter is now possessive of a Light-force
which emanates from the core of its origins.
As originally
seeded with the spark of Light long ago, it would be inevitable that
our evolution would occur. Through the re-integration of matter as
rebirthed into the final life; we are involved in the process of the
greatest conceivable divination, we can not die -- and we are proxy
for the collective.
Through the dispensations of the
primordial Source-essence thus found in the life of the
Lightworker/evolutionist, we are becoming One with God. We will
return to the Source all the information we have learned through
human life, and educate the many universes of our great tale. The
story continues on, as we see the movements of the continuum resume,
that we are found in control over everything -- as writhing through
our Free Will, to decree where we must go, where we must be, and
where else to spread the seed of Light. Upon the re-integration of
matter, finding our Lightbody, and involved in the self-immortalized
final life, we seem to be alive in the New Age, the Cosmic Spring of
the universe -- and we are all world-changers, self-contained
vehicles for divine Light. We are multidimensional, only given to
the illusion of separation from the Source. We lived through duality
and limitation for quite some time, but now we realize the changes
are actively occurring, and our great mission of life on Earth is
proving worthwhile in accord with All That Is.
As
"the plan" is hard-wired into our DNA, that we see a world
of self-divined ascended masters, is the futurity that awaits us.
Divined to the original twelve-strand encodement, enamored with the
vivacity of our Free Will, and in touch with nature and the Earth, as
an elemental part of the whole -- that we are nature -- we are all
things realized in the eyes of the enlightened. Matter re-worked from
the past into the present, for the recess of the final life, one is
divined to Godliness, and finds that enlightenment was the end-result
of all human existence.
Chapter
Twenty Four: The Hologram
"One
final piece of evidence in favor of the holographic model is the
paranormal itself.
This is no small point, for in the last several
decades a remarkable body of evidence
has accrued suggesting that
our current understanding of reality,
the solid and comforting
sticks-and-stones pictures of the world we all learned about
in
high school science class, is wrong."
-- Michael Talbot,
The Holographic Universe
It
is a growing perception with the everchangeful reality that the third
dimension is a hologram.
Perceiving
the third dimension as a hologram -- to which one part contains the
holographic image of the whole -- and studies proven that when a
section of ones brain is removed, the memory exists non-locally
throughout the brain; that the entire brain contains the holographic
memory-bank of all, as found non-locally dispersed throughout the
brain. So it would seem as we look at the structure of an atom, and
how molecules revolved around the necleus. We stretch this from the
microcosm to the macrocosm of a galaxy, and how energy spirals around
the central core, in its galactic formation. So we go from the
microcosm of the atom with molecules revolving around it; to the
macrocosm of the galaxy with the spiral revolving around the central
nucleus. Such that we are in a "holographic universe" to
which the parts from macrocosm to microcosm act the same. As our
universe exists within an aggregate of universes, perceived as the
center to which all universes revolve, this may be profound -- but
the Earth is not the center of the universe, we know, we are simply
one "bit" within the entirety of All That Is. However, it
is perceived that as we generate enormous amounts of Light and
information -- in this which is the Free Will universe, we output
enormous amounts of energy through the natural biogenic field, and we
endow the entirety of the multisphere with our multidimensional
expressions. We have come here, in this which is the physical
dimension, the dense dimension, to live through indifference, only to
realize that we are all the same. As within one individual must
contain the holographic totality of the collective, we find that
universality is often our ticket toward the highest life. That
however unique, universal principle resounds -- and it would seem the
rules of the third dimension are everchanging.
As we are now
in the recess of the New Age, with the Light projected by Sirius
inhibiting us with the wake-up call of our enlightened DNA, we are
learning of our place within the hologram of the third dimension. We
realize our place is everywhere and nowhere. That we can teleport is
soon to be known, and through the concepts born through instinct we
may arrive at all the right destinations, at all the right times. As
we move into the fifth octave, of which we are found as able to
teleport through the hologram of the third dimension, that we are
synchronized into the natural workings of our Free Will which is
governed by tones of the Light -- we are perceived as time-travelers,
and able to harness the time-space continuum. We perceive that time
can be folded, and we may arrive from point A to point B in the mere
blink of an eye. In this hologram with rules that are now changing,
we see the evidence in our extrasensory experiences, and as thought
is shared in the recess of telepathy, it is especially understood how
intangible and impermanennt matter is. We find that matter transcends
reality in this dimension, what Einstein referred to as "spooky
action at a distance." We see people like Uri Gellar bending
spoons with the mind alone, telepathic Indigo's who can read their
parents thoughts, and recent studies proving the energy-field, of
which we may refer to as the Source Field, or Universal Mind, is
being tapped into -- through the universality of belief of some
scientists, we are learning about the true nature of the third
dimension, and how the rules are only hardly in place.
As the
Source Field will be imagined, the collective network of all minds
that are generating electricity with their thoughts, and producing
energy for the fueling of the unisphere, as we have been
"manufactured for control" in two-strand DNA, cut off to
the spirit, and thus involved a prolonged period of ignorance
preceding the endurance of the Light. Our energy has been
mal-inclined, built around fear and scapegoating. Now that we are in
the New Age, and the perceived Light has come with the evolutionists,
we are making the shift into a new field of awareness, that of the
infinitude of the human imagination, and the natural vivacity of the
life-force we possess. As the third dimension perceived as a hologram
will strike the mind as logical, a hologram which is a seemingly
physical image produced by intersecting lasers, we know that
teleportation results in Light convergence, and this reflects the
holographic nature of reality. As time does not really exist, it
would strike the mind as logical that we would survive death through
teleportation as a result of the Light within our DNA. As the Light
is alive, living information, as born from the Source, conduited
through Sirius, and emanating through the Akashic Records, we are
learning of the highest reality -- that to which matter manifestation
and telekinesis become household events. One form of telekinesis may
be achieved through the inhibition of the dimensional properties of
the containing space in reference to the phrenology of the space
encompassing the brain. We imagine the given space is an extension of
the mind itself, and all objects contained within the hologram are
merely thoughts, which we control. Employing the word "move,
gravitate, or grow" we focus on the object in relationship to
the dimensional properties of the containing space -- and as such,
express telekinetic control over the objects/thoughts within the
given space. I have achieved telekinesis only so many times in this
life, and the power thus found -- in one experience -- only caused me
to faint as a result of the directly-manifested reality. Telekinesis
is surprising, what would seem has been something only seen in the
movies, but as we see through such individuals as Uri Gellar, it is
possible.
Perceiving this reality as a hologram affords us
great power. As we are gifted with sight, and the imagination is
infinite, we will understand that what is endured upon sight is
merely a hologram, and matter will transcend reality in these times
to which we are now living in. This is as a direct result of the
noosphere, the network of iridescence that is raising the planets
vibration. As the Earth is a living creature, with a mind and
thoughts, we are elements of this which is perceived as nature --
elements within the hologram -- and we can be anywhere within the
hologram through Light convergence, and the theorized act of the
teleportive event. We see, in events like this, that we are finding
ourselves immortal within the hologram of the third dimension. That
our imaginations are endless is clearly seen in the endurance of the
extrasensory. Once, in an altered state, I would focus on the image
of a pencil in the binding of a notebook, and repeat the thought
"grow" until the pencil grew, got larger, and eventually
stretched out from the binding. In another experience, in a certain
state of mind, I saw green when I thought of the color green, and I
saw purple when I thought of the color purple. This is one form of
telekinesis, however unexpected, suggestive of the impermanence of
reality. We choose and decree what is real, we actively produce our
own future, and we all know, verily, that our purpose is hard-wired
into the mainframe of all human existence. Our file on the computer;
our probabilities eventual; our evolution instantaneous; our
experiences divine; our thoughts in perfect rhythm; our
belief-patterns in perfect flux. We are living in a hologram with the
rules hardly in place, and we are move into a totally new octave as
the planet continues to rise in vibration.
With the imagined
noosphere that is enveloping the Earth, we believe that the
impermanence of matter is starting to find itself more alive. Through
the endurance of the Light, which is informational, that the Akasha
and Earth are entangled through living information, we event our way
through thought to arrive at the state of which we know our power
over reality, and calmly realize that we are in full control. One
always possesses Free Will and the choice over what inhibits their
senses, and environment. We always have choice. And our choices are
geared toward learning, it would seem, toward happiness, longevity,
and the free-flow of energy for the unity of the human race. We
perceive Utopia as a time when peace will wash over mankind in the
perceived rebirth of the Essene brotherhood, that we are in the New
Age is evidence that we are worthwhile creatures, and the evidence
resounds that this dimension is governed by Free Will -- we choose
our realities, and we endure what we have chosen upon ourselves. In
imagining the infinitude of matter as found through the hologram,
that matter transcends reality, we see that reality is self-created,
and we are in the future, peering back. The future, we find, is
endless, in this great hologram which seems to be rising in
vibration; we are seeing the changes with evidence in the
extrasensory, and many minds are starting to realize the same
universal truth, that the third dimension is just a vast
hologram.
So it goes, we live in a changeful, holographic
dimension, with rules hardly in place. The Earth, as rising in
vibration causing a shift in all her inhabitants, and we are all
finding through universality the same genius truths realized by so
many ascended masters before us. Employing great focus and
concentration, we can work with the hologram, and find that it can be
controlled as a fluid entangled matter. We can organize ourselves and
the environment, to which we are aware that all objects within the
space are thoughts in themselves, controllable through telekinesis.
As we become telekinetic, we are harnessing matter and time, that
things "come to us" and not the other way around. Through
the natural force of the law of attraction, and our ideals existing
for the higher good -- we activate the law of attraction through
endurance of feeling reality is a hologram, and we express control
over the hologram as objects are moveable from place to place; that
we in ourselves are a part of the bigger picture -- that the hologram
of reality is in each one piece to the next, invariably connected,
entangled, and the same. As there is ony One True Spirit, and the
evidence is easily found in telepathy, that the third dimension is a
hologram is something many minds are starting to accept as we become
telekinetic, that the containing space is like a microcosm of the
universe itself, and by thus affecting the hologram of the given
space, the environment, the Earth, we thus affect the very
fluctuating walls of the universe. We affect the entirety of All That
Is through the endurance of belief that revolves around the concept
of the hologram, that things are only as real as they seem in this
dream-sequence we have been living in -- starting to wake up from the
dream, tapping into the once unused ninety percent of our brains,
harnessing the hologram, our power thus found -- we are evolving
cognitively toward the control over the given space that through the
endurance of the belief that all is merely a hologram, we will
possess telekinetic control over all objects within the given
space.
As the paranormal and extrasensory are suggestions of
the existence of the hologram, that we know drugs such as Detura can
produce seemingly physical hallucinations that can be touched and
felt -- and we know that the imagination determines reality -- God
knows that our power is endless in realizing that the third dimension
is a hologram, and our power come to be expressed through the
extrasensory only serve to fuel the belief. We realize that we
possess control over reality -- that all things can be organized
through the hologram -- and we see through electric eyes, knowing
that observation alone will affect the vibrations of matter. As we
are all in essence vibrations, made up by living information, we have
faith, that there is a logical scientific reasoning for all of this,
and the scientific reasoning seems to lie within the concept of the
holographic reality. Perceiving that there must be some logical
science behind the nature of reality -- through our advancements
through the hologram we are producing Light for the world, and it
shall be found that through the endurance of our beliefs revolving
around the concept that matter transcends reality -- we find
activation of the hologram as a part of the mind; an extension of our
thoughts, and we realize that control over the hologram is found in
thought alone -- thought and matter thus entangled --we perceive
control over the given space, the hologram, of which our extrasensory
talents are a direct evidence of the true reality.
The
non-local dispensation of belief-patterns that flow through the mind
-- writhing through the theme of the hologram to which we possess
control -- we imagine the “final environment" -- the final
environment of the mind. In meditation, we may reduce our focus to a
singular point -- and enter into the alpha-wave patterns of which we
are most programmable. Here, we may autosuggest certain thoughts to
ourselves, like "matter transcends reality" and "I am
an ascended master" and "the universe is a hologram."
to a plethora of conceivable autosuggestions that densify thoughts
within the recess of our minds. As the final environmen is that of
the mind, where all Light originates through the Source of the
subconscious mind -- we are evolving to the point of finding that the
rules of the hologram are changeable, and we see verily that in this
changeful reality, that we are in control over the rules -- we
personally define them -- and human flight, God knows, seemingly a
theory out of the movies; is theoretically achievable in the highest
levels of Lightbody through the development of ones merkabah
vehicle.
Human flight, it will seem, is going to pass as a
logical part of this changeful reality. Levitation and telekinesis
were theoretically used to build many of the pyramids, and already
our government has technology as gifted from the Zeta's, for the
physical construction of the merkabah starship to reach physical
manifest. This self-contained, antigravitational flying machine is
theoretically one amid the future forms in transportation, that we
can fly is seemingly science fiction, but already most UFO sightings
are in truth human pilots, in their self-contained merkabah
starships. In this life, I have seen the erratic stop-and-go
movements of that distant firefly-like light, and I am calmly aware
that this may be extraterrestrial, human, or ascended master. I
believe that it was a merkabah starship, inhibiting me with the
thought of their existence which would produce faith in my being. As
I have seen countless UFO's in this life, and experienced the
extrasensory so many times now, and found telekinesis as a result of
my self-created reality -- I know
this
is merely a fleeting thought within the mind of God, as facets of His
energy, unique sparks, and individuated by experience, we are merely
thoughts, mere thoughts within the great vast plethora of all
thoughts which have ever occurred.
We are holographically connected, as thoughts, identities, names, and individuations. We are all connected by the hologram of the third dimension -- that our bodies are part of the hologram is invariably found, and such, by affecting ourselves; we affect the hologram of the third dimenson. That we find universal principle where faith only stood once before, we are realizing our true power through the indelible life-force of our thoughts, and as we see that thought and matter are entangled, that the hologram of the third dimension is tied into our thoughts to which we always possess full control -- we may see ourselves somewhere, and transfer our energy through the hologram to end up in that place.
We are to be found teleporting at our own Free Will. We are all going to find our true power as ascended master, as unique sparks of the primordial God-essence, as bound by the energetic Source Field of which all minds are invariably linked, working, and evolving together. As the entire universe, we perceive, is also holographic, we must imagine that as molecules revolves around the nucleus of an atom, and planets revolve around the sun, so the totality of the universal aggregate must revolve around a center -- which we perceive as our own unisphere, the Free Will universe.
This
universe was experimental, a process which began theoretically with
the big bang. Born from another universe, another mind, another
Source. Time went on for a duration, incarnations became karmically
entangled, and over time, we realized the final incarnation. Once the
final incarnation was realized, we found our power in thought was
endless, and that we were creators of our own realities. As we grew
and evolved, we may have strayed far from the original fount of
Light, but our journey was not walked in vain. Through life and
existence, we came to produce a plethora of stellar souls -- artists,
writers, geniuses, and profound intellectual thinkers. We learned
that we are the fuel, we are the Light, we are the shift, we are the
prophecy -- all of these things and more as we are now coming to find
that the Earth and the Free Will universe -- are part and parcel to
the growth of the total aggregate which revolves around the nucleus,
which is the Free Will universe.
As the third dimension starts
to break down and re-form into the new, of which we are now moving
into the fifth dimension, we shall find that as I will so lovingly
suggest -- that the future is
endless
-- and our journey has just begun. "We are alive in the New Age"
-- here within the perceived center. We know ourselves as
informational Light -- that our identities are hard-wired into the
collective plan -- and we know that we weave the future, and we are
all unique creators. We see that we exist as energy, that energy once
expressed produces karma, and the karmic relationships are at last
divined to the final few -- with the thought "getting closer,
getting much closer now" in reference toward the highest
conceivable relationships. We seek to be loved, judged, and adored.
We seek to possess a place within the rows of the Cosmic Family.
Eventually we look back on how the world used to be, and reflect that
it was all merely a fleeting thought within the mind of One -- an
experiment, realizing this test was won by faith, and we found
ourselves enlightened through time . . .
The
experiment of physicality and time would go on, and we now perceive
the future civilization of ascended masters who are naturally in tune
with nature, and the infinite. As we move through Lightbody into the
eventual realization of the fifth octave, and that future resource
found, the Light of our DNA, we will be realized as ascended, realize
our DNA has unwound to that original twelve-strand encodement, and we
are divine, and we are Light, and we are God, and our power is
seemingly endless upon the realization of the infinitude of matter.
We see evolution moving in only one direction, as we may watch the
ticking clock, or the movements of the clouds, and we see that
animation of matter continues on. That matter is moving together,
interrelated, holographically connected from one part to the next. As
we find ourselves in touch with the hologram, and find ourselves
"outside of the matrix" -- able to witness the Akashic
probabilities, it will come to pass that we are in control over this
reality. We see Light in the uniqueness of the self-divined soul. We
see information where only ignorance stood before. We see the fifth
dimension.
Chapter
Twenty Five: The Fifth Dimension
"Time
is an illusion. The only truth is animation."
The
fifth dimension, where there is no time, and we are in the original
twelve-strand encodement, we shall find our reality is directly
manifest by our thoughts, and the final environment of the mind
interpolated into the sacred space -- our room for divination -- this
single cell will represent the place where we endeavor to work with
the fifth octave. So we imagine that in the fifth dimension there are
universal principles that never change -- such as the amorphousness
of the human soul, the teleconnection of matter, and the direct
non-local transferrence of shared thought. In the fifth dimension, we
writhe solely upon the thoughts -- the imagination -- non-linear
thinking as governed by certain goals realized, and the goals seem to
manifest directly.
In
the fifth dimension our bodies are ethereal, and we can take on any
shape or form at our own Free Will. Always reverting back to the
soul-form after taking on a specific shape, creature, or embodiment,
we always return to the source of the soul -- to relay back what we
have learned through the manifestation. As the soul is essentially
amorphous, a shape-shifter, and in the fifth octave we writhe upon
the abstractions of the imagination -- we shall see that we are
capable of being "anyone, or anything." That we experience
the identity of, God knows, another individual -- and re-live their
karma -- through the empathy of shared thought, as we are all
telepathic in the fifth dimension, we shall see that karma is now
active, and what we think actively manifests. Whatever wish upon
ourselves is shared with the rest of the many microcosms of reality
-- and we see our effect on people is direct.
Certain
technologies exist in the fifth octave such as the Akashic Computer,
to that of the psycho-imaginarium. The thoughts of the imagination
are projected onto a screen for all to view. We may soar through
geometric patterns, auroras, and nebulas, the most divine conceivable
possibilities of the human imagination -- and this technology
theoretically already exists.
As we perform this great film, a representation of potentially many minds working together to produce a cinematic masterpiece -- our ability to entertain, and educate ourselves, through the imaginarium will come to pass as one of the greatest tools for learning and divination. This which is like a cinematic bible, as related to the Akashic Computer, may project things past, life on Earth, or other planets. We may perceive the grand scope of things, and view from the apogee of awareness, All That Is. In the fifth dimension, everything occurs "all at once" and operates through a sort of non-linear patterning.
Everything
occurs all at once, such that the universe begins, exists, and ends,
within the essence of a single thought. Our thoughts in the fifth
dimension are wholly enlightened to God-consciousness, and we know
that our Light is writhing through the twelve-strand DNA we possess,
is the true living matter which composes the universe. We accept that
Light is the final truth, that in the fifth dimension there is only
pure-love and Light and unconditional peace, and well-being, such
that when many die it is allegedly reported that a great white light
is perceived. Theoretically, the naturally occurring psychadelic DMT
floods into the brain, producing euphoria upon the moment of death.
Yet, we are as found in the fifth octave incapable of death -- that
naturally occurring chemical occurs through our enlightened thoughts,
and as such, we reside within a permanent stasis of euphoria.
If
one has ever taken a strong hallucinogenic drug, they may have some
sense of what the fifth dimension is like. Through the imaginative
capacities, we will see intertwisted geometric patterns, nebulas,
auroras, and glowing waves that seem to travel through the recess. We
will see that once observed, matter reacts, and is activated into
animation. Just by observing something, we affect it, as quantum
theory will boldly declare, so it goes, whence we look upon an
object, or an individual -- they will feel our thoughts
instantaneously, and know exactly how we feel. As there is no pain in
the fifth dimension, or any sense of limitation, but only Free Will
-- we shall see that in the fifth dimension where there is no time,
no pain, and no conception of duality, but only the final beliefs of
the final mind -- and we writhe through our beliefs expressed through
tones and images, that we see what we want to see, feel what we want
to feel, and know what we want to know. Life in the fifth dimension
is endless, and there is no stopping the infinite power of the human
imagination. As we are found in the fifth octave, God knows, we may
be capable of traveling from one point of the universe to the next --
via portals, hypercontinuums, and various advanced technology. As we
see reality is directly manifest by our thoughts, it will seem as
though we are within the recess of a lucid dream -- that things once
solid and physical are now ethereal, and translucent. Theoretically
we may be re-united with discarnate souls and lost loved-ones who
parted from the third dimension. Theoretically, we will re-unite,
with many stories to tell about what it was like to live in time.
We
writhe through intent, empathy, and emotion -- and we personally
decide what we want to experience. Many stories will be shared of
what it was like to live in time, physicality, and limitation. How we
have been many different people, in many different times and places,
only to equalize into the final life. How we lived through duality
and separation of belief for a prolonged "dark night of the
soul" -- the darkness preceding the overwhelming Light. In the
fifth dimension, where there is only unconditional love, peace,
sharing, and longevity of life through the infinitude of our
enlightened cells -- we are
divined to the highest cogitations, writhe through the theme of our
beliefs that we create our own experiences, and find, that whence
shared with other people, we truly start to learn. As we may writhe
through the reality of another, and experience their own unique Light
-- we shall see, learn, and know, where this person is coming from,
what ideals they possess, and how they choose to live out their
existence in the fifth octave. Self-concepts will be shared for the
betterment of humankind. People will have no fear in sharing their
thoughts, nor any fear in sharing their beliefs. We are all
individuals, a mass collective of individuals -- styles, and unique
hues of fragments of the original spark. As we do not know "when"
the return to the Source will be -- as there is no time in the fifth
octave -- how or where we will merge with the Source, we simply know
that this perceived locale within the continuum exists. As we are
become interversal travelers, the masters of the aggregate, we view
the probabilities of which ignorance lies in other systems, and thus
take it upon ourselves to act as guide, through the avatar of our
ascended body. Here, we intervene in certain peoples lives to produce
the thought that we exist, and they are not alone.
So it goes,
matter is infinite, as in the fifth dimension there is no time, but
animation continues on -- we will control the weather, hold a thought
for as long as we want to, and meditate through the deepest
conceivable images of beauty and Light that can possibly be manifest
by the mind. The fifth dimension is the imagination-world, a place
entirey governed by the vivacity of Free Will and pure-love. And we
only continue to rise in vibration once that stasis has been found.
As many are unsure of what lies next, in the perceived "new"
realized -- that once all is seemingly known, we see the movements of
the continuum continue on, and life upon life upon life prevails
infinitely through the recess of what will come to be our own
universe, with our own set of rules and principles. Just as we all
have a sacred space of some form, a home, or a room to which we
learn, so we will possess our own universe -- our own cosmic base --
our headquarters through which we may invite other souls to convene
with us.
Just
as the Free Will universe was constructed by one mind alone, so the
new universes are being constructed by singular facets of the
primordial Light, given to the recess for which a world of ones own
is made, and come manifest.
As the psycho-imaginarium is
employed, we are to educate ourselves toward the highest conceivable
awareness -- that we may view one persons story as related to
another, and perceive the karmic relationship, and witness the energy
exchange. We may perceive, in this cinematic representation, what a
subject is thinking, how their energy is being used, and what
probable future they are heading towards. As we are capable of
viewing the many probable futures through the Probability Factor
Mechanism, we may witness one stream of events, and then another, and
then another, witnessing all the conceivable possibilities for
evolution, to betrayal of expectation, hate, trauma, and fear -- and
love -- all of these things and more, seen on the screen, witnessed
directly through the psycho-imaginarium.
Whatever can be
imagined exists in the fifth dimension.
This is the realm of the imagination, that what we experience is wholly governed by our own cognizance. Our consciousness is found Godly, that we are aligned with the natural workings of the unisphere, and travel from place to place in the mere blink of an eye. As we are teleconnected, potentially moving our civilization toward life on Venus -- God knows -- we may have many worlds to disperse the seed of Light, to other planets which have only been distant from us, for the betterment of other races. Having reached the final incarnation thus integrated into the fifth octave, it may become our mission to act as harbingers for change on other worlds.
Perceiving the symbol of the caduceus as that to which we serve -- the joining of energies dark and Light into a unitive, harmonically convergent whole, we see energy as infinitely interwoven into the tapestry of all universes. In the final analysis, we hope to live within our own universe eventually, made up of our own rules, and declarations. It will come to pass that our primordial spark is the necessary ingrediant toward the production of new life-forms. Our creations will be divine, and ascend through their own process of evolution.
If
one could imagine an aquarium, to which within lies another aquarium,
we see this universe of our own making -- that exquisite cell within
a cell, our universe exists just as Adam would create Eve out of his
own being, so we have created new universes from that of the center
of the aggregate which is governed by Free Will. One universe begets
the next, and through the matrix of universes -- that one of our own
exists, and here we writhe through the totality of the most grand
"sacred space" that can possibly be imagined.
Free
Will is the imaginations tool for self-divination.
As
we find our Free Will is endlessly expressed as become One with the
Source -- and transformed into a totally new being, a totally new
form, just as the De Novo mutation is a entirely new mutation that
most doctors and scientists do not understand -- this which is
derived from the Latin meaning "fresh, to start anew" is
related, it would seem, to the endurance of Free Will, and the
concept of tomorrow.
That through ones own special quest, the mutation is realized, that we are cast into a totally new state of being. We are wholly renewed, we "start over" and feel somewhat born again. Here we are resurrected, with the re-integration of matter found in that of the finalized host, the final life. Only to progress logilinearly through the continuum into the highest revelations. Finally, we are capable of producing the space to be filled. We work with the energies that already exist, form the outer shell, and then ignite the universe with its own big-bang, the cosmo-cathartic supernova. The universe is ignited into life, time begins, and the creation of star systems and worlds start to manifest. Over time, the Elohims which are fragmentations of our being, start to create planets, suns, and galaxies. Finally, various worlds are eventually populated by the Elohims, and the creator Gods start to produce fragmentations of their own selves, a furtherance of the original divine dispensation, that life is given to matter, and we see our creations have taken on a life of their own.
One has created life that is now creating life of its own, in a sort of artificial intelligence that writhes through the power of its own vivacity. Like a self-resident program that operates through its own natural accord, we come to see reflections of our Godliness in our creations, and we start to observe as religion, separation, duality, fear, and scapegoating start to overtake the masses. Thankfully, we perceive certain guides, world leaders, and high-charged thinkers start to right the waves of the tide, and personally witness the guidance of the race back to the primordial Light, through certain individuals. We observe as our creations willfully save themselves from the resounding darkness, and make the collective effort for peace and longevity of life. Eventually, ones creations start to discover Lightbody, and realize scientific evidence for the existence of the soul. Further in event, ones creations start to realize they were created from one mind -- one sole individual -- and this is somewhat hard to comprehend.
As
ones creations realize their Free Will must be under the scope of
some higher force, the paradox of Free Will would suggest there is
always something hovering, overwhelmingly, above them; so our
creations start to accept this higher force, and begin to question
it, and how their existence relates. Revolution occurs -- and our
creations start building starships, and work toward discovering the
true nature of the universe. We watch this calmly and carefully, as
they find themselves nearing the blackhole. Eventually, they merge
with the radiating vortex, arrive at the Source -- stare us plainly
in the eyes, and ask us: "why..?"
O God, why was I
created..?
You
were created in reflection of the beauty of the Source.
But
why was I created for divine Light, while others meander in the
darkness..?
It
is your responsibility to change the tides of reality.
How
will I do this..?
By
extension of your Free Will.
What
is Free Will..?
The
expression of your inner nature.
What
do I truly desire..?
A
closer connection to God.
What
is God..?
You
are God.
So
I desire a closer connection with myself..?
Yes.
But
you created me -- you are above me -- how could I
be
God..?
We
are all God.
How
did any of this even happen, where did it all begin, and again,
why..?
No
one is really sure.
What
am I to do, O Lord..?
Go
to other worlds, and spread the seed of Light.
Will
I ever see you again..?
Yes.
How
many times..?
An
infinitismal number.
Why
must I undertake this arduous task..?
You
already know the answer.
You
are too beautiful to stand -- I . . . I am at a loss of words.
Words
are merely an abstraction. There is only Light.
Thank
you.
Thank
you as well, and good luck!
The
entity returns to their own Source-station, builds a universe of
their own, and eventually, moves on to other worlds.
So we
have imagined the conversation between creator and the created. The
created becomes a creator in their own right, so progresses the
infinite number of universes, and life as governed by tones of Free
Will. We send our child out into the world with fond hopes, but worry
somewhat, as we know he or she is nye to return to us, and the story
they bring might be something we never expected. As our creation
endeavors into the expression of his or her own Light, on other
worlds, in other universes, we will humbly wait in our headquarters
-- await the return of our child -- and hope
for the best,
that our creation will have good news about the changeful reality.
Here we are the Source, of which all thought resides, we know our
creations are divine, and we humbly realize that our power is
endless. We wait for the return of our child. And we prepare to learn
something new. We will learn from our own creation, as they are
youthful, a representation of something we once knew back on Earth.
We see their vivacity, childlike nature, and how they perceive beauty
in all things. We are inspired by our own child, and we learn much
from that of our child thus returned to its creator. As we all have
learned from someone, as we all pray to some master, so it would seem
in the seemingly infinite hierarchy of universes, there is what is
referred to as the Thetaverse which lies at the apex of all
universes. This is our own parent cell, the one that started it all.
We observe from afar, how this mindverse operates, and we humbly
accept that the power seems to be beyond us. We look at this, from
our own universe, and see that the machine is actively working -- we
trust the movements of the universes are goal-oriented in their own
right, and it may come to pass that we do not need to go to the
Thetaverse, but the Thetaverse will come to us. For all we know our
creations will rise to a higher vibration than that of our own, and
become greater than their primordial Source, able to, through
mutation, arrive at the Thetaverse, and inform us of what it was
like.
This
individual we have produced will work to produce their own universe,
that one universe begets the next in a infinite string, that never
seems to end. Our universe breeds another, and that universe breeds
another -- in a infinite hierarchy that never seems to end, but only
continues through the self-resident life-force of the vivacity of
life. So it goes, we have come to live in the center of the aggregate
of the Free Will universe, the energy-source where all life emanates
from, only to become interversal travelers, create our own universe
governed by our own rules, and thus found equal with that of the
original Source from which we came.
So we have gone over one
perceived example of how the future may progress.
We perceive that one universe begets the next, and ascended masters are produced from the original codex of the Source.
God would produce copies, dispensations of the primordial Light, in order to learn from His own being.
Life creates life, this we know, and we are all creators.
All energy is dispersed from the center which invariably returns to the Source.
We
learn, invariably, from the Source from which we originated, and as a
cell within a cell within, that we are alive in the fifth octave, and
we theoretically commune with the Source whenever our Free Will
permits.
"The future, is endless," and this is
wholly defined by the imaginations capacity to produce it.
We
are One.
Life will produce new life, and the re-integration of matter will continue for as long as the continuum exists.
The
continuum, which is simply the animation of the spheres, the natural
movements of all life through existence -- is only infinite, and
never ceases its wavelike-undulations through the perceived spaces in
between universes. Like synapses joined through the endurance of new
thought, the universes are interconnected, and all relative,
invariably, to the primordial Source from which all life
originates.
Chapter
Twenty Six: The Primordial Rhythm
"At
the heart of all existence, therein lies a rhythm."
The
primordial rhythm, to which we are based upon, is the foundation of
our existence. Tapping into this rhythm is a matter of synchronicity,
that we perceive this rhythm exists, in the heart of the universe --
at the Source -- there lies the primordial rhythm. And this rhythm
pulses as the heart of the universe, with the fluctating walls of the
universe. We are a part of the universe, and we find existence
possesses a rhythm, that through incarnation and many lives lived on
Earth, there is a certain number to the incarnations, and we have
rhythmically incarnated through time. Through the matrix of
incarnation time would eventually lead up to the final one, that life
lived within the recess of the New Age, we are now starting to writhe
through the primordial rhythm -- the true divine flow of self-aware
sentience that is rhythmic. As time is nonexistent in reality, but
there is only the present living moment -- and we are now in the
final incarnation -- so we see that eventuality of all life leading
up to the final one -- that this time would eventually lead up to a
conclusive element -- the re-discovery of the primordial rhythm.
The
future is constructed by the rhythm of our thoughts, and time only
moves in one direction . . . so we learn, we grow, and we evolve,
through the natural rhythm we possess -- and we all possess a unique
rhythm. In meditation, we may operate through numbers alone -- and
calmly declare that all thoughts will occur in perfect syllabic waves
-- perfect intonating patterns -- that we find that we are "riding
our thoughts" -- and thoughts occur naturally as the rhythm is
entrained upon them. The rhythm to our thoughts is syllabic, and most
thoughts, as suggested in the chapter about syllabation, tend to
occur in 5-10 syllables. Around the center lies the seventone, a
seven-syllable thought, and these are theoretically the most powerful
ones. But of course we are all different, and for all we know our
most powerful thoughts occur in eights, nines, and tens.
All
sentient creatures opertate on words, language, and semantics -- such
that invariably we possess a rhythm to the language of our thoughts,
and as writers we may commit this rhythm to poetry or lyricality --
that we view our thoughts is one thing, but that we are able to
perfect, construct, truncate, and form into a natural rhythm is what
turns us into a true creator, and self-expressor. As we are
inherently telepathic, we are essentially multidimensional -- that we
are amorphous, and may wear any thought at any given time, any unique
rhythm, and as such, there is a music
to our thoughts. The
ancient mystic Rolle referred to the highest act as "thought
turned into song." As we all possess a unique rhythm, and there
is a natural lyricality that lies within us, a natural orchestratic
melody, we may find that through poetics and rhyme, which are great
tools in meditation, that we tap into the primordial rhythm of the
universe, and find our natural flow.
The infinitude of rhyme
shall be seen as a matter which links our thoughts together. Rhyme
ties into memory, and we naturally remember things better when we
rhyme. Myself, I tend to rhyme constantly -- and survive through my
own use of lyricality. I have a natural understanding of sound,
waveforms, music, and rhythm, such that I have spent great time
studying waveforms, which are the aesthetic depiction of sound as
presented through frequencies, so I know that thought exists in
waveforms, and waveforms, with their bumps, curves, and juts, are
always flowing within us -- that we may attribute image to our
thoughts, and imagine them flowing within us in their own unique
rhythm. I believe much can be learned through the inhibition of
perceiving thought as a waveform.
The waveform travels through the ether, out of us, our crown chakras, into the emanating recess of the universe, the cosmos, and then back to us. As our thoughts may rhyme through their own natural flow of rhythm, we are endeavoring toward the production of the most higher-vibrating thoughts.
Rhyme is an expression of creativity that when tied into thought finds a special unique rhythm.
The infinitude of rhyme is evident many creators that through rhyming thoughts we are more able to remember our thoughts, and not only this, but operate through constantly lyrical, and high-vibrating thought forms. Our rhyming thoughts which flow as music, and we all possess lyricality to some degree, as we are all writhing through a certain rhythm that is unique to us -- from the foot-step, to the beating heart, to the natural movements of the eyes, to our animatable abilities expressed through the sacred space. We know there is a rhythm to our thoughts, and we believe that through tapping into the inner musicality of our cogitations we will remain in a creative state, and always have poetics waiting aready at the tip of our tongue. In elocution, dictation, or mantra, we may observe our thoughts being spoken aloud -- flow within the given space, reverberate off the walls, and thus echo back to us. Spoken thought is a powerful exercise, and through intonation of thought through mantra, great states of insight can be realized. As writers, we are finding the primordial rhythm through punctuation, and the internality of words that link together, of which prosaically we present our thoughts, and observe how they naturally occur. For some, we flow endlessly in streaming-consciousness,and here, we find the primordial rhythm of our thoughts, no matter what our thoughts are. The rhythm is to be found through streaming-consciousness, we are able to view, read, and understand our thoughts thus committed to text through, through automatic writing.
Following
the rhythm of our written thoughts, the primordial rhythm is found
through intuition, effortlessness, and instinct. We endeavor to
remain "effortless" -- that we flow as a river, and our
thoughts are fluid. Such that we may imagine our thoughts are
producing a waveform that travels through the universe, cycling
endlessly through the universe -- that our thoughts are essentially a
waveform -- the aesthetic depiction of sound as frequency -- and
these waveforms flow through their own natural percussian. And we may
find in meditation that as we attach image to our thoughts, the
inborn percussian of this waveform is to be imagined as naturally
rhythmic, and we perceive it flowing out of us endlessly into the
fluctuating walls of the universe and back.
The primordial
rhythm is based upon the Source, of which all life originally
emanated -- the pulsing heartbeat of the universe -- it throbs and
writhes and vibrates in strings, that are all connected through the
primordial rhythm, these rhythmic waves travel out of the heart
divine, into us, becoming the thoughts we project back into the
universe, transmuted, in the emanating Light that travels infinitely.
Rhythmic transmutations, through informational Light-based waveforms,
thoughts, rhythmic and flowing through the uniqueness of our
existential riverlight; -- we learn the rhythm often through
meditative states, and the rhythm of our thoughts when found in
meditation is usually come to be mantrasized, or affirmational
"suggestions" -- a conversation between the hemispheres,
and this meditative state (the state of alpha-wave patterns) -- a
relay between the hemispheres in the rhythmic dialogue, and exchange
of question and answer -- soul-searching, peering into the very
shadow of our existence. We peer into the abyss, and the darkest
abysmal recesses of the soul, and this flows naturally in the
effortlessness of our high-charged thoughts as found in the
revelatory state.
Chapter
Twenty Seven: The Revelatory State
"The
records that have been written have been written . . .
Then the
natural question of the entity, from that which has been given,
is:
From what source, or how, is such a record read of the
activities of the past?
How may self know that there is being
given a TRUE record of the activities
In a period of which there
is no written WORD [of] history?
Yet the entity itself sees, and
is being taught, and is studying,
the records that are written in
a nature, in the rocks, in the hills, in the trees,
in that termed
the genealogical log of nature itself.
Just as true, then, is the
record that the mind makes upon the film of time and space
in the
activities of a body with its soul that is made in the image of the
Maker;
Being then spirit, in its form, upon the records IN time
and space."
-- Edgar Cayce
So
it will seem that the relevatory state is matter in motion, that is
gradated through thought, and we perceive these as elements of God .
. .
The
revelatory state is of which we are found in the perfect rhythm, and
the revelation is insight of which relates to our future, very often,
or the realization of certain constructs of reality that we now
control. We may learn that human sameness is evident, and human
connection is the highest act, or that we, made up of the same atoms,
sub-atomic particles, and are a body composed of the majority of
water -- the same matter that composes all human bodies -- we
generate electricity which thus fuel our bodies, with beliefs
crystallized within us -- all governed by our indelible Free Will --
and the basic universal principles flow as naturally produced
thoughts that invariably "suddenly make sense to us." We
will learn from our revelations, and achieve that insight through the
expected field of which to be filled with its beauteous patterns of
insight.
"Reality
is owned."
We
all decree what is real, and what makes sense in accord with the
theme of our beliefs. Reality is owned in the sense that we
understand the subconscious doesn't know the difference between what
it sees, and what it remembers. The subconscious and the imaginative
processes found therein, are what decide our realities -- and through
knowledge of that now-point -- to which we
know we can think any thought. "I
am divine Light." "I love life." "I am human
evolution" etc. -- we may program ourselves which powerful
revelations, and many are guided by their instances of these profound
moments of reverie. The inner genius is the subconscious mind, and
through connection to the storehouse of records, the Akasha, and
peering into the book, and seeing a certain memory; we find a certain
image, word, or insight. The revelatory state is often found in deep
alpha-state, as opposed to beta which is the totally conscious state
-- in the alpha-state we are theoretically about ten times, to a
hundred times, more able to program ourselves. In meditation, as we
flow through alpha-wave patterns, we are inviting revelations by
putting our thoughts into direct awareization, to think about thought
in itself, and place all thought into question -- that we are in the
invitive state, and revelations storm through us as a direct
result.
Finding the relevatory state is often direct result of
meditations. As we meditate, and come to focus on our pure thoughts
-- writhing through the natural rhythm of our cogitations, we may
recite a mantra, focus on an image, or repeat a certain invocation.
Here, by repetition of thought through such, we invite the
alpha-state, and eventually find ourselves within her recess. As we
find the alpha-wave patterns of the meditative state, and we are
wholly aware of our own thoughts, and where they are leading us -- we
endeavor to reach into the subconscious, for new knowledge and new
insight to be gained. Here, we may repeat the thought "I am
alive in the New Age" to give us some sense of importance, or
"this is my final incarnation." We perceive the importance
of our existence, that there is only One Life, One Spirit, One
Mission, and One True Goal of all human existence. The one true goal,
it shall seem, is our desire for connection with another soul. In my
own right, whilst in the meditative state -- I would reach this
revelation, that the highest act a human can achieve is connection
with another human, and that willing to be changed by another defines
our open-mindedness, and ability to learn. As we will realize that
time does not exist in meditation, but we are in the timeless state
-- our thoughts will undulate in formidable patterns that wholly
enamor us with a sense of reverie.
That
we realize the eventual masterpiece of thought, telling ourselves "I
will have a cosmic revelation in five minutes" and then
distracting the mind from the thought -- focusing on other matters
until the five minutes have passed; just as we may remember better by
upon forgetting something, to tell ones self "I will remember in
a minute" and then distract ourselves through conscious thought
until the minute has passed. Naturally, the memory will be recalled,
or the revelation will be found. The act of priming is a great
advancement in human knowledge, that the Mayans knew this well, and
we have always been readying ourselves, through the goal-oriented
processes involved, toward the relevatory state. We operate through
constant prayer, those of us who are in the relevatory state almost
all the time -- that we receive revelations constantly throughout the
day will shape and mold our existence. We realize we can cogitate any
thought, commit any action, and we are wholly enamored with the power
of our Free Will. Here, in meditation, we may reduce our focus to
that minute focal point of awareness -- and focus fixedly on this
point -- as the gaze will fade into the coziness of meditate thought
-- we are enamored with the image -- we feel its intensity, its
power, and its life. Meditation is different for most of us -- that
we may be lying down or sitting upright is wholly based upon the
individual. As meditation is something that will go to the core of
our existence, and the exercise of "thinking any thought,
cogitating any notion, forming any new string-set of beliefs" we
invite the revelatory state.
The shadow may be uncovered, but
tones of creativity will save us -- that we remain in a creative
state, everrhyimg, everflowing through the riverlight of our
imaginations; -- flowing from thoughts of Godliness, to those manic
states of great passion. This must be realized, and wholly endured
upon the senses -- and nothing can shake our Free Will -- we may
perceive the next day, map it out, God knows, but we are wholly
realizant of the fact that tomorrow is still somewhat mysterious. We
move into the next day with fond expectations, waking up in the
morning perhaps to focus on our thoughts through meditation. The
waking hours are a sacred time, and the morning must be respected as
a recess for which focus on ones own self, and deepest thoughts, are
found.
"The
trick is to not think about it."
Remaining
intuitive, and right-brained, we endeavor to remain in a fluid
effortless state. Eventing our way through the given space, from
organizing books, to perfecting the environment, we hope to create
the environment where our revelations will occur. The sacred space is
ones tool for learning, and here is simply an extension of our mind.
All objects within the space are thoughts, and we always have control
over these objects/thoughts. Within the sacred space, we move through
thought, act intuitively, and express that however patternless nature
may be, there is always a conclusive result. The eventual masterpiece
of thought found in revelation is what all intuitive thought is
leading up to -- and so it shall come to pass that very often, whence
we are effortless and intuitive, a thought will seem to have "come
out of nowhere" -- one which sums up our entire existence, and
possesses a a vast amount of information. This is usually a message
from the Akashic, and Akashic transmissions are more easily found
whence we remain intiutive, effortless, and flow as a river.
Perceiving a metaphysical storehouse of all thoughts and events
within a given locale is just logical, and seems to make a lot of
sense in Light of the concept of living information. Such that it may
be found that through an understanding of this perceived storehouse,
whether it is real or not, we may call it God, the Universal Mind,
the Source Field, the Collective Unconscious -- whatever the name --
the information exists, all thoughts and actions ever committed leave
a sort of cosmic residue, energy aggregates, and they become
integrated into the things we will realize upon the endurance of the
revelatory state.
"The
Akashic Records is made up of living information."
"I
think about it now and then . . . I cogitate the thought . . . the
resounding words within my mind -- such that I know the words are
true, and they are words born from the universe itself." One
is enamored now, once the revelation has been engrained into ones
mind, and all conscious thought following is based upon the truth of
the revelation, we are learning from ourselves, and thus guided by
the inner Light. Mere double-strokes, upon a rotated surface, may
reveal symbolic truth -- or the energy made visible in
free-association drawings, toward the poetical expressions of words
that are made alive through the vivacity of their use in expressed
rhythms. Words are alive, they vibrate within us, and they all
frequent around certain oscillations of waveforms that are endlessly
emanating in various patterns, bumps, juts, and curves, within our
minds. Thoughts as transmitted to waveform through recording device
such as microphone and computer microphone jack, and the free music
program Audacity, we may see our thoughts visually -- the revelation
thus imagined -- images that flow through their natural forms,
patterns, and geometry, we see with our inner eye the making of which
paragraphs are eventually formed, and they manifest into form,
synchronistically, as naturally occurring. The waveform travels
within our minds, the imagined stream of Light-based cogitation . . .
as cogitations will be Light-based, as bound by the rhythm of
existence, the primordial rhythm, thoughts flow in a natural accord
which is always leading up to the divine revelation. So the
revelation as found as a waveform that frequents around the nucleus
of the thought, is undulating and vibrating within our minds -- here,
we see the revelation, perceive the glowing text, and read it calmly
with assured awareness. All thought and action is leading up toward
the eventual masterpiece of thought -- such that the process of
enlightenment, as theorized within this text as a spontaneous
occurrence through the dream of awakening, is the beginning of time,
our now-point to which we invariably return to the Source of our
enlightenment.
Light-based cogitations are thoughts which writhe through the theme of our beliefs -- of which thought revolves around the nucleus of a certain idea, and the Light which emanates in all directions from that imagined core -- our center -- the very center our existence, here emanates, like the Source, all fount and flow of knowledge and insight as presented through the Light-based cogitations. From the center emanates all energy -- that center of which eclipses with the perceived center of the universe -- creating a vibration which only builds in rate the further we imagine the frequency, and perceive thought as the flowing waveform. As we can now see our thoughts, given to the waveform, and we see the words in the expressed tonal images, through use of the program Audacity, or whatever tools of audio engineering we may possess -- it requires little skill to dictate voice into a microphone, and so it shall seem that once we are able to view our thoughts -- like being able to view the Earth from outer space -- we find greater control over the matter.
So
we perceive an image to thought, the waveform, and how it flows in
various shapes and patterns. The waveform of ones voice is typically
a very jagged frequency, with breath-pops, voice-clicks, and
sibilance (S sounds) -- that all as thus perceived in the imaginetic
form of the waves. So we perceive an image to our revelations -- and
our revelations are to be seen as invariably realized through the
endurance of making thought visible, and thus enamoring ourselves
with how thought appears in the make-up of the waveform pattern. That
thought is perceived as image, that of the waveform, and all
invitation of new thought found in admiring how thought appears -- we
may be involved in such meditations that we can see our voice in the
waveform patterns, that in this very moment we can see our thoughts
through the image of the waveform, we can see the flowing movement of
the inner music of the mind -- and we are attaching image to
cogitation that only invites further imaginings of thought to exist
-- once the recess has been endured upon the senses that we are now
capable of visibly perceiving thought as a waveform. We know thought
bears an image when see in the waveform, and we know it enhances the
imaginations ability to produce attractive waveforms, the natural
inborn reverie as found by looking at thoughts in terms of the
waveform.
As we may consciously imagine the waveform as we
cogitate our thoughts -- that "my thoughts are a waveform"
is the thought, and we see this waveform emanating across the
recesses of the universe, we perceive this as a super-string of
harmonic frequency, that joins with other frequencies, mixes together
into the form of a revelation -- and here is a revelation that is
like an orchestra of thought constantly being interpolated into the
datasphere of knowledge. As thought and Akasha are always in
frequency, that the records are infinitely revised through our events
and movements through time -- we are realizing that the revelations
will come naturally through expectation and priming, and this is what
all life is leading up to -- that profound moment -- that one
instance within the grand scope of All That Is -- that we are
enamored with a certain thought, one which resounds so profoundly
within our minds that it is thus saturated upon every cell of our
being -- it is definitive, and it is evident of certain truths.
The
revelation occurs in its natural imaginetic waveform, is thus
enamored upon the senses, body, mind, and soul, all energies eclipsed
toward the masterpiece of perfect thought -- and it bears a certain
rhythm -- and it flows in perfect syllabic intonation. The waveform
of enlightened thought thus held within the mind, we refer to this
revelation constantly throughout the rest of ones life, that it is a
message from the universe built specifically for our own evolution,
and as such, evidence of the living information. So we are enamored
with the revelation, the insight wholly empowering us to the higher
degree of sentience. Enamored with the revelation, we now move
through the proactive animation of acting upon the thought. As the
revelation may be realized as "there is no higher act than human
connection" -- we may act upon this notion by endeavoring to
meet someone new, and inviting a new relationship into our life. So
we act upon the revelation, through the theme of our beliefs, and
this will only continue for as long as we remain in the revelatory
state.
I believe that the revelatory state can be reached by
anyone, that belief in the Akasha may yield the cosmic truths, or
simply praying to the energy of the Source from which we came. Matter
is quantumly entangled, all is connected, and all things are
occurring actively within the higher dimensions, all at once. So we
may realize "everything" in a single thought -- a
revelation which holographically contains the energy of the entirety
of our beliefs. This profound realization charges, fuels our
existence. It will be carried with us until the very end. So we are
enamored by the revelation, and this is something we may never ever
forget -- but what will seem to possess a rhythm, and undulate, and
oscillate within the mainframe of our thoughts -- as the very fuel to
our living existence. All concept of "new thought"
following that revelation realized, the concept of tomorrow, and all
thought that these answers only lead to more questions -- we remain
enamored with the beauty and information, we may peer through
rose-colored glasses and see that information in itself is enhancing
to our lives. So we are enlightened by the thought, we may attach
image to this thought through waveform, and then progress toward
imagining as the very walls of the universe are touched by the
emanating waveform of our self-divined thoughts.
Thought
is always travelling both in and out of us, as transceivers, that we
may be "input mode" or "output mode." In
meditation, we are endeavoring to communicate with the subconscious
mind -- and an imagined conversation between the hemispheres may take
place.
Powerful meditations are found often in a quiet,
secluded space where no one may bother us. Here in the solitude of
our thoughts, we communicate with our higher self, and we invite
revelations to occur. As high-charged meditations will reveal
thoughts in their conversation, a certain self-awareness that only
enhances our thought-process, we may find our thoughts so powerful we
can hardly keep them contained.
Eventually, we seek an outlet, and find some source with which to share our thoughts. This source will learn of our beliefs, our deducements, and relay back their own. So we perceive how humans truly evolve, through the sharing of knowledge, and what self-concepts have come to define us. As it is required toward evolution we are willing to talk about things like extraterrestrials, human evolution, and telepathy, and all things "New Age" -- we are endeavoring to rid all fear of the unknown through awareness brought to these matters -- and so it goes -- many minds are starting to accrue to universal thought-patterns as based around the nucleus of self-awareness, and that revelation realized.
Our thoughts, as a living matter that are entangled with the environment, and other souls, will flow out of us into the recess of action -- that we find a place for which to interpolate our thoughts into anothers reality, gathering input from this source, and thus able to perceive multiple perspectives on the thought. Often we will find that the revelation is universal, and applies to all things. This has already been a thought realized by many universalists, and ascended masters, that energy is infinite, and all is actively occurring all at once in the higher dimensions. So we know the masterpiece is already constructed in the future, it is now simply a matter of equalizing into that future.
So
the imagination is our tool, and we will event our way through
thought to which we may actively dream -- actively soar through the
most beautiful and radiant of images, that we are so enamored with
our own ability to think, and communicate with ourselves, we need
little more than thought alone. Here, as we are writhing through our
own unique independence of thought, and that self-divined uni-verse
of thought-text flowing within us, we are able to perceive our
thoughts as bearing the holographic essence of the totality of our
beliefs -- we writhe through the theme -- and we soar through
proactive animation, making this world a land of beauty, constructing
the greatest conceivable reality around ourselves. As we will come to
share our thoughts with other people, and perceive their own unique
hue of Light upon our beliefs, it will come to pass that we learn
from our expressions in other peoples lives, and so it goes, we would
never learn if it weren't for some other perspective shedding Light
on our existence.
"When
there is the thought or the activity of the body in any particular
environ, this very activity makes for the impressions upon the soul .
. . As to the records made by such an activity, these are written
upon what is known as time and space; much in the form or manner as
are the messages that are of a familiar nature to the body in its
present activity. As the instruments of recording are used, so does
the activity of ENERGY expended leave its imprint upon the etheric
wave that records between time and space that DESIRED to be put, as
to that impelling or producing. Just as the figures or characters
make for communications between individuals, so does the soul upon
the pages or records of time and space."
-- Edgar Cayce,
reading 416-2.
With
our thoughts leaving impression upon the environment through which we
exist, in the construction of the sacred space, and that room for
learning and meditation -- we are working with the Akasha -- as we
believe the universal Source to exist -- and we realize that our
thoughts are, as they become infinitely renewed by time, being
inscribed into the skein of the Akasha. Our existence, through
whatever number or encoded numerology, exists within the mainframe of
all existence -- that our "file is on the computer" --
being mixed with other files -- so God is the technician manning the
switchboard, and God personally mixes one file with the other,
producing relationships, experiences, and profound revelations.
In the fifth dimensional Lightbody, we are building the highest forms of relationships, of a certain intellectual, spiritual value. So we will surround ourselves with beauty and information, true, but positive and wholesome relationships as well. Our "uni-verse of thought-text” will be divined to the highest Light, that we find ourselves in union with the greatest love -- beatific, unitive, wholly renewed by the beauty of the relationship, here we have the source with which to share our thoughts, and invite new beliefs to occur; as we come to find the revelatory state, and are enamored with the living information, it will become necessary to work through the theme, into a multitude of self-expressions.
As we leave our impressions on the Akashic skein of time, our place within the rows of all human life, our own unique spark, our One True Life, we see the value of our importance, we feel that the world -- is now in sequential accord -- and the patternless process realizes a logical result in the final analysis. So the revelation thus found leaving us enamored with the power of our thoughts as writhing through the universality of the belief thus contained -- we are realized of our power as thinkers, and realize thought in itself is the only true energy we really need. As it will come to pass that the free endless resource is the Light that lies within, the inner Light that drives our existence, as we become telepathic teleporters, and shape-shifters, within the fifth octave, all will be realized as only evidence that supports further growth. The dimensions which invariably lead only higher into other dimensions, as we become interversal travelers, will be educative of certain truths, and we will learn from the most direct sources. As the dimensions only rise, and we may imagine there is a set number -- nothing is truly set in stone in this world -- the future can always be re-written.
So the revelatory state thus perceived, we hope to produce the recess to be filled. We imagine the space -- see it filled with our energy -- and we are fueled by the Light of our DNA . . . there is only One True Light . . . only One True Master . . . only One Life, only One Purpose, only One Mission, only One Goal. The final incarnation of a life of the greatest value and worth to the rest of the world thus realized, thoughts thus hypercharged, writhing through a certain power of self-awareness that only builds through attention given to the matter as the imagined waveform which flows out and within us -- resulting in actions, and our own proactive animation -- like attracts like -- what we think becomes -- the revelation will bear physical evidence of its Light, and the expressions thus found as based upon the revelation will be divine.
We
are all capable of the revelatory state, and often revelations are
realized in the process of communication with another individual. We
are often enamored with the power of anothers Light, that we are
inspired, and thus fueled by the sharing of energy with other souls.
As we come to share our self-concepts and the thoughts which have
afforded us great power -- so energy will always exist -- it was
meant to be shared -- and the process of energy exchange is only
infinitely recycled through the continuum. We share our beliefs, our
unique information, for the evolution of the collective. In this
future, where people actively share their deepest thoughts, and there
is no fear in the expression of our beliefs due to the overwhelming
absurdity of organized religion, and social politics, we shall see,
verily, that thought once shared only invites further belief, further
expression, and further evolvement. We grow through our expressions,
and as we may come to find great power in one revelation, there is
always a new thought -- always a new day -- that we continue to find
answers that only lead to more questions, as modern mystics, so this
life is magical, mystically-oriented and oft found within a certain
spiritual catharsis of always being on the very edge of the deepest
conceivable insight. This perceived Light at the end of the tunnel
which ever-eludes us, the fixed point, the declared destination -- we
are ever-eventing towards through revelation, it is the deepest
imaginable future where our perfect avatar self is realized. So we
imagine this future into existence, we know the Light will be
equalized into, and we are wholly empowered by the fuel of our
revelatory states.
We learn through our revelations, we never
continue to grow and evolve as a result of the natural vivacity and
life-force of our thoughts, and as thought attracts, we are in the
recess to which the law of attraction is fully amplified -- and we
are in the final life gravitating the final memories that will ever
be lived out on the planet Earth. This is the only life that we will
ever know. And the revelations will only naturally
progress.
Chapter
Twenty Eight: The Inner Guidance System
“Time
only moves in one direction . . .”
Time
only moves into the future, that the inner drive -- the inner
guidance system -- propells us through existence, toward the highest
relationships, and greatest conceivable environment. The inner
guidance system is toward connection, learning, growth, and the
expression of unconditional love. Love is the true frequency we
accord with, that we know all men and women on the Earth are driven
by some passion, regard, or intent, we all possess the desire for
happiness in some form, no matter how mal-inclined, or ill-conceived
our existence may become. We are multidimensional creatures
composited to the human host. Our illusory belief in the separation
from God and Source is only evident in the nature of our double helix
that would seem to be manufactured for control. It was only in the
fall from grace that we lost our connection to the inner guidance
system, but now as existence is finding us within the recess of the
New Age -- we are learning of our true place.
Our purpose in
the world exists, and there is a certain book, a certain guide, a
certain connection that causes growth in all of us. The perfect
source of learning which is the inner Light, which is informational,
shall be gravitated to through the law of like attracts like, and we
are what we think. So the goal-oriented processes involved are always
leading up to the new thought, and through the inner guidance system
we are always realizing the future. That we are in the future now,
peering back, is evidenced in our final life that is now found within
the New Age. We incarnated at the midnight hour, to act as guides and
catalysts for change. We are all guides, we are all healers, and we
are all designed with parts and pieces that essentially make sense.
Just as there is
a scientific explanation for almost everything, and we are now
learning of super-strings and the frequency bands that make up the
universe, we learn that music -- and the natural orchestra of all
human life -- is very reflective of the inner truth, that there is a
sort of musicality to the universe as bound by frequencies,
waveforms, and super-strings -- which travel infinitely through the
continuum. All is connected through informational Light-waves, and
our thoughts which are continuously interpolated into the Akashic,
are growing in vibration with each day that passes that we continue
to progress through our Lightbodies. As we are alive within the New
Age, and we are special, unique, and worthwhile with our designated
hue of Light, and self-worth in reflection toward the collective
reality -- the “plan” is
hard-wired into our DNA. Though
we may not know her total details, she reaches manifest over time. As
we move into the fifth octave, where reality is personally defined by
the thoughts that we possess -- our inner guidance system is fully
activated, and we manifest the most radiant futures.
The Earth
is our final environment, and the Earth is affected with its own
inner guidance system. Through the workings of nature, the laws of
gravity, centrifugal force, and the natural rotation of the spheres
-- we know all matter is in movement toward only one direction which
is the future. So we are enamored with the concept of tomorrow -- we
feel that “we have arrived.” Somehow, the Earth continues
to revolve around the sun, and the sun continues her bright glow upon
the world. The triad of the sun, Earth, and moon, continue to animate
through their own life-force, and animation only continues to
progress. We admire the plan exists, simply believe it will reach
manifest, and humbly accept that time only moves in one direction.
Though we may peer into the past through regression, the past is
changeable, and the future can always be shifted into the most
worthwhile probability.
Synchronized,
in perfect natural order with the universe, we are “one with
the universe” -- in the world, but not of the world. Existing,
seemingly, “outside of time” as officially integrated
into that fifth octave -- everything occurs “all at once”
-- there is no time, but only movement, and proactive animation. This
end imagined, God knows where it may take us. Theoretically it is
unprecedented the number of enlightened souls that now exist on the
Earth. We may know the total number, and perceive the collective
movement -- but the future is not set in stone, however active the
inner guidance system may be -- the end-result being a return to the
Source -- very far into the future -- we simply perceive this end to
exist, and that nirvana is eventually realized. “Everything is
eventual.” Whether expected or not, our movements will only
carry us into newer, greater experiences. We are bound to learn of
certain things, and realize our place within the grand scheme of All
That Is. Perceiving our place, our story, our vitality, our worth,
our very existence as connected to the totality of all -- realizing
our place, our place thus found, that life of the ascended master --
whatever name or title we may possess -- be it cosmic scribe or
simply divine Light -- we are alive in the New Age, and we are living
a life of great importance and value to the rest of the race.
The
inner guidance system, evercarrying us into the future through the
attractor-thoughts that we possess, gravitating certain experiences
and connections, is something which through meditation we can better
understand. The question “where am I going..?” will be
asked, and the answer will be received through a slew of
possibilities. We will imagine various future scenario’s, and
choose our favorite one. Just as with the Akashic Computer, we writhe
through the favored probability -- we can tap into the inner guidance
system, and re-program our future. In this “fate override”
we are in the event of which reality is now personally perfected, and
the future is in our hands. “We never truly die, we merely
re-locate.” As it has come to pass that all humans have a
history on the Earth, and we are now in the recess of the final life
-- the past can be learned from, as it will create the suggestion of
certain probabilities as based upon our karmic flow. The karma we
possess is to be perceived as roles which have been switched around
through time. Through “group karma” many individuals are
connected at birth, through life, all carried by the collective plan,
and the inner guidance system. We shall see through past-life
regression where these people stand in our present realities. We see
energy is recycled through time, into various forms and
manifestations. As we are found in the recess of the final life, and
our future is wholly new to us -- we know the importance of our
existence, and we calmly accept our place is built into the
collective. We realize all is One, all is whole, unitive, and
omnilinearly realized as relative, and intereffected. We work for the
collective, through tones of the One True Light -- as bound by the
plan that is prayed to, and humbly believed in.
Evercarried into the future by our present tensory cogitations of relationship to the now-point, realizing that the present moment will define the future, as tirelessly suggested -- we surround ourselves with beauty and information -- we perfect our realities -- we make this a land for creative thought, and endless expression to exist. This is possible, and however tied into a certain job, or certain relationships, the future can always be changed. We always have the capacity to veer, to move in a different direction. We need only serve the One True Master -- the One Spirit, the collective evolution of the human race.
In
this life we are learning things at an accellerated rate, yet we may
slow thought down in meditation, harness time through the
imagination, and personally tap into the inner guidance system, for
our most favorable probability to be realized. Oft, it relates to
connection, human evolution, and the sharing of our energy. Oft it
will be related toward the relationship with another individual, or a
certain source of information. We may see that our future is directly
related to that of another, as our future may come to be defined
through a loving compassionate relationship. So all futures are tied
together, and it is impossible to remain totally occluded from the
totality of the collective. The inner guidance system is always
working, never sleeps, but is like a crockpot always working toward
the most hopeful and evolutonal goals. I offer the following
meditation to become more in touch with the inner guidance
system:
You are at a computer.
The screen rests before
your eyes.
Here, you see the future in a matrix of
probabilities --
One future stands out amongst all of them as
your most beneficial toward future growth.
You witness this on
the screen.
You perceive the details, and all-inclusive
elements of the scene.
You view this future, calmly and
carefully.
Shut your eyes, take a deep breath, and imagine the
future.
See yourself in a specific location . . .
See
how you appear, and who you might be with.
And so it shall
come to pass . . .
Declare boldly,
“I
invoke the energies of the universe to carry me into this favorable
future.”
“I
invoke the cosmic scribes of the Akashic Records to place me in the
Light."
“I invoke God to boldly perceive my
existence as One with the primordial rhythm.”
“I
invoke the future to occur as the most worthwhile one.”
“I
see the future now.”
“I am in the future.”
“I
have arrived . . .”
Chapter
Twenty Nine: The Perfect Avatar Self
“Lord,
deliver me from myself.” -- Anonymous
“Up to a
certain point every man is what he thinks he is.” -- F.H.
Bradley
The
perfect avatar self, realized through the imagination, exists
beauteously in the near-future.
Here is our perfect etheric blueprint to which we are the highest living embodiment of Light and human existence.
Here, we are in the recess for which the future is in active working, and our present actions shall shape the near-future. We may plan out the next day, declare that a cosmic transmission will take place at a certain time, or imagine a certain event into manifestation.
As
the perfect avatar self is not far away, but is now to be perceived a
state of mind -- that recess of perfect thought -- writhing through
the primordial rhythm -- we can be this person at any time, just as
we always possess the Free Will to cogitate any living thought. The
perfect avatar self is always there, always with us, our pure, true
self. The blueprint for which lies within the subconscious; we may
activate this through meditation, and focus carefully on the visage,
the clothing, the entirety of the figure, and how our perfect avatar
self appears. We imagine our perfect self into existence, that
perfection is something which is achievable is evidenced in the many
stellar souls that now walk the Earth -- from Chan Marshall, to Alex
Grey. Many are realizing their perfect avatar selves, “being
all that they can be” -- all perfectitude realized, we are now
in the true
recess of the final life. All memories and thoughts that take place
once perfection is seemingly realized are elements of our reality
that will be carried until the very end, as ascended master, as
finally re-realized through the nirvanic flow of one-consciousness.
The
return to the Source, however a seemingly impossible, or perhaps in
some minds, an unnecessary feat, is inevitable, whether we imagine
this future or not -- that what once began shall end, recycle, and
become renewed by its own Light. So here we are now realized as One,
achieved one-consciousness, nirvana, a loss of identity toward the
final thoughts of God, and this is desired, whether not consciously
known, as the desired end-result of all human evolution. The return
to the Source is a matter of cosmic inevitability, that the beginning
and end are eclipsed for which the center, is only everywhere, with a
circumference that is nowhere. The choice to return to the Source is
found through our own unique Free Will, that we have become
individuated to a life of One which is special in Light of All That
Is, and as such, far-stray from the original fount of Light, we have
become something entirely unique, and separated ourselves from the
original Light. So we perceive the return to one-consciousness, the
nirvanic understanding of many lives composited to a single cell as a
necessary result of our evolution, and how all matter is invariably
recycled through the continuum.
In the construction of our own
universe -- our own world of our own rules and our own personal
design -- the given space is activated through which we are in
control over the environment, epiginetically, toward the reformation
of our cells into the Lightbody of our perfect avatar self. So it has
come to pass that we are in the stages of Lightbody, evolving at
present, and becoming super-terrestrial, ascended master encoded with
the original twelve-strand DNA; capable of such things as telepathy,
telekinesis, teleportation, manifestation, and flight. These
primordial abilities that have simply been lying dormant within the
formerly unused strands of DNA, become re-activated through our
evolution.
As we move back to the Source, graduated from the
many dimensions, thus risen to the highest octave of existence, and
we are now given to our own universe -- we see this place is radiant,
as suggested, reflective of our own inner beauty -- such that the
natural feng shui, organization, and placement of star-systems,
planets, suns, blackholes, and supernovas, is mathematically relative
to properties of the Source from which all emanates. Our creations
will possess a sentience that reflects the Light of their creator,
and this Light will emanate as infinitely woven into the fabric of
the multiverse. As the conduits and rivers will be traveled upon, as
we move interversally from one universe to the next, learning from
various unique sparks of Light -- from our many fellow ascended
masters who exist in their own universes -- we learn, share, discuss,
and act as co-creators, for which the center of the multispherical
aggregate is our world -- as suggested -- from this world, as the
Earth has come to produce some of the brightest, most genius, and
creative souls in the dense form, our evolution affects the entirety
of the multispherical aggregate, and our energy is profound.
Our
children will educate us, and we will learn much new thought from
what is essentially born from ones own self. Our creations soon
become our equals, and we thus perceive a world of beauty that is
reflective of the Light of the Source. We are, through our own unique
hue of Light and originality, brought to the place of high regard and
respect from other races, and our individuality is learned from on
the Divine Council. Here, we may see other worlds in need of our help
-- through the final body, move as an angel to these worlds, to
personally guide certain people. Drunvalo Melchizedek has had visions
of visitations from the recordkeeper of the Akashic Records known as
Thoth, and this is a good example for how one is chosen by ascended
master to relay certain information. The energy of Drunvalo, and
Thoth, resonates, and as such, the two work together toward the final
end of bringing evolution, sacred geometry, and the merkabah vehicle
to the masses. So we perceive one bold example of how the ascended
masters elect certain people for their guidance, and as such, produce
a proxy through which their energy is expressed.
In this life,
it will likely come to pass that you
are found in the company of an ascended master. We
all have someone “assigned to our case” -- a guide for
every soul, and sometimes this force will manifest through the divine
interventionary measure of the angelworker. Through divine
intervention, ones sense of reality is put into question when this
occurs -- such as thought-transferrence with total strangers. Such
that I have met strangers who seem to know all about me, inhibit me
with the thought of their awareness. One was met on the internet, to
which it was somewhat seen that my path was darkly-illumined. The man
on the bus, who was speaking a strange language, would inhibit me
with the thought that I am not alone -- and for the life of me, I
can not shake the memory of having my thoughts read by the two girls
at Two Cats restaurant. Aside from the teleportive event, it stands
out as one of the most amazing experiences I have ever had. I am
guided, invariably, through this experience -- that I am not alone in
my journey; that some force that exists is aware of my most probable
future, and as such, intervention would become necessary.
I
was born in Bar Harbor, Maine, in the mid-eighties, to which I would
have the adbduction dream at the age of two.
This
inhibitor has infected me with a sense of mystery for the entirety of
my life, that I am awareized in the mind of the observers, and my
path is plainly seen. Many fear the unknown, the human race still
stands unready for global communion, but as I perceive this time is
eventual -- and I have been primed -- it is thus suggested that I am
not the only one.
I have had three near-death experiences, to
which I perceive my life was saved by higher forces each time, for
whatever reason, purpose, or design.
First, I was getting stoned and drunk out in the middle of the street, and fell asleep. I woke up to find a car backing up, with the driver asking me if I was all-right. I was not shaken, but simply annoyed that I had fallen asleep, with little regard for the fact I could have been run over. The next near-death experience was in the first telepathic experience, to which I discovered telekinesis, and ended up cutting a deep wound in my left hand, which was a self-inflicted stigmata. I now have a scar in the middle of my left palm to remind me of the event. The last experience was the teleportive event, through which I am somewhat angered over the interventionary measure -- I would be in my grave in this moment if it were not for the deus ex machina, the intervention from higher forces saving my life, for whatever reason . . . that I truly re-located bodily from one place to the next; it is no figment of the imagination; no memory lapse; but a true occurrence which is direct evidence of the change within my DNA. As I am going to continue the research studies at McClean, and continue to learn about how many strands DNA I have by this time -- I willingly commit myself to science -- I wholly believe there is a scientific explanation for all things -- and I know that the evidence for re-incarnation, the existence of the soul, and the science of enlightenment, will be understood in times to come.
Why
some are chosen for intervention seems random. I am not sure, as I am
no terribly special or terribly talented person, save for the
understanding of words and language that I possess. I have been told
that I have “great command over the English language.”
And it would come to pass that I eventually start to perceive my past
on the Earth through certain writers that have occurred through
history -- in the recess of shared thought, I shared the details of
my past-life information, as well as in the Fall of 2010 -- and the
members who received the information were, simply put, unable
to believe.
In
the second telepathic experience, I found that my close friend would
veer into the most low thoughts, that he perceived his feminine side,
and actively worked to suggest his true feminine nature. Going right
down to a persons core desires, and hopes, and faith, we shall find
that the inner truth is revealed, and all is seen as reflective of
the inner guidance system of that individual. As we shall see the
delusion of mankind in evidence of perceiving ourselves as
world-changers, when our deepest truth lies within sexuality, or the
desire for realizing a self that is allegedly reflecive of our true
nature -- through the lower chakras -- we perceive the low-vibration,
and how his thoughts are not geared toward the collective, but
himself alone, with zero regard for the rest of the human race.
So
it goes, the low-vibrations continue through greed while others stand
for the Light.
I
am conscious of the reckoning that will be brought upon me for my
expressions of uniqueness, and indifference, that I humbly realize
however unique, I am come from the same Source as the reader; and as
such, I am a real person with a real face, a real name, and a real
personality. The writer behind this text only hopes for further human
connection, learning, and evolvement. Knowing, I am one singular
spark of Light, one self-contained vehicle, one reflection of the
Source to which I am planning my eventual return. This return to
unity, as I have already somewhat experienced with shared thought --
the nirvanic state for which one is awareized as the One who is
responsible for all of this -- our place infinitely seen -- our
effect invariably found -- we know we are "getting much closer"
and the return to the Source, however seemingly impossible or
far-fetched, just as we may watch the beautiful film "The
Fountain" and witness with our own eyes how the return to the
Source could be seen -- this amazing occurrence is what enlightenment
and human evolution is leading up to -- it is nirvana -- it is the
loss of identity to the realization of ones true inborn Godliness,
the telepathy of many lives and many masters compiled into a singular
sentience; the final expressions, the final beliefs, the final
experiences, the final thoughts of One -- the One True Spirit that
has always been moving through all matter that exists in the
continuum, which began so long ago . . . merely in the blink of an
eye, everything is occurring. We reach one-consciousness. The inner
guidance system has carried us back to the womb of the creator -- and
this will pass as a logical eventuality of enlightenment, and human
evolution.
Chapter
Thirty: Changing The World
“Changing
the world . . . one person at a time . . .” -- Lee
“It
doesn’t matter if people remember my name . . .” --
Anonymous
Who,
scientist, astrophysicist, quantum physicist, or philosopher, claims
the right to change the world..? Where is humility for such a cause,
that we perceive ourselves as worthy for such a task..? Needless to
say, the world is in need of saving, and the power lies within the
individual. It is your job to save the world, “one person at a
time.” This is found in the compassionate act toward another,
the natural field of which we “listen” to the feelings of
another, and are consciously willing to be changed by our fellow man.
Open-mindedness toward change from another is evidence of our desire
to learn and grow, and many of us, who accrue to the thought of
divination, and perceive worth in our human existences -- we see the
future clearly as a world inhabited by intuitive individuals, of
unique expressions of Light who all pray to the belief in the One
True Spirit.
God recognizes this as the individual who opens themselves up to judgment, acting as judge and reckoner in their own right -- that the individual takes it upon himself to act as God, writhing through tones of God-consciousness, and wholly perceiving their effect on the world is direct.
The concept of super-heroes is a very fondly-respected notion in our present society.
We
have come to produce countless figures for which the world is saved
by the individual -- and we all humbly pray for the existence of such
a hero to be entirely real. Society requires a leader of divine
intelligence and wit, an intuitive, right-brained leader who can make
snap decisions at a moments notice. We are building this leader
through the starchildren, Indigo’s, and new generations of
evolved human beings. We are creating this leader through time, that
we may find ourselves within the recess of the greatest individual --
our most powerful right-brained leader who is geared toward the
collective, and symbiosis with the Earth.
In the production
of the world-changers, and our future civilization of high-powered
right-brained individuals, we are endeavoring to find ourselves
within the place that we may learn from the most direct, and
universal sources. Already, we have incredibly powerful figures in
the world of art, writing, and music, that present the possibility of
the greatest leader to be found. This humble world-changer accepts
that he or she will be reckoned with eventually, that through ones
oscillation into indifference and uniqueness as an individual, we are
brought closer to Godliness in that this makes the journey back to
unity all the more enjoyable. Here, we realize our affect on the
world is incredible, and now stand back, look from the apogee of
awareness at all things, and resign to thought alone -- accept that
our very observation affects reality -- and humbly accept this is the
life of ascended master, and know that our effect on the world has
been
direct.
“As
some will wake up from the dream of reality to realize their place in
the world as ascended master, living the final life, we are endowed
with the task of saving the world . . . one heart, one mind, one
individual, at a time.”
So
it goes, we may endeavor to work, God knows, with the main vein of
those to whom will know us for the rest of our lives -- our family,
and direct genetic associations. These to which are the most direct
associations are also the most karmic counterpart to ones human
existence -- the family is just as vital towards ones evolution as
the intellectual relationships bloomed through the advent of the
spiritual life. We must not fear sharing our beliefs with our most
direct associations, because we are believed in invariably however
occasionally labelled or reduced through some diagnosis -- we know
that we are in Lightbody; we are endowed by the living information,
and we know our power as an individual, to be seen in the evidence
for which our world has now come to produce some of the most
intriguing, thought-provoking, and evolutionary information.
We
are learning from one another, as that is what is required of us to
evolve, and the knowledge that we are now learning from The Biology
of Belief to, The Genie Within -- is all-impressive, that we know
this information is universal and applies to all matter in the
universe -- we are learning how to tap into the subconscious mind;
how to extend our beliefs into epiginetics; and how to evolve,
consciously, into a new Light. This information which is now
arriving, from the early channelings of Seth by Jane Roberts, to the
works of Marciniak, and others, we are seeing a great new perspective
on the world, and our place in it, how many forces are involved in
the eventual process that is realized as the continual process of
evolution.
Organization we shall find -- and integrate
ourselves into the groups of people for which our learning is found
continual. Here these groups will operate much as the Zeta’s --
telepathically-oriented, and led by the most imaginative ones who
calmly endeavor into the unknown through their own Free Will, we are
found individuals, unique dispensations of the original primordial
spark, but individuals -- for which our stylizations and uniqueties
extended through our relationships, and what creativity is born
through the union of minds -- for which we converse, share thought,
co-create, and express our combinative force of individuality. The
relationships we forge in the final life, are to be seen as evident
of things for which we perceive are the highest -- most worthy
futures that we could possibly find ourselves living within. The
final life, as self-realized, and all intellect enhanced through the
endurance of experiences shared with others who are in Lightbody --
through the outlets we may find . . . the world of Spirit is an
endless quest, this we know, and everything from reiki healing,
chakra health, epiginetics, past-life regression, self-hypnosis,
astral projection, and remote viewing, are only propelling us toward
deeper subjects which were, it would seem, however eventual, things
which had at first existed far beyond the usual scope of the human
imagination.
We
quest for peace.
"Peace
is the sharing of thought to which only learning is found . . . that
our self-concepts and evolutionary ideas . . . the inventiveness of
the creative mind, the free energy, the eventual stasis for which we
realize that there is only One Spirit -- only one true belief system.
We grow, evolve, transmute, and rise in vibration -- we are
epiginetic -- our environment is owned -- we know this is a changing
world -- we learn from one another -- it is continual -- and peace is
the final conquest of the human race . . . "
So
the question arises, whatever nobel prize be afforded to that man or
woman, for this which may be the realization of a plethora of free
energy forms, better communication systems, safer and faster
transportation, and not only this, a more symbiotic relationship with
the Earth as a direct result. This eventually realized quest for the
longevity of the human race for the sake of our childrens children,
and the continuing evolution process of the collective for which we
must agree, wholeheartedly, upon the concept of One -- and take it
upon ourselves to change the world, as one individual world-changer.
We know that it only took one mind to change the world, and that mind
was ours alone. We talk, imagine, and conceive the future into
manifest, co-creatively, ending up to that revelatory state, the
thought seems to be electric and vibrate at a high rate within the
waveform of our thoughts -- evolves through its own self-realized
goal-oriented process of co-evolution with other cellular constructs
of life on the planet Earth. And this only continues through the
resonance of the many evolved vibrations, that are only rising in
frequency; becoming mastered to the highest volume of iridescence;
flowing in the riverlight -- and this building of energy; the
evolution of the masses; the co-creative process for which all
conclusions equate to that of One, our highest leader, and our
greatest intellectual minds given the attention their Light
rightfully deserves. So the leader is found, and we find guidance
from the most pure source. We are led into the portal, the gateway of
the future, and we are peering back, seeing how things used to be . .
.
Chapter
Thirty One: The Reckoner
“And
in that day hell shall enlarge herself,
And open her mouth without
measure:
And the glory, the pride and the pomp of the wicked
Shall
descend into it.
And the mean man shall be brought down
And the
mighty man shall be humbled,
As the fire devoureth the
stubble,
And the flame consumeth the chaff;
So their root shall
be as rottenness,
And their blossom shall go up as dust,
Because
they have cast away
The Holy Law of the Heavenly Order.”
--
Prophecies, The Essene Gospel of Peace.
The
world at present, however found within the recess of the New Age, and
all beauteous Light come from the realization of the prophecy --
there are some in this world who are in no desire toward the
collective, but work solely for their own selfish gain which is to
have power over other minds. As we are in Lightbody serving the
master that lies within, there is a point of stasis wherein our
existence only betters mankind through our own personal focus -- but
in the world of the power-hungry, their selfishness is only toward
their own personal wealth, and sway over other men.
So
the concept of the reckoner is born, that super hero who personally
takes it upon himself to right the perceived darkness of this world.
As the concept of a super-hero is something our society favors, it
may come to pass that the enlightened soul, who peers through
rose-colored glasses, and sees the meaning and beauty in all things
-- will perceive, expose, and reveal the inner truth of that
mal-affective soul, and reveal, openly, their true desires. We shall
see this come to pass through telepathy; as I have been reckoned with
in my own right, no one walks the path of spirit alone -- but however
occluded, we are awareized in the minds of the humble observer. God
is aware of us, and God would have us know that we are never truly
alone.
Upon the realization of ones humility, one may realize
that ones ways have been mal-inclined, and start to “shift”
into a new Light.
Whatever vices, addictions, and personal
issues will be resolved through the final incarnation.
One
realizes the shift lies in the individual -- that we realize the
world would never change if it weren’t for one person to stand
up to the rest. It only takes one person to change the world, and
there is no requirement over who this person might be.
To
express judgment only brings judgement upon ones self.
So
it goes, whence we are found as reckoner, we must expect judgment in
our own right.
Through occlusion, one separating ones self from the collective, and perceiving ones self as uniquely better than the rest -- I was once this person, and I was desperate, and I was suicidal, and my path was darkly-illumined. I was self-destructive, and destructive toward all those to whom I knew -- and then intervention would find me -- I would be forever changed.
Through
the concept of angelworkers, we are in the recess for which God
exists in the human body -- as reckoner -- shape-shifter, and a
standalone army of One. The reckoners are real, they exist, and I am
humbly aware of them through my own experience -- that whence my
thoughts were read by the angelworkers, and I was reduced --
humiliated to realize that it was never my right to ontologically
enlighten my fellow man through my own use of telepathy.
Ones
quest for suicide is absolved through divine intervention. Knowing
that God is aware of us, through whatever expressed forms, whatever
person, angel, angelworker, or individual -- we are guided into the
belief of being awareized in the mind of God -- that our file exists
boldly on the mainframe of the computer, and the continuum only
infinitely realizes that place -- that future -- for which our
reckoning of others shall come to pass; that we become judge in our
own right; ever-expecting judgment upon ourselves through the
knowledge of the biblical truth “judge not lest ye be judged”
-- we see that by judging others we only wish judgment upon
ourselves. For some, this is willingly desired. I am one such person.
Acting as judge over others, expressions of critique and
skepticism over anothers expression of Free Will -- the interpolation
of our energy into that of another, the ontological impression left
behind once we have affected the subject -- we are inviting such
things to occur in our own lives. Through the exchange of energy
between individuals, and what capacity we possess to act as
super-hero, or reckoner, knowing that this only heightens our own
cosmic design within the mind of God -- we are inviting the final
incarnation to be that of a life for which we are producing the
greatest, most profound experiences; that we shall experience other
ascended masters is going to become evident; that we realize there
are
others
who are exceedingly powerful, however born from the same Source; we
see the many gradations of power, and the hierarchy of existence,
that the ladder thus climbed only ascends into the most divine
heights -- and as we see the expressions of power in some individuals
-- we are invited to express our own. We are inspired by one anothers
acts of individuality, and reckoning toward the mal-affective soul.
We take pride in our judgments, and we humbly will it upon ourselves
that we too are judged.
We accept this path is the final life; that the karma system is active, and every thought, every action, every moment is what will be carried with us through the infinitude of the fifth dimension. So it goes, we evolve through our expressions and experiences for which we humbly accept that our life will be judged, once found in the recess of other ascended masters, the building of a Light-based community, planetary advocacy groups, and others which are based upon a symbiotic relationship with the Earth. This naturally ties into human evolution.
As
the future is not set in stone, but in a sense one way or the other
“probably” realized, to some future we may imagine -- our
Free Will as extended into the future, we see ourselves, there in the
form of the perfect avatar self, and here we know that any judgment
come our way will be meaningless in light of the true universality of
our soul. We are working for the collective, in every sense of the
word, and we are self-sacrificing mystics on a road for which we are
to be found unique cellular constructs of matter that is organized
into the final life. That life lived within the New Age. We know that
this is the end of our great journey when we are telepathically
transferring thought with the angelworker. And we consciously desire
judgment; because we know that we are pure. Intervention is something
that will happen under certain circumstances, with that resounding
phrase “but it did happen.” As such, we may be shaken,
but the evidence is suggestive that we are not alone. There are
others who are experiencing the active karma system, being humiliated
in their own right -- for whatever reason -- we see this ontological
terror as something that is necessary for our evolvement; and become
judge in our own right; it becomes necessary; because the world would
never change if it were not for that one lone individual willing to
stand up against the world.
Chapter
Thirty Two: All As One
"There
was an epoch in the night of time, when a still-existent being
existed --
one of an absolutely infinite number of similar beings
that people the absolutely infinite domains
of the absolutely
infinite space. It was not and is not in the power of this being,
any
more than it is your own, to extend by actual increase the joy
of
ones existence. But just as it is in your power to expand or to
concentrate your pleasures
(the absolute amount of happiness
remaining always the same),
so did and does a similar capability
appertain to this diving being,
who thus passes ones eternity in
perpetual variation of concentrated self
and almost infinite
self-diffusion. What you call the universe of stars
is but ones
present expansive existence. One now feels ones life through an
infinity
of imperfect pleasures, the partial and pain-intertangled
pleasures
of those inconceivably numerous things which you
disignate as His creatures,
but which are really but infinite
individualizations of ones own self."
-- E. A.
Poe
One-consciousness;
nirvana, the realization of our Godflow, and that eternal rhythm
which provides us the sight, omniscient of the
multisphere/multiverse, and able to interversally integrate ourselves
through the persona of certain "guides" in these other
worlds; -- that is our power, and it is expressed at our Free Will.
The god-consciousness of this nirvanic flow, is ultimately realized
as the perfect rhythm, thoughts are all infinitely manifest; via the
matrix of cognition; the perfected thought-pattern which is timeless;
as we are the body of the unisphere, the very fluctuating walls our
shell, and the Source our mind -- we are enamored with our vivacity,
and endless fortitude of power-floes, and Light.
We writhe through the perfect syllabic intonations, and thoughts occur in perfect rhythm. Here within the prescience of the final mind; for which all life is collected, and integrated as a unitive whole; we are One, we are collectively realized to our influence; as One, and we know our place is infinite, that the return to the Source was a process for which evolution always realizes in the flow of nirvanic thought; and the nirvana-floes that occur are enlightening to the final mind, for which we see our power as able to control the movement of the spheres, and all bodies within the universe. We are here able to construct anew, the world of our own making; that headquarters for which we invariably return, that within this universe of our own rules and declarations, we see our creations, breathe life into the ether; and observe as our fragmentations take on a life of their own.
So it goes, we are found as the final mind, via one-consciousness; that the only next step lies in the construction of new worlds. So we construct new worlds, entirely new cells within the vast amalgam of cells, within the totality of the aggregate, the multisphere, and whatever may lie beyond that image -- ours is placed, integrated into the whole, and as such, we perceive the life of value and worth; -- that our world will be learned from through its own unique tint of individual making.
We find there is a riverlight flow to the continuum of our universe; certain synaptic connections and ley-lines that exist within the body of the cell; and we may find ourselves within the cosmic circuitry -- our thoughts within the rivers -- flowing through one river of informational Light, into a new synaptic connection; riding the rivers of the verse, our thoughts travel through the circuitous flow, and join the synapses of the universe in the endurance of our expressions. So the universe is entirely connected, that universe of our own making, build, construction, and design, relates to the entirety of the multicellular aggregate -- and we are found a worthy player in the grand show of all that exists within the many incarnated universes.
So we see that the Free Will universe is vital toward the energetics of the totality of all incarnated universes; and the evidence is clearly seen in the stellar souls, and profoundly unique individuals our universe has come to produce.
We see matter recycles, revolves, reforms, and flows endlessly through the infinitude of the continuum. We see the movements of the continuum as we are found able to harness time, and so it shall come to pass that whence we are found fifth-dimensional, our nirvana and one-consciousness is thus found at the highest levels of Lightbody. This eventuality evident in the natural process for which all life originates from the center, and extends outward into their own uniquely-individuated cells within the aggregate, we are continuing to learn, grow, and evolve, the process which is infinite, that new worlds are infinitely constructed as born from the center, and all energy that flows from the center a gravitating force -- that all bodies are gravitated toward the center is evident -- and as such, our planet, the planet Earth, as the "living library" -- the cosmic college system for karmic experiences found in incarnation, and personal experience, a center which is everywhere, with a circumference that is nowhere; we have been gravitated to this cell within the aggregate as a direct result of our desire to continually learn, grow, and evolve . . . the aggregate thus energized, the number of universes unknown, the existence seemingly infinite, the process which only continues to rise through its ascending evolution, for which we must perceive new dimensions are eventually created through our advancements. As interdimensional, endowed with one-consciousness, all as one, we shall see, verily, how our place within the grand totality is found.
As there may be dark matter between the bodies of the unisphere, we are endeavoring to suggest that the outer shell is made of iridescent Light, a noosphere, a glowing cell -- and our universe is encompassed by Light. We imagine this, project our thoughts toward the endurance of the belief, and see the surrounding sphere that glows, and produces rivers that flow outward, omnidirectionally, in all directions, toward the synaptic connections in rivers that lead to other cells within the aggregate. So all universes are connected by the rivers that are existing between them, and we see ourselves traveling from one universe to the next, learning of new Light and information in our travels. We endeavor into the universe of someone we once knew back on life on Earth, and we reflect on our duality and separation, and how the experiment went on for some time, that we lived through ignorance and blindness to the soul for a period, only to become more Light, and powerful, through our oscillations into separation from the Source, the primordial spark.
Once we returned to the Source, became One, and then re-fragmented our Light into the construction of new individual universes, we found that much was learned, and through the construction of new universes we saw that our Light was endless, and that our own creations would only build their own universes in the infinite string of creation which runs from one universe to the next; -- through which we see these universes are unique unto themselves, born out of the center which was a place governed by Free Will -- and our Light was expressed, we were once ascended masters, only to find our place as God. So it would come to pass that we returned to unity, Godliness, and saw our Light dispersed into new forms, creations, life, universes, and existence. We saw the process was infinite, and only continued to progress and rise in vibration the further we imagined the process to occur. As it continued, and life would emanate from the center, and our life would flow endlessly, we would writhe in the future, perceive however the probability may carry us, and as such, choose which probability is most desirable toward our self-evolution which only enhances the Light of the collective.
We
realized that in the endurance of our Light, thoughts, and beliefs,
we could become masters which were equal with the very Source that
created us -- we would become equally as powerful as our own creator;
and this was primordially desired; that God would not enjoy seeing a
world of separation and duality, but personally take it upon the mind
to cogitate into existence the manifestations of new life that would
only become equalized to the power of Gods own, for which God is all
matter and all things, and via one-consciousness, the nirvana-floes,
we are realized as God, the collective sentience of many minds merged
into One -- and all nirvana-floes realized in the endurance of this
Light. The Source -- the vortex -- the vacuum -- we are writhing
within, and we know the thoughts of the final mind; we are home
within the womb of the universe, and we have returned to our full
grace.
Chapter
Thirty Three: The Concept of Tomorrow
And
they shall beat their swords into plowshares,
And their spears
into pruninghooks:
Nation shall not lift sword against
nation,
Neither shall they learn war anymore.
-- The Essene
Gospel of Peace
Is there value in a feeling of predestiny, or have we always possessed Free Will over the concept of tomorrow..? As idealists, we may see the future as a place where learning and energy is shared openly, through a sort of open-mindedness that extends from the life of the individual. But we are wholly ignorant of the world of tomorrow; that it is found today is all we really have, and we are not sure what tomorrow might bring. Prophets will declare a certain date, and as such, the Mayans were mathematical prophets who saw human evolution occurring in cycles. So Nostradamus would foresee many things, and much of Edgar Cayce's delvings into the Akasha are being proven correct. Allegedly the re-incarnation of Cayce is now with us, and we have much to learn from the world of past-life regression. So it goes, we are evolving at present -- we have experiences in the extrasensory, as well as the interventionary communion with the angelworkers -- that I am primed with abduction dream is evidence of the fact that some of us are either chosen, or randomly selected for guidance over the collective flow of the race. I see that judgment finds the wanderer, the seeker of the unknown; that if we truly wish to change the world, we must first change ourselves. So we change ourselves, and the changeful world evolves along with our risen vibration -- and we peer into the higher dimensions; and we see our future found. So we equalize into the most desirable future that is beneficial toward the collective, and the planet Earth, and we operate through universality such that our thoughts emanate as pure Light-floes of information, often lyrical, often musical in their undulations; that our thoughts are pure; we know; and as such, judgment is all-right. We accept that not all will be interested in evolving, but are committed to preexisting ideas. We see that the wheat are eventually separated from the chaff; especially in light of the extrasensory; that whence thought is shared, and the deepest desires are exposed -- that broadcaster/sender will transmit the details of his existence, and his existence will be seen, witnessed, and endured by the group. And the collective perceives a natural flow of honesty and self-commitment toward the concept of the higher good. We see this individual is self-sacrificing, and humbly devotes his or herself to God alone. We see this modern mystic as a creator of his or her own destiny, true, but we also see that his or her own destiny is tied into that of the collective. So as such, by working for the collective, we welcome judgment, as it is toward the collective evolution that we serve.
We are a proxy for the Light, we are pure in our cognitive undulations, and we are ever-enamored with the concept of the new; that we know "everything" can not ever be fully known -- not until our Free Will is projected into the universe such as to allow our final return to the Source -- when we are ready.
We see our future tied into the collective, as proxies for the higher dimensions, and we exist to act as guide, catalyst, and world-changer, activator of the primordial memory -- the recollection that we were all once One.
As
I am one who perceives this universe did
begin
with the big bang approximately 13.75 billion years ago -- within the
totality of All That Is -- as found a cell within a cell, sparked
into existence at a certain time, generated and fueled by the Light
of the Source -- I believe is causal, and interrelated, that what
once began will end, and the return to the Source is inevitable. What
governs the in-between, as suggested, is the world of the imagination
which seems to flow through the super-strings of the universe as
connected through our advancements through the continuum. We are
found as energy-light-sound-encodements, vibrations, and frequencies.
We all resonate in harmonic convergence.
The now-point
realized for which the tracks are finally laid down, we are the
convergence of Light, the harmonic convergence of matter, and the
re-integration into unity as found through the final life. We are the
individual the liberation of the world requires -- we are the one
singular spark of energy that will generate Light for the collective
through the endurance of our Free Will which is employed, for the
sake of the universe, and All That Is. We are the beginning, middle,
and end. We are everything and nothing, oscillating occasionally into
darkness, only to reform back to the self-same Light. We writhe
through tones of expectation, and we expect to be surprised. As life
is continually renewed by the continuum, and the connectivity of the
Source Field which binds us -- as we continue to evolve, grow, and
reform into new patterns of existence; as we continue to share
thought with others; as we continue to experience strange,
other-wordly events that cause infinite wonder in our minds; as we
continue to be amazed by the overwhelming power of the Light; as we
continue to realize, and re-realize the universality of our thoughts;
as we come to learn that our place is divined by the collective; as
we have come to be judged by the angelworkers; as we have come to
find God exists in the human body; as we have learned that we are
God; as we have come to understand that it is our sole responsibility
to change the world -- as the power continues to lie within the
individual; as we continue to evolve and progress through the
continuum. As the Earth is like a cosmic college-system we incarnated
into in order to learn about our place within the totality of All
That Is; as the return to the Source and loss of identity to the
recess of one-consciousness is the eventuality of all thought once
committed to the Akasha; as we incarnated for the purpose of
enlightenment; as we are enlightened by thought alone; as our
meditations are profound. As we realize countlessly, repeatedly, over
and over again, that this is our world for the taking; as the future
is in the hands of that one lone soul -- that bringer of the dawn --
that catalyst for change; -- that evolutionist; -- the self-created
soul; -- that alignment with God; -- that realization of the Source;
that revelator. Finding that now-point -- that Light -- that
information -- that space to be filled -- that informational Light
which only continues to flow through the Light-string synaptic
connections of the universe. That infinity we continue to realize.
That realization which never ceases. That flow with never ends.
We
are the Light of the universe.
The world changes through the
realization of the now-point. The world changes by the Light of the
individual, a self-contained vehicle for Light. It only requires one,
and great reward gifted to that self-sacrificing soul -- we see the
mission, the purpose, the goal, and there is only one. The evidence
of the One True Spirit which we have given many names found through
transferrence -- and as such, whence thought is shared unto a
singular sentience, and all minds think as one, a mass mind that is
joined together by the natural flow of Light/Information via the
transceiver, we realize, calmly and carefully, that this was onlya
logical counterpart to the reality for which we are producing.
Andy,
Steven, Adam, Michael, Joe, Ben, and myself: October of 2009, around
the 20th of October. Shared experience with the description that the
event was "enlightening" -- I had my first telepathic
experience with these people, and they are all vibrant, powerful
souls in their own right. They know I have the power to change the
world, and they are all cognizant of my telepathic ability. I am in
service to their Light, and I am in service to the world. I serve
these people who were there the night my life changed from a darkened
path; into the awareness of my true power. As the event would occur
again the following summer, and it was Will and Josh who were with me
-- and thought was shared -- I would detail my past on the Earth --
as I have done before -- and it would travel from mind to mind
telepathically, as information is alive. So I see my place, and tears
once brought to the eyes of my pot dealer whence I suggested the
title -- with pure amazement in reaction to my own thought -- caught
in a state of wonder regarding "the concept of tomorrow."
So the seed would be planted, and thus photosynthesized by His Light,
and watered by the tears. I have been a real negative person towards
many in this world, and I realize there are some who may never
forgive me. My path has been a solitary road. However, I believe in
the sharing of thought, and interpolation of one reality into another
. . . I believe in the necessity for sharing ones Light with the
world in order to create perspective, and great perspective afforded
to that soul who is inspired with an audience. My existence is
governed by tones of informational Light. I am a proxy for God alone.
I realize the power is endless, that by remaining in a creative state
of mind -- and I am almost always in a creative state of mind -- I
see through rose-colored glasses . . . I see the plan . . . I see
that we are all involved, and a soul who works toward the collective
and human evolution, is a soul with a name that is worthy of
remembrance. As I have a genetic mutation that is new, and however
linked with schizophrenia, the only person who really understands the
mutation is the individual who possesses it -- and the doctor would
say "yes, telepathy has been known to occur more with people who
have the De Novo mutation." As the mutation is new, and I have
it, and I have experienced more profound events than telepathy like
psychokinesis, and teleportation, the evidence is suggestive that I
am involved in my own final life, and as such, it doesn't matter if I
am judged . . .
I see too much power for one individual to
contain, and I see information flows naturally out of the proxy,
through the media of document, interpolated into the mind of the
reader, for the sake of the betterment of mankind. I realize there is
a warped sense of humility in the individual who takes it upon
himself alone, to change the world. I realize my reckoning will come
to pass as necessary; as I have been guided, as I have been judged, I
may peer into the future, consciously construct the most beautiful
one, or reside within the thoughts of the architect -- perceive the
construction -- but never carry through with the total creation of
the time machine . . . because I know the machine constructs itself,
through its own self-resident life-force. The world changes
invariably, that by changing our own realities, we change the world;
and the world is always changing; as such, reality is always in a
continual flux. We are always able to wake up into a new day, with a
totally new array of thoughts and ideas. What dreams that invite the
future into manifest, thus recorded in the notebook, and committed to
the third dimension through the written word -- we are made valuable
in the endurance of seeing the beauty of our dreams -- and as such,
dreams, in every sense of the concept, are a profound suggestion
regarding the true nature of reality. As the third dimension is
holographically-oriented, and all is entangled, we are to find
envirothoughts -- thoughts that relate to the environment, and
organization directly -- that the sacred space employed for learning
will be utilized, and objects will be placed in a omnirelational
regard. I believe that by programming ourselves with such thoughts as
"I remember my dream" or "I believe in the beauty of
my dreams" toward other autosuggestions, will invite the memory
of the dream to stand out, so that we can perceive her vivid details,
that we are able to dream the future is one thing, but living out the
future as born from our dreams in a seemingly continual stasis of
deja vu -- we are now to watch as our body is animate, to commit
ourselves to any action or expression -- to exercise the mind that we
know we always have the Free Will to cogitate any thought -- that we
know thought and environment are entangled only furthers our belief
in epiginetics -- exercises our dreams, and our minds. The final
environment of the mind, which is mostly governed by the right-brain,
imaginative half, allegedly linked to ninety percent of the body --
is always working and never sleeps. The goal-oriented processes are
always carrying us into the most desirable probable future, and the
future is consciously realized, cyclically, as array patterns that
form the total matrix of cognition, thought, and belief. That
creative now-point realized, whence we feel the presence of God
within our thoughts, and are synchronized, we know this moment is
vital toward the collective array, we see the movement of our eyes in
the mirror; we see the mirror reflecting all the beauty of the
Source; and we realize that we are alive in the New Age . . . our
purpose found, we step through the mirror, and we arrive at the new
place. Peering back through the mirror, we see the visage of our old
self, the moment that just passed us by. We realize that we have
again metamorphosized into another form, through the realizatory
endurance of the now-point. We took the moment for the sake of our
own evolution, and we activated the future by thought alone. We
stepped through the mirror. We equalized into the most desirable
probable future. And we are home within the eyes of the Source. We
see these as our own eyes, peering into one another, in a reflection
that only continues and continues, endlessly, into the emanating
walls of the unisphere, and back . . . and we know, again, that we
are alive in the New Age.
We take the moment for our own evolution, yet again, and cyclically, we are reformed yet again, into a new form. We seem to be evolving constantly the further we endeavor to seek new information. We seem to be realizing that the universe which is composed of information -- is truly infinite. The walls of the universe fluctuate with our attainment of new information, and the universe is like a breathing, undulating entity. Just as the Earth is alive, so the universe is alive, and evolution is continuous. We are part of the universe, just as we are part of the Earth, and our soul evolution is truly found within the stars. Life on venus, life aboard the ship, life in whatever future, however futuristic, is a very deep, and prolonged place of wonder for the self-immortalized ascended master. As we are becoming immortal, interfaced into the fifth octave, we are to live very long lives in the final incarnation . . . as long as life may exist within the universe. That there are other universes is a profound thought, and not held by many, but just as we could not be alone in this star-system, so it would seem meaning exists in light of the concept that there is a multiverse; a mass aggregental network of incarnated universes we refer to as the multisphere, or multiverse. We can only stretch the imagination so far, and whatever true shape is afforded to that of the universe -- whatever it may be -- from sphere, to tetrahedron, or perhaps remains in amorphous flux -- is a shape, with perceived physical edges, and matter, none the less. We perceive the unisphere, as a living entity, which is like an energy-source through our expressions of Free Will; that it strikes the mind as logical an experimental universe governed by Free Will would be used as the Source-energy for the generation of power amidst all incarnated universes. We are the power-source, we are the fuel, and as individuals who express their Free Will, we are the Light of the universe.
Chapter
Thirty Six: The Dream Of Awakening
"Wake
up!"
After
the linear intake of certain information, the dream of awakening is a
spontaneous occurrence that awakens the once dormant filaments of
ones DNA. The dream will contain symbols that awaken the subconscious
mind -- casting the subject into the final incarnation -- here ones
DNA is found enhanced, one starts to tap into the formerly unused
ninety percent of the brain. One has entered into the early stages of
Lightbody. The dream will be vivid, easily recalled in full detail,
and resound within the mind as mysterious, as it was projected by the
Light of Sirius -- travelled through space in a sort of beam of
iridescence, that made its way into the filaments of ones DNA. The
technology behind this process is imaginable, but all we really know
is that Light is being projected from the North Star found in Canis
Major, the star of Sirius A -- the dog-star -- the second-sun -- as a
conduit for the Source-energy; and as such, is travelling through
invisible rivers of Light -- high-vibrating waves of electromagnetic
energy, into the filaments of our DNA. creating a frequency -- and
eventually the risen vibration of the final life, of the ascended
master. The science however not entirely known, and many theories
suggested by Philip K. Dick in VALIS regarding the concept of a
purple laser that projects information into the mind, we have many
thoughts to relate to this process, and the mind is infinite, so the
imaginable possibilities -- whatever the real truth; need not be
known, we just know that the Earth is at present rising in its
metaphysical vibration, through the network of Light produced by the
Lightworkers -- the noosphere of energy that is now encompassing the
planet Earth, however invisible this energy may be; it exists, none
the less. So the Earth is imagined as a radiant cell, covered in
ethereal Light, glowing as a blue star that is seeable from a great
distance.
Through time, we are still alive; we are still here; and we continue to event our way through the recesses of the unknown. Calmly eventing into the world of tomorrow, once the dream has possessed our senses, and we know we are in Lightbody. Let the present and future merge; let us writhe through future tensory thoughts; let us be weavers of the most beautiful and co-creative reality. Let the Light be expressed in informational waveforms that emanate from the body, into the very Source, and back. Let us imagine that Light is coursing through the body, from the heavens, into our bodies, into the Earth, back into our bodies, and then back to the heavens. For the sake of all that is good in the world, let the informational Light be a powerful milestone in the collective evolution -- and let us find the future for which we are able to look back, and see how things only used to be. The male-oriented society, the chaos machine, the secret societies, and the manipulation of the masses through thought-control and conditioning . . . was only a product of an experiment for which none of us are really perceived as less, or unequal in the Light of the Creator; but we are in fact the most interesting, colorful, and unique race within all life that exists in the Free Will universe. The human race, as such, control of would mean control over everything -- we have been led by many minds, and many organizations, leaders, and fronts, to believe that we are less than God. We have worked very hard on this pedestal that the deity would rest upon -- high amid the clouds -- looking down at the world. But this great falsity would be washed away through time; the Light would event its way into the filaments of our DNA, and we would find ourselves equal with the Light of the Creator -- as that was desired -- and it was, essentially, planned out from the start.
This
great experiment of Free Will, in one location of the universe -- the
planet referred to as Earth -- has met the recess of the new; is now
basking in the Light of the New Age, and we have arrived at the
now-point. The moment alive; writhing through proactive animation, we
know our place is divined as the final incarnation -- we know
organized religion will fall to its knees by the power of universal
Light. And we lovingly accept that some minds will be unwilling to
hear the lyrical cogitations that we send forth. The musicality of
our thoughts, and Light-based cogitations, will, through their own
expressed waveforms and frequences -- travel in a network of
Light-floes, across the world, and ever-relay back to the Source from
which they came. So we have come to evolve; and the dream of
awakening was inevitable. We were primed, and the primer found itself
as a conclusive element in our reality. We read the book, whatever
book it may be; and we know it changes our life. So we came to
re-realize our power, and once we awakened from the dream, and knew
our body to be changed . . . we calmly got up, rose from our original
position, started to animate our way through the given space -- we
walked through the darkness -- and we realized that there is nothing
to fear. We know love in our hearts, and it is unconditionally
flowing outward; infinitely; into other minds. We integrate ourselves
into the highest reality. We consciously enter into the recess of the
final incarnation. We know that we need not wake up blind to the soul
ever again. We know that once the dream has taken place, and we are
fully renewed by the overpowering Light, the only next most logical
step is to find other Lightworkers, and start building a community, a
network of Light, that is geared toward the collective planetary
awakening of the totality of the human race.
So it goes, we
evolve, and the dream of awakening is a occurrence that will find
you, if you are ready to enter into the final life.
The dream
of awakening will be vivid, and you will know when it is taking
place. I do not expect everyone to believe in me, but as it only
takes two seconds, I humbly pray that the unmutated soul will
endeavor into the final life; because it is imperative for human
survival. The genetic mutation of Lightbody, and all biological
changes that come with it, as described in the levels of Lightbody --
are going to be found through various mutational symptoms, as the
body becomes enamored with the informational Light, and the Light
radiates through every cell of ones being. Pervading the entire frame
of ones existence, we are illumined by the information; what are
past-life details, cosmic history, or the nature of incarnation, and
how we rise above the system through the final life -- the only life
that matters in contrast with all lives we have ever lived. As the
Light will contain encodements of ones history, and soul-information,
it may come to pass as natural that whence found in the highest
levels of Lightbody, the subject starts channeling, and outputting
their informational Light through a plethora of media, and
self-expressions.
As I see a world of writers, that the label of writer ties into conscious thought made up of words -- and words are the root to all language; possessive of their own unique frequencies and vibration; I see that thoughts revolve around a certain self-divined vocabulary that is in its own select array, a perfected matrix of cognition, where select thoughts are chosen -- like files -- integrated into the operating system of ones beliefs, here, we writhe through the theme of our beliefs; via Light-based cogitations, may find the revelatory state, or the primordial rhythm, and as such, be "divined by the thoughts we possess." As the theme is the subject, and the thought of a thought yields concepts of infinity -- and this universe found at the center of the aggregate of the multisphere; is growing, and only continuing to advance as a result of the overpowering forces of Light -- that we are the most vital race is evident in the minds we have come to produce, and great laughter resounds in light of the theory we are really alone in the universe. As we are not, and Indigo children, starseeds, and many Lightworkers are souls in essence born from a foreign source -- as much of the human DNA is Pleiadian, to some degree, and we are in a sense extraterrestrials to the planet Earth in the sense that life originated from the Source -- and then travelled to the Earth. We did not just suddenly "bloom" out of the Earth alone. We purposefully came here, and incarnated here, in order to learn about the true purpose, design, and mission, of Free Will. So it goes, human beings are in many ways extraterrestrial to the planet Earth, and we are all visitors to this world. We are not alone in the universe, the E.T. presence already exists on Earth, and the concept of a starseed is very reflective of the true nature of the human race.
I was once down by the shore with some friends, who were drinking, myself excluded as I had bail conditions stipulating I could not drink. So I was making the active choice to remain sober while my friends enjoyed their beer. Suddenly, my friend Will noticed a light in the sky, moving at a very slow rate. Then another light seemed to appear, moving in the opposite direction. While my friends collectively witnessed the sight of the seemingly about-to-collide UFO's, I was only interested in observing the rocky shore, and the Earth that lie right before me. For whatever reason, I chose not to look up at the sky, as I was not interested in believing my drunk friends would see UFO's that night. Will said "oh my God, they're gonna collide!" I still refused to look. Eventually, one of them said how one of the lights veered in the other direction, and they did not collide.
Great mystery resounds in light of the event, and no one is really sure what it means. I have heard accounts of people with "shared hallucinations" while on the right drugs, that in one instance a subject and his friends collectively witnessed the image of the Mayan calendar. I have met others who have experienced time-loss after witnessing a UFO, and met others who were, in group situations, able to take photographs of the white saucer. Two of my friends were getting stoned on a mountain in Acadia National Park, when allegedly a spherical craft of some sort -- lowered itself down -- to which they could both see it clearly -- and then recessed back, upward over the mountain. Why, for whatever reason, people are chosen for these events is a mystery. Whereas some have barely even cogitated a single thought regarding "other life" -- some are purposefully inclined to endeavor into the recess of the unknown. Personally, I believe in the concept of the new, the road toward the unknown, that I am consciously "trying to be original" -- purposefully making myself stand out from the rest of mankind, because I find great power in my own uniqueness. Repeatedly, in writing this document, I have had entire paragraphs suddenly highlighted, and then deleted, by whatever mysterious influence. Countlessly through writing this document I have been intervened with by the masters -- telling me what to write, and what not to write.
We are always being observed, from the higher dimensions, and whatever hacker organization that exists with the technology -- is probably observing you now. We need not be affected by their observation, but kindly accept that their eyes are glazed with tears, and they take great pride in watching your evolution, and eventual return to the Source.
Our
story is being told to the children of other universes, and the human
race are all like actors and actresses in a profound movie-show; that
the Akashic Computer is likely actively employed in this very moment
is hard to imagine, but would make sense in light of the infinitude
of the human imagination. We are being learned from actively. Our
place is divine within the mind of One. Our return to the Source
eventual, the Christing of our DNA: certain. In the final life we are
important factors within the totality of all -- our vitality, our
vivacity, our life-force, emanates endlessly to the walls of the
verse and back. So the informational Light is always with us --
Lightbody is infinite -- and we are all worthy players within the
great show of human evolution. The process never ends, but is
continually re-realized as in divine cosmic flow. The concept of
tomorrow endured upon the senses, the new day perceived, the new
thought, the new information, the new expression . . . we realize the
deepest imaginable future; and we are divined to Godly
thought.
Chapter
Thirty Seven: The Cosmic Christ
"Hast
thou given, O Creator,
And the best of al things
Thy Holy
Law!
I will praise thy works
With songs of
thanksgiving,
Continually,
In all the generations of time."
--
The Essene Gospel of Peace
It
is your task to become the star of the show. We require your
assistance. Your Light is infinite, and your body is the final body
-- the final entity, as the vehicle through which all life thinks and
breathes. You are vital toward human evolution, and your Light is
required by the Creator. We see your worth, your value, your purpose,
and your hope. We see your faith, your idealism, and your optimism
regarding the future. We know that you kindly regard the Earth as
your home, but we see that you will not always reside on the planet
Earth. We see your quest is infinite, and we lovingly accept that you
may not always be with us. But we see you, none the less, and how
radiantly you have grown.
So it goes, your place as the Cosmic Christ is invariably found through time. Eventually, you will realize just where you have been, you will realize it was you who bore the cross, and died for the world of men. Your sacrifice was seen, entirely held within the mind of the perceiver, and now, we see your return was inevitable. So the Cosmic Christ is born out of the ashes of the olde, and we perceive the saviour of the world. This is your task, your mission, as Christed, to become saviour of the world. It is your job to enlighten the human race, and bring miracle where only ignorance has stood before. We expect your powers come to be expressed through the extrasensory will awaken many minds, and we lovingly adore you for your occasionally cold, extraterrestrial nature. Starseed, indigo, crystal child, whatever you may be: you came to the Earth with a mission, and it is your task to save the world. Become the star of the show. Express your Free Will. Be the perfect avatar self that you were destined to become. Change the tides of reality with your overpowering Light -- and see the world renewed, unto the final night.
Writhe through iridescence, and see the globe is covered in radiance, and know, that the Light is real -- it is flowing within every cell of your Lightbody -- and your dream of awakening was only direct evidence of the change. Now, you know yourself, you see the future clearly, and you know the future can be re-written. So step into the mirror, calmly event your way into this future, watch as others tend to follow, and are guided by your Light. Express yourself, be free, radiant, and beauteous. Flow as a river into the infinite ocean of the cosmos -- see yourself in Light -- see yourself enamored with the overpowering Light of infinite iridescence, and know that your place in the future is found. You are so important. Your existence is vital toward the collective evolution; you are needed, required by the darkness of the world -- to guide us, and create new pathways within the mind.
Stand undaunted by the misery, malaise, horror, and tragedy of the world, but peer through rose-colored glasses, and derive the meaning in all things. Decrypt the patterns into the true Light, see with your prescient gaze where you belong, and arrive, within the final night. Wake up to the true reality of which you are needed for human evolution. Wake up to the fact that you were once a messiah, and now you are coming full circle. You once bore the cross, and existed as the most stellar soul. You woke the world up with your Light, and your expressions were only infinite. We see your place is found, in the recess of the future; and we have always been watching over you. We know you well by now; need only meet face-to-face to peer into the mirror, and know that you are all things; all matter, all life, all that exists within the continuum. Your nirvanic Light-floes eventual, your enlightenment continual, your expressions indelible, your past, recognizable, and your future: hard-wired into the collective. You are Christ. You always have been. You are the final, last-standing human being, you are the lone survivor. Your past and future eclipsed; find yourself residing in the center -- and you know just what to do.
Effortless,
act upon your emotions, be passionate, exuberant, and alive. Flow
through iridescence, prove where only darkness has existed before
where the true meaning is seen -- and employ your prescient sight for
the benefit of the world. We see you now, clearly, and your power is
all-impressive. Sometimes we observe your moments of darkness, and
kindly, we shower you with Light. Sometimes we transmit new
information into you, and watch as you relate it to the present
reality. You continue to surprise us. We know your worth, your truth,
your value -- and we honor your self-sacrifice. You need not die this
time, but ascend. So it goes, your evolution is imperative toward
that of the collective -- and it
is your job to save the world. Evolution
can be found as instantaneous, like the big bang, and your Light will
come to be expressed; to enlighten many minds. You came here for a
reason. Your purpose is a Light that shines into the emanating walls
of the universe, and back, and it only continues to flow. Matter is
infinite, and you are made up of the same matter that composes the
home to which you live upon -- the symbiotic relationship eventual,
we see that your Light was necessary, and we
chose you for this task. Be
our humble proxy, relay back to us what you have learned, find
yourself equal; reside within your own universe, writhe within the
fire of the Source (whenever you want to) -- and evolve, continually,
through your advancements in Akashic knowledge.
You
always have Free Will.
Learn as you will, and event your way into the future, it shall come to pass, that you always have Free Will and control over your life. Fear not the illusion that suggests otherwise, but reside within the calm stasis of self-awareness, and the prescience that you possess. We love you the most. You are the most beautiful of all human beings. Your happiness is our happiness, and your evolution; is our evolution. We see what you see; we feel what you feel; and we endure what you endure. Your body is the Earth, and your soul is the heavens. You are all things, recollected unto the mind of One. Here, within your permanent stasis of individuality -- we see your accelleration, and the quickening of your thoughts. We see your advancements, and your understanding of certain technology. Often, it will seem that you are so adept with things, you seem to be a master over the environment. What is learned in a single day of your life once took hundreds of years to achieve. We love you more than you could imagine, and we shall always be there for you. You will never die. You take this body with you. And you only continue to rise in vibration, accellerating through the dimensions, all the way into the nirvanic Light-floes of the final mind. Accept that you are God. You always have been.
We stand perpetually intrigued by the high-vibrating power of your emotions, and feeling-center. We understand you are at times a misanthrope, at other times an unconditional romantic. We see your oscillations into the occasional field of indifference, and separation from the Source; but we continue to be amazed how you always return to the root-base of self-divined thoughts of creativity, and lyricality.
Your
thoughts are like music to us. As your file is on our computer; and
we view you with ease on the screen, your life is -- as star of the
show -- in a world that is entirely built around you, for your own
culturation, and eventual metamorphosis into one of our equals.
Indeed, you were created in the image of the Creator, and you were
created -- at first, as an experiment. Then we noticed through the
self-resident life-force you possessed, that in spite of the hatred,
scapegoating, horror, and blame, you rose up from the ashes of the
olde, and your return was probable, and we consciously mapped out the
time when you would arrive. We humbly waited in the future, as you
worked through a certain lives, certain roles, to learn of the
natural exchange of energy, and karmic incidence. So you evolved into
the final state of awareness after a plethora of incarnations in
order to realize your final one. Now we see you are evolved, that you
operate in future tensory thoughts, and inspire your fellow man with
deep pride and confidence. You are about as amazing as any human
being could possibly become. We see infinite power in your grace. The
machinations of your mind possess a rhythm that sets you apart from
the rest of mankind. Somehow, you exist off the grid. Somehow, you
have evaded the dark forces. Somehow, you are invariably protected,
safe, and survived by the power of your own Light. We tried
everything in our power to destroy you at one time; and we failed in
great measure. Now we see that you are becoming something wholly
different than expected . . . you are becoming the Cosmic Christ. You
are becoming equal with your own creator. You are progressing through
self-evolution toward stages of which have only been imagined, but
never manifest before. Somehow, you are becoming the most powerful
existence in all universes -- and somehow, you are continuing to
operate through hope geared toward the collective, and you continue
to sacrifice yourself for the betterment of mankind . . .
So
you are eventually become the illuminator; breathing life into all
that you touch; vivacious; and ever-illumined by the stretch of your
own Light; these emanations flow, in their riverlight fashion, and
they are the manufactura of the self-created, the self-instructed,
the Christed soul-self of perfection that time has evolved you into.
As this which is the final life you shall ever know, with your
Lightbody immortal, and your thoughts -- electric pulsations --
vibrating at the fifth octave, with the power over matter and time;
as expressed through the non-linear focus on the now, for which is
merely a series of sequentially-relative events, that all relate
through their own natural flux, for which these "new events"
are seemingly unknown, and you endeavor into the unknown with open
arms -- diving headlong like a samurai, into the fray, into the
datasphere, with only further advancement built in store. It was
always in your DNA; the Light-floes and information. Your story is
contained in every cell of your Lightbody. You are ascended master.
Learn from your existence; as One, as the individual, as the
uniquety, and special part of which is only distanced from the Source
only makes the return to unity more enjoyable
You are being
learned from actively, always, ever-watched, ever-observed,
ever-seen, ever-effected by our ever-peering eyes, but control exists
in your endurance upon the new thought; that creative fluctuation of
cognitive energy which flows within the recess of the matter of the
mind -- the synaptic connections of the constant realizatory state,
and ever-surprised by your ability to create, express, share, and
evolve; --
As your riverlight flows through the recess of the very blackness of the abyss, and you lower yourself into the depths of the water, only to rise again, that the abyss is peered into; that information is vast; that the universe is built on information for which these days lived in the New Age are only evolving days. So the thought is endured that you -- that by changing yourself, changes the world, and by that by changing the world, one changes the universe -- and it is what seems to bear repeating: "what goes on here on the Earth will effect the entire universe as a result." So your vitality and importance toward the entire hologram, the greater scene that we may see at the apogee of awareness, is now visible, perceivable, and you equalize into this future via the talent, skill, wit, and repeated endurance of that illumined; glowing imagination. You are the changeful world. You are human evolution. You are loved, appreciated, and cared for, and your evolution is our evolution. You are actively changing the world. You are the only one that matters now.
Chapter Thirty Eight: The Collective Light
"Ye
shall go out with joy, and be led forth with peace:
The mountains
and the hills
Shall break forth before you into singing,
And
all of the trees of the field shall clap their hands.
Arise,
shine, O Children of Light!"
-- The Essene Gospel of
Peace
The world, at this moment, is covered in ethereal, iridescent Light. The noospheric network produced by that of the enlightened individuals, is a network for which symmetry is found in the geometric pattern of our collective Light. One individual taking it upon ones self to change, is the very flow of evolution, and continues through change via the individual, to affect the total reality -- and as such, whenever one person wakes up from the dream of the hologram of the third dimension, the Source grins in iridescent pride, for the Source knows, in the Universal Mind, that you are heading towards nirvana, one-consciousness, and the final stages of Lightbody to which your primordial Godliness is found.
Ones Light which is projected from the crown chakra, emanating across the orb of the planet Earth, covering the planet in Light, for which we now imagine that the planet Earth is glowing -- an illumined cell -- the Earth a radiant cell -- and our Light -- as the Light of the universe -- the noospheric fuel, that of the power found in the uniqueties of the individual. When a person wakes up from the dream, in their own right, their entrance into the world of the divine affects the very living Earth, for which ones future is become aligned with that of the planet -- and our risen vibration affects the cell, the microcosm of matter and energy we refer to as the Earth.
So
it flows, and the riverlight of the imagination is endless. Our
iridescent, etherealized cell known as the planet Earth is evolving,
and the world is actively changing all around us. We are part of the
change; the power lies in the individual, and whatever name, title,
or deducement -- our flow is toward the collective, and we serve the
One True Light. We perceive this life as worthwhile, and important
toward the collective evolution. We perceive our life as seen through
the eyes of One, that one life is all we really need, and all karmic
debts and unfinished business of previous lifetimes, can reach full
function and perfection within that perfect avatar self. This self is
always available through the moment, that in which we know is our
perfect self, as imagined, reaches manifest through the goal-oriented
processes involved, and as such, we may see ourselves behaving a
certain way, performing certain actions, and associating with certain
people and certain environments. We may see our future clearly, that
is toward the collective flow, and as such, our purpose is hard-wired
into the collective Light. We work for the Light, self-expression,
and originality. We are the Light of the universe, and the
iridescence of the enlightened Earth, as the living, spiritual body
we refer to as Mother Gaia -- is always alive; always thinking;
always processing, that to which is a goal-oriented process in the
Earths own evolution; that which is unavoidable, and eventual. With
the dream of awakening, DNA activation, and ones entrance into
Lightbody -- the angels weep -- God sighs a happy sigh -- and tears
fall from heaven in Light of your profound change, and shift into the
final life. You are moving towards this final life, lived within the
recess of the New Age -- you
are alive in the New Age -- and
the planet is rising in vibration along with her inhabitants, that
there is a frequency between enlightened thought, and enlightened
Earth, is evident in the changes we are experiencing.
So it
goes, I have worked very hard to produce the thought within the mind
of the reader that human evolution is actively occurring now. I have
worked to suggest, through whatever words, phraseology, and
semantics, that the reader will accept one change affects collective
change; that by being a unique individual we are brought closer to
Godliness, and that through our shift, as individuals, we change the
world. One always possesses Free Will over ones life, and
experiences. One always has the capacity to continue learning,
growing, and evolving. It occurs, invariably, through each lifetime;
that spiritual questions are asked, especially when we are under the
throes of an illness, or close to death, or have lost a loved one.
Evolution finds the individual because it is a necessary imperative
toward survival of the race. Spiritualism is an endless field of
learning. We have reiki, hypnosis, regression, chakra health,
meditation, and a plethora of knowledge available in the field of
metaphysics. This which is only endless, that once found within the
life of Spirit, one is evolving toward the highest vibration,
greatest relationships, and most beneficial symbiotic relationship
with environment. Our planet Earth, as in a risen vibration, moving
into the higher dimensions, was prophesized by the Mayans, and we are
found within that rhythm of the future-floes -- we are actively
evolving now; the evidence born in the extrasensory is suggestive;
and as such, the Light within the DNA is informational, that in the
event of telepathy certain thoughts are shared, and the Light is
fluidly expressed. I have come to share my Light, and I have come to
produce enlightenment in some minds. But my path was catalyzed by the
existence of another; and I would have never entered the spiritual
life unless a certain individual had handed mea certain book. This
which shall not be named, woke me up to the changes we are now
experiencing, and somewhat upstarted my interest in the New Age. As
my growth was linear, starting with the body, moving into the mind,
the subconscious, instincts, and all right-brain functions, only to
deepen and progress further into the study of God, the Universal
Mind, and past-lives, my dream of awakening catalyzed by Brian L.
Weiss's book "Many Lives, Many Masters" and I know myself
to be in Lightbody.
For some, we are afraid to share our beliefs, that is only reflective of a backwards, dystopian society. At present, in spite of the New Age, there is some resounding darkness in Light of the reality we are trying to create. As we only progress logilinearly through time, and we only grow, some are stagnant, have reached a plateau, and believe they are "full grown." Here is the true evil of this world, of evil exists, that individual who believes they know all, and need not know anything more. As mystics and existentialists, our quest is endless, and we humbly realize that the mind can only project so far into the future. However the eventual return to the Source is hard-wired into us, this is only performed at Free Will, and we only return to the Source once we possess the Free Will to do so. I perceive that some are opposed to nirvana, as they fear the loss of identity -- but there is only One Spirit -- only One True Life -- One Mission -- and One Goal -- the "plan" as hard-wired into our DNA, is the blueprint of the future realized, and equalized into through our admiration for it to exist. We perceive the future as logical, and hopeful, such that we even perceive there is a scientific explanation for most things.
We are humble in this quest; perceive the conquest of evidence, and as existentialists, we humbly realize that our beliefs are essentially based upon those things which we have experienced, and shared, with other people. As we all influence one another, and evolution is a collective matter -- that which is eventually realized, as only infinite, as the walls of the universe flex with our attainment of new information; the universe, built on information, as a living, breathing, entity -- alive by the Light of the informational -- and vibrating, as a noospheric unisphere, a glowing cell within a cell, an infinitsmally realized matter that never ends, but only continues, through the continuum; so as we may find ourselve interstellar explorers, we find the depths of the universe only increase the further we endeavor to explore.
The
multisphere, for which many unispheres revolve, act together, through
the life-force they possess. The Free Will universe, as a place that
breeds artists and individuals -- through the Earth (the living
library) -- as a cosmic college system for learning and
soul-purification, is, the grounds through which many souls evolve,
and we came to this cosmic college system with the hope, purpose, and
inclination, to continue our evolution.
Perceiving the Earth,
and this very universe, as an "art project" is somewhat
reflective of the truth of this reality.
As artists, great power is found via this one label, that we see beauty in the details of matter, and relate objects through our life as art-forms. We may be inhibited with our own ability to produce double-strokes on a rotated surface, bring life to energy through the free associative process of the repetition of a certain symbol, or perhaps layer photographs, or perhaps direct our thoughts into matter given life through the advent for which we may -- as artists -- weave divine poetry through enlightened paragraphs of thought, that seem to manifest occasionally, through a natural process, via the revelatory state of the artist.
We are all artists and creators to some degree, and reality is our collective art-project. The operating system of reality, frequently updated, and renewed through time, is fueled by the Light that lies within -- for which a self-created reality is evident in the Lightworker and evolutionist; we are in an environment that is most symbiotic with our own flow; we are associated with other individuals to whom only enhance our own evolution; and we believe in the beauty of our dreams, ideals, and hopes regarding that of the collective. In the final life, the only life that matters now, for which we may activate the living moment, and writhe through proactive animation, to which we are actively creating the future -- that we are cast into a state of wonder upon imagining the concept of tomorrow -- that as so much has been realized in the final life, we see existence, as ascended master, guide, and evolutionary catalyst to only come to be seen on life on other worlds. Our evolution carries us to these worlds, for which our home-base of ones own universe, is infinitely referred to as the Source of the living soul. So we return to our own universe, our own natural, pure, artistic form, and we occasionally make changes to our reality. We become a shape-shifter, through which our imagination carries us into certain forms. So we may experience certain things, in one form, but always revert back to the self-same place of the soul, repeatedly, to which as shape-shifter, and amorphous soul, we are consciously enhanced through the purpose, goal, and end-result that we focus upon -- and deep meditations for which we are merging the hemispheres into a unified whole, to which we may find ourselves in telepathic communication with the higher self -- direct communication with the soul -- I do this occasionally, and there is an imagined conversation. One communicates with ones own self, and through self-talk, and inner exploration, we arrive at certain thoughts. So in meditation we may focus on one thought, and one theme of belief, which may be a certain mantra or affirmation, densifying the energy within our minds, God knows, furthering this focus to the rhythm of though-syllabation may help us stay grounded in the moment, and we may find ourselves "riding our thougts" in their perfect natural rhythms that flow creatively within us.
The creativity found in meditation, through lyrical thought-patterns, and the natural poetics of the human soul -- that we soar through images that are beneficial to our growth, or focus on a phrase that enhances our thoughts entirely. The thought "I am divine Light" or "I am human evolution" -- to whatever self-aggrandized forms that occur within the mind, we are enhanced through our creative thought-patterns, and we are wholly realizant of the control we possess via Free Will. Seeing ones self as a special, unique spark of Light within the totality of All That Is -- seeing ones self as necessary toward the collective growth, with a purpose that is geared toward the collective evolution, our place on the council exists, and our thoughts will be regarded with infinite respect. The honor of expressing ones self as reckoner, and changer of the times is the true Light of the universe. The self-contained world-changer, the self-fueled individual, the catalyst, the harbinger, the guide, the beacon; this has always been you, for which your purpose is seen in the eyes of our omniscient Universal Mind -- you are connected to the Source, and we are all born from the same fount of emanating Light.
Our
bodes are all made up of the same matter as the environment, and
thought and environment are always
entangled.
The soul is naturally amorphous, and in the days of Lemuria we could
take on any form. The thought thus given life to matter via the
imagination, would come to be expressed through certain divine forms
-- such as a wingéd
angel -- a flowing riverlight pattern -- a natural geometric form. We
are able to do this actively in the present life, through certain
titles and labels. Artist, expressor, evolutionist, universalist,
ascended master, Spirit, or whatever name that we naturally possess.
Whatever ones desired name, to be found, we operate more imaginitely
through the title thus worn. We are all unique styles born from the
same Source, diferring arrays of certain archetypal probabilities.
Individuated through our experiences, to which we learn from one
another, and we all require someone to learn from. There is only One
Spirit moving through everything, and we find this realization in
learning from another. We find that we require some guidance, and
that it would only require one person to wake us up from the dream.
We are all geared toward collective unity, and peace. All wars,
killing, genocide, and dissension will cease through the natural
workings of human evolution. The politics will change, the system
will break down and reform into something new, and eventually, free
endless energy will be found to prove our eventual finality, in the
final life, as symbiotic with our home, and, eventually re-integrated
with the many races that exist within the Free Will universe.
We
seek integration, and further advancements. Our technology is
evolving with the Earth itself, and many portals, gateways, and
cosmic vehicles for transformation -- just as with the pyramids
originally used for enlightenment -- are going to come to pass as
technologies we will possess. Already, the human race has discovered
free energy, but countlessly certain individuals have been quieted,
by the "powers that be." Allegedly, we would have free
energy today if it were not for these silencings, and as such, we
perceive the true insidiousness of some peoples power-seeking, greed,
and selfishness toward personal gain that is not related to the
collective. The selfish gene often prevailing, that one individual
will serve ones self without any regard for the active karma system,
or the Light of the collective, but become occluded to ones own
self-declarations that we perceive are made real in providing a
reality that is "above" someone else. Perceived as better,
all humility nonexistent, and thus, the true damnation of the human
race found in this greedy soul -- we see the wheat shall be separated
from the chaff, and especially whence found in the recess of
telepathy, these individuals shall be reckoned, have their deepest
desires exposed, and as such, caused to revert back into their
original soul-form, only to realize they were attaching many
deducements and self-fabricated seperatory factors in distorting, and
bastardizing the original fount of Light from which all life arose.
I see this often, and have received pamphlets about "heaven" from Christian children handing out pamphlets in the street. Many are conditioned to believe in certain things without any physical proof, and many operate through faith. The blind faith of most organized religions that suggest some form of reward in "being good people" -- that we contrast ourselves with the concept of darkness is only the work of human ignorance.
There is no black and white, "two-road option" -- no thing we refer to as evil, but this is only a fabrication invented in order to make what seems to be "good" to stand out better in due contrast. Organized religion seems to discuss fear often, and will refer to themselves as "specialists in God." I have my distaste regarding organized religion, as I see only the separation of belief, and bastardization of the One True Spirit.
As divine intervention has come to pass with certain individuals such as myself, for which I would see the pale expressionless face of an extraterrestrial visitor at the age of two -- and hold the memory for the entirety of my life. I am forced into the knowlege that other life exists; I am forced into a world of meaning, purpose, and all-inclusive design. I have been catalyzed into belief through the whims, and design of another -- a mere two year old child inhibited with the thought of extraterrestrials. And I have seen UFO's, in the distant erratic movements, and I have been guided, very often, by the desirous modes of other people. For whatever reason, I am now capable of writing this text, and able to transfer my beliefs into the written word. Once, when I was under the throes of psychosis, I would hear a page blowing in the wind -- synthetic wind -- within my studio. This was some message, from the future, indicating that I would write the book. I have been inspired by certain people to put my thoughts into text, and I am inspired by the thought that "someone" will take my words in fond regard. As I may be guiding the reader into new belief-patterns, and perhaps a dream of awakening, humility exists in that I am not just some mysterious figure behind the text -- but a real individual, with a real face, real genes, real personality, and a real heart.
One works to empower the fellow individual, and help provide the thought of uniqueness in ones thoughts. One wishes to see creativity, beauty, Light, and information. One wishes to see the world changed by One alone -- one prays for the free endless resource -- one hopes for peace opposed to discord -- one hopes that all concept of opposition and competetiveness was only an experiment, a test of our Free Will. Eventually, it was found that through such leaders as Caligula, and Hitler, we have come to produce individuals that use their reality in order to govern others, often with disastrous, horrific results. This world has been productive of some of the most amazing experiences and events -- our history is vast -- we have many profound historical figures to learn from -- from the great honesty of such men as Hunter S. Thompson to the lyrical workings of the creative mind of Burroughs, to the existentialism presented by Kafka, and Camus, to the films produced by Paul Thomas Anderson, Tarantino, Aronofsky, Lynch, and Cronenberg. We have come to produce some of the most profound presentations of what may be possible -- and so it goes -- "if it can be imagined, it must exist somewhere." The concept of parallel realities, in relationship to the concept of probabilities, and finding a certain road that is most favorable -- activating the future through prescience, and the many goal-oriented processes involved; this masterpiece of thought we are headed towards, as eventually-realized, is a point of focus, for which we are at a cathartic crossroads, may feel the presence, and realize we are actively changing the world. It only takes One to change the world, and that is a natural universal law of the Free Will universe. Expressions of power, as seen in our U.S. government through such awful, contra-idealistic "men" as George W. Bush who was merely a proxy for other peoples energy, to the profoundly idealistic Barack Obama -- we have come far, from that great low which was the Bush regime, to a more peace-based, and evolutionary leader. I am a believer in his energy, and I truly believe that the human race is now moving in a very good and hopeful direction.
Only a couple years ago, the president would make a visit to my home-town. He ate dinner at a restaurant right in town, and stayed in Bar Harbor for a few days, declaring on Oprah that Maine was his most favorite vacation. My town is a growing spiritual mecca, and it will only contine to evolve. Bar Harbor, a tourist town famous for its long-standing community of artists, intellectuals, and spiritualists, is mentioned in the book 2013 by Richard Grossinger, as a future locale for spiritual learning and growth. For whatever reason I was born here, on this tiny island, surrounded by water, with only one bridge leading off of the island. I have been cultured, at first, being forced into learning and education, to which I would naturally oppose, and I had great trouble with certain subjects as I felt they held no pertinence to the present. Over time, I would start to find my passion in waveforms, and start working with sound, surgically, through a certain wave editor that I use to edit sound. I would spend up to seven hours a day studying waveforms, and observing how sounds will mix together. I would spend, at one time, an entire two months on only one song -- which was to be found as prophetic, as well as other songs I have written that eventually manifested into my life. I once wrote a song based on the story by Philip K. Dick "The Electric Ant" about a man who wakes up in a hospital to find his hand wounded, and realizant of his true android nature following the incident. Over time, this android would find himself removing his "reality module" and tampering with his own reality, as tall skyscrapers would blip out of sight, and certain people would disappear. So I wrote a song about a self-created reality . . . in October of 2009, I woke up in the hospital with a wound in my left hand, and the memory of direct non-local thought-transferrence that would change my life, and begin to provide the evidence that I really am in Lightbody, I really do possess a new mutation that is highly unknown -- and I am a living example for the self-created reality . . . so I have written songs that would manifest results in my life, with one song entitled "The Final Mile" about walking with no purpose and no plan. As the night of my teleportive event, was that final mile walked, I would cross the bridge off of MDI, and endeavor into the unknown, only to find my life saved by re-location. One is guiding ones own self, one produces ones own future, and one is able to see their Light is endless.
We
have come through karmic incidence, that America was once invaded by
the settlers, which is essentially stolen land that has now amassed
into a society based upon television, gossip, rumour, and ill-belief.
This land which was never ours to begin with, has been used toward
our own personal gain over the reality of the world -- as such --
America -- the land of freedom and independence -- is now the most
powerful country in the world. Our government holds sway over other
governments, and we are in control over the resources. Thankfully,
our president sees the negativity of our present society, and I
perceive he is a Lightworker to some degree. We have found our great
leader, we now task him with guidance toward collective peace. We
task our leader with the purpose of guidance, and collective
evolution, longevity of life, and the sharing of energy. Personally,
I see that this battle we have been fighting was with an illusive
enemy that never existed to begin with. Somehow we have worked very
hard at attaching many different names and deducements to what is
essentially the same thing. In Buddhism, it is highly suggested that
"we are all the same" -- and so it goes, we perceive the
Light of one of the worlds greatest religions. We are
all
the same, there is no battle, there is no war, there is no
disagreement; this is only an illusion that has been fabricated by
the mind. As we see war in the Middle East, and the "battle"
continues on, in the "Holy Land" -- a battle over belief
itself, this great experiment known as the Earth, as governed by Free
Will, in its self-resident processes of life, and animation, has
found itsel very disassociated from the original Source -- however,
this oscillation into separateness only makes the journey back all
the more worthwhile -- and as such, we are
brought
closer to Godliness through the expression of our uniqueness and
individuality. So far, the human race still disagrees over God,
belief, and many religions continue to harbor fear-based energy. We
see the evengalist repeating the words of the bible, relaying a
message that is now obsolete, and holds no pertinence to the future
reality -- we see people running in circles, via the same densified
thought forms, and lower chakra based animalistic functioning. We see
that some of us "like drama" and do not want to be in
agreement. We see that some people enjoy
separation,
and like
to
be judged for their superficiality, and materialistic gain.
So
it goes; the wheat must
be
separated from the chaff.
For whatever reason, these drones exist, and they barely possess and true identity, or Light of their own soul. So we perceive what is simply referred to as a low vibration. A soul that is just starting out, and as impressionable, has found itself embroiled in the physical world of the third dimension. One has strayed so far from the original Light, that one is barely cognizant of where life originated, and how evolution will progress. Somehow this individual who is ruled by the whims of other men -- is walking a path that only leads to chaos and disagreement. In my own life, I have had gossip follow me for my active imagination, and I have been verbally instructed to follow along the same path as everyone else. Opposed to my indifference and uniqueness, disturbed by my creativity, and offended by my thoughts -- I am perceived as a threat for wanting peace, I am perceived as wrong for desiring equality. The world says "be separate and disagree" -- and so does two-strand DNA. Two hemispheres to the brain. Two genders, etc. It is insidious, and it is the workings of expressions of others Free Will, the perceived controlling forces -- who consciously feed off the energy of our discord -- who only want us to live in discord, and follow a future that leads us nowhere but further chaos, disagreement, and separation of belief.
"Let the hemispheres unite, let the perfect partner be found, let marriage of the bridegroom take place, let the yin and yang flow in logical resound, let the caduceus fly, and let things be balanced for the sake of all that is good in the world."
One
always possesses Free Will, in spite of the resounding horror of our
present-day "controlling forces." Already, we have the
greatest president, and we are moving in a hopeful direction. No
matter what, the human race will evolve, and only continue to
progress through the self-created reality made up of individuals and
free-thinking people of passion, fortitude, and imaginative wit. We
may find that some people unwilling to change are become the chaff as
separated from the wheat -- and that "not everyone can be
saved." For whatever reason, their quest is found on a different
star, in a entirely different world. The karma that is possessed, is
finalized in this environment, and eventually, one realizes thay are
born from the same Source as everyone else. The process of evolution
continues whether the consensus reality is in agreement over this
matter or not. The human race has produced many fictions, many
stories, and many fabrications. The bible, in its profound weight and
girth is condescending to the concept of books, in itself, that
through the wretchedness of its design -- in spite of the somewhat
universal truths found in the ecclesiastes -- is mostly a load of
fabrications, invented in order to control people in order to believe
in a certain history, and geneology that is opposed to the true
nature of evolution. Ones family background is not relative to the
evolutionary process, and our evolution is essentially come from a
totally different star-system. We are essentially alien to this
world, like the settlers of America, and as such, we possess no right
to act as though this is our world alone. The Earth receives great
interest for its capacity to produce life, and house a multitude of
different types of beings -- as such, we are referred to as a cosmic
college system through which people incarnate here in order to learn
about Free Will. So it has come to pass that many incarnations have
taken place on the Earth, and it was all leading up, logilinearly,
toward the eventual conclusion of enlightenment, DNA activation, and
the vitalization of ones Lightbody in the final incarnation.
Chapter
Thirty Nine: The Primordial Spark
Theoretically,
energy which has always existed, preceding our own universe, has come
through the primordial spark, the Source, for which Light would
emanate in all directions from the center which is everywhere, and
circumference that is nowhere. The universe was suddenly brought to
life, via the mind of One, and this great experimental universe based
upon Free Will, as perceived as an energy-source for the
multicellular structure of the matrix of universes, the omniverse,
the multiverse/multisphere. We see that the Free Will universe has
existed some billion years, life emanated from the central core, and
as such, chose inhabitance on various star-systems; through the
natural evolution of life. God sparked the universe into Light, and
God saw that the Light was good -- it was based on living information
to which all is governed akashically, through the histories and
precedents recorded through what was perceived to begin with the
construction of the Free Will universe -- time and physicality. The
continuum, which preceded this universe, time before time itself, as
such, energy was always existing -- energy is infinite -- and energy
never dies. So the Source, the primordial spark, emanated Light from
the perceived nucleus -- the start of the universe approximately
13.75 billion years ago -- sparked into existence -- seeded with life
by the mind of One, and thus manifesting over time through various
star-systems such as the Lyra/Vega constellation, creating such races
as the Pleiadians, Sirians, Arcturians, Zeta Reticuli, and Humans.
These
many races now exist in the New Age -- the Cosmic Spring of the
universe -- and it was all leading up to this time.
So we have
begun, perceived, theoretically -- with the big bang -- so many
billion years ago -- to end up incarnated in the New Age on the
planet Earth, the cosmic college system, in order to learn of the
nature of our own Free Will, all in event toward the eventual return
to the Source. What has been perceived to possess a beginning must,
in due reciprocity to all concepts of universal balance, possess a
climax that is nirvana, or one-consciousness. This telepathic shared
sentience of many minds merged into one, a totality of all divined
sentience, the God-consciousness that emanates from the core, so this
energy which was always infinite has come to remember itself -- and
as such -- know just where it has been. The Source shall be educated
by our trials in human life, that once brought into the highest
vibration of the soul-body we are capable of returning to the Source
at our own Free Will. We only return to the Source when we are
entirely ready, and yet, for some, this act is perceived as a rarity,
or simply erroneous. Nevertheless, if the universe did
begin
with the big bang, then there must be a conclusion to human
existence. The return to the Source simply strikes the mind as
logical in light of balance in the universe. As described, the
conversation, in the chapter about the fifth dimension, we are to
find the divine conversation. So we find that we are God, and it was
ours alone that responsibility came manifest. We realize, through our
ascended body, thus bound to the recess for which nirvana may occur
-- however mysterious this acts performance must resound within the
imagination -- it is perceived, that perhaps through entering a
blackhole, a wormhole, or some cosmic portal, we would arrive,
physically, at the Source.
So, the ship -- contained of all
enlightened passengers and divined minds who seek nirvana, will event
its way into the beauteous core -- become consumed by the vortex --
all cells of all bodies dispersed and re-gathered unto a singular
sentience, and this "final body" to which is simply the
mind of God possessive of God-consciousness, flows in riverlight
fashion, through the primordial rhythm, for which we recall our place
as the One to whom is responsible for all of this. The matrix of
universes, perceived as infinite, simply a continuum of matter that
is held up by its own natural gravity, and force -- is like an
aggregate, as described, multicellular -- a great matrix of cells.
And cells within cells within cells, utterly composed by the
fluctuating spherical curved walls. The entirety of universes is, in
its network, fluctuatng, rotating, and animating through the natural
life-force of the energy thus possessed. The energy which is
infinite.
So the Free Will universe perceived as the epicentre, the place for which all bodies seeking nirvana are invariably gravitated toward the center -- as centers attract -- and as such, we find ourselves living the life of a human being transforming into an ascended master, alive in the third millenium of the New Age of the planet Earth. And we see our place is divine, and we know our future is grand, and we realize our mind is Light, and we verily come to understand of things wholly unexpected to us in contrast to how life used to be. As we transform into the ascended master, and perceive nirvana as the end-result of all human existence, so this which has had a beginning of time -- however preceding this universe energy must have existed invariably -- we see that the beginning, middle, and end, are all relative to one another -- holographically -- such that within one piece of the whole is contained the total image, and we through the now-point realized, the sense of the presence, verily realize our Godliness, and so the walls of the universe flex with our attainment of new information. Endeavoring toward "new thought" in every waking moment, to which we are actively producing creative thoughts that operate through certain tones of uniqueness, and Light, we are brought closer to Godliness.
As
we may writhe through uniqueness, there is still the concept of
universality -- that certain universal laws are irrovocable -- and as
such, we realize universality through tones of uniqueness, profoundly
enough, that in the solitary
quest one
is realizing the same genius thoughts realized by so many ascended
masters, and cosmic geniuses, before us.
To realize
universality through uniqueness, we are to see that the solitary road
-- that of the mystic who is operating through independence, and the
self-contained vehicle for divine Light, to which one is a servant to
God alone -- so it goes, certain concepts and ideas regarding nature
and reality, universal principles thus found, invite our
belief-patterns to form into that of which has, technically, already
been achieved before. Some genius minds who lived before us, some
mystics, some saints, have operated through solitude -- a
self-created environment, and their own natural epiginetics. They
have reached nirvana in their own right, and as such, we learn from
these existences like Father Enoch, the Buddha, and others. I refer
to the return to the Source as the "mind of One" meaning it
was solely one individual who this universe is based around. The
saviour of the world. In need of saving, our present world is in a
sort of dystopia, fueled by gasoline, working tiring jobs in careers
that don't accord with our soul-nature, often spread so thin through
an excess of information -- to many choices to actually choose.
Manufactured for control in our two-strand DNA, subjects to the will
of beings who know they can hold all the power -- they can be the one
responsible -- we all have the capacity to take over the world. So it
would seem that through control of the humans, the entire universe,
and multiverse is controlled, and it would seem we have lived through
a period of prolonged darkness in order to realize the primordial
Light. So it was found, one was awakened, the dream recalled,
Lightbody activated, DNA transformed, the final life, realized. The
life of which holds the greatest value and importance to the entirety
of All That Is -- is found within the final life. You hold the cards
for your existence; you have the capacity for balance, and
integration. You are realizing that the power was always yours, and
it is all a matter of remembering. As such, it becomes your task, as
the world is in need of saving, to become the saviour of the world.
Chapter Forty: Final Thoughts
We
all chose to incarnate on the planet Earth, this humble blue star,
the cosmic college system, and we have come to find that final
analysis for which life only equates to the final thoughts of
Godliness, in the end. Realization of life as the ascended master, as
Christed, is only an eventual process realized by all life-forms that
are graduating the third dimension, with Lightbody. As I have
detailed the levels of Lightbody, provided my own experiences, and
done my best to suggest that the Light is in fact a real thing,
however invisible to the our eyes -- it exists, none the less. Our
faith that the Light is real, is to be found in the evidence of the
extrasensory, and the synchronistic events that will come to shape
our final incarnation. The writer of this text is one who is aware of
many theories, whom mostly operates through faith -- to which the
body of the universe -- the multispherical aggregate -- is what may
be imagined; that the Free Will universe is the Light of the
aggregate -- the fuel to which the artists are born -- is suggested
greatly by the stellar souls our civilization has now come to
produce. We are the cosmic college system, through which karma shared
will provide insight into the exchange of energy, and how certain
resonances between individuals reach toward the highest Light. In the
final life, one is aware of the environment, the people, places, and
events which shape ones view of reality -- and as such, expresses
control over these things, to which epiginetics, and DNA activation
is the only logical result.
Human
evolution is a process, but spiritual awakening can, and will be
instantaneous. The symbols contained within the dream wake up the
subconscious mind; and one is catapulted into the final life. So it
goes, the writer has his experiences, and existentially bases beliefs
off of these experiences. The writer, awareized to the fact that DNA
activation is a reality -- to whom has lived in the same environment
for the entirety of his growth-process, who has learned of the Free
Will universe; the realization of the spiritual life, and how human
evolution is now actively occurring with evidence born in the
extrasensory, suggestive that the Light is real -- expects a risen
vibration through the self-evolution of the Christed individual. That
many are taking the New Age for their own selfish gain is evident,
and one is merely fortunate to be alive at this pivotal hour. I have
had divine experiences, to which an outlet is required in expressing
I am not the only one -- the number of Lightworkers is theoretically
a number in the millions, and the numbers are only growing. Of
course, there are about seven billion people on the Earth at this
time -- a great number of souls, and unique individuals. We see that
war still exists, killing continues, and the human race is still a
rather primitive force. Often operating through the lower chakras,
and a certain animalistic nature -- it would seem that the
selfishness of some souls only projects toward sexual satisfaction,
sway over other men, the self-created dramas, and various expressions
of greed to which knows no end. So the wheat shall be separated from
the chaff -- and the Light is a prevailing force. The Lightworkers,
in their Lightbodies, enhanced DNA, and experiences in the divine.
Energy was meant to be free, shared, and not harbored. The free
endless resource of the Light that lies within is the final answer --
in this, we are found self-contained vehicles for Light. Singular
one-man-armies of infinite power and fortitude. The power lies in the
individual.
In my studies of the subconscious mind, I am
coming to find that the rules of the subconscious are very much like
that of the universe. Things however patternless, through events, and
certain stages in evolution, operate through the now-point, as well
as a goal-oriented process that is enlightenment as the end-result.
We all came to the planet Earth to experience the enlightenment of
our Lightbodies. Enlightenment is the very reason why we exist, it is
the space to be filled, the void that requires Light. That once
unused ninety percent of the brain, and the unused strands of DNA
scientists have referred to as "Junk DNA" is merely a
dimmer-switch, and it can be raised at the individuals Free Will.
Lightbody is as real as anything, and yet, whatever we may refer to
as the enlightened state, is an occurrence that takes place in our
lives eventually. So we have come to the Earth, in this recess of the
continuum; to learn of the matter of the soul, and see our divine
place within the rows of the many ascended masters. We chose this for
ourselves, that the path is never walked in vain -- but there are
many evolving Lightworkers, and the individual is never alone. The
purpose of the soul is toward actualization, and the highest
resonating frequency. That is the task of the final incarnation, to
graduate from this dimension, and walk the crystal stair into future
divination. We are evolving through the presence tense, the now-point
realized, that in this very moment the subject bound by Free Will can
cogitate any thought, or perform any action. The individual always
has Free Will. That is the nature of this universe, that is the way
things work, and that is a universal law to which Free Will is
something we all possess as individuals, and evolution is the only
next most logical result of Free Will. The choice to evolve into the
highest life, as evidenced in our words, declarations, mantras, and
self-concepts, is a reality we are creating for which can be shared
with the most high-vibrating individuals, and co-create the future as
evolutionists.
This future we are creating, via the imagination, and all high-powered concepts born through the thought of a thought -- this which only yields infinity, as thought is endless, evolution is endless, and co-creation is, as co-related, from one shining star to the next within the grand tapestry of network symmetry -- this unitive whole -- is only endless. So growth, learning, and all things within the continuum are found only in a continual state of renewal. As we see in the seasons of the Earth, how flowers return once seeded, and things do tend to re-incarnate, and become re-created over time, so it goes, we as human beings have worn this form -- that of the human host -- for many years, and now all is becoming equalized into the final incarnation. The belief in re-incarnation, now coming to be shared by many scientific minds as learned through the fields of past-life regression, and certain revealing meditative states -- is a reflection on nature, that karma is real, and energy once expressed invariably returns to the sender.
Science will catch up, and the science of human evolution is something our race is nye to understand. Already with my own somewhat rational explanations for enlightenment, in coupling with the many levels, and biological changes of Lightbody -- it is presented on a somewhat scientific basis, that these are no theories, but in fact truths that are now coming to pass in these stages of human evolvement. I work to suggest that Lightbody is a reality, however mostly unknown by the masses. It is simply the term we use in reference to the enlightened state. Lightbody, otherwise known as the merkabah vehicle -- is a product of human evolution, and will yield such experiences as the extrasensory in the highest levels. As the human race was originally gifted with these talents, and we are now in the process of recollection, re-realizing what we had once learned in so many times before, we have come to find ourselves integrated, a unitive whole, the actualized, perfect avatar self, and we are coming to find that we are immortal as a result of ascension. We refer to the actions of the subject who is in Lightbody, as the products of the ascension process -- that to which is only a continual rise in frequency, and greater resonance with the totality of All That Is. I have worked to suggest the nirvanic stage, God-consciousness, or one-consciousness, which may lie so far in the future it holds no precedence to the present reality -- none the less, we perceive a beginning -- the big bang -- and what begins must reach a climax at some point. Just as our universe is expanding, and some theorists suggest that through the inbreath and outbreath of the unisphere, our very universe itself will reach a point of catharsis -- and find the return to the Source, of all life, as a cosmic inevitability.
I make a conscious choice toward unity, and the return to the Source, where others fear the loss of identity. We may perceive this event as rare, but I perceive it as eventual. I perceive that what once was One, shall return to One again, and become infinitely recycled by the continuum. I see that our universe is like a power-source, to which I have (through what workings of the imagination) attempted to produce what I perceive as the body of the aggregate, cells within cells, in a seemingly infinite array of universes. As "uni" denotes One, and some believe our universe is just that -- the only one -- so we also perceive this in contrast with the theory of extraterrestrials, that if there is only one universe, and we are alone in this universe, then great absurdity resounds, we perceive a lack of meaning and purpose to it all. As a result of our ability to imagine the future, and see that the mind is capable of perceiving communion with that foreign life-form -- peering into those eyes -- we shall see, verily, that some of these beings are come from their own universe, that is different from our own. The thought of multiple universes, not a commonly held theory, but processed within the mind of the transmuter, the Lightworker, the deep thinker, is an imagining that provides meaning -- a perception of cells -- of the grand matrix of spheres -- of that to which is simply referred to as the multisphere. So we will come to perceive there are many universes, ours is not the only one, but our importance within the grand symmetry -- as the realm where artists are born, and Light is expressed -- bound by the Free Will of the individual, and the world easily changed by one person alone -- is located within the center of the aggregate, as suggested, and fuels the multiple cells. So we are the fuel, we are the Light of the universe -- our Light expressed flows in riverlight fashion, and emanates from the beauteous core. The core is surrounded by spiraling energy-forms, and the hologram of reality -- in static flux -- only continues to build, grow, and evolve.
As
envirothought, thought related to the environment, and the
environment which is a living matter entangled with the mind of the
perceiver -- we are in the Free Will universe -- and we are
individuals incarnated with a unique purpose and design. The path
ranges, such that we may pray to universality, true, but often our
beliefs born through experience are wholly unique to the individual.
As the power lies in the individual, that self-contained
world-changer, the Christed soul, is to be found as the element
within the grand symmetry, as vital toward human evolution -- so I
have worked toward influencing the Cosmic Christ -- and I have worked
at influencing the reader with a sense of value and cosmic
importance. Humility is often questioned in the quest for
self-aggrandizement, and the writer only works toward seeing a world
of equals -- and the perception of the One True Spirit. As this
Spirit is evidenced in thought-transferrence, and the writer has had
such an experience only to be shared with other individuals -- is a
suggestion, from one mutated Lightbody experiencing the final life,
that these sorts of things can be expected by other subjects to whom
are in Lightbody.
As I have described the many levels of
Lightbody, and the subject is invited to meditate on what level they
are in -- it is to be found that this information is related to the
biology of ascension, and works toward the suggestion that evolution
is real. Science and evolution, as well as "Science and Spirit"
-- or simply metaphysics, is a field of interest that is growing with
more and more individuals. As we continue to experience heartbreak,
the loss of friends, trauma, or very seemingly coincidental
experiences, to that profound catharsis in realizing our Free Will
over our thoughts and reality -- all the way to the mind-bending
experience of seeing a UFO -- or having a visitation -- we are caused
to question this reality, and what really determines how things work.
Karma, as it shall come to be what is activated through the stages of Lightbody in the final incarnation, is more direct, and as such, one is kind of forced into awareizing to the true nature of their deepest thoughts and passions. I have revealed the deepest desires of certain individuals, through my own telepathic ability, and I have exposed the One True Spirit. I have presented the thought of the unisphere, re-incarnation, and the concept of the final incarnation who is Christed. Some are bound by physical desire, and a certain atrocious obsession with physical needs -- where others are bent on hurting one another, and causing violence in the counterpart soul. I believe that the human race are simply experiencing the pain of being multidimensional creatures composited to a simple form. We are in essence multidimensional, for which we can be, think, and accord to anything our Free Will permits, which is only infinite. As shape-shifters, operating through one thematic title to the next, from writer, to artist, we flex the mind -- we flex the imagination -- and we become interfaced to the final reality.
Organizing the environment is imperative toward our growth, and natural epiginetics.
We
must become organized, with all objects and media within the given
space -- and we must have choices -- and options -- but the selection
may be reduced. So we are more able to choose through a self-limited
array, and as such, find the right films, the right books, the right
art-work, and the right songs to benefit our self-evolution. We are
surrounding ourselves with beauty and information. Light, as
informational, is simply the datasphere of knowledge to which we
learn from, and it is alive, and it flows through all matter that
exists.
We endeavor to produce new thoughts out of the ashes
of the olde, to rise like a phoenix into the greatest lifestream of
people, places, and events.
In our rise in vibration, the environment rises in vibration, and so does everything we touch, see, feel, and connect with.
The energy which is only infinite shall be known, and harnessed by all humans.
Lightbody
shall find the subject willing to evolve. For the benefit of the
collective, one works with the Light/information toward the final
reality of a race of equals, and multidimensional beings.
Individuated through certain experiences and events, this shall all
add up to a logical conclusion in the end -- that we may employ the
Akashic Computer, in all futurity to come, in order to directly view
the past, and learn of its effect on the present reality. So we may
learn of many things, but know, verily, that the present moment is
our tool for divination. In meditations, hypnosis, and all
endeavorings into the subconscious mind -- we are communicating with
the body of God, and we are activating our DNA to only continue to
rise in strand. That dimmer switch of the DNA thus raised, and all
experiences heightened as a direct result; in Lightbody, we require
less sleep, and less food, as our body starts processing proteins and
chemicals at a faster rate. Through the risen vibration of the
environment, and envirothoughts -- we are transforming into a whole
new being, that of the perfect avatar self, and as such, all things
we now choose to welcome into our lifestream once found within the
final life -- are choices and decisions and thoughts that will be
carried with us, forever. One is immortalized by Lightbody, and as
entered into the final life starts thinking the thoughts that really
matter, finding the relationships that truly matter, and finding the
environment as changeful, but under our control, through the natural
organization of matter, and the feng shui of the living environment.
So in the final life all matters, all is meaningful, and all
possesses a purpose. There is no part of the hologram that does not
relate to the whole. The information is non-locally dispersed. It
exists in many places, in many different probable futures, and many
different lives. The information that binds us which is simply known
as Light -- is the matter which composes the universe, and as we
enter into Lightbody -- the frequency between environment and body is
enhanced, that the noospheric shell pulsates in rhythm with the Light
of our DNA, and the frequency between the glowing Earth, and that of
the enlightened DNA, is only causally rising in vibration as a direct
result of the flow. One is like a river, that is endlessly streaming
into the emanating recesses of the environment/the universe, and
back. One is continually sending energy into the Akashic Records, and
the Akashic Records is continually revised with each passing day.
With every day that passes in the New Age to which the Lightworker is
living the final life -- the world changes -- and we know that by
changing ourselves we change the world.
"Time
is invariably moving into the future."
I
repeat this phrase often, knowing that time is the great healer. I
will meditate with my thoughts, and perceive the conversation between
conscious and subconscious, for which the inner conversation often
reveals certain things to me. Finding the alpha-wave patterns of
meditation, and the thought of a thought -- transversing through
certain images, geometric patterns, shapes, symbols, and the words
which define ones being; we activate the subconscious mind. So we see
in meditation that looking at a certain object for a prolonged period
of time will induce pleasure in the image, and as such, bound by Free
Will, we can always exercise the imagination. Just as we can think
any thought, we can imagine any scene. The mind does not know the
difference between what it sees and what it remembers. Whatever the
consensus may be -- we know, verily, that in enduring the
communication from the joined hemispheres, and meditation, we
activate the furtherance of our own evolution.
We
are aware of our thoughts that carry us through time, and as such,
thought is
occurring
with time, that we may occasionally glance at the clock and know our
place -- or otherwise never look at the clock, and operate through
ones own biological rhythm. So we meditate, we focus upon the matter
of our thoughts, and we activate the law of attraction. We will see
certain things that are desired, certain events, and relationships.
We will meditate through the scenes, and follow our thoughts as they
carry us into the future. We will see what we want to see, and
experience what we want to experience. Free Will is the theme to
which we ride -- and we know that Free Will always exists. We humbly
realize that some events must occur in reflection toward our growth,
but we always possess Free Will to react a certain way -- and as
such, we are defined by how we choose to react. So we must expect
certain things, and yet, never expect too much -- for hate is the
very betrayal of expectation, and we know this place gets us nowhere.
We realize Love is the final truth, that to which is unconditionally
expressed to all walks of life. We draw Light from the common
stranger, and we may open a random book and flip to a certain page,
we may inhibit ourselves with anything -- we always possess choice,
and our Free Will shall be expressed.
So we come to find the
organized environment, the thoughts of the final life, and what
profound meditations carry us into the future.
We activate the subconscious mind, and alpha-state through our own mantras, and cognitive repetitions -- and we see ourselves moving through time, and we may perceive the track, the distant Light, and convergence of our body with that thus found in the desired destination. Teleportation as something the writer has experienced as a result of instinct, and a possibility that now exists for all Lightworkers -- is that now-point realized for which we construct the machine, and take it upon ourselves to personally travel into the future. As we are to find our fifth-dimensional Lightbodies fully activated, that once unused portion of our minds is now active, we may verily find ourselves capable of teleportation, and other such feats. We are desensitized by the media, super-hero films, from X-Men, to The Matrix, to believe that genetic mutation yielding extrasensory talents was only the product of fiction. Yet, the writer has experienced telepathy numerous times with the testimonials of those involved with direct reference to the thoughts which traveled -- thoughts which would not have been spoken aloud -- and the doctor would tell me himself, following the research study at MacClean, that "yes, reports of telepathy are more known to occur with people who have the De Novo mutation." And De Novo which simply means new, in other words, the "new mutation" is what the writer possesses, such that the writer probably has tri-strand DNA, and shall continue research studies at MacClean in order to better understand the true science and biological processes of my mutation. One humbly devotes himself to science, and one humbly believes there is a rational explanation for all things within the universe -- and I refuse to believe that I am merely possessive of some illness, or self-fabricated reality. My dream of awakening was about as symbolic as a dream of awakening could be -- I destinctly recall the sensation of becoming the caduceus -- and I shall never forget the sensation of those million different thoughts radiating in static drone in my entire right-brain hemisphere. I would find myself hovering in the mirror, wake up from the dream covered in sweat, such that the dream occurred immediately after I had lied down. For this knowledge to exist, and to realize that I am undergoing the ascension process -- one is simply hoping to produce support for the fellow evolutionist.
Now
I see the shift lies within the individual, and I am now working
toward a more symbiotic, and loving relationship with my family and
friends. I know the world will never change unless I start by
changing myself. I see the choices I make are carrying me into the
future, and I went far into the depths of desperation in order to
realize my effect on the world is direct. As a result of divine
intervention, the presence of the angelworkers in my life, I am
caused to wonder, infinitely wonder, as to how any of this is really
possible. The answer seems to lie in the concept of Free Will. If you
would look at me, and the way I was, perhaps, five years ago, you
would see no hope in this individual. You would see that the
drug-use, manipulation, lies, and desperation, were only productive
toward an experience, seemingly, of hell. That life of the addict
lived in the third dimension is now transitioning into something new,
but it took great focus and concentration to arrive where I am now. I
would have never written this book, unless it were for the
inspiration of some individuals who see Light in my work, and
perceive the writer is truly being honest in his declarations. For
whatever reason, I have been inspired.
The world is now
changing all around us; the New Age is a time for which many are
starting to see as a new reality. We are transforming into something
entirely new, for which our prolonged oscillation into darkness was
just a test of our Free Will, to see if we could make the shift. As
the shift lies within the individual, and individual choices -- we
see the world can be changed by one person alone.
In my
studies on thought-vibrations, matter, and sound, as an audio
engineer (to which I have studied this field at college) -- I see
that music holds great truth; that in essence the universe is like
music, made up of super-strings and vibrations, ever-leading toward
the eventual orchestratic masterpiece of enlightened thought. As all
humans with a voice are capable of singing their thoughts, or
reciting invocations, we are all musicians to some degree. For
everyone, there is a specific instrument that accords best with ones
energy. For everyone, therein lies a song -- that I believe we all
have a song within us is evident in the Light of the beauty of the
human race. I see that music these days is reaching eclipse to which
some of the artists are about as "good as they can be." We
truly are in the New Age to possess such divine evidence as Bon Iver,
Iron and Wine, and Chan Marshall -- to such filmmakers as Anderson,
and Aronofsky, to such writers as Royal, and Steiger. We have a great
vast array of stellar souls incarnated here on the Earth, and for
their own sake and longevity to whom we serve, we absolutely must
make the right choice. The right choice is toward unity, evolution,
and the sharing of our beliefs. Human evolution occurs as based upon
one person willing to make a change -- shall come to pass as
eventual. The process is realized over time, that as synchronistic
occurrences, the loss of loved ones, to the experience of trauma in
ones life -- begs the question for reason, that these events must
have occurred for a reason, and as questers, and wanderers -- we
search for what this answer may be.
The answer found in Light,
to which the final life well knows, we arrive at the finalmost
conclusions of the mystic quest -- we realize our quest has reached
the now-point for which enlightenment occurs, and the body is
revitalized. We recall the dream, share our entrance into the world
of the divine, and acknowledge that the Light has officially entered
our body. And we perceive the purity of our entrance into the world
of the divine -- of knowledge of our identity, place, purpose,
mission, and goal. The soul is bound by the goal, and we realize
enlightenment once the time is right for us. Certain books (as well
as certain guides) are meant for certain people, and we are able to
read them, from chapter to chapter, only in a linear intake of
information that is catalyzing the DNA into awakening -- such was my
case -- and my case is very simple.
As
described, in my own process of evolvement; I learned about the body,
the mind-body connection, instinct, the subconscious mind, the
universal mind/God, past-lives, re-incarnation, the knowledge of my
own past on the earth -- in the very sequence as presented. For
whomever may possess the same archetype as me, God knows, that path
toward evolution must be invariably the same. So I would event my way
into my sacred space, as described, and enter into the recess of the
dream of awakening. I would come to realize that I am alive in the
New Age; as a mission-based, soul-oriented bent on creating
exploitative knowledge, and as I evolved, I might go into remission
for a while, but the Light was always there -- guiding me through
certain people, certain individuals -- such as the dealer who invited
me to the party -- in my first telepathic experience. I have of
course been guided all the way, from the dream of abduction
experienced in my infancy.
I know that other life exists apart
from the human race, and I am unerring in my certainty as I have also
seen the distant stop-and-go movements of UFO's countlessly in my
lifetime. I know that other life apart from the human race exists --
and they have been integrating themselves into our reality, for many
decades now. With the onset of the New Age, the harmonic convergence,
and the close of the Mayan calendar, the starseeds have arrived in
the final hosts of ascending masters -- and we are in the recess of a
reality to which "God exists in the human body." So we
learn through the presence of the angelworkers, abduction dream, and
paranormal experience; that reality is always in flux, and things are
never quite solidified. Each day offers a new opportunity -- a new
thought -- a new idea. We are believers, all the way, such that we
always writhe through the theme of some
belief.
All human beings have beliefs of some form to which they base their
realities around -- and through our uniqueties we are made divine.
Sharing of ones beliefs is not something commonly accepted in our
society, and there is where the paradigm shift is nye to occur. In a
society more right-brained and intuitive, more feminine, and
creative, with the perceived "return of the Goddess" -- we
are to find that sharing of ones beliefs is now accepted; as we come
to writhe through the final, one true belief system. This was
eventual, as organized religion has served its purpose long enough in
separating us. Now integration of all matter is to be found in the
recess of the final life. We are become universalists, and prayers to
the unknown. We are finding life as determined wholly by our own Free
Will, and imagination. We find the wheat separated from the chaff in
these changeful times -- that some vibrations no longer accord with
our own and thus must be filtered out. So it goes, we change, the
world changes. One person changing means another changing in due
result. The domino effect of self-evolution via inspiration seen in
one individual world-changer causes others to see no fear in sharing
of their beliefs. This is the perceived point of learning, where true
inspiration resides. So we see the change in one individual affects
another -- and this string of influence flows as a ripple in the sea
-- in the datasphere of human life -- toward other minds -- via what
media's exist; text, music, art, and conversation -- we are always
learning from one another -- and we are all
guides
and healers, in many senses.
So changeful this reality, that
things are never quite static or remaining in one place. We know that
humans have incarnated several numbers of times, that this is the
Free Will universe, that God exists in the human body, and matter
transcends reality -- that ascended masters guide us through their
own means, and other life exists -- but we are not sure of all
things, however resounding the principles may stand. The Akashic
Records, ever-revised through the history created in these waking
times, is a living matter always in flux with the growth of human
knowledge. We know of some things. These things we may be certain of.
But the future stands as a changeful matter. A friend may pass away,
a heart may be broken, a great asset may be lost, or someone may end
their own life -- we see the tragedy continues on, in spite of how
beautiful the world may be, so it becomes our responsibility to act
through proactive animation -- to stay enamored -- to stay busy in
the world of Spirit because our Light is needed by the world.
At
present, we are still dominated through a male-oriented society that
seems to favor the male gender as primary leader, and influencer of
the world. The paradox in this would be seen in nature -- that
females are more typically the most dominant gender, and at present,
our world is quite dystopian. So it goes, as we find ourselves in the
Cosmic Spring, and a more right-brained intuitive race, we shall find
many great female leaders, and learn, verily, that the power of the
feminine is returning -- that the polarities must be balanced in
order to harmonize -- and we require both a positive and negative
charge. This does not denote black and white, or good and bad, it
simply denotes the balancing of energies. In a more right-brained
intuitive world, we would find that women and men are total equals,
and the balance found in these polarities eclipsed would make for a
better world.
Finding the mystic archetype, that wanderer of the recesses of the unknown -- the calm eventor into the world of tomorrow jumping headlong like a samurai into the fray of existence -- for which our life is worthwhile, and honored by others for our endeavorings into the unknown. In some cases, it will seem that some individuals are as though guides, very much, without realizing it. They will be learned from, from their honesty, and integrity, for which this honor that is projected fills the hearts of all to whom they know. In the merging of energies yin and yang, the polarities balanced, we shall seek a certain neutral transparancy, that to which we are allowing of certain energies, knowing verily that the darkness is transmuteable through our honesty. So we are honest, and we are truthful, and we speak in honest words for which we humbly realize may be judged in reference to the speaker. So we event our way into the future knowing that not all can be attained; this search is endless, and as such, always fun, interesting, surprising, and worthwhile. So the Earth, the epicentre for these energies to play out -- has karmically danced through incarnation to incarnation in realizing the same genius truths once realized by so many genius minds before them. Energy has always existed, preceding this universe -- and we have never been able to learn if it were not for some guiding force. So it shall seem that the many quantum leaps made by humankind were advanced through other races, and just as much evidence suggests no human hand could be totally responsible for the construction of some pyramids -- whereas there are even reportedly pyramids on Mars -- we see the evidence is suggestive, and we know, verily, that influence through some force has always existed.
So
we are led to believe through much evidence that we are not alone in
the universe, and many quantum leaps have been made by humankind from
the days of Sumeria as described by Sitchin, to the many other
cultures that have been influenced through time. This guiding force
is benevolent of course but our media only suggests otherwise -- that
they only wish to assist in our evolution is seen. We are advancing
now through whatever guiding force -- and such, we may call upon the
guides, or spirits, to aide us -- but we know that Free Will
prevails, and no matter what happens to us in this life, we always
have choice over how we react. And we choose how we react with
fortitude, and we do this prevailingly through time. So we learn
through our actions, and our actions define us -- many will say --
reality is truly self-created and this is the final truth of the
matter; we chose to be here; always possess Free Will; are unique
reflections of the Source; and all self-aware creations are capable
of evolution.
Humans have evolved, it would seem, already, to
have reached much of the information that is now available to us. The
media is fantastic in some ways, and the music is evolving as well.
The art-work of so many divine artists at present are also
overwhelming, and we see so much to learn from our fellow artist in
this world. The text, and channeled information is only amassing, and
we are learning through these mediums and channels of great cosmic
wisdom. The New Age is entirely evolving from each new soul
endeavoring into that world of Light and Information -- and we are --
many of us, choosing guidance from other souls to learn from. We are
of course guides in our own right, and so it goes in infinite cycle,
the re-patterning of one inspiratory life upon another, and advancing
through co-evolution, and co-creation. So it flows as one river
connected to another to grand ocean of existence, unto the Akashic
skein, and hard-wired as productive of a co-advancing regard toward
the honoring of the collective, and the eventual end of human
evolution. One such as to advance through DNA strand, Lightbody, and
the biological changes that come with the enlightenment of ones body,
mind, and spirit -- as integrated into one unitive whole -- the
polarities balanced, and the pineal generation more supernal energy
than before; all advancements of the cellular structure become
holographic with each piece containing the image of the perfect
avatar self, and one seems perfected to the final life.
Yet we
continue to evolve with each new day that passes, and I hold
astonishment at times with the concept of the days to come, as I am
not always sure of the future, as no one is, and that, it would seem,
is what makes us good people. As I may project into concepts of
certain technologies such as the psycho-imaginarium, the akashic
computer, and the holocell -- we are perceiving possibilities, but we
do not know when these things will come to pass. We simply realize
nirvana, along with other events, and other technologies, is
eventually found through time in the final incarnation. So become
immortal it would seem our longevity of life is infinite, and we
shall see these technologies come to pass in our immortalization.
So one perceives the concept of immortality as found as a
result of Lightbody, and the final incarnation; and here, the
universe is nye to be explored, that we shall spread the seed of the
human race, and survive through multiple environments is found as a
result of our evolution through time. I believe that the human race,
however needful of some cosmic assistance, is essentially capable of
surviving on Venus, or other star-systems, through their own natural
abilities. We are gifted already with much E.T. technology from such
races as the Zeta's, and Pleiadians, that we see these gifts shall be
used for our advancement is evident. Our technology is evolving, and
theoretically NASA remains interested in various new technologies.
Already, the recently discovered planet Kepler-20f which is about the
same size as the Earth, totally covered in water, and orbits a sun
much like our own -- is suggestive of other worlds to live upon. The
evidence is prevailingly seen that we are going to learn of future
locales for existence, and the human race will survive on other
star-systems. Our future as found on other stars like Venus shall
come to pass, God knows, in the future that lies ahead. We simply
imagine these things through at present -- just as no one imagined we
would make it to the moon, so presently few imagine we might make it
to Venus. Nevertheless, Venus is already much like the Earth and has
a terraformable environment that can house life. It lies in our
future that we shall make a New Earth, and find our race survived as
living on multiple stars. I believe this future may come to pass, and
that by awareizing ourselves upon the possibility now, we are priming
ourselves for the survival that lies ahead.
Theoretically the
planet Earth is in for a shifting of the poles, causing the entire
planet to tilt on its axis and as a result cause various land-masses
to be submerged, while others rise to the surface. This would be
devastating to the human race, and very few would survive the
cataclysm. As such, we believe that the Earth is "flushing us
out" due to our fear, and inability to congeal to one belief
system, or a global acceptance of peace, harmony, and co-creation. We
still have threats from terrorist organizations, genocidal leaders,
corrupt bureaucrats, and dark politics that still continue to plage
humankind. Wars continue to this day, and nations still fight over
what belief holds the highest truth. We stand at a crossroads, a
cosmic catharsis -- of whether to make the choice for peace and
longevity, or commit ourselves to a dying world. The choice to move
on, into a new Light -- for which the shift lies in the individual,
is the change that will come to pass, is a work toward peace,
harmony, and symbiosis. We are in the throes of misunderstanding when
we perceive ourselves as better than another, and where humility lies
in reciprocity of sharing, and positive energy-exchange, we shall see
that the right move is toward the sharing of our thoughts without the
expectation of judgment, that the self-concepts and beliefs that
define us must
be
shared in order to evolve.
Evolvement as a result of the sharing of belief, self-concepts, and ideals, we are co-creators and work toward a collective goal. The hope is that all human beings can make it into Lightbody, cease dying, and enter into the final life. But as we may see through the evidence that in having lost loved ones in our own right, we must die ourselves in due reciprocity. So it goes, some are simply not ready for the final life, but see their karma interwoven into expressions on different worlds. It is apparent that some may re-incarnate somewhere else, in order to live out their final incarnation on another world. But as we shall come to see through the immortality found through Lightbody, our place is found eventually, for which we may extend our civilization to Venus or other planets in all futurity to come. In the final analysis, we become the perfect avatar self through the process of a holographic orientation in that one thought shall contain the energy of the whole -- and thoughts are enlightened; the subject takes pride in the ability to think at all, and finds ones self involved in relationships, environments, and experiences of the most intellectual and evolutionary regard.
Once found in the recess of the final life, we are to start building planetary advocacy groups, spiritual networks, and groups for which the exploitative knowledge, sharing of energy, and evolution of the human race is our primary goal. So we convene in these groups, share our thoughts, our beliefs, and our ideas -- we interpolate our ideas from mind to mind, learn of new perspectives, and see many unique hues of Light on the expression of ones inborn divinity. We learn from one another, co-evolve, and grow as a collective. We are all leaders in this group; all with a worthwhile story to share, and all with a sense of universality in the understanding of the infinitely growing universe. So we shall see that the expressions we come to reveal are ontologically built around such things as expressions of the extrasensory, from telepathy to teleportation. In our groups, we may activate the broadcaster/sender of thought to whom is in the highest level of Lightbody of all in the group -- thought is found within the recess of the higher dimensions, thought travels instantaneously, and all members of the group are found in the recess of direct non-local thought-transferrence. So the broadcaster will activate the field through which this energy may come to pass, and all involved in the telepathic experience are to become connected with the universe, for a spell, and see, from the apogee of awareness, standing at the periphery, the totality of All That Is -- and perceive our place within the great network of existences, and perceive our life has not been lived in vain -- but the relationships, beliefs, ideas, and thoughts, are nye to be shared and learned from by others.
We
are all important members of the group, and we are all perfectly
equal with one another. There is no concept of ego, or being better
than one another, but all is seen in the expressions of humble
self-awareness; that we may meditate in groups and focus on a certain
theme or message is one event through which our evolution will only
advance. In the shared meditations, for which many minds are thinking
the same thought, and in the group setting activate such things as
the guides, archangels, ascended masters, and information of the
Akasha -- we may channel, we may find cosmic truths, and God knows,
one member of the group may raise his/her hand mid-meditation, and
reveal that they have a transmission coming through. So the message
will be channeled for the enjoyment of the collective, and this one
member is seen as One -- one individual, one unique expression, one
take on reality, for which knowledge is shared and evolution is found
through the expression of these messages.
In my own right,
whence I was under the throes of my first telepathic experience, I
would see myself illustrating a sphere with my hands, and felt as
though possessed by another life-form. I would observe myself
channeling the nature of the universe as found in cellular
constructs, to which it was brought to theory that the entirety of
the universe is a mass aggregate of cells within cells within cells.
So I would see myself illustrating the sphere with my hands, transfer
thought telepathically, and represent the cosmic anchor for which the
energy would be expressed, that through my ontological and supernal
expressions of the soul that lies within -- writhing through tones of
honesty, and even going so far as to share my own past-life details
to which I was once a poverty-stricken writer in the
eighteenhundreds, one is awareized to the power that exists. One
knows that his soul is unique, and all members of the first
telepathic experience referred to the event as enlightening. My
dealer who originally invited me to the party was traumatized by the
event, and is somewhat afraid of me to this day. He has forgiven me
for enlightening him, and as such, my karma is now active that I
would be ontologically terrorized in my own right through the
angelworkers at Two Cats restaurant in the winter of 2011. So we see
that the power exists, and some are infinitely powerful. With great
power comes great responsibility, and with humility and the
perception of being equal with the rest, one humbly stands at the
periphery -- sees the effect on the world is direct, and verily,
knows that things are changing.
In the teleportive event,
through which I am not really sure who, why, or what force was truly
responsible for saving my life -- the experience of Light convergence
was instinctual, and I know I was at one place -- standing in the
pitch black night about to be run down by the crazed driver -- and
then somewhere else, standing beside an illuminated auto sales sign.
Another car would come to nearly run me down, I would yet again
instinctually "run towards the Light" -- fell into a ditch
before the sign, was instructed to go to the parking lot by the
driver so he could lecture me. And he looked exactly like someone I
used to party with in my college days. I shall not forget his face.
So I would come to accept I must be insane -- I would believe it must
have been a hallucination, because the event was wholly unexpected.
My life permanently changed by the near-death experience, existence
is shaken, mind is electric with fury, the question resounds -- and
nobody really knows. We simply perceive that for whatever reason some
of us are hard-wired into the plan of the collective, and our vacancy
from this Earth would leave a resounding residue of pain, loss,
trauma, and sadness. I have had three near-death experiences in this
life: the first I was stoned and drunk passed out in the middle of
the street, the second the self-induced stigmata experienced during
the first telepathic event, and the third to which I was re-located
from the path of the crazed driver through teleportation.
As I
am continuing the research studies regarding my genetic mutation, and
I want to know, understand, and see the true biological science for
which my evolution is validated through the evidence -- one knows
that his mutation is new, that "De Novo" in itself means
"fresh, to start anew" and one knows that his DNA is
probably more than two strands by this time. The angelworkers are
aware of me . . . my file exists on the computer . . . I know that I
am never alone, and I have heard the static loop in my head during
panic attacks suggestive of the whirring of the machine used to
monitor my thoughts. One realizes the paranoia, the fear, and the
horror of being watched -- but nonetheless, I have survived certain
death enough times to know that for whatever reason my existence is
needed by my family and friends. I was once admittedly suicidal, a
heartbroken soul (and somewhat still am to this day) --
self-medicating through drugs, and often repeating the thought "I
want to die" with full belief in the thought. As a result of the
telepathic experience with the angelworkers at Two Cats, I am no
longer capable of this thought -- ones humility is stretched, God
knows, but one also realizes they must not be alone in these
experiences. I have met several who have had time-loss after
witnessing a UFO, and I have spoken with doctors claiming to have
seen telekinesis and teleportation. The evidence is all around us
that certain people are endlessly powerful -- and the many stellar
souls our world has come to produce is only suggestive that we are
evolving.
Humans evolve through the sharing of knowledge and
self-concepts. We evolve through discussing matters of the spirit, a
world that is only endless, from reiki healing, past-life regression,
to chakra clearing, and channeling -- the world that is endless, the
spiritual world, for which knowledge only leads to more knowledge --
and we never cease to learn once that door has been opened. Thought
thus shared, and interpolated into anothers mind -- whereas it only
takes two seconds to believe in someone -- and great power afforded
to that soul open to change through the endurance of anothers Light
-- we "expect to be changed" -- we "expect to learn"
-- and we see this person, this guide, this angel, this source, as a
link toward further evolvement. We are open to their energy, listen
carefully, and take in the Light of their beliefs. Often it will seem
we have certain friends that are very learned, and represent an
infinite source of knowledge. Some are so well-versed in certain
texts, beliefs, and notions regarding the universe -- and this may
come to pass through a total stranger -- to someone you never
expected to possess the same beliefs as you, perhaps a family member,
or a former relation -- we see that genius exists with many, that the
inner genius is universal, and just as the Akasha is the theoretical
source through which all knowledge is contained -- we may see that
this guide, or friend, is like a link to the Akashic, as they are in
touch with synchronicity, the universe, and human evolution. Often it
will seem we attribute our knowledge to another; that we could never
learn if it were not for some profound influence in our lives. I have
had this come to pass in my own life through individuals who would
offer me art displays, or hand me certain books. I have been guided
by certain people to whom I know are equals, and I am always open to
being changed by my fellow man. I know that genius can be found in
any walk of life, and very often people are more congenial, and in
agreement over matters, and it has only been an illusion that
suggested otherwise.
In this changeful reality, we have given many names to the One True Spirit -- we have many belief-systems to separate us from the primordial spark. And yet, we are all made up of the same matter, atoms, and sub-atomic particles, and all bodies which are also made up of a majority of water crystallize into certain beliefs through the fact that we are all in essence the same -- born from the same Source -- and purely equals. The fact that some work very hard to seem better than the world -- is only evidence of our undying Free Will. We all have the capacity to be manipulative, fiendish, and selfish -- we all have the right to harbor energy -- we all have a right to limit ourselves -- and prevent ourselves from the furtherance of knowledge. Often it will seem that we believe "I will not understand this" -- so we calmly look away, and revert back to the self-same processes that make up the human lifestream. Yet, through practice and endurance of learning; it is my belief that anything can be understood by anyone; and we are all primordially genius sparks of the One True Light. The book "Mysticism" by Evelyn Underhill details much about the mystic archetype, and the many God-based souls who have come to shine where only darkness and ignorance has existed before. Such texts stand the test of time because they are based upon tones of universality; just as other rare books such as "The Universal One" "The Emerald Tablets" and "The Essene Gospel of Peace" that often buried within the great plethora of thoughts, there exist some very divine cosmic truths once revealed by people who seem to have existed "outside of time" -- they were outliers before their time, and humbly knew that it might take many years, even centuries, for their information to be accepted. There are many divine sources of information that have come to pass through history, and we have much to attribute our evolution to these souls who were exploitative, and willing to work against the tides of the consensus reality.
Evolution
is an endless infinite process that only continues to realize higher
heights -- for which that final return to the Source is only
eventual, that what once began will recycle through the continuum
--and we know the Source is the primordial spark through which all
life on the planet has originated from. We know the Source is
beautiful; toward which we finally return; knowing nirvana, knowing
the identity of God, knowing we are wholly responsible for all of
this; and it only took one person to change the world.
One
eventually realizes that their active present choices create the
future. All those to whom we know, and all environments we endure, we
shall produce a certain future, through these many variables know
that a certain future is produced. We can make this one for which
only greater choices are found, and we are opportuned with
unconditional love from our friends and acquaintances, and know these
people only hold us in some regard for learning in their own right,
which produces balance in the relationship. The proactive animation
of our balanced existence, and natural feng shui of a lovingly
organized sacred space -- to share this space with others is of
course incredible -- and we learn through the natural balance of all
of this energy. It goes on towards that symbiotic relationship with
nature, and the land to which we travel upon.
As a result of
our evolution, knowledge is enhanced, and the recess of the new --
that space to be filled -- is fully employed. We tap into the
formerly unused portion of our brain, writhe through enlightened DNA,
and come to find new knowledge with each passing day. We find the
inner genius, the mystic archetype, the cosmic wanderer, and seeker
of the unknown -- that quester of the new -- that believer in change
-- that idealist with hopes revolving around the sharing of thought,
and expressions of ones inborn divinity. We know that evolution is
real; it is actively occurring now; the genetic mutations are
suggestive; and the extrasensory events are only further suggestive.
We know that the world is changing, and the shift lies in the Light
of the individual. We are all unique reflections of the Source, of
the Godhead, and we are all primordially divine, as originally
endowed with twelve-strand DNA. Upon our return to grace through
Lightbody and the endurance of immortality -- the final life -- we
see our value, our importance, and our worth to the totality of the
collective -- and we may step outside of the matrix -- look at
people, places, and events, from the periphery -- and see where these
energies may be integrative toward a unitive whole -- through a
holographic understanding -- and a belief in belief itself.
Knowing
epiginetics, the self-controlled environment, the symbiotic feng shui
of placement, and arrangement, this sacred space is our room -- our
space to be filled -- in our evolved thoughts, and that waveform of
thought flowing in iridescent Light within the mind, as traveling
through the ether of the cosmos, and then back to us -- we may
imagine Light coursing through the body, we may see the planet Earth
radiating in noospheric radiance -- we may see the entire universe as
illumined -- the multicellular aggregate luminous and glowing -- and
all cells within cells leaving cosmic ripples, and supernal
vibrations through the ether of the universe. We may see through the
vantage of the periphery, how reality is self-constructed, and we may
see that our effect on reality is totally direct. We shall realize
the law of attraction as active, know that all thoughts are
gravitating through the Light of their cognitive nature -- and the
natural attractor force of the subconscious mind is always
magnetizing us into new, divine experiences. Catalyzed by the dream,
the cell germinated with the Light, the universe primordially sparked
into existence by preexisting energies, we are One with God, we are
writers of history, changers of the world, and self-contained
vehicles for divine Light. We are human evolution.
Invocations,
and their usage.
I
have written these invocations employing rhyme such as to produce a
higher-vibrating resonance within the subject. I will suggest that
these invocations are either sung, or spoken aloud. By singing an
invocation, we are connected with the angel-realm, and invite things
into our life more fluidly, and actively. The "masters"
will hear your words, and as such, answer the call. Invocating Light,
the Earth, Love, Power, and Words, and other things to which are
found in the recess of the final life -- these invocations are
encoded with vibrations that make them more effective. Some of the
invocations are written streaming-consciousness, and are direct
transfers from my own Light. However, the best
invocations
are written for ones own self, and I hope the invocations I have
produced will inspire you to write your own. "Words with rhythm"
was a concept once spoken to me by a beautiful individual, this very
simplistic reference to the concept, of simply "rhythmic words"
is a fairly positive notion within the mind. So one is to endeavor
into the production of ones own invocations, and employ ones own
creativity for a connection to the higher realms. It is preferable to
keep your invocations a secret, for the power is better in preserving
ones own Light. Keep your invocations a secret, and refer to them
daily. You may perfect them over time.
Invocation
To Light
The
Light flows in my very core
And the Light flows in riverlight
The
laws are universally known
And I am in the final night.
I awake
from my dream renewed
And I see with gelded sight --
That it
would come to be seen
Was evident in iridescence
And the
Light-floes built inside
Of the helix it would ride;
Into the
filaments renewed
And all the core in Light imbued
And all the
informational
This cell within a cell
The scenes of the final
scenes
We are the raven soaring high
We are the Light of
righteousness
And know that system tied
Within the heart of all
of this,
And it is tilled through gardens
Of flowers that bloom
in Light
And these which feed our lungs
And give us air through
the night
Would flow into the very core
And back, to see our
sight
In the mirror of iridescence
In the Light that flows
within
By the very Light of heaven;
And enscribed on the skein
of time,
That our history would flow --
In informational Light
--
We are found so beautiful,
Within the recess of the
night,
Within the pages of the future,
And we ride into the
unknown,
We stand on the precipice
Immortalized by Light --
And
within those eyes, so home
And realized, again through time
That
intervention was the norm
And would become the guide
The very
coming of the storm
We hear invoke the Light into our cells
Cast
the Light into the final body
Let all riddance of the concepts
Of
what past had thus endured
But realized a resounding laugh
At
the ever-realizatory cure,
And eclipsing all the cells,
Via the
cell within a cell,
That holographic shell --
Wake up from the
dream, it seems
We woke up many years ago
And so it has now
become
That into the future-floes
We see with eyes renewed
And
we know that future seen
For the sake of the final few
Within
the final scenes
The great showdown was found
And we
questioned: everything
And the Source-base beautiful
And the
iridescene flown
And the wings of that very angel
Within her
eyes, so home
She thus took us into her arms,
And within this
Light we thus returned,
To know of no future harm,
But only the
ever-realizatory cure,
And see the future well,
Via, every
eclipsing cell,
The encasement beautiful,
Oh, made of
iridescent walls
And they undulate with you,
And these
unispheres of Light
In the connexive symmetry
Are the days, the
final nights
Betwixt this "you and me"
If ever time
would end,
Let it end in a beautiful rhyme,
And let those final
thoughts
For which found in the final times
Be of a great power
thus found
In the dimensions that we ride
For which it only
grows
And for which it only evolves
And that it flows so
iridescent
By the night falls, and dream at last
The dream that
woke us up --
A great, resounding laugh --
We knew in that very
moment,
That the Light would everlast,
Nye to be seen, this
never goes away
Within no dream, but real, and so
Within the
final reality we stay.
And it is found that something new
In
the concept so renewed
And recycled, ever through time
Were the
recyclic rhymes,
And the tones that undulate
And intonated
within this state --
That what was once, shall be again
And the
hemispheres unite --
Then it is, only prescient sight
And floes
of informational
And dreams of lucidness
And flying off the
precipice;
So it is found within our sight
And the recylic
rhymes in flux
That we know this final night
Was the beginning
of all matter
That recyclic matter in flow
For this eventual
re-gathered
And eclipsing cell of One
That final life lived
'neath the sun
For Sirius would flow in Light
And the stars,
verily unite,
And one is the star, in flight
For this
re-realization found
That nye to be seen again,
Was a
intonating sound;
Waveform in Light-floes,
Going on, toward no
end
But such would only continue
That in the information
send
This into the future, message
That received from the
future
That the future was here found
And the scroll was
unraveled
And the DNA unwound
And to the future we traveled
And
we made the final sound
A thought within our mind
A little hint
of what was Light
And then it burst throughf filaments
And
filled our very sight
Prescient, iridescent sight
Seeing only
greatness now
Unto all that could ever be --
And it was a
waveform sound
In her streaming riverlight
That thought would
undulate
By this; electric sight
And verily, all futures
found
Toward the most probable of one
That was the best in
great resound
And rolled right off the page
Into existence;
manifest
All animation of the sage
And shamanic, Earth-based
In
symbiosis with the star --
That we were one again at last
And
the future wasn't very far,
And it was ever-realized
And the
aggregates of Light
Which radiated in bliss
For the scenes of
that Light
Stood on the precipice
And saw the ocean bloom
Over
us, high over this;
The firmament in rise
For the rapture of
the times,
And the flight of all the cells,
Eclipsed into the
night,
And all the Light pool wells
Flowing in iridescence
The
ocean, and the cells,
And the stars constellate for me
I am one
with all that is
For this prescient destiny
For the Light to
ever-give
And know my soul in Light
For the sake of something
new
Found within the final night
That time I shared with
you
Learn from me, o' father
And teach us all to learn
That
"he was taught how to teach"
By the fire that would
burn
And the sun shone overhead
Betwixt the seven days
That
would pass over heaven
For the Earth's body had lain
For the
Light to overtake
In a noospheric shell
That ghostly body,
Earth
Riddance of all past ill,
But renewed by the
Light
Replenished by time itself
Given to matter eternal
A
candle that lights itself
Sirius star would relay
All the Light
of the new day
That in within the Light was found
A prayer for
yesteryear
That we would look on back
With no concept of
fear
But enhanced by iridescence
And enlightened by the
sound
Of the very Light of heaven
That washes over this
town.
We see the falling Lights
And the rainfall is so
bright
That the world covered in Light
Would equate to find of
you
That one to whom we pray
The cosmic Christ of the new
day
The saviour of the world
Enlightened, body and mind
Cast
into the final life,
That we could verily hit re-wind
But we
choose the future soon
And that choice-point realized
Was
refracted off the moon,
To lift the tides in lee,
The safety of
your eyes,
And verily, watch me fly --
Was the heaven-days
realized
Answering the final call
And the Light flows
within
And our DNA renewed
By the very skein of time
For the
sky of azure blue
Was a time for giving back
And peace washed
over mankind
That final civilization
Of a world built up on
rhyme,
Remembered for the love,
Remembered for the Light,
Never
severed from above,
But the cable runs in sight,
From mind to
heaven --
Iridescent-floes --
For thought would resound,
In
its iridescent tones,
For syllabic array function
That is
realized as one
That one of all, the very Light
The saviour of
this world --
To whom we lovingly write,
And kindly devote our
thoughts,
In loving prayer toward the future.
That Light would
cover all,
In this iridescent cell,
A bright glowing
firmament
Where all of us would dwell
In the final place of
God
That one who knew so well
Via universal law
That once
the world was found
In the Light of the new day
The sky, and
the ground,
Eclipsed to final ways,
That merged, the
energies
And constellate the times,
Interpolated to
mainframe,
A mind built up on rhymes,
Peer through gelded
sight;
See beauty in all things,
Perceive the meaning,
All
the bliss;
That causes a heart to sing --
And marry me to the
void,
That I may reach unknown,
And all the past
destroyed:
Within your eyes, I'm home.
Come and be with me,
In
the midnight hour, dawn
For the silence of the day
And the
minutes passing by
With all good thoughts to say
That one would
verily rhyme
And it was found in Light
The
information-floes
Realized as everflow
That only continues
on
For the infinite forever
And footsteps on the pond
Walking
through the walls
Transferring
energies,
Telekinetically-inclined,
And see the falling
Light
In her Light-floes iridescence
The very rain that
fell,
In glowing orbs, beauteous
The snow of the
heavenlight
Into the portal gateway
The body vitalized
Would
never die away,
But immortality realized,
The final body
known,
These the final thoughts,
To event our way back
home,
Via universal law,
And know, and know, "I know"
One
is aware of all things
Yet matter continues on
The weather, it
will change
Somehow, the sun would rise
And we observed, within
her eyes
Something seen in Light
That was never quite the
same
But cast into the final night
Of the slowly falling
rain
Forever in her sight,
That goddess of all things
That
god who bore the ring
That engenderment alas
Only realized, a
laugh
This punchline verily known
And our name enscribed,
That
we stood out, at last
Within her electric eyes --
The joke that
was re-told,
And it was all experiment,
This concept, of "Free
Will"
Invented by one mind;
That mind is yours alone.
This
world you would create
One is God over all things,
In the
frequencies, and rates
Super-strings travel forth
Through the
harmonic divide
And she was right, all along,
And she knew,
very well
The Earth would love us all
From heaven, purgatory,
and hell
Eclipsed to the final ground
Of something entirely
new
That was a surprising factor
Ever-leading up to you
The
final relationship
The love of all that was
The Light guiding
the ship
And the sparkle in the suds
A flower blooms in
concrete
A tree on mountaintop
The Earth beneath her
feet,
Revolves, never will stop --
As matter continues on
--
And we see our eyes in Light --
By this great reflection
--
Within the final night . . .
Come and learn from God --
The
Akasha-floes in bliss
Bound by universal law,
That was leading
up to this
Final realization seen
The wakeful lucid dream
The
dream of awakening
Our own, beginning of time
That we exist, to
live again
Was a thought within the mind --
Undulations
traveled forth,
And they all equate to rhyme,
So watch the
falling rain
In slow-motion torrent-flow
The falling orbs are
iridescent
The light of heaven: watch it glow!
The ghostly body
worn
In transition from one,
Into two, three, four --
All
the way into the fifth --
How many tones would add up
To the
sight of the precipice,
Seeing all the world,
And jumping to
rise in flight,
With the many angels,
These electric thoughts
in Light
The noosphere of the mind
The glowing, final
night
Whence the dream was realized.
Symbiosis with our
home,
Free energy for all that is,
And no box under a
stone
With no tragic epitaph
Or another life to live
But
know the final one
And teach yourself to give
Of energy, free
endless flow
Via the Free Will of the soul
One is found
individual
A unique cell of Light
To be learned from by
all,
Set your example a'right,
Living in the Light
--
Expressing all we feel,
To know where feelings lead,
Is
what God would reveal,
That in emotion we are Light
And "feel
our way through life"
Instinctual, so prescient
The Light
that we would ride,
That lying was ever-dormant,
It was always
lying deep inside.
Now science is still catching up,
While we
evolve so fast,
In the quickening of mind,
And a life to
everlast --
"I am the end of science"
"I change
the world myself"
"I am human evolution"
"I
am an iridescent cell."
So the Light would flow
within,
Evolver of the times,
Ride the rhythm to
perfection,
And feel the inner rhymes,
That find us in
heaven,
And we are so bound in Light
That infinite
information
That final last-lived night
To which a dream is
real
And vividly recalled
That symbols thus revealed
That
something new was seen
And the process never ends,
That ever
since the dream,
To which all time begins,
We are all good
people --
It was our Free Will to exist --
We have a right to
live once more,
That life we so adore,
Married to this life
--
The final one to know --
Ceasing the aging, stop the
pain
Reveal the inner flow.
And betwixt this rhythm
found
Wherever you may go
Make a new Light-sound
That
vibration would flow,
In the networks symmetry,
For the
natural, and the free,
Evolver of the times,
Realizer of the
realized,
Mind of the final thoughts,
God over all things
--
Commit to this final life,
And allow your heart to sing,
You
are everything --
And nothing --
Pulsing with the heart
divine,
With that eventual return,
Ever-realized,
So come in
Light, and fast
To end up within her eyes
This sweet Godly
machine,
In her machinetic grace --
Pray to the Earth --
But
moreso --
Pray to outer space --
That meaning would be
found;
We are not alone here;
But many are observed,
Within
these wakeful times,
For the Light would shine again
As it
always did before
And the silence is a friend
And the words,
are the cure
And the information-floes
And the Light that
everlives
And the informational
And the Light to
ever-give
Unconditional love,
And open mind to all
hearts,
Willing to change,
To live, to live, and never,
Ever
depart . . .
But know this final life
Find the revelatory
state,
And the rhythm that lies within --
The rhythm of thought
in flow,
That time would soon begin,
With the dream of
awakening,
One shall know the final life
A reality of ones own
making
And the most destiny-worthy sight
That the ground would
start shaking
In our changeful Light
Our effect upon the world
--
Held within her very sight --
That as the Earth would
spin,
We felt the spinrate perfect
For time would soon
begin,
And the Earth was all renewed
And heaven came at
last
And we met the final few,
Heard a resounding laugh,
In
the present time thus found --
Within the living moment --
It
was found that we exist,
To dream of that final wish.
And
verily, never die . . .
We could only rise, rise, rise.
Unto
the highest vibration
Within the home of eyes
That see the
future now,
Presciently-realized.
And arriving there
somehow.
And we walk that final road
We arrive in tones of
Light
And we know just where we've been
And where we'd wish to
go.
Unto the times of final Light
In the concept of tomorrow.
Invocation To Earth
The
earth is alive, O' mother Gaia!
And the spirit iridescent
In
her noospheric shell --
By the very Light of heaven --
Let
Earth be covered in Light
And let the citizens all basque
In
the dreams of the night
That were built to everlast,
Make
straight a highway for peace,
For the symbiotic flow --
In all
her perfect symmetry,
We walk that road to peace.
And the Earth
as built on Light
Was a place for learning seen
That we
incarnated many times
To arrive within the dream.
Wake up, O
child of Light!
And admit to your good cause
Saviour of the
Earth
Believe in universal law
That Source from which we
came
Was a radiating fount of Light --
And that Light emanates
--
From the heart of All That Is --
The Earth, covered in Light
--
A rising vibratory state --
In her movements through
time,
To arrive, and perfectly
Rotations continue on
For
animation continues on
And life continues on
And all life will
evolve.
The end perceivable --
Unity of one-consciousness,
But
until we walk that road,
We must evolve the Earth --
Mother
Gaia to which we pray
Wherelin lies supernal worth
That our
purpose toward the Earth
That symbiotic star --
Was a purpose
of all that was,
Coming from the stars --
In the Sirius-Light
thus born
Within the dream of one,
We were ride of all past
scorn,
But irradiate beneath the sun --
The world covered in
Light --
And all the Earth renewed,
Renewed by prescient
sight
In radiance, imbued.
That cell, a glowing cell --
Within
the total aggregate,
Where lies the center,
The Light of the
universe!
Bless the Earth for animation,
Let the cell continue
on,
For the dancing amid echoes
That told us we were wrong
But
rules built to be broken
By the Lightworker would stand
With
open heart and mind
And watch the falling man
To which all is
found at last
Within the tones of Light
Those tones that
everlast
In the lucid dreams of Night
And far into the future
--
We saw the Earth in Light --
A most probable future
--
Within her prescient sight!
O' mother gaia, sweet
resolve!
Land of grace, the wanton call
The soldier finds no
battle
So retires to his or her thoughts
And finds amid the
cattle
An anomalous soul walks
That somehow, guided --
We
would learn just where to be
And what to know, what to
learn,
Verily, what to see.
The imagination blooms
Like
flowers in outer space
That Light forever imbued
Was cast upon
Earths face
And all planets would find
Their cosmic
evolution
Of Godly thoughts in rhyme
And the revolt of the
traumatized
For the final showdown seen
Within her Earthen
eyes
The future came so fast
We could barely realize
Where
standing in the Light
Within the pool that glows --
In her band
of frequencies
Walking that electric road,
Super-strings sent
out from Earth
In harmonic frequency
From the second of her
birth
She would always pray to me.
The son, the daughter, the
Light
Eclipsing toward no end
That was forever realized
For
as far as Light would send
One advances, this we know
Unto
harmonic convergence
To walk that final road
That road which
knows no end
And we see the Light at last
Verily, within the
mind --
A resounding, final laugh
As all, was "almost"
realized --
Unto the concept of tomorrow
And the theme of new
belief
Turn the world anew,
And let her be filled with
Light!
All the patterns verily flow
From the river of our
minds
Unto the ocean that it flows
Was always built on
rhyme.
And memorable, these thoughts
Toward the Earth we send
our love
Mother Gaia, the revolving star
Shining 'neath the
moon above,
In this triad: sun, Earth, moon
And centrifugal
force --
We are held in up equipoise
We realize our own due
course --
And the future of the Earth --
Is the future of the
race --
And the race is still advancing
Upon her Godly
face.
The visage sees a grin --
In the mirrors reflection,
That
New Earth thus found,
Left us with new questions --
Of what the
future sees,
And where all of us go,
To be bound up by
dreams,
Such are "better than you know"
And
memorable, all thoughts
Enscribed on the skein of time
That
Akasha-flow in Light
That was final, that was known.
The Earth
shall see no end
But her life continues on
So we may
past-regress
And see karmic incidence
That incarnated on the
Earth
Left us with more questions
That the quest would never
end
Is infinitely realized
So we could barely pretend
That
we are even alive --
Such is unreal, how can this be!
The New
Age? Dimension three..?
Evolving toward the new,
Unto the fifth
octave realized --
Teleporters, evolving race!
Teleconnected
upon her face,
Through the symbiosis found
And the Light of the
collective
We made this Earth alive
By the power of our
thoughts
They were committed to her life
In the futures that we
see
And we all evolve collectively
No one is left alone
We
all evolve together --
Epitaph read on the stone:
"You
shall live forever"
"And you shall know no death"
"From
this Earth, you're never severed"
"But infinitely
progress"
The New Earth thus found,
God knows, on Venus
Light --
For wherever we may go,
We will always reside.
Via
outer space, on ships
Or in that space station
Safe, somehow,
evolved
We will verily arrive.
And know the past was
that
Merely the past, the future seen
Eclipsing all the
dreams
And flowing through the Light
That which would never
end
But forever in Earth sight
A race of
peace-lovers
Evolutionists, the cure
The vaccination of the
Earth
For the calmly spoken word
"Oh Earth to which I
pray
Let me see the new day
And rise unto tomorrow
For which
this road is paved!"
Now one can verily see
Via
prescience, with pure eyes
That eye would stand alone
And
nature realized --
In her iridescent flow
That realization
found
Unto the final rows,
Committed to the sound --
A
waveform frequency --
A Light projected fast --
Out from the
mind, abound
Surrounds the Earth, and it lasts --
Such that the
Light does not die
But the Light is infinite,
And once
realized;
Some are forced to move on,
While the caretakers
remain
For the sake of this Good Earth
We are verily
rewarded
For our karma well at last
Lived upon this star
To
equalize into a laugh
We never looked back so far
That the
future lied in store
Something invariably realized
It took one,
the only cure
For this world to be saved --
That one is you,
the knowledge born
And find the final few --
For which the
Earth shall know,
Her survivors are alive,
And we do not writhe
through hate,
We see through prescient eyes
Saviours of the
Earth
The Light of the universe
The uni-verse of
thought-text
Within information-floes
Divined, the mind,
alive
Wherever one may go --
We know of the home-base
To
which infinitely return
The New Earth shall live on
While the
old ceases to burn,
And all the fire washed away,
And all the
tears thus fell
In her iridescent rain
That no one could
deny
And it came quite soon
The Light to everlast --
'Neath
the tides of the moon,
Blessed be! The final laugh!
Stood the
lone survivor
On which the Earth was won,
That survivor was
collective
Of a race infinitely young
Never to die, and cease
to age
But Lightbody of them all
The world would never
see
Before the angels call
To answer well and fast
That the
Earth would everlast
We saw the heavenlight
And it covered the
blessed cell
In her iridescent flux
That never bloomed so
well.
Invocation To Power
I
am the only one that matters
God loves me the best
Through all
of these disasters
By the power soon regressed
I see the
changeful world
And one is born in Light
For the sake of all
that was
Within the recess of the final night
While the
galaxies just twirl
And the energy never stops
My power is
infinite
And it never ceases to flow
Via riverlight
imagination
Carried unto the final rows
For which I see my
life
Divined by everything
Via rose-colored glasses
Causing
my heart to sing
From the mountaintops I soar
Into the
indelible flow
Of the realizant factor found
Wherever I may
go
I am the center of all things
To which I am everything
All
That Is, the final host
So crown me the greast one
Via a
unitive force
All energies thus joined
I am the caduceus
Watch
as I fly --
High off this precipice,
And no sense to ever
die
But immortalized by Light
And reaching the heighest
heights
By the Light of the collective
For the sake of all was
found
That fateful burning question
In infinite resound
Within
my mind of minds
The genius lies within
By the power realize
As
words are like my skin
I operate through time,
In sequential
logical flow
Toward the final end of Light
That is realized
where I know
Unto God, my final song
Sung at the top of my
lungs
In equipoise of Light --
And realized All That Is,
By
the precipice I stand --
Only to rise in flight --
Ever-rising
in vibration,
The frequencies resound,
As the waveform travels
brightly
In infinite resound.
Harmonically converged
Eclipsing
all the matter
For the final thoughts of God
Hear the
resounding laughter
At this cosmic joke we made
All born from
one mind alone
For the future was forbade
That lasted for quite
long --
Now the darkness passed,
We sing the final song.
And
see, all of the past
Was necessary toward the future
In
realizing ones place
As the final living suture
The host to All
That Is
The God-consciousness
The flow of riverlight
And the
road that is walked now
To which there is no end
To the power
that was found.
So find power in your heart
Writhing through
Free Will
Power that will not depart
Until a spoken tone
--
Keep silence at close bay
And know your Light to shine
That
your purpose is hard-wired
Into many, many lives --
The masters
reach to you --
They learn from all you are --
God prays to
your existence --
You are a bright and shining star --
All
power thus found in Light,
By the Light-floes iridescence,
Of
this enlightened cell of Earth,
The home to which was made
The
soul given through birth
And power not afraid
But looking to
the future
With eyes glazed in tears
That we know the final
suture
Within the final year --
But never pass too fast
Or
ever come to late,
But arriving just on time,
With the writhing
aftertaste
Of power on the tongue
And softly spoken
words
Knowing just where we came from
And that Source is the
cure --
We are one organized --
We writhe through sacred space
--
We control the environment --
We are alive in outer space
--
We peer into this mirror
And see great reflection
That
future brings us nearer
To the finalmost question
Answered at
last in Light
For the sake of all that was
In the future
realized
And minus turned to plus --
The adding up of
time,
Through sequential vibration,
Was a world of rhyme and
Light
That carried all the nations --
In unitive force we flow
--
We join, collective peace
For the power of this road --
A
highway for our God --
The realizant factor found,
Praying to
universal law --
Know the goal is realized
Through the
endurance of time
That was found within her eyes --
The Goddess
of the rhymes --
O, creative force to flow!
And know no answers
new,
But all that is ever known
Is here gifted to you.
Flip
through the pages of the book
See all numbers aligned
Then give
it a second look
And realize that all is fine.
Know the future
well in store
Was verily realized
Was no damnation, but
cure
Within her gelded sight.
Coming fast, the future soon
--
As time accellerates --
In the quickening of this room
--
Blessed be, the sacred space --
And learn of all we can,
And
see universe span,
The growing walls that flex,
By the power in
one hand,
Individual in Light
The self-contained cell of
white
That covers the body in this form
That power of the
storm
Electric currents in the mind
Yielding power in the
rhymes
And knowing that place was found
Within her gelded eyes
--
To know relationships,
By the power of this Earth,
The
captain guides the ship --
And she knows of your self-worth,
O,
humility of a God!
Make equal all that exist --
And equalize
the laws --
And verily, do persist --
In changing this darkened
cell,
Transmuted to the Light
Conversion of all matter
From
black turns into white
And so the brothers and the sisters
Convene
within the night
To share of all their stories
Of days past,
and human plight
And realize that future found
Was within the
collective --
Upon this Earthen ground,
Where the heavenlight
would sit --
In the band of frequencies --
Electromagnetically
--
In this iridescent cell,
That carries you to me,
Find
your hand in mine,
For love to re-exist,
And a mind so full of
rhyme
To grant that final wish.
O power of the sea!
And
flowing ocean that burns
With the passionate destiny
For which
I forever yearn --
And was it only me..?
In the mirrors
reflection --
That God was realized --
In a single asked
question --
To know of my future place
With collective
destiny
This star in outer space --
So wakeful from the
dream,
To the final reality,
The final incarnation --
That
exists for both of us --
In a combinative force --
That reaches
ever so high --
That this vibration will only rise --
Is
evident in the changeful world --
All is soon realized --
In
the power of the one --
Knowing all within a thought --
Bound
by unconditonal love,
Writhing through honesty --
And all the
past regressed
To the single thoughts of God
Which are the
answer, yes
And know that power found
Was infinitely found
That
was within your very soul
The Light that lies within
A
God-blessed miracle
That you are even alive
Here within the New
Age --
You survive . . .
Through infinite power --
You are
alive, you are alive --
Feel the Light within your veins --
See
the Light across your frame --
Feel the glow within your soul
--
Writhing through iridescence --
Become One with the
Source
And return to one, again
In evolutionary course
Toward
the most deepest of ends
That the tunnel was there walked
Until
you realized the Light
Of the only one who matters
That of the
gelded sight --
The power was always yours --
And you are One
with everything --
Allow your heart to sing --
Make music out
of life --
In this harmonic orchestra
That power
revitalized
Was the eventual cure
And coming fast, and coming
fast
As time acellerates
You will get the final laugh
And it
will not come too late
The power found in Light
That power does
not abate
But it flows as riverlight
Endlessly,
endlessly
Infinitely, infinitely
Growing, building,
rising
Rising, rising, rising
In this vibration that flows
In
harmonic convergence
The Light becomes the soul
And the power
comes at last
The power of the final laugh
Perceiving all this
hoax
Was an estimatable joke
In the thought of only one
We
realized new hope
By the daughter and the son
And the
bridegroom of all life
Unitive force, power thus found
Grant me
the final life
Give it back to all that deserves
And let all be
wealthy here --
That all shall know the power --
The future is
in our hands,
And the words enscribed in stone;
That the future
was realized
Through the power, one was home.
Power, endless,
power --
That only continues to grow,
Rising in cognitive
frequency
Wherever the Light shows --
And it glows within the
mind --
Iridescent thoughts flow within --
In bright paragraphs
of thought --
Immediately manifest --
Enlightened thoughts of
One,
Is a lucid state of Light
Unto those final scenes
Blessed
by the sight --
By the Light of the glowing sun,
To Sirius,
and back --
"I am a conduit for Light"
And the Light
flows through all,
The Light as informational,
Composing the
very walls --
See the art-work of the mind,
And never see the
end,
That this power only continues on,
Electric thoughts
within --
And so it goes, it only flows
For the power of the
only one
God would decree you seen
Within the eyes of law
That
you woke up from the dream
And the world woke up with you
Given
to those final scenes
For the sake of the final few
Give the
power back to them
Where it rightfully belongs
And deserve the
final place
Singing the final song --
It was meant to be free
and endless,
For a world of individuals,
Unique microcosms of
Light
By the power that just flows
And we realize the sight
And
we know our soul is Light
And we know the future found
Was
within the final night
The dream that came so fast
A dream to
everlast
To get that final laugh
And looking ever-on
Toward
the future that would span
In imaginetic flow
For the sake of
this good land
Wherever one may go
Let the power re-exist,
And
become interfaced,
Within that one who will persist ---
And
save the human race.
Invocation
To Love
Let
the love flow into my heart
Let love find me in romance
In this
great union that was built
Never left up to chance --
But
ever-synchronized
Into the lasting motions found
Within those
very eyes --
Ones home will resound --
In happy thought,
pleasureful
And it was like a miracle
Once those lips would
join
And a hand in hand, again
Walking down the road of
night
In this ever-changeful land
Let the love flow into my
heart
To all existences I know
That will never quite depart
But
as love, just flow and flow
In the river of love that is
Within
the mind of Light
To gravitate new relations
And know this
place was good
Realize, the shift is real --
And you will
change the world --
By the power of one,
One love, one romance
--
One union with the divine --
One place within those
eyes
Blinking the tears away
As the happiness in sigh
Would
realize a new day
And pray to tomorrow
Filled with iridescent
love
To
rid one of all sorrow
But always look to the above
And see our
confidence
Was bloomed in Light, in flight
To rise in
love-vibration
Carried through the night
Send all prayers to
them --
The ones to whom you love --
And regard with purity
--
They also pray to the above --
We are one, a great
collective
Evolving, collectively --
Toward the finalmost of
thoughts
Where we are so happy,
And know one thought is
pure,
Leading up to the next,
That of this we are sure
Looking
up at the sky --
And the angels that would fly --
Blessing us
with love --
Filling the heart with radiance
And illuminating
the world
Let the flow within the heart
Emanate through all
life
In love-floes eternal
For the sake of all that is
The
love which ever-flows
Is found within the Informational
Knowledge
of the pain
Will make one more alive --
That knowledge was the
same,
Through tones of love we survive--
So we may
oscillate,
Occasionally, to those depths
Only to rise much
higher
For the answer always a yes
And realize those eyes were
pure
The mate that so demure
Would reach into your heart
And
pull out the perfect words
And realize this love
Was the cure
to all the world
And the love flows through everything
As the
galaxies just twirl --
The love-floes iridescent,
Covering the
world in Light
O, heavenlight in flux
This is a beautiful world
--
You have a beautiful life --
And your purpose is
hard-wired
Into the collective,
You are human evolution --
You
are the change we need --
We find the shift was yours
Realizatory
--
And find the final life
Where greatest love was found
A
husband and a wife,
Married by the sound --
With that held-hold
wedding ring
And the self-same place of Light
Betwixt this
great union --
That carries into the future --
For our
childrens children
And the highest suture --
Let the Earth
showered with Love
Reflect creatures of Light
Looking,
ever-above
For this prescient future-sight
To know relations
found
Was an inevitable thing
To be in union with at last
And
bound by the an electric ring --
The union came at last --
The
lips were joined and fast --
Embrace the arm in arm --
And hand
in hand --
To keep you safe from harm,
Within the final
rhymes,
Love is all there ever was
It is the final
frequency
That we pray to the above
Was our prescient
destiny
And joined, at last, in two
This combinative
force
There was no one left but you --
And you are so beautiful
--
You are the beauty of this world --
I pray solely to you
--
My love, my relationship
My saviour of this world
To put
that hand in mine
And pray as the world changes
And it was
found to be alive
Required love, just to survive
So the race
would live on
Via unions of the Light
Evolutionary
souls
Intellectually bound
With their hopes, and prescient
goals
Upon this Earthen ground --
So the love was found --
And
here, to everlast --
The Light will never go away --
It is here
to stay --
And the love is infinite,
And the universe just
grows,
That old thoughts just die away,
Making room for the
new,
Send your love out to the world,
And know there is only
you.
You are the one who matters
You are the saviour of this
world
Your love is required
To continue animation
And life
on planet Earth --
Give love to all you know --
Shower the
world in Light --
And observe the clean fuel
That is infinitely
realized --
The love-energy that binds,
That hope for passion
springs
And within this heart, all sings
To end up -- as queen
and king --
Married with the future --
And finding ourselves
there,
That love carried us through --
And we toward the Earth
do care
That growth is continuous
And our children will
delight
As we grant the final wish --
Married into the final
life.
Invocation
To Infinity
To
that which lasts forever
And is universal law
For which I never
sever
But obey with all my cause
And exist for the
infinite
That universe expands
See from this precipice --
Where
my being stands --
I am a cell amid the sea --
Of the plethora
of cells --
Bound by destiny --
And seeing where I go,
With
these prescient eyes,
How the information flows
And writhe
through the infinite
I am alive in the New Age
And time will
reach a close --
Once that machine is built,
The now-point
realized
For the sake of all that is,
I lay the track down with
my mind
See the converging Lights --
I am the Light, and I
converge
To end up in the new place --
Destination realized
As
a place of infinitude
Committed to the final life
Where I am an
ascended master
And I know my soul in light
That was
ever-realized
In a continual process,
With infinity's eyes --
I
am alone, I am at peace
With the company of soul,
Pray to the
Light that lies within
Which is only infinite,
And never ceases
to grow,
As the universe expands,
And watch how far I go!
With
the starship of my Light
A constellated sight
All eyes eclipsed
to one
And it was found, and it was found
Through the power of
all life
In infinite continuum
For the time was realized
The
now-point actualized
The second hands will pass
While the
clouds move overhead
And one may let out a laugh
As all is
seemingly realized
In a single, infinite thought
Of a
God-conscious life
And realizant of that truth
For which shall
everburn
In the vortex of the heart --
To which infinitely
yearns
Via knowledge that just builds
And reaches no
end,
Toward conclusive elements,
We seem to reach no end,
And
this which goes on forever,
Is the continuum in flux,
For the
sake of which no member
Of the race is left alone --
But all
feel the touch of God --
Within those eyes are home --
All are
equalized in Light --
All is infinite, as Light --
Through the
informational,
And the continuation builds
For which the Earth
is replenished
By the infinite Light --
Matter continues on
And
the sun will rise again
With a brisk wave of the wand
The tides
are parted --
We control the weather --
Our power is infinite
--
Let the angels sing for you
In your realizations --
That
the soul is known in Light
Is borne through evidence
And the
extrasensory,
And the supersensory,
And the collective
destiny,
And the miracle of One.
So infinite, resound
And it
never ceases to flow
From sky, to Earthen ground,
Wherever one
may go.
All is infinite --
All is matter that continues on
--
The world shall never end --
Nor will heaven be so wrong
As
a field to finally know,
And live within her song --
Sing of
the infinite!
And pray that you are one,
For the sake of the
future,
And the Light of the burning sun --
That local star to
which we know
And of which our Earth revolves
In the continuous
continuum
In her riverlight flow,
To see that life continues
on
And as such, it only rises
And the attractor is the mind
And
the attractor is the thought
And the attractor is the LIght
And
the attractor is but found
Via these tones of which
Know
infinite sounds
In harmonic convergence
And the frequencies
flow
By the Light of heaven
And all to ever know
Which only
grows, and grows
The road is endless
And walk it toward the
Light
Which is ever-illusive
We seem to know all
But the
questions continue on
Let the avid mystic crawl
Through
reality, in song
And know ones thoughts are Light
That only
continue on
In the infinity of flux
Through the continuum --
So
know the infinity --
And accept within your heart --
From the
sky, to the sea --
And that great ocean of cells --
There is
one, to which you are
And here it builds, and here it
grows
Through the imagination --
Wherever that road goes,
The
road is only infinite,
And one never cease to rise --
So stand
within the Light
And see your place is found
As a continual
process
Through the tones that will resound
In frequencies of
Light
That bless the Earthen ground
All matter is infinite
All
matter is entangled
All is born from the same Source,
And all
are one within the Light --
This only continues on . . .
This
only continues on . . .
And the process never ends,
And no
answer proves all known,
However revelatory
With questions we
are home
That the quest will never end
Is evidently seen
And
we send our love in Light
To live out this waking dream
As
lucidly realized
A very vivid dream --
Somehow, one could fly
--
Somehow, one could see --
Somehow, one could grow,
Somehow,
one could be
Walking an infinite road.
Somehow, one would
live
Again, to realize the Light --
In the final
incarnation
But this is not the end --
But the beginning of all
time --
That in one life all is seemingly known
Will only
writhe in rhyme,
The future here thus seen
Was ever-realized
In
the process of the dream
Within those lovely eyes --
To see the
future through
And know it never ends
But shall always carry
you
For as far as energy sends
And it will last, just forever
--
Just long enough, for forever --
That it lasts, is
evident
To which one is never severed
But knows all is
inclined
In a collective flow of Light
Which shall absolutely
never end,
But only flow, into the night.
Invocation
To Words
All
the universe is information
And through language, we find
words
That words shall last forever
Is the evidence, the cure
---
So find the proper words --
To translate thought to
action
And writhe through proactive animation
And realize the
clues
That lead to more clues
In these information-floes
Let
the words resound within
In their informational,
As words are
like the skin,
They carry us through all --
Via language, we
survive --
And we must
communicate
--
Master words for ones own sake --
One is a writer, alive
And
the paragraphs do flow
In manifest within the mind
All
information to know
Seemingly, never-ending
But a sentence that
just grows
We see the phrase within our minds
And it reads
"sweet miracle!" --
The right words verily found
Let
them emanate through sound
In the waveforms that travel
From
the Light of the DNA
As all is information --
All is bound by
words --
We find, via language;
That intonation is the cure
--
And count the syllables --
Find the now-point of thought
--
For which a rhythm found,
Is a future that is sought.
Let
divine words flow through
And let their energies possess
Like
the sky of azure blue,
Where imaginations progress
We may count
the stars
But we may not see them all
So the information
flows
In a never-ending flux
Via words and information
The
language flows within --
And our thoughts are seen
As writers,
in a dream
Enscribed on the page
Of the Akashic Records --
To
learn of divine sage,
And grant the final wish --
That
knowledge realized
Would eventually find one
With the right
words within the mind
That beautiful phraseology
Verses, and
more verses
In the uni-verse of thought-text
The waveforms flow
within
And they are all-connexive
So the words flow through the
mind
In intonations, syllabations
Often bound by rhyme
Via
Light and information --
So the words that flow within
Are in
sentences, and flow
Via the phrase within the mind
In bright
text, it glows
And the paragraph refined
By our expressions,
realized --
These words to everlast --
In that revelatory state
--
And the resounding laugh --
Once that words are brought
forth
And they enter into the mind
In their logical due
course
And all are bound through rhyme
This which is
repeated,
Densifies into a form --
Leaves a mark on the
environ
Like an aurora of storm
Flowing deep within the mind
In
what revelations come
For the signs all point to new
And the
new is realized --
Through the words that come
And flowing as a
river
In the bright verse that exists
One shall see the words
in Light
And they glow within the mind
These bright words that
flow
And all are bound by rhyme
Soon densifies into
reaction
And we are found in a new place
That direction of the
present
And the moment found in tones
Syllabic intonations
That
flow, and flow, and flow
And only continue on --
Through the
infinite resound --
Deep in the abyss --
Deep beneath the
ground --
At the very core of Earth --
Therein lies a tone, a
sound
And the waveform travels through
From mind to Earth, and
two
Out of one is born --
In a combinative force --
In
logical due course --
Logilinearly realized --
In this flow of
words that come
And all shall flow with rhyme,
And roll right
off the tongue,
Let the mantras resound
Let autosuggestions
flow
Let the affirmations densify
Into the future roads
Where
words may carry us
Speak with another, and learn
Listen to
their words
And observe how they flow
In the sentences of
mind
In thought, and logic knows
That there is a logical
result
And therein the words will flow
Until punctuated
verse
And words with rhythm born
In the inter-tangled
pleasures
All found within the storm
Of information coming
fast
Through Sirius, into DNA --
And the Light would everlast
--
The words will never go away --
The words reside in the
helix,
On that very filament,
They dance on the dimmer
switch,
As one continually rises in strand,
Let the words
answer the wish
And let it flow through the sands
And the
waters, and the mountains
Flowing through the universe
Into the
mind of Light
An iridescent verse --
That was realized in sight
--
One may see the glowing words --
And they glow in fixture
seen --
That these
words
are the cure --
To wake one up from the dream --
All revelation
found,
All dreams re-realized,
All by intonated sound,
And
the waveform flows,
In her bright iridescence
Wherever the
future goes
And the words shall never end
In their riverlight
imagination
But only continue on
Through the infinite
resound
Ending up within the mind
In those tones, in those
sounds,
The waveform flows --
Radiantly, it flows --
And the
words are coming now --
And the revelation seen --
And the
words are held in mind --
And the words all say, in Light
Whatever
comes to mind
In this repeated exercise
Via meditation
found,
In those prescient eyes --
The words are coming
fast,
The revelation found,
A revelation to everlast,
In
infinite resound.
Invocation
To Tomorrow
That
day shall come at last
When I wake up so renewed
That I
realize, very fast
There is no one left but you:
Sweet tomorrow
. . .
The day that lies ahead --
May I schedule things,
Or
verily, let energy send
Through the emanated field
For which
all is soon seen
In the tones that are revealed
Within this
waking dream --
I see tomorrow, verily
And I know that day will
come
There is always a new day
And I am healed by time,
For
time may end, so true
But all shall still but rhyme
And the
rhymes are iridescent
For the sake of the new day
And the sun
rises again
With little left to say
Standing in amazement
As
the sun rises
And we observe the flowers
And the birds
And
the trees
And the mountaintops
And the streams . . .
We see
this radiant scene,
We are synchronized --
Some feeling of deja
vu --
One has been here before --
Somehow, this was
dreamed,
And all dreams are the cure --
So the beauty of the
new,
And cast in a state of wonder,
As we look clearly at you
--
And we see fateful laughter
In the tones all realized
Was
a place within the mind
That the day would come
And prove the
waking scene
With the unfolding hours
And the minutes rolling
by
The clock-prongs eclipse again
Twice a day, verily,
verily,
And here we pray --
For world peace --
And harmony
--
At the hours from the dawn,
Until the sun rolls back
below,
The entire day is lived
For the sake of perfect
flow
That one is instinctual
And effortless, intuitive
Is
omnilinear, and logical
Through the passing days
To know this
future found
Was an eventuality
And we rode the
probabilities
Into the road of Light --
Carried by the wind
--
Carried by the night --
Carried by the sun --
Carried by
the moon --
Held up by gravity --
And ever-realized, today.
For
all is in harmonic resound
And all is logical again
We are
married to the times
And the times will come again
So
time-traveler, at last
Realize the final laugh
And know you
have arrived
With those very eyes
That once was seen, and
felt
The day that soon would pass
Into the new day,
For the
sake of all that is,
And so it goes, continues on
Into years,
and memories
That haunt us forever --
One may look back, God
knows
But toward the future we see
That by walking this road
It
is only infinite
And never ceases to grow
So we build in new
vibration
And the frequencies all rise
And we find ourselves at
last
Within those prescient eyes --
The collective race at
last
In the world of tomorrow
To this concept that we pray
Will
rid us of all sorrow
But know there is a new day
There is
always new hope
And the time will prove our fate
Was overriden
by the new day
And we erased the past, with new
And it all
added up, into
The final flow thus found
Upon this Earthen
ground --
So time-traveler, accept
That the path is plainly
seen
But the future, one rejects,
To end up within that
scene,
For which is self-created,
Activated by the dream,
And
we know ourselves alive
In the recess of the new
For which all
life survives
All leading up to you.
Getting closer,
Much
cloesr now . . .
But towards what, God knows
The answer
exists
But the question resounds
And tomorrow persists
Found
on that ground
Answer the wish
And know at last,
This final
wish --
To see ones self --
Within those eyes --
Of
prescient Light --
And realized --
The day was found
As
something new,
That carried us, back into you --
The Source of
all --
The Love for God --
The knowledge seen,
Universal
law.
So know this day,
And find it fast,
The only way,
Is
paved in that --
We know ourselves --
Via the Light,
To live
in tomorrow,
Would be all-right --
And see this day,
Coming
so soon,
To walk away,
Right past the moon,
And never look
back,
And never look back,
Because we know,
We have
arrived.
And here one is --
In the future now --
Somehow,
somehow,
That day came fast,
And it plowed through time
To
end up realized
As a conclusive element
That fateful day, that
fateful day
To which we pray, to which we pray
The concept of
tomorrow
Inhits one with wonder --
That it may never come,
Is
a fact we never know,
So live for this day in peace
And walk
that final road
To know the future seen
Through self-created
hands
And destiny interwoven
Into the sands of time
Tomorrow
realized
We have arrived, we have arrived
Peering into the
mirror --
To see ones own eyes --
And at last, at last,
This
day, was the final one
Within the stream,
Within the
continuum,
It was the final analysis,
Realized within the
mind,
Stood on the precipice,
To rise, and up and fly . .
.
Flying into the new day
That day was found at last
Again,
was found all new
To grant the wish at last
And know the future
seen
Was very much like a dream
A dream that never ends,
Not
until the final scenes
And we shall see, at last
The decimation
of the past
Re-write all that once was,
For the greatest future
found,
In the mere blink of an eye,
One arrives in the new
day.
And no soul could ever die --
The soul lives for the new
day.
Invocation
To Peace
Let
all the world live in resounding peace.
Let knowledge be shared
for all
For energy was meant to be shared
And your Light is
required --
By that of the collective,
For which all once was
hid,
And we lived through darkness,
Yes we did . . .
But at
last, we have arrived
In human evolution.
As prophesized, the
shift --
Lies within the individual --
So change the heart,
change the world
And spread infinite information
To reveal
peace to all mankind
And all humans on the Earth
As verily
built on rhyme
Ever since the day of birth,
One was born into a
world of images
And had a name to everlast
This individual
found
That the future killed the past --
And peace was found
for all,
In the damning ways of one,
That fateful
individual,
God's only one --
O' fateful child
Saviour of
the world!
Rise, children of Light!
Into a world of peace!
And
let it all equate to night
Wherein lies invocation --
I invoke
peace within my heart
To bless all of mankind
Peace that will
not depart
But exists, and flies in rhyme
And I see the world
in Light
Renewed by infinite peace
That knowledge would be
shared,
From one person to the next,
Expressing that we
care,
And do not self-reject.
But know that fateful
stair
Walked into the Light
And peace for all existence
Within
the final Light --
That knowledge came, and fast
Via many
channels to outlast
And the media would flow
In images and
words
The very Light, the clothes
Worn since the day of
birth
That was peace, longevity
And sharing of self-worth
We
perceive confidence
In the individual soul
Who is the harbinger
of peace,
And bound by prescient goals --
The future realized
--
A radiant time of peace --
Within those fateful eyes --
To
the futures we will reach --
In the concept of tomorrow --
That
wondrous declaration,
For which all would see,
And unite all of
the nations,
To wake up from the dream,
And admit to life in
Light --
Let peace flow from soul to soul
That in network
symmetry
We may know of prescient goals
And see this waking
scene
To time, re-realized
In peace that we would find
By
the power of the Light
Married to the Earthen ground --
And
peace that everlasts,
And only continues on,
For the symbiosis
found
With a planet that would grow,
And evolve, continuous
To
walk that final road
Into the land of peace
And breaking all
the rules,
They were built to fall away --
There is nothing
greater
Than one individual --
The peace expressed at last,
In
the governments unfold
Via mind, and via rhymes,
We see that we
are alive --
In this, the midnight hour --
To which all is
coming fast,
To the information-floes,
That last, and
everlast
Where peace will everknow.
That was a time, and
realized
Within peace we are so home
And know that peace shall
last
Once found, for at least
A thousand years . . .
God
knows, some ill exists --
But is weak in contrast with the Light
--
That some selfishly steal,
In the hours of the night,
While
others work for peace,
And sing that final song ---
So it goes,
we do evolve --
Into the future grounds.
And the answers all
once hid,
Are revealed to us in dreams
So let peace flow
through all
Let sharing be the norm
And let energy be
expressed
In a torrent, in a storm
In Light-floes,
information
That blesses us in Light
To rid of all question
But
afford the future sight
To see peace in the world
Was an
eventuality
We would realize in time
Via the final
incarnation
And know our place in Light
And know peace to
everflow
And realize that now is here
And here is now
The
time for peace resounds
All the Earth joined in Light!
Open
hands for tomorrow,
And the coming night,
Let the mystic days
pass us by
In existential stream
Governed by experience
And
realized in dreams --
That the future found a place
To reside,
infinite peace
And this was logical,
It only made sense to
share,
The energy once expressed
Shall emanate so fair
Through
the rhythmic divide
Into ones prescient eyes
A land of
peace
For all creatures alive
In symbiotic flow
And network
symmetry
In these evolving times
Power to the peace-maker
And
the one who sees the path
Is walked toward the collective
That
path to everlast --
And now, this time is here
For the peace to
resound
From each year to year
And bless this holy town
For
the neighbors to know
And share of energy
That all citizens
would glow
In the land of the free.
So show yourself
alive
Express peacegiving ways
To find yourself realized
In
the tomorrow, the new day.
And speak your words in kind
Relate
to your fellow stranger
And often through love, support
That no
world is full of danger
That is always full of love --
Peace is
an eventuality --
Of all human evolution --
It is the
restingplace of God
By the very Light of heaven.
So bless these
waking hours
That are leading into peace
For the seasons, and
the flowers
To the heavens that they reach
Kind words, kindly
acted deeds
And saying plainly "father"
"Put
your words in order before me"
We welcome all forms of
judgment
Because the soul is pure,
We live for peace, and peace
alone.
That peace is the final cure.
Invocation
To Rhythm
Let
the primordial rhythm flow
With the mind of Light
Where all the
future knows
That presciently realized
In intonated sounds
That
occur within the mind
Perceive the waveform,
And watch how it
flies --
I invoke the rhythm of my heart,
With the stepping of
my feet,
To the ticking of the clock,
And the rhythm of the
beat,
That percussive symmetry,
Which flows within the
mind
Separating all of us
Via time, and knowledge now
But we
are all as one, at last
Via rhythm overcast
Find the sun, and
pray to her --
That she would rise, and so demure
The rhythm of
the rising sun
With that of the bright-glow stars
And the moon
that stands so high
Over the world, so young.
So time would
last forever,
But time-travelers unite
For the rhythm thus
found
Within recess of night.
And reveals that all is
right.
Such is born through the primordial,
And is
rhythmically-derived
There is an inborn rhythm
To which all
life exists
It is the primordial rhythm
Through which all life
progress --
And this rhythm that exists --
In purity, and in
form --
Is a rhythm that persists,
And continues to
inform.
Educated by the tones --
Learned of the final flow
--
Synchronized --
We knew just where to go --
To end up
within those eyes --
Within which the soul is home --
Find the
Source within --
The centre-pulsing rhythm
From which all Light
emanates
Through the Lightbody --
And the very cells
composed
For eclipsing to the Light --
Was all in flux, and
realizant
Of a future that came fast
Once the revelation
found
In her rhythms, that doth pass
Via streams and
riverlight
We see energy flow
From the mind, into the
masses
Wherever it may go
And so it goes, we live
Through a
certain rhythm
That the heart would beat
And see the moving
clouds
While the clock-prongs eclipse
And we pray to the fallen
sound
We see matter continues on,
Through these days we
find,
And we are synchronized,
Into the universe --
One is
at peace with all --
In this rhythmic divide --
Answering the
final call,
To know we'll never die --
And so, immortally
seen
This dream, of all dreams
Would stand out in perfect
rhythm
And naturally occur
Within the mind of night
For
which all answers flow
And know, so verily
Within the
future-floes
That time would come, and fast
For the realizatory
factor
And that fateful final laugh
As we observe the movements
go
And matter continues on
In her eternal flow
With a single
wave of the wand
We are where we want to be,
Teleporter,
synchronized --
In the very blink of an eye --
Finding the
destination --
Was ever-realized --
And within that rhythm
seen,
With the pulsations of the mind,
Was a revelatory
dream,
That woke us up in Light --
From the dream of
awakening,
To the tones of the final night --
For which, time
is nye to stop
But renew herself again
Through the
time-traveler found
In that fifth dimension --
There is no real
thing
Such as time -- merely a moment
A second ticking down . .
.
Within lies the nanosecond
And other forms of rhythm
found
That there is a minute rhythm
To the movements of the
sound
In her waveform flow
Within the mind of Light
This
rhythm we verily know
Was found, and found at last --
And it
came in natural rhythms
For future equalized with past,
And
sequencing through the days,
With a knowledge of the future
That
will never die away --
We see peace in time
And a collective
symmetry
Of many minds collected
Unto a rhythm: free
And all
men and women unite
Unto the final rhythm --
Of that time which
realized
Found us at the very Source --
The Source-rhythm that
flows
In her natural due course
For which, this, primordial
The
spark that started it all
Emanates in all directions
And time
is verily renewed
By the very Light of heaven
And rhythm
leading up to the new
And as soon was realized,
The moment
seen, and fast
Observed proactive animation
And a power that
would last --
Know this rhythm is divine,
And it came, and it
came fast --
As time acellerates --
And the machine is working
now --
The machinations of the future --
For which all things
resound --
And find infinite peace --
And find revelation
--
And find the rhythm
Of many minds, in due duration
Through
a telepathic accord
That lasts only forever
The rhythm carries
on
With matters continuance
Through the infinite continuum
All
matter continues on
Through the primordial rhythm
To sing of
fateful songs
And see the Light reflect off the moon
We are
proxies for this rhythm
Indeed: we are time itself
Incarnations
of rhythm
Who naturally occur
Singing . . .
"I am human
evolution
And in rhythm, I forbade."
So the change would
come,
From one softly-spoken word,
The rhythm falls in
sequence,
Unto revelation,
And it is found, within the night,
A
naturally occurring dream
Inviting future sight,
Inviting
future scenes.
The rhythm continues on
As matter is infinite
--
All is born through Source-rhythm
And this rhythm prevails
--
We are carried into the future --
By the rhythm thus
possessed --
The host of the final suture --
To the past we see
regressed --
And know, verily, where we are
Where we are
headed, shining star!
The rhythm is infinite,
It pulses with
the heart divine,
As the universe would flex,
In the
manufactured rhymes,
So flow, all energies
Toward a conclusive
element
The dream was realized
In perfect rhythmic flow,
And
this rhythm never ends,
Into the future, we shall go . .
.
Eventing through the days
Eventing through the years
Eventing
through millennia
To know the future here.
And it would
everlast --
The rhythm of future and past --
Eclipsed in a
great sight --
That rhythm infinitely realized
Was an
intonating sound
Occurring naturally through the verse
And it
was found in Light
The rhythm of the universe --
The rhythm of
God --
The rhythm of the Source --
The rhythm of universal law
--
All are bound by rhythm.
There is a rhythm to all
things.
One prays to all this rhythm,
For the heart to kindly
sing
"God bless the new day!"
"Coming fast, unto
peace!"
"That will never die away!
"Into the
future, I reach!"
Invocation
To Rhyme
Let
all thoughts flow through rhyme
In the inner musicality
For
which all is seen in time
Bound by the rhythms of the mind
Let
all cogitations soar
And let all inner undulations
Flow through
lyricality
Via rhyme, and super-flow,
So come and be with
rhyme
In the melodies that flow
Through the synaptic
connections
And the combining forces
So that we could watch,
and grow
Through the reality we made
Via experience, and
Light
That all the hate forbade
In that dark recess of
night
The future that was made
In a world so built on
rhyme
That it would only make sense
For rhyme to rhyme with
time --
And thought to rhyme with God --
And eyes to rhyme with
LIght to rhyme with sight
And God to rhyme with "awe"
--
Thee to rhyme with see --
And seven to rhyme with heaven
--
And the electromagnetics of the Pleiades
Flow into a
different dimension
So we find rhyme is memory
And within
memory is thought
That is held up through this ability
For
which rhyme is all we've got --
And the ability to learn,
Through
the power that thus yearns,
Through a field of iridescence,
Is
the very Light of heaven --
And the seven stars doth shine
In
their immortal Light --
Over all the days of night,
And all the
Earthen plights,
And so rhyme is everything --
It is the memory
of this world --
And it only grows into a rhythm --
For which
therein thought knows --
And this rising rhythm flows in Light
--
And we all rhyme with one another in life
And our
information, so it flows, and vibes --
And rhythmically collides,
harmonic convergence
That a rising star would once again fade
back
And refer to that great resounding laugh
After which it
seems this rhythmic
Flow of which only constant
And so it flows
and on
Toward a rhythm
And this is
All is
Toward a
finality that only grows --
And sequences through rhyme,
Oh how
beautifully it flows --
In this grand riverlight --
The
imaginations sight --
The perpetual growth at last,
In her many
stages that outlast --
Grinning in iridescent pride --
In that
mirrors reflection --
Through the rhythms that we ride,
And so
it flows, our evolution
In the continuation of dreams
And the
ideals of the hopeful
And the ones who saw the scenes
And
observed the changeful times,
And so it flows, these radiant
Lights --
And in the constellated starshine
Of which our
wonderous noosphere
Glows with that of our own Light --
In the
heavenly recess,
That of those higher dimensions
Toward which
we can only progress
As that is the only real choice --
As born
from the same Source,
However we may have a voice
And prove our
own due course,
This is only making the journey
Back to the
Source, a more enjoyable
And worthwhile, experiential flow --
And
that river that glows --
Toward the Source of which it was made
--
Is only in equipoise,
This nirvana -- that would be --
In
the mere blink of an eye; --
A level we would reach --
All
identity survived --
Through the records we shall leave,
In our
ascending legacy, --
Of the rhymes, and invocations
Of the
thoughts, and undulations
Of the vibes, and frequencies
Of the
prayers spoken from our knees,
From the thoughts related to
One,
To the Source from which we came from,
To the eventuality
of all that is,
Toward nirvana, that precipice
Toward which we
do not fall --
But only rise in due flight --
And, all together
now --
The union of all LIght --
In her perfect rhythmic
flow
Is a rhyme for love of time
And that God of One who
Knows,
That final life, that final life,
That love for all that
flows --
In this, riverlight fashion.
And so it goes, and so
it goes --
Life continues on
And peace is eventual,
We are
found in reality
That one to which we made
Seeing all we want
to see
Feeling all we want to feel
Knowing all we want to
know
And thinking all we want to think
And being all we want to
be
And revealing all we must reveal
And flowing as we flow
And
winking at the glow --
And see the mirror knows --
That of
which we are,
And all of us contained,
Unto the final
thoughts,
Of the Source-rhythm-floes
And knowing almost nearly
all to know
In that mystic catharsis
Of the furniture of the
void
To which our star, it burns --
In the merkabah
vehicle,
And through the space we fly
Through the mere matter
of the mind
In the rhyming composition
Of the verse that inner
flows,
And this verse for which is found
That great, infinite
sound
To which sky merges with the ground
And some rhymes we
must repeat,
Because they help us levitate,
And so it goes, we
come to be
Governed by our rhymes --
And the rhymes that make
us up
Are only beautiful rhythms --
In the make-up up the
mind
That very mindfield of energy
Which flows in due
regard
With all the mirror shards
In holographic logic
Light
That informational
And it is burning in the night
And
it never does sleep
And your mind, that subconscious
Wherein
images are found
So find the symbol,
Find the rhyme --
Find
the memory --
Find the mindstate of evolution
And flow with
rhythmic Light --
Let there be Light to fill that space
That
portion of the mind
For which was once unused
But is now to be
employed
We shall see through inner Light
That we are the
vehicle of change
And it only took one --
Invocation
To Beauty
Let
life be filled with beauty
With a mirror through which to see
Life
blooming from all things
That cause rhyming thoughts to sing
And
see a blooming world of Light
That is only perpetually
arise
Through these building frequencies
Of the beauty in your
eyes --
The one to whom is shared
With all that we do know
And
telling of these questions
To which answers may flow,
And it is
seen that connection --
Therein lies, what is beautiful
And the
romance of our growth
Through the pride and confidence
Of Love
shared with another
Only yields beauty in due consequence,
Knowing
the law of attraction,
And beauty finding beauty as it will,
That
like attracts like --
And we live as through a thrill
And this
it flows, in that river
And it is a river towards the
ocean-floes
These heavenly days lived
In the New Age
Of
beauty and innocence
And pride and knowing this
Which is
continually learned
In the art-work we shall see
That is art;
the very Earth
And all are artists
All are creators of
destiny
All are reality-producers
All are individuated
cells
All are iridescent with life
Imbuing life which only
leads to more life
And survival of beauty is constant
And we
have the Light within,
To cease aging, and all else
That
through immortality --
All beauty is found --
And we shall
never meet death.
We shall live forever
Beauty carries us
And
the environment just is
Beautiful and forever
Infinitely
frequentially in rise
And of super-strings
Through
waveforms
And thought-vibrations
Which are all seen as
beautiful.
So beauty ever-surrounds,
And so does information
As
Light is information
And information is beautiful
We seek to
learn; evolve; grow
And so this is so, via thought
And the
inner Light we found
And the thoughts, yielding a sound
And the
Light for which contained
Is like lightly falling rain
And the
gentle love expressed
And flows as the wind blows
And may
commonly progress
Through this discussian we shall find
In the
beauty of our minds
And that which only flows
In due
consequence, God knows
Is perfect in its form
And formless, yet
again
Takes on a new shape --
And so beauty is worn again
--
And those words, so like our skin
Our irradiate, and
beautiful within
That glow in sentences
Perfect, glowing forms
--
And these thoughts revelatory
May within hold a story
Of
the beauty that once was
And shall ever be again,
Lying in the
DNA,
The very filaments of One,
That never goes away,
Once
the Light is won --
For which the beauty to everstay
And so all
these frequencies resound,
And it is a grand, beautiful path
That
yields the final laugh
As so suggested before
That only glory
is held in store
And the destination found
Is a waveform, is a
sound,
And its beautiful flow that goes
And infinitely resounds
--
That only builds and grows
In a storm of
frequencies
Storming in a network
That of the infinite
energy,
The electromagnetics join
And the harmonies
converge
And all is seen in a whisper in the noise
That only
builds and grows --
That lone, beautiful one
That changer of
the times --
Flowing in the self-fashioned future
Otherwise,
not peer to far
But as well, the final suture
That bright, and
glowing star --
So all beauty thus found
Can be seen in the sky
above
In the seasons of the trees,
And growth of flowers in the
Spring,
The iridescence of Summer
Of the changeful leaves of
Fall,
And the beauty of Winter,
So beauty is naturally
produced
And it surrounds one, everywhere
From the environs
that one knows
So this beauty is all Light
And
information-floes
That grow and build and grow
Evolve, all is
eventual,
And all is so beautiful --
Unto the days of
tomorrow
Which are only seen as beautiful
In counterpart to All
That Is
In due consequence --
The storm of Light that
flows,
The Lightning cast by One
The One Spirit beautiful
In
the core,
And glowing outward from centre,
The Light of the
universe --
The epicentre
For which the artists are born
And
we creator masters of beauty
And the creators are found
And the
ascended masters come
From their own realized finalities
In
time, to which the rhythm found
Is only eventual beauty --
That
perfect avatar self --
Wholly holographically beautiful,
Resounds
with that you see
And it is radiant, so it flows
In the
riverlight that grows
And imaginative cells
Oh, the Light of
the individual
And what power did arise
From the ground once
hovered a stone
And an epitaph surmise
With some lonely
declaration,
That once gone, once gone is all,
But beauty
prevails
And all is calm,
In the eye of the storm,
Like the
seasons, soul returned
And the One Spirit prevailed
In
returning beauty to Earth
In that historic birth --
One is
alive in the New Age --
Of the planet Earth --
In the Milky Way
--
With a blackhole
At the center of our galaxy
And our
planetary revolutions
Around that central star
The sun
photosynthesizes flowers,
And life exists in the triad --
With
our location in space unknown,
But perceived as somewhat as an
epicentre
That what once is found our home
Will be a place
until the eventual calm eventor
Into the deepest future --
The
greatest relationships --
And the highest forms of beauty in ones
life --
On this beautiful blue star --
Is resoundingly
infinite,
That re-incarnation is a reality
We shall see in
evidence
Of the re-incarnated starseeds
Who now live and
breathe
Through the beauty of the indigo
To the master found in
Light
The powerful meditator
To the one of prescient sight
--
To the prophetic dreamer,
To the prayer gone out at night
--
To the one to whom we serve,
That inner master we so
deserve;
To know the beauty,
Of the guiding Light --
And
that system which flows,
Only infinitely in her matrix array
That
grows --
And beauty prevails,
And the Earth is beautiful
And
life is beautiful,
And humans are beautiful
Primordially divine
--
Masters of beauty --
Epiginetic creators --
Flying as the
angels would
Soaring through images
Of which Free Will
prevails
And so whatever is imagined
Is attracted into life
--
This all know, a common truth
No secret, --
But beauty,
and the endurance
Of the riverlight flow
Of our inner
images
That grow,
Only continue forth
And we are all
artists
And creators
And expressors
And divine Light
We
all have beauty in our Light --
And beauty prevails --
So we
grow upon the Earth
A beautiful blue star
And we have come here
for a reason
To see our beauty go far
And continue
infinitely
In beautiful Light-floes
That only continue on
And
we see beauty in the stars
And the clouds that overpass
Beauty
in the sunlight day
And oxytocive laugh, --
That security is
found,
In everything we see,
As flowers bloom like sound
That
resounds infinitely
And beauty is all life
The purpose, the
destiny
Only one life
To produce the masterpiece
And karmic
incident
Is referred to as beauty
And it is learned from,
forever
In the body of our Light
Which is only beautiful
And
lasts through the mystic night,
Unto the new day
Which goes
forever on,
And only continues on,
Beauty prevails,
And all
things are beautiful
Let beauty surround all life
Let
expressions be informed
And knowledgable
Of all beauty
That
prevails, and so grows,
And exists,
In everything one
sees.
.Invocation
To Connection
Let
new relationships be formed
That are most beneficial toward
evolution
And symbiotic environment
Let this connection be
evolutional
And a positive resonance,
That grows in beauty over
time,
That what will now be remembered,
As the days of the New
Age
Are a joining of believers --
And dreamers of great
sage
Knowledge that everlasts
Coming to be universal
And a
natural connexive force
The network of Light in floes
And the
informational enhanced
Recyclably, over time --
Through new
connections made
That carry one to future
Where all the
frame-work laid
In the force of new connection
By the
relationships thus formed
Within recess of the final
life
Information in a torrent-storm
Flows through every
cell
Inviting other Light
To exist with us in here --
The
now-point of awareness
For which thoughts progress
And emanate
through the field
Calling forth new Light
In the new relations
formed
That was ever-realized
As the connection made in
sure
For the sake of new knowledge
And a growing evolution
In
this changeful times
By the very Light of heaven --
All are
unitive in flow
Joined together and well know
That connection
was the end
And toward the ocean one flows
Knowing the future
found
In those recess of eyes
Peering through the soul
And
all knowledge realized
In human connection found
The greatest
masterpiece of all
In the final life to which I know
That I am
One with all --
And my thoughts are electric
A gravitating
force
Drawing new connection
In a flow and righteous
course
Through which learning comes to pass
From one cell to
the next
That knowledge that everlasts
By the walls that
everflex
As the universe just grows
The further we
explore
Knowing that final road
The all-connexive cure
And
it was some miracle
The union of the minds
Like an eagle
soaring high
Perceiving through the vantage
Of those
enlightened eyes
Seeing where connection leads
In the recess of
this life
For which the river bleeds
Leading to the Source
For
which all Light arose
For which all new connection found
Is a
vibration that grows --
And so harmonic convergence
And the
joining of minds seen
Through evolution of the times
In this
ever-wakeful dream
To which one wakes up fast
And knows to
everlast
That final life so realized
Of great purpose to the
world --
The Light that emanates --
Covering this blue star
--
For the all-connexive force
That never went so far --
In
the new connections made
In the recess of the final life
All
karmic incident repaid
And knowing all that is
To be seen
within these eyes
That it was no dream
But a reality thus
found
Within the final scenes --
So that connection found
Would
enlighten every cell
By the power holographic
That ranges, so
well --
Beautiful in flux
In her flow of radiance
Within the
mind that glows
And flows through riverlight
In beauteous
imagination
For which all evolution seen
Is the eventual
process
Of this great machine --
The machine of evolution
--
Turns in her machinations --
In rhythmic perfection --
That
is all, verily seen
For the new connections made
Within this
life so great
Was a connection that lasts
And everlasts, to
writhe in phase
With a resonance of souls
And frequencies
aligned
By the super-strings that travel
And the vibrations
that writhe
Traveling from mind to mind
In that newfound
telepathy --
So direct transferrence was
Evidence of the change
--
And one lived with the purpose
That is geared toward the
world
Serving the collective
As the energy just flows
In her
radiance, her Light
The creative storm in flux
Within the Light
of the mind
The attractor well in flux
Gravitating new
Light
For the sake of all that is --
And realizant of the
new
That flows in everything
Betwixt the you and me
Oh the
romance of the soul
Greatest relations found
New connections
forged
In the merging of energies
Toward eventual eclipse
River
leading out to sea
And growing in Light at last
A continual
endless growth
That only builds over time
In the self-renewal
hope
For the new connections made
And the relations well in
flux
Back when the world was made --
We were all seeded with
love --
And so connection found --
In the Light of the very
soul --
To end up within those eyes
For the future manifest
And
all new Light realized --
So the new connections forged
In
recess of the final life
Eventual, in course
Lead up only to
more Light
That frequency just grows
From mind to mind it
flows
And so evolution continues on
We walk that fateful
road.
Invocation
To The Seasons
Find
the beauteous snow of winter
And the beauty of the spring
The
radiance of summer
And the fall of fallen leaves
That seasons
come and flow
Through their natural accord
We see the new
tomorrow
For the evolutionary course
To which the seasons are
renewed
And all the Earth doth turn
For the union that is
found
In environmental resound
Envirothoughts, in activate
And
see the seasons coming fast
Through the times that everchange
And
the Light that everlasts
So see the beauty of the winter
And
the radiance of spring
The brightness of the summer
And the
colors of the fall --
So the seasons renew all things,
And the
world continues on,
For as the angels sing
Their song is toward
the flow
And all angels see the Light
For which is walked that
final road
To know time-traveling
In all the right places
--
Carried by the song
Of nature that which flows
In her
iridescent Light
That covers all the world --
So the seasons of
the heavens
And the celestial bodies move
Via frequencies, and
tones
Of convergence of the sights --
All eyes eclipsed to
this,
The lone image in the mind --
Beauty fell over here
And
once perceived radiance
That all the world was glowing now
And
it was a land of infinitude
That upon the knowledge of the
seasons
And the celestial bodies move
Turning, in our
motions
And centrifugal force --
In the spinrate realized
--
For the future found in course --
That the seasons carry
on,
And matter continues on --
And the rhythm doth prevails
--
A most angelic song --
That equalized in mind
Was the
realization found
To the endurance of time
Where the
time-traveler resounds
And burning with the Light
Gathering
sunrays
Starlight that oscillates
In her constellating flow
--
That is realizant of futures
To which the seasons grow
And
know the seasons well,
The recycling of time,
That continuum
prevails --
In a world so built of rhyme,
And memorable these
thoughts
Those of the final life
To which all is sought
In
the advent of this Light
And the seasons continue on
And the
sun doth rise again
And the angels see the song
Of the waveform
that travels through
In the super-strings that emanate
And fill
the universe --
All the waveforms travel
In their logilinear
due course
For harmonic convergence found --
The eventuality
seen --
Was a place within the mind,
Awakened from the dream
--
In the world that is everchanging
And the winter, spring,
summer, and fall
Bound by this symmetry
For which the angels
see
Our movements in time
Carried by self-destiny
That one
knows the soul in Light
Through the knowledge of the seasons
That
all is cyclically renewed
And matter continues on
Life is
animation
And the cells are animate,
Traveling forth through
Light-floes seen
In grand, beautiful prescience
Knowing the
seasons coming fast
Was a time within the mind
A holiday of the
world
A time of the cosmic spring
A great joining of all
Light
For the radiance to sing --
And grand, these thoughts
that flow
In the movements of all time
That the internal
rhymes
Are flowing naturally
Along with the movement of the
seasons
And seeing what one sees --
In the Light of the sun
--
The verdency of the trees --
The changeful, tinted
leaves
And the snow that sprinkles down
The renewal found in
Spring
The flowers that return
Re-incarnated so seen
In this
changeful reality --
That only continues on
In the natural
process found
So animation is infinite --
And the conclusive
elements
Suggest that nature seen
Was a realizant factor
Waking
up from the dream --
And new life thus found
For the sake of
childrens children
And the renewal of the sound
In her perfect
waveform flow
That nature is possessed,
And the vibration just
grows
The further one will progress --
So the seasons come and
go,
Matter continues on,
We see the concept of tomorrow,
And
we know it will be good.
Find the schedule realized
Of a
self-perfected future
Within these prescient eyes
The body of
the final suture --
To see the future realized
As the seasons
come and go
Infinitely renewed by time
For which all matter
knows --
Time-traveler alive --
In the recess of the new,
For
which the race survives,
In the seasons that come and
go.
Invocation
To Laughter
Let
laughter come at last
And let laughter resound
In the knowledge
thus accrued
Via the waveform sound
Oh, laughter in our
thoughts
The absurdity of it all
How karma would outlast
But
one shall never fall
Knowing humor well in store
Was the logic
of the mind
That the cosmic joke at last
Would resound within
the mind
Perceiving from periphery,
Seeing all that we may
see,
Therein lies the punchline
For which all thought
relates
In this laughter come at last
That we see just where we
are
Where we have been, wish to go
By the Light of the stars
--
We are aware of most all
And perceive the inner joke
For
which the laughter calls
For the renewal of our hope
Know the
humor of this world
Never take too seriously
Any quest, any
dream,
But realize humility --
In the jokes that make us
up
From punchline to punchline
We writhe through certainty
That
all is never known
But realize this never ends
For the laughter
that would come
In light of All That Is --
Where the emanating
Light
Rolls beauteous off the tongue
In the comicality
And
the hilarity of this
For which therein lies meaning
But that
meanin we may miss
In the jokes that pass us by
Knowing no
seriousness
But committed to laughter
And perceiving "all
of this"
That the laughter came at last
In reflection on
the way
For which is built in stone
That was only made to
break
While the system is revised
The humor lies within,
We
see through prescient eyes,
And know the jokes of kin,
For all
relationships
Must join in hope and laughter
That nothing is
too serious
We shall know no disaster
But always reside within
humor
And see light where meaning lies
That therein lies a
meaning
And it is seen within our eyes
That directly
perceived
Is the joke of this world --
That the laughter
flows
In reflection upon all,
Like the absurdity of union
In
a world built on discord
That we see the chaséd
tails
And how the fox will run
Through the inner joke that lies
So there is a purpose to all
And we may see in dreams
That
as the laughter calls
We shall know those scenes --
Where the
joke is inner truth
Perceiving as absurd
For the sacred of the
youth
And the power found in words
Let laughter resound!
Let
it be the final cure
For laughter heals everything
And nothing
is too real --
The rules are always changing
And within we
shall reveal
That our growth was endless
But we reflected, with
good eyes
That nothing is too perfect
This we humbly
realize
And see the joke of life
For the absurdity of it
all
That somehow we survived
In a world built on
discord
Manufactured for control?
Created in the image of
God?
The mere two-strand DNA
Is the greatest joke of all
And
how we went so far
To answer the final call
Was like the
Light
Of a shining star --
That never shined so far --
And
shone over ones life
In the illuminated rays --
For which all
meaning lies
In the humor of the day --
So see the joke in
Light
Never be too serious
But writhe, exuberant
For the
humor of life is good
And laughter is the healer
For which all
is seen true
Within the eyes of Light
That ever-lead to
us
Joined by all the laughter
And the joke that passes by
Unto
the new, the next
The finalmost punchline
--
All-conclusive,
All-revealing --
The honest words do tell
--
That wherein lies absurdity
So the laughter fell.
And we
looked at life
Through the eyes so self-renewed
Saw our power
in this life
Was all humorous, in two's
With two eyes, two
genders
Two hemispheres --
And two-strand DNA --
We are
built to disagree,
And so exists the grandest joke
For Free
Will to exist
In the land of fallen hope
Somehow we
survived
Through the trials of this life
And we look back on
this
With prescient, realizant eyes
Knowing that it was not
real
But merely the dream of one
To which within all is
revealed
Like the very Light of God's son --
So the absurdity
resounds
How could any of this be?
The cosmic joke is
found,
And punchline verily seen.
So the joke resounds,
Nothing
taken too seriously,
But exuberant with pride,
In our waking
destiny.
Invocation
To Music
So
the music flows infinite
In the syllabated thoughts
Via
intonated sound
And the foot-steps, and the talk
Resounding in
frequency
Oh, how the waveforms flow
From body and mind
And
spirit --
So the energy will glow --
In her musical accord
The
melodies of the mind --
Via Light that lies within --
And
ever-bound by rhyme,
So the rhythm is perceived,
And the
rhythmic destiny
Is ever-leading to the future
For the sake of
you and me
Joined together by music
And thought turned to
song
For the revelatory state
And the knowledge of our
sight
That only grows, endless
Unto the final night
Wherein
lies the dream
That woke us up at last --
So saw those final
scenes,
Where the music doth flow at last
In her melodious
frequencies
And convergence of waveform
The sonic resonance
And
the natural harmonies
In their melodic resound
Flowing within
the mind
Ever-bound by sound,
And the Light of everything
--
Oh, the music of the mind
The music of our thoughts
In
their connexive-symmetry
Bound by universal law
For which the
One Spirit
Is flowing good supreme
And finds the Light as
magic
The beauty of the dream
Wherein all adds up to music
And
music is the final thought
The universe is music
Super-strings,
and frequencies
Light and Sound are merged
In the waveform
flow
That is flowing through the mind
Watch, as it grows
And
rises in vibration
Through the supremacy of thought
Of the
power found in Light
And the foot-steps, and the talk
And the
inner Light that lies
Within those frequencies
Where all music
is found
Of perfect destiny
And the sky merged with the
ground
And gravity fell at last
For the joining of
energies
Energy that everlasts
So the harmonic convergence
And
the super-strings in flux
All the Light convergence
And the
teleported love --
Telepathic minds --
And readers of all
Light
See the pages, the skein of time
And it flows so
musically
Like the music of our thoughts
Of perfect destiny
And
so that road we walk
Toward a final end of Light
That never
ends, but Source
Shall know our eventual return --
Once one is
ready --
Once one is prepared --
For the commitment, to One
alone
The One Spirit that exists
Moving through all matter
That
all matter is entangled
And the Light-floes shall resound
In
their musical patterns
That only flow in sound
And the
waveforms merge
And the mix is everseen
The layered tracks,
The
layered tones,
The layered music,
Where all is Home --
The
layered thoughts
The syllabic tones --
The occurrence
within
The thought in One
And merging all Light
By the Light
of the sun --
And that Sirius star --
And the awakening dream
--
For which the music equates
To those final scenes
Wherein
lies
The inner masterpiece
Created through time
And manifest
by the mind
A musical flow
That shall never ever end
But is
only continual
By the power it would send
And the music of the
heart,
And the music of the mind,
The music of the
thoughts,
Shall all equate to rhyme --
And know this power
endless
That in music power is found
All thought is music
All
music is thought
And the formula prevails --
That in frequency,
all survives
And through reverie one never fails
But the music
that flows within
In harmonic frequencies
Are tones and
vibrations
That occur within thee --
That the Light is
infinite
Is only evidently seen
The growing universe
The
profundity of the dream --
And all symbols contained
That thus
woke up the mind
Like the slowly falling rain
In music, rid of
all pain
And see the Light where once was hate
That the music
came too late
Was a fabrication invented
By the evil sons of
low --
But music has always existed
And music will prevail
That
we are all musicians
And we are all capable
Of this expression,
divine Light
Sing your thoughts --
Sing your Light --
Sing
your inner frequency
And intonate with all --
The
envirothoughts thus found
In musical symmetry
They can only
resound
And join all energy
For harmonic convergence
That
doth occur again
In her cyclic patterns
That occur, over, and
over --
Building in vibration
Rising in orchestra
The
melodies prevail
And they all equate to Love.
So the music is
thus found
And the knowledge that there waits
Is a musical
symmetry
In sonic waveforms
Betwixt you and me
That
orchestratic storm
Only flows infinitely
In musical
discourse
To end up within dreams --
The matrix of all love
--
Equating to the scenes
And angels high above
Singing
songs of Love
And joy, and peace, and spring
Renewal of all
life
That to which the Light would bring
And the rhymes
flow
And the thoughts flow
And the rhythm is found
Wherever
one goes --
In lies the music --
That which everglows --
In
the waveform patterns,
And the emanated tones --
For which all
equates to Light
And within Light we are Home.
Find the music
of the heart
And ride the passion of life
That this shall never
depart
But be carried through rhyme
Given to memory
And
recalled, through time
As what was infinite
And ever-resounding
Light
The music of the spheres,
And the animated forms
That
all move in synchronous flux
In logical due course
For which
the music of all life
Is a thought within the mind
And the
music of ones thoughts
Are verily, built on rhyme.
And so
lovingly repeat
Certain rhymes, certain thoughts
That power is
found, we see
And all the love thus brought
Through the music
so we flow
And we are in the orchestra
Wherever one goes
The
inner musical awe --
That we are in a state of wonder
By the
power of our thoughts
And the music is iridescent
In perfect
symmetry --
Flowing through the mind --
Joining all energy
--
In harmonic convergence --
In perfect destiny.
The music
flows as infinite
The realizatory state
The knowledge found in
Light
And the tones, and the sage
And the wisdom, and the
power
And the fortitude of Light
By the music of the mind --
By
the internal rhymes --
By the flow of riverlight --
And the
beauty that lies within --
Music is all thought
Music is the
end of matter
All is music, we shall find
In the tapestry of
life --
Interwoven musically,
That resounds, in Light
To
which the music flows
Infinitely on, forever
And the orchestra
knows
No end . . .
Invocation
To Joy
Let
joy fill all the senses
And well-being come to pass
As the
final state thus found
That state would everlast
With the music
of our thoughts
And the melodies inclined
For which therein
lies joy
And all the beauty one may find
In the beautiful
environ
That to which is filled with joy
In the pages of the
book,
To childhood memories --
Knowing once that we would
play
And make a theatre out of life
Actors in a show --
With
only joy to share
In the kindest of all words
Rid of all
concept of despair
But at last, the joy is found
Vibrating
within the mind
From the sky, to the ground
And all is made of
Light
For which the joy that flows
Within every cell
Within
the holographic host
The body knows so well
In dancing Light to
shine
For the music of our cells
Wherein lies true Light
In
that holographic shell
So find joy in life
Find peace and
fortitude
Let the joy flow through all
And let us be in
tune
With the very infinite
The matter that continues
on
Looking down from the precipice,
And then up at the sky
--
The only choice is to ascend,
Via joy, we never die --
So
find ones self immortal
Through all the tones of joy
For which
knowledge that is come
Is like a realizant factor
To which new
light blooms
For the love of all and laughter
That joy is
evident
So we find it, so peace is true
And the joy that flows
within
Only brings one closer to you --
In this great
relationship,
For new connections made,
Sharing Love, Joy, and
Light --
And all the love that is
To be in relational
bliss
From this high-standing precipice
We see joy in all
matter
That all is vivacious, alive
And it writhes through
laughter
That all is nearly realized
For the joy that comes at
last
Is what had always been
That to yield a laugh
And
reflecting on the when
For which we know our soul in Light
Bound
by eternal joy
By the power of the night
And the morning well
in rise
From the dawn, until dusk
Therein lies only
joy
Exuberance of soul
And a love for all things.
So the joy
continues on
And happiness shall never end
We equate to that
song
To share with a friend
And know this sister, brother
The
union of all Light
Was an event realized
As in logical due
sequence
For which all leads to joy
And happiness of
mind
Pleasure in the cells
And a world so built on rhyme
That
all is musical,
We perceive the evidence
Found in the
miracle
Of this lovely world within
So the Light doth shine
And
joy to everlast
That thoughts are all in rhyme
And
ever-yielding a laugh
That startled by the bliss
The
spontaneity of life
We grant that angel in a kiss
And find the
final life
To which joy shall everlast
And only know in
peace
That would come to pass
Was a realizant factor
Realizant
of laughter
And all happiness shared
With the world in Light
--
From one joyful song
To the next in sight --
That only,
goes on . . .
Infinite song
Laughter and joy:
Nothing is
wrong
All is all-right
We are at peace with the world
And
the joy thus flows --
Infinitely on . . .
Invocation
To Abundance
Through
the currency of Light
And the free energy found
Let all be
abundant
Let all energy pass 'round
And all energy thus
shared
For the sake of the future
That is found in wealth
The
abundance of the suture
Given to our families,
Our friends and
associates
For the re-distribution
Of peace, and Light, and
Love
That abundance finds the soul
Who works for the
collective
And peace and longevity
For the Light that lies
within
Was ever-realized
Making us abundanct
And fully
actualized
So that money is loved
And not hated, for the
evil
Such that we find no cause
For mis-use of energy
But
know universal laws
And pray they set us free --
That money is
enjoyed
We shall see in every day
Money well spent,
And
money well saved,
For the sake of the future --
And
re-distributed wealth --
And never be selfish,
Never know
greed,
But germinate with Light
That abundant seed
To see
the future bloom
In currencies of Light
In this fateful
room
Self-realized
And all money to come
For the sake of the
good
That it is to be well-spent
And not based on
"should"
Needless to say,
Some are poor,
And do
not know wealth --
We see the service required --
And we pray
for their good health --
That some must be wealthy,
While
others strive so low
At least we can be healthy,
And knowing
the great show --
For which all are seen equal
And abundance to
all souls
The free energy of Light
That lies within, this goal
--
That future realized
Was only eventual
So the currency
thus found
Would grant a better life
Of security and
well-being
The perfect mate, no strife
But knowing power in
this Light
For the re-distributed wealth
Given to the many
homes
And the ones who see good health
For the Earth, and all
the world
And the energy thus shared
We exist to share --
And
so it goes, we evolve --
Through the wealth that we shall find
In
the abundant cell --
That microcosm of life
That knows only
good health
So one is blessed in this life
Fortunate and
wealth
To know great relationships
And beauty that resounds
We
are living for the Earth
And the sake of our own town
That the
money that is spent
Is spent for soul-advancement
And the One
Spirit knows
That within Light that flows
Abundance is
here-drawn
That only builds and grows
So find that final
life
Where abundance is found
The perfect mate,
The perfect
avatar --
The perfect waveform sound --
As we attract abundance
--
Via what was never a secret --
As like attracts like --
And
we see this growing field
That space to be filled with
Light
Wherein abundance is revealed
And we live for our
brothers,
Our sisters,
And the Earth --
For the sake of all
that is good
And worthy of this worth --
That we are prideful,
iridescent
And know grace in our Light-life
That the free
energy thus found
Was only infinite
And the Light that would
resound
Would always lead up to this
That second passing
fast
The clouds moving overhead
The trees blowing in the
wind
And the tides of the ocean
Blooming Light with the
Spring
And the beauty of the Fall --
The greatness of the
Summer --
And the wonder of the snowfall --
We are blessed by
everything
One lives for the sake,
Of a purpose found in
Light
That is wealthy, and is forever --
And through this final
purpose
Of which one may never sever
That therein lies
abundance
Is the eventual result
For the wealth that
ever-flows
And granting every wish
By the law of
attraction,
And what is no secret --
All thoughts attract
--
This we know --
And so it goes, we operate
Through an
intuitional mode
Gravitating new relationships
For which
therein wealth lies
The greatest relationships
Lived within the
final life
Only one, this final life
Gravitated all
together
And always seeing Light --
That is only infinite
--
Carried by the sight --
Gravitated into it --
The
abundance that will flow,
Within this final life,
Is a
gold-paved road,
And loving all that is --
We realize the
purpose,
The sake, the cause, the Light
And all is like a
river
To the ocean of all that is --
All energy cycles
around
In a continual flow
That one is synchronized
Is a
thought to everknow
For the wealth that comes to us
For our
families and friends
A minus turned into plus
Wealth that never
ends.
Invocation
To Healing
We
know the mind-body connection
That the mind is the great
healer
And the mind is powerful
Just as the body knows only
health
And the right-brain hemisphere
In which we may
communicate
"My body is strong," here --
Through
words thus illustrate
That the body in good health
And,
subthought "my mind is strong" --
And know,
verily
Health flows through every cell
Holographic of the
whole
To which is the perfect avatar self
Let health flow
through every cell
In the body holographic
Knowing only being
well
Life only gets better
Carried through continuum
For
which all is worn
Like a lovingly-knit sweater
That is
comforting, and Light
And so it goes,
One is surrounded --
In
the radiant white Light --
The body is Light --
Light fills
every cell,
And we rise, we levitate
Radiant, in good
health
That the body is strong
That the mind is strong
And
the Spirit is strong
All energies eclipsed
Toward the violet
Light
The Light of the universe
Radiant through every cell
In
the body holographic
Knowing only good health
That lasts only
forever
The body is immortal
One shall be pure of age
And
know verily the angels
Sending Light into the body
For which
the glowing sphere
Is encompassing all
And we are alive within
the here
That now-point realized
The affirmation found
Singing
through the song
From the Earthen ground
That one is alive in
the New Age
In a body of good health
Is the seer and the
sage
Light to fill every cell
In the body holographic
To
which each piece contained
Is reflective of the whole,
Body of
water, like the rain
That this water is conductor
And the
energy doth flow
Through the fields of iridescence
That
illumine the future roads
Wherein lies only good health
That
the body well knows
And one is aligned
With the Light upon the
road
Walking through iridescence
And radiant, every cell
Within
the glowing sphere
Knowing only good health
All dis-ease is
absolved
By the Light verily found
That one shall evolve,
By
the power of the sound
Intonating fluidly
In glowing
riverlight
That joins all bodies
Through health, vigor, and
life.
Gravitated center to center
That animation finds the
cell
Within the sphere, the epicentre
That the subconscious
mind
Is in communique
With the body at all times
Carrying us
into the new day
Wherein all health is found
For which the soul
well knows
By the power of the sound
A frequency that grows
For
which the body is Light
And the Lightbody radiant
Shall see the
glowing white
The very Light of heaven
Eden rising on the
Earth
The New Age found at last
That once given to birth,
One
would meet the everlast
For every cell eclipsed
In perfect,
goodly health
For which one knows the road
Only leads to
granted wish
By the Law of Attraction
And the gravitated
cell
Within the glowing sphere
One knows only good health.
In
the body holographic
Within each piece contained
The total host
in health
Like fragments of the pain
Eclipsed into a Light
That
makes sense to the mind
Knowing verily,
One is alive in the New
Age --
And the Light so iridescent
And the world become like
heaven
Is in biological flux
For which renewal of the cells
In
Lightbody of the One
For which only knows good health
That
shadow overfell
And we knew it quite well
Was the pain of the
past
Re-written by good health
For the future found at last
Was
a place within the mind
Via mind-body connection
And the
ever-connexive cells
By the Light of heaven
The future flows in
health
So the body is alive
And all cells are
eclipsed
Holographically realized
As the granted wish for
One
The hope of the sun
The Light of the moon
The turning
world
Time coming soon --
For which love blooms
And we know
all health
For life resumes,
And there is no end --
We can
only grow --
Forever now --
Now-point realized,
And infinite
health.
So empowered by
The radiant Light
Heal all the
cells
The life is vitalized
And radiant, it glows
For the
future well knows
Only good health
Of the final bodily
host.
Invocation
To Revelation
One
calls for transmission
From the heart of the universe
That
Light was my mission
For the cells to disperse
And then
re-gather again
Within electric thought
And notions of heaven
--
Come, transmission
Bless me with your Light --
Whatever
guide, whatever name
I see with gelded sight
And I realize my
place
Within the grand totality
I see my life is revelatory
And
I am one with All That Is --
One calls for tranmision
Come from
the very Source
Guided by Light, the mission
Realized in its
due course
So enter my psyche
With the information-floes
Where
revelation flows
And the knowledge only grows
This flower of
the mind
Cast to bloom with rhyme
Was ever-revelatory
With
the prescience of heaven
So find the revelation
Within the very
mind
In a glowing paragraph
Guiding through the prescient
path
See the future realized
By these present times
And one
shall know of love
That love that causes me to fly --
I here
levitate with words,
And the words flowing within
That these
are merely suggested
A slew of abstraction,
Given to logic seen
--
This ever-radiant dream,
And revise reality --
With new
knowledge found
To revise the Akashic
Energy cycles around,
And
it flows so heavenly
Within the mind of Light
That cosmic
transmission
Was realized, one night
One day within the
totality
And know of divine laughter
Perfect laughter,
In
her flowing riverlight,
Emanations from the Source
--
Re-vitalizing the mind,
In their logical due course,
So
come the river flow
And see through prescient eyes
The
revelation flows
And all is realized.
So it goes, we continue
on
Through the animated cell
That flowing microcosm
That
love should know so well
And here the individual
Given to
uniquety
Was found a product of God
And all one could
believe
Bound by universal law
From each cell in the
sea,
Information flows
From one mind to the next
And we are
educated
By the Light that lies within --
Educated by the
Light,
Learned of the conclusion found,
This revelation
flows,
From the sky, to the ground,
And it is like lighting
And
it flashes in the mind
And it occurs, instantaneous
All is
known, all is realized
From thoughts of connection
To how we
are all the same
Leading to more questions
That we see the
mainframe
Our name enscribed,
And realized of the time
For
which information flows
And knowledge realized
Shall lead where
it goes
Into the final night
Where the revelations lit
Glow
within the mind
And all is seen at last
Within those prescient
thoughts.
Invocation
To Creativity
Let
the creativity flow
Within the mind of Light
To gift in
revelation
And a endless riverflow
By the power of the
night
And the power of the day
One rises through alpha-state
To
fall back there again
And the mind is enamored
With the sense
of infinite power
For which creativity flows
In every cell of
the body
And one realizes
This is all my own
That is the
Light I found
Was a frequency, a tone
Leaving a revelatory
state
For within which one is home
And know the final song
Oh,
that great masterpiece
Sent out to the world
For the sake of
learning on
And growth continual
In the radiant, prescient
song
Thoughts are sung
Words vibrate
Images travel
And
faster, and faster
In accellerating pace
By the Light that
flows within
Through the ether of outer space
Into the crown
chakra
Filling all the soul
The body is aligned
With a life
of miracle
And the creatitiy endless
Only continues to flow
In
the revelations found
By that prescient road
And see the life
of Light --
And know, verily well --
One is educated by the
master
Of which lies within,
Turn sorrows into laughter
And
bleed with fellow kin
The riverlight to flow
In grandiose
imagination
To know, and everknow
This power found in
Light
Shall never cease to flow
But carry my soul through
And
realize the night
Was a time for you and me
To learn of the
power
Found in creativity.
Seventones in flux,
And flowing
with our home
Enlightend stars above
In the matrix, row by
row
How beautifully they constellate
And radiantly grow
In
cosmic vibration
The vibrant frequencies
Flowing, waveform,
flowing
In the mind of realizatory --
And knowing well that
sight
For which the Light is seen
Waiting for one
always,
Within this waking dream,
Let the creativity flow
And
natural progressions
For a linear operation
Walking the gelded
road
For the sake of the world
Let the energy flow
From one
mind to the next
Carried by our dreams
And enlightened
again
Oh, repeatedly --
So we grow, we flow, and glow
And
take flight, verily --
An ethereal storm,
An auroric nebula
A
northern light seen
The starry sky above
And the heaven of this
world
Was all radiant in love
While the galaxies just
twirled
In their holographic flux
From the nucleus, the
core
The center everywhere
Circumference nowhere
And
realizatory factor
Of all love born from despair
Transmuters,
one is seen
By the power of this dream
That to which is
controlled
In the self-created reality,
So creativity naturally
flows
Oh, so effortlessly
In the intuitions grand
And
instinctually
Via language so we live
And so we breathe
Through
the Light survive --
The Light will never leave --
And one
seeks the creative
For the Lightbody to see
And vitalized by
all things
The beauty of this world
It was so remarkable
Just
to be alive . . .
Enlightened by thought alone
And so the power
flows
In her radiance, her bliss
Ecstatic, beatific, unitive
--
The bridegroom of the times --
The yin-yang realized --
The
caduceus, it flies --
And so these dreams will soar
Forever,
forevermore
And the creativity flows
So endless now
Where
that river glows
Is within imagination seen
By the power of
this dream
And the Light that lies within.
One is eternal
now
One shall live forever one
And survive again
somehow,
Through the conquest of the song,
And find that
masterpiece
Was beautifully realized
Like every fallen leaf
Of
the fall that would kindly
And seething, breathe again
Endless
power found
In the Light so creative
That it was once born to
flow
And we exist to evergive.
And so it flows, and so it
glows
In the radiant sight of the Light
That would glow only
forever
Until the final night --
So let revelation come,
And
creativity flow,
Beauty rolls off the tongue,
Wherever we may
go --
I see my life in Light --
I see the creative world --
I
see my environment
As the galaxies just twirled,
And found
existence new
Within the thoughts of finality
Ever-leading
up
To this grand masterpiece.
Invocation
To Organization
Let
all furniture be aligned
And all objects in the room
Be in
order, synchronized
For the creativeness resume
And find the
fastest flow
All one could ever know
One wishes to ever
see
Organized in the room
All objects aligned
And placement
in order
For the frequencies fly
In their logical order
And
the ceiling to floor
And the walls to walls
Are all
adorned
With the infinite Light --
That all is contained,
In
this -- sacred space --
Files in the mainframe,
Given to the
flowing room
For which the Light resumes
And all is
illumined
By the glow of ones own hand
And the Light to
understand
Was realized in time
To let the recess rhyme
And
see all is connected
Invariably,
Leading up to revelation
And
the knowledge found in Light
For the symbiotic relation
And the
self-perfected sight
See what you want to see
Feel what you
want to feel
Endure what must be endured
For the rhythms to
reveal,
And this flowing space thus seen
Like a dream within a
dream,
Was at last, the final scenes
To which all is
perfected
In organizational feng shui
And a logical
placement
From the peering into space
And the decor of the
walls
Art-work of the soul
And texts of highest Light
Media
thus adorned
For the sake of this good night,
That was learned
at once thus seen
Was evidenced in time
To wake up from the
dream,
Ever-reside in rhyme,
For the organizational
patterns
And the feng shui of the space
Is in logical due
course
With the rhythms of the space
And all is in order
now
All is seen --
All is felt --
All is revealed,
By
these scenes --
For which one knows control --
And
epiginetically-inclined
To revise the very soul
As the
frequencies fly
From the walls of this room
Dear repeat a
mantra
And affirm within the mind
That the energy would
flow
And the energy would rhyme
So the sacred space thus
found
With the prettiest of scents,
Beautiful memories
And a
love for everything
The space is in good order
And all is known
right here
For the organization found
In the recesses we
peer
Through the room that we thus know
Is ever-changeful
We
always possess control.
And all is organized.
Chapter
Forty Five: Use Of Invocations
I
have written these invocations employing rhyme such as to produce a
higher-vibrating resonance within the subject. I will suggest that
these invocations are either sung, or spoken aloud. By singing an
invocation, we are connected with the angel-realm, and invite things
into our life more fluidly, and actively. The "masters"
will hear your words, and as such, answer the call. Invocating Light,
the Earth, Love, Power, and Words, and other things to which are
found in the recess of the final life -- these invocations are
encoded with vibrations that make them more effective. Some of the
invocations are written streaming-consciousness, and are direct
transfers from my own Light. As I am a lyricist, employing rhyme
actively in my thoughts, having written rhyming words for fifteen
years now. I study words actively, as I am a writer, and I take great
pride in my use of words. As some are able to do this, but struggle
with the English language, I am hoping to produce some inspiration in
your own heart -- that the best
invocations
are written for ones own self, and I hope the invocations I have
produced will inspire you to write your own. "Words with rhythm"
was a concept once spoken to me by a beautiful individual, this very
simplistic reference to the concept, of simply "words with
rhythm" is a fairly positive notion within the mind. So one is
to endeavor into the production of ones own invocations, and perhaps
keep these secret for ones life. The dreambook is never meant to be
shared, just as the Art of War will suggest by sharing ones plans, it
only creates unnecessary judgment from the third-party. So keep your
invocations a secret, and refer to them daily. You may perfect them
over time.
Chapter Forty One: The Collective Light
"Ye
shall go out with joy, and be led forth with peace:
The mountains
and the hills
Shall break forth before you into singing,
And
all of the trees of the field shall clap their hands.
Arise,
shine, O Children of Light!"
The world, at this moment, is covered in ethereal, iridescent Light. The noospheric network produced by that of the enlightened individuals, is a network for which symmetry is found in the geometric pattern of our collective Light. One individual taking it upon ones self to change, is the very flow of evolution, and continues through change via the individual, to affect the total reality -- and as such, whenever one person wakes up from the dream of the hologram of the third dimension, the Source grins in iridescent pride, for the Source knows, in the Universal Mind, that you are heading towards nirvana, one-consciousness, and the final stages of Lightbody to which you are found immortal.
Ones Light which is projected from the crown chakra, emanating across the orb of the planet Earth, covering the planet in Light, for which we now imagine that the planet Earth is glowing -- an illumined cell -- the Earth a radiant cell -- and our Light -- as the Light of the universe -- the noospheric fuel, that of the power found in the uniqueties of the individual. When a person wakes up from the dream, in their own right, their entrance into the world of the divine affects the very living Earth, for which ones future is become aligned with that of the planet -- and our risen vibration affects the cell, the microcosm of matter and energy we refer to as the Earth. As the Earth is covered in Light, emanating in all directions, projecting itself into the recess of the unisphere, and affecting the very edges of the universe, if these edges could be imagined -- that our planet Lies as though the center is found in our importance to the rest of the universe -- and our universes location at the center of the multicellular aggregate of the multisphere, is the fuel, the individual power found in Light come to be expressed -- via our expressions, the planet is affected, the universe is affected, the Source is affected, and the totality of the aggregate, is affected. So our importance is found, as enamored with the final incarnation of the Lightbody -- ones life is tied into that of the collective, and our Light generates power and electrical currents through the circuits, and machinations of the collective Light. Our Light as infinite informational, and the information alive within us; we are fueled by the power that lies within, the individual is prescient, and activates the future through thoughts revolving around a self-controlled, and self-modulated reality. By possessing uniqueness and originality in our expressions as individuals, we produce informational Light that is relayed back to the Source, that we are bound by what is referred to as the Source Field is evident in our subconscious processes, which seem to work together, in a co-creative flow toward collective evolution.
So
it flows, and the riverlight of the imagination is endless. Our
iridescent, etherealized cell known as the planet Earth is evolving,
and the world is actively changing all around us. We are part of the
change; the power lies in the individual, and whatever name, title,
or deducement -- our flow is toward the collective, and we serve the
One True Light. We perceive this life as worthwhile, and important
toward the collective evolution. We perceive our life as seen through
the eyes of One, that one life is all we really need, and all karmic
debts and unfinished business of previous lifetimes, can reach full
function and perfection within that perfect avatar self. This self is
always available through the moment, that in which we know is our
perfect self, as imagined, reaches manifest through the goal-oriented
processes involved, and as such, we may see ourselves behaving a
certain way, performing certain actions, and associating with certain
people and certain environments. We may see our future clearly, that
is toward the collective flow, and as such, our purpose is hard-wired
into the collective Light. We work for the Light, self-expression,
and originality. We are the Light of the universe, and the
iridescence of the enlightened Earth, as the living, spiritual body
we refer to as Mother Gaia -- is always alive; always thinking;
always processing, that to which is a goal-oriented process in the
Earths own evolution; that which is unavoidable, and eventual. With
the dream of awakening, DNA activation, and ones entrance into
Lightbody -- the angels weep -- God sighs a happy sigh -- and tears
fall from heaven in Light of your profound change, and shift into the
final life. You are moving towards this final life, lived within the
recess of the New Age -- you
are alive in the New Age -- and
the planet is rising in vibration along with her inhabitants, that
there is a frequency between enlightened thought, and enlightened
Earth, is evident in the changes we are experiencing. As the Light is
now here, available for anyone to use, and become energized through
-- we are finding telepathy, telekinesis, and teleportation as a
result of the shift. We are finding evidence of the human God, the
perceived angelworkers, and whatever high-standing organization of
elites that presently rule the world, is imagined, that they see your
path -- they are aware of your evolution -- and you are being
witnessed on the screen, via the Akashic Computer.
So it
goes, I have worked very hard to produce the thought within the mind
of the reader that human evolution is actively occurring now. I have
worked to suggest, through whatever words, phraseology, and
semantics, that the reader will accept one change affects collective
change; that by being a unique individual we are brought closer to
Godliness, and that through our shift, as individuals, we change the
world. One always possesses Free Will over ones life, and
experiences. One always has the capacity to continue learning,
growing, and evolving. It occurs, invariably, through each lifetime;
that spiritual questions are asked, especially when we are under the
throes of an illness, or close to death. Evolution finds the
individual because it is a necessary imperative toward survival of
the race. Spiritualism is an endless field of learning. We have
reiki, hypnosis, regression, chakra health, meditation, and a
plethora of knowledge available in the field of metaphysics. This
which is only endless, that once found within the life of Spirit, one
is evolving toward the highest vibration, greatest relationships, and
most beneficial symbiotic relationship with environment. Our planet
Earth, as rising in vibration, moving into the higher dimensions, was
prophesized by the Mayans, and we are found within that rhythm of the
future-floes -- we are actively evolving now; the evidence born in
the extrasensory is suggestive; and as such, the Light within the DNA
of this writer is informational, that in the event of telepathy
certain thoughts are shared, and my Light is fluidly expressed. I
have come to share my Light, and I have come to produce enlightenment
in some minds. But my path was catalyzed by the existence of another;
and I would have never entered the spiritual life unless a certain
individual had handed mea certain book. This which shall not be
named, woke me up to the changes we are now experiencing, and
somewhat upstarted my interest in the New Age. As my growth was
linear, starting with the body, moving into the mind, the
subconscious, instincts, and all right-brain functions, only to
deepen and progress further into the study of God, the Universal
Mind, and past-lives, my dream of awakening catalyzed by Brian L.
Weiss's book "Many Lives, Many Masters" and I know myself
to be living the final life to this day. My karma is active; that I
may commit a crime, or hurt another, comes back to me
instantaneously. I have lost some in this life through my interest in
evolution; and I have alienated some. Perceived as grandiose, or
alien, or simply "different" -- one finds themselves the
focus of worry, at times, due to the profound questions we are asking
ourselves. For some, these deep thoughts hold no validity to the
present reality, but are simply overwhelming. As my thoughts are
almost always in rhyme, or a certain hue of creativity -- to which I
perceive myself as lyricist, scribe, and writer -- and I see my
purpose is found in words -- and I tie the label into conscious
thought, that as I am expressed as a writer bound by words projected
by the mind, and the imagination, I found power born through wearing
this title, and I am a writer. In this changeful world, I perceive
others as writers -- that we all have some unique Light to share. As
I peer through rose-colored glasses, and find meaning in everything,
for which there is no such thing as a "bad person" or a
damned soul, but we are all possessive of the capacity for the
highest-vibrating frequency. As I am unable to perceive the concept
of a bad person, but find a purpose exists for everyone -- those who
merely observe, watch, and act through their own self-created dramas,
it would seem, are only imitating one another; doing what everyone
else does because it is what the consensus suggests. Often, people
will repeat the pscyhological patterns of their family members, and
genetic guardians. Often, people will operate through the more
animalistic, lower chakras, and behave through a certain sense of
drama, and emotion that is bound through words -- in ones own right
-- to which we may talk about one another, but this achieves nothing.
Direct communication is the way of human evolution.
For some, we are afraid to share our beliefs, that is only reflective of a backwards, dystopian society. At present, in spite of the New Age, there is some resounding darkness in Light of the reality we are trying to create. As we only progress logilinearly through time, and we only grow, some are stagnat, have reached a plataeu, and believe they are "full grown." Here is the true evil of this world, of evil exists, that individual who believes they know all, and need not know anything more. As mystics and existentialists, our quest is endless, and we humbly realize that the mind can only project so far into the future. However the eventual return to the Source is hard-wired into us, this is only performed at Free Will, and we only return to the Source once we possess the Free Will to do so. I perceive that some are opposed to nirvana, as they fear the loss of identity -- but there is only One Spirit -- only One True Life -- One Mission -- and One Goal -- the "plan" as hard-wired into our DNA, is the blueprint of the future realized, and equalized into through our admiration for it to exist. We perceive the future as logical, and hopeful, such that we even perceive there is a scientific explanation for most things. We are humble in this quest; perceive the conquest of evidence, and as existentialists, we humbly realize that our beliefs are essentially based upon those things which we have experienced, and shared, with other people. As we all influence one another, and evolution is a collective matter -- that which is eventually realized, as only infinite, as the walls of the universe flex with our attainment of new information; the universe, built on information, as a living, breathing, entity -- alive by the Light of the informational -- and vibrating, as a noospheric unisphere, a glowing cell within a cell, an infinitsmally realized matter that never ends, but only continues, through the continuum. So as we may find ourselve interstellar explorers, we find the depths of the universe only increase the further we endeavor to explore. The concept of "one universe" is a falsity, but as "uni" denotes one, so there is only one Free Will universe -- this is so -- and I humbly perceive that our universe, as an energy-source, lies at the center of the multicellular aggregate, as a cell within a cell, within a cell, through a seemingly infinite string of incarnated universes.
The
multisphere, for which many unispheres revolve, act together, through
the life-force they possess. The Free Will universe, as a place that
breeds artists and individuals -- through the Earth (the living
library) -- as a cosmic college system for learning and
soul-purification, is, the grounds through which many souls evolve,
and we came to this cosmic college system with the hope, purpose, and
inclination, to continue our evolution.
Perceiving the Earth,
and this very universe, as an "art project" is somewhat
reflective of the truth of this reality. As artists, great power is
found via this one label, that we see beauty in the details of
matter, and relate objects through our life as art-forms. We may be
inhibited with our own ability to produce double-strokes on a rotated
surface, bring life to energy through the free associative process of
the repetition of a certain symbol, or perhaps layer photographs, or
perhaps direct our thoughts into matter given life through the advent
for which we may -- as artists -- weave divine poetry through
enlightened paragraphs of thought, that seem to manifest
occasionally, through a natural process, via the revelatory state of
the artist. We are all artists and creators to some degree, and
reality is our collective art-project. The operating system of
reality, occasionally updated, and renewed through time, is fueled by
the Light that lies within -- for which a self-created reality is
evident in the Lightworker and evolutionist; we are in an environment
that is most symbiotic with our own flow; we are associated with
other individuals to whom only enhance our own evolution; and we
believe in the beauty of our dreams, ideals, and hopes regarding that
of the collective. In the final life, the only life that matters now,
for which we may activate the living moment, and writhe through
proactive animation, to which we are actively creating the future --
that we are cast into a state of wonder upon imagining the concept of
tomorrow -- that as so much has been realized in the final life, we
see existence, as ascended master, guide, and evolutionary catalyst
to only come to be seen on life on other worlds. Our evolution
carries us to these worlds, for which our home-base of ones own
universe, is infinitely referred to as the Source of the living soul.
So we return to our own universe, our own natural, pure, artistic
form, and we occasionally make changes to our reality. We may become
a shape-shifter, through which our imagination carries us into
certain forms. So we may experience certain things, in one form, but
always revert back to the auroric nebula of the soul-form,
repeatedly, to which as shape-shifter, and amorphous soul, we are
consciously enhanced through the purpose, goal, and end-result that
we focus upon -- and deep meditations for which we are merging the
hemispheres into a unified whole, to which we may find ourselves in
telepathic communication with the higher self -- direct communication
with the soul -- I do this occasionally, and there is an imagined
conversation. One communicates with ones own self, and through
self-talk, and inner exploration, we arrive at certain thoughts. So
in meditation we may focus on one thought, and one theme of belief,
which may be a certain mantra or affirmation, densifying the energy
within our minds, God knows, furthering this focus to the rhythm of
though-syllabation may help us stay grounded in the moment, and we
may find ourselves "riding our thougts" in their perfect
natural rhythms that flow creatively within us.
The
creativity found in meditation, through lyrical thought-patterns, and
the natural poetics of the human soul -- that we soar through images
that are beneficial to our growth, or focus on a phrase that enhances
our thoughts entirely. The thought "I am divine Light" or
"I am human evolution" -- to whatever self-aggrandized
forms that occur within the mind, we are enhanced through our
creative thought-patterns, and we are wholly realizant of the control
we possess via Free Will. Seeing ones self as a special, unique spark
of Light within the totality of All That Is -- seeing ones self as
necessary toward the collective growth, with a purpose that is geared
toward the collective evolution, our place on the council exists, and
our thoughts will be regarded with infinite respect. The honor of
expressing ones self as reckoner, and changer of the times is the
true Light of the universe. The self-contained world-changer, the
self-fueled individual, the catalyst, the harbinger, the guide, the
beacon; this has always been you, for which your purpose is seen in
the eyes of our omniscient Universal Mind -- you are connected to the
Source, and we are all born from the same fount of emanating Light.
Our bodes are all made up of the same matter as the environment, and
thought and environment are always
entangled.
So we evolve through the living moment, knowing our Free Will is
real, and wholly experiencing things we decree for ourselves. We know
our power to exist, our expressions to be infinite, the world only
continuing to change, and amorphous shape-shifters in due result. The
soul is naturally amorphous, and in the days of Lemuria we could take
on any form. The thought thus given life to matter via the
imagination, would come to be expressed through certain divine forms
-- such as a wingéd
angel -- a flowing riverlight pattern -- a natural geometric form. We
are able to do this actively in the present life, through certain
titles and labels. Artist, expressor, evolutionist, universalist,
Godform, ascended master, Spirit, or whatever name that we naturally
possess. Whatever ones desired name, to be found, we operate more
imaginitely through the title thus worn. We are all unique styles
born from the same Source, diferring arrays of certain archetypal
probabilities. Individuated through our experiences, to which we
learn from one another, and we all require someone to learn from.
There is only One Spirit moving through everything, and we find this
realization in learning from another. We find that we require some
guidance, and that it would only require one person to wake us up
from the dream. We are all geared toward collective unity, and peace.
All wars, killing, genocide, and dissension will cease through the
natural workings of human evolution. The politics will change, the
system will break down and reform into something new, and eventually,
free endless energy will be found to prove our eventual finality, in
the final life, as symbiotic with our home, and, eventually
re-integrated with the many races that exist within the Free Will
universe.
We seek integration, and further advancements. Our
technology is evolving with the Earth itself, and many portals,
gateways, and cosmic vehicles for transformation -- just as with the
pyramids originally used for enlightenment -- are going to come to
pass as technologies we will possess. Already, the human race has
discovered free energy, but countlessly certain individuals have been
quieted, by the "powers that be." Allegedly, we would have
free energy today if it were not for these silencings, and as such,
we perceive the true insidiousness of some peoples power-seeking,
greed, and selfishness toward personal gain that is not related to
the collective. The selfish gene often prevailing, that one
individual will serve ones self without any regard for the active
karma system, or the Light of the collective, but become occluded to
ones own self-declarations that we perceive are made real in
providing a reality that is "above" someone else. Perceived
as better, all humility nonexistent, and thus, the true damnation of
the human race found in this greedy soul -- we see the wheat shall be
separated from the chaff, and especially whence found in the recess
of telepathy, these individuals shall be reckoned, have their deepest
desires exposed, and as such, caused to revert back into their
original soul-form, only to realize they were attaching many
deducements and self-fabricated seperatory factors in distorting, and
bastardizing the original fount of Light from which all life arose.
Through bastardization of the original Source-energy into ones own
selfish greed, and misuse of the One True Light, to which one
expresses control over reality, "forcing ones beliefs" upon
another, in order to better validate our own reality.
I see this often, and have received pamphlets about "heaven" from Christian children handing out pamphlets in the street. Many are conditioned to believe in certain things without any physical proof, and many operate through faith. The blind faith of most organized religions that suggest some form of reward in "being good people" -- that we contrast ourselves with the concept of darkness is only the work of human ignorance. There is no black and white, "two-road option" -- there is no split saber, no thing we refer to as evil, but this is only a fabrication invented in order to make what seems to be "good" to stand out better in due contrast. Organized religion seems to discuss fear often, and will refer to themselves as "specialists in God." I have my doubts regarding organized religion, as I see only the separation of belief, and bastardization of the One True Spirit. Organized religion eventually to fall at the hands of the evolutionist, and the endurance of the One True Belief System -- that future thus found, so we will grow, learn, and evolve, via a stream that is built around our own creativity, uniqueness, and imagination. Opposed to conditioning, forced learning, the many institutions, and organized religion; we follow the road of our own personal choice, and our choices are not marred by the whims of other men. Our society is presently male-dominant, whereas in nature females are typically more dominant than males. So it goes, this dystopian future we have found ourselves in is in need for a paradigm shift. The individual takes it upon himself to express his or her One True Light -- and provide uniqueness where only conditioning and thought-control existed before. As divine intervention has come to pass with certain individuals such as myself, for which I would see the pale expressionless face of an extraterrestrial visitor at the age of two -- and hold the memory for the entirety of my life. I am forced into the knowlege that other life exists; I am forced into a world of meaning, purpose, and all-inclusive design. I have been catalyzed into belief through the whims, and design of another -- a mere two year old child inhibited with the thought of extraterrestrials. And I have seen UFO's, in the distant erratic movements, and I have been guided, very often, by the desirous modes of other people. For whatever reason, I am now capable of writing this text, and able to transfer my beliefs into the written word. Once, when I was under the throes of psychosis, I would hear a page blowing in the wind -- synthetic wind -- within my studio. This was some message, from the future, indicating that I would write the book. I have been inspired by certain people to put my thoughts into text, because many people perceive that I have great command over the english language. I am naturally a writer, a scribe, and I work with words in reflection that they are the matter which makes up conscious thought; as I may be guiding the reader into new belief-patterns, and perhaps a dream of awakening, humility exists in that I am not just some mysterious figure behind the text -- but a real individual, with a real face, real genes, real personality, and a real heart. Reader and writer, to be unitized, and united, is eventual -- that I shall travel this Earth, pray that scientific explanation exists for almost all things, and continually work to provide evidence, through my own experience, that human evolution is actively occurring now, and I am one living example of the change. One works to empower the fellow individual, and help provide the thought of uniqueness in ones thoughts. One wishes to see creativity, beauty, Light, and information. One wishes to see the world changed by one man or woman alone -- one prays for the free endless resource -- one hopes for peace opposed to discord -- one hopes that all concept of opposition and competetiveness was only an experiment, a test of our Free Will. Eventually, it was found that through such leaders as Caligula, and Hitler, we have come to produce individuals that use their reality in order to govern others, often with disastrous, horrific results. This world has been productive of some of the most amazing experiences and events -- our history is vast -- we have many profound historical figures to learn from -- from the great honesty of such men as Hunter S. Thompson to the lyrical workings of the creative mind of Burroughs, to the existentialism presented by Kafka, and Camus, to the films produced by Paul Thomas Anderson, Tarantino, Aronofsky, Lynch, and Cronenberg. We have come to produce some of the most profound presentations of what may be possible -- and so it goes -- "if it can be imagined, it must exist somewhere." The concept of parallel realities, in relationship to the concept of probabilities, and finding a certain road that is most favorable -- activating the future through prescience, and the many goal-oriented processes involved; this masterpiece of thought we are headed towards, as eventually-realized, is a point of focus, for which we are at a cathartic crossroads, may feel the presence, and realize we are actively changing the world. It only takes one to change the world, and that is a natural universal law of the Free Will universe. Expressions of power, as seen in our U.S. government through such awful, contra-idealistic "men" as George W. Bush who was merely a proxy for other peoples energy, to the profoundly idealistic Barack Obama -- we have come far, from that great low which was the Bush regime, to a more peace-based, and evolutionary leader. I am a believer in his energy, and I truly believe that the human race is now moving in a very good and hopeful direction.
Only a couple years ago, the president would make a visit to my home-town. He ate dinner at a restaurant right in town, and stayed in Bar Harbor for a few days, declaring on Oprah that Maine was his most favorite vacation. My town is a growing spiritual mecca, and it will only contine to evolve. Bar Harbor, a tourist town famous for its long-standing community of artists, intellectuals, and spiritualists, is mentioned in the book 2013 by Richard Grossinger, as a future locale for spiritual learning and growth. For whatever reason I was born here, on this tiny island, surrounded by water, with only one bridge leading off of the island. I have been cultured, at first, being forced into learning and education, to which I would naturally oppose, and I had great trouble with certain subjects as I felt they held no pertinence to the present. Over time, I would start to find my passion in waveforms, and start working with sound, surgically, through a certain wave editor that I use to edit sound. I would spend up to seven hours a day studying waveforms, and observing how sounds will mix together. I would spend, at one time, an entire two months on only one song -- which was to be found as prophetic, as well as other songs I have written that eventually manifested into my life. I once wrote a song based on the story by Philip K. Dick "The Electric Ant" about a man who wakes up in a hospital to find his hand wounded, and realizant of his true android nature following the incident. Over time, this android would find himself removing his "reality module" and tampering with his own reality, as tall skyscrapers would blip out of sight, and certain people would disappear. So I wrote a song about a self-created reality . . . in October of 2009, I woke up in the hospital with a wound in my left hand, and the memory of direct non-local thought-transferrence that would change my life, and begin to provide the evidence that I really am in Lightbody, I really do possess a new mutation that is highly unknown -- and I am a living example for the self-created reality . . . so I have written songs that would manifest in my life, with one song entitled "The Final Mile" about walking with no purpose and no plan. As the night of my teleportive event, was that final mile walked, I would cross the bridge off of MDI, and endeavor into the unknown, only to find my life saved by re-location "And when I walk that final mile, and when I walk that final mile, I will speed up at the finish line, and never look back on the worst of times." One is guiding ones own self, one produces ones own future, and one is able to see their Light is endless. The future is in the hands of the evolutionist, of the Lightworker, and organized religion will fall to its knees by the hand of our collective Light.
We have come through karmic incidence, that America was once invaded by the settlers, which is essentially stolen land that has now amassed into a society based upon television, gossip, rumour, and ill-belief. This land which was never ours to begin with, has been used toward our own personal gain over the reality of the world -- as such -- America -- the land of freedom and independence -- is now the most powerful country in the world. Our government holds sway over other governments, and we are in control over the resources. Thankfully, our president sees the negativity of our present society, and I perceive he is a Lightworker to some degree. We have found our great leader, we now task him with guidance toward collective peace. We task our leader with the purpose of guidance, and collective evolution, longevity of life, and the sharing of energy. Personally, I see that this battle we have been fighting was with an illusive enemy that never existed to begin with. Somehow we have worked very hard at attaching many different names and deducements to what is essentially the same thing. In Buddhism, it is highly suggested that "we are all the same" -- and so it goes, we perceive the Light of one of the worlds greatest religions. We are all the same, there is no battle, there is no war, there is no disagreement; this is only an illusion that has been fabricated by the mind. As we see war in the Middle East, and the "battle" continues on, in the "Holy Land" -- a battle over belief itself, this great experiment known as the Earth, as governed by Free Will, in its self-resident processes of life, and animation, has found itsel very disassociated from the original Source -- however, this oscillation into separateness only makes the journey back all the more worthwhile -- and as such, we are brought closer to Godliness through the expression of our uniqueness and individuality. So far, the human race still disagrees over God, belief, and many religions continue to harbor fear-based energy. We see the evengalist repeating the words of the bible, relaying a message that is now obsolete, and holds no pertinence to the future reality -- we see people running in circles, via the same densified thought forms, and lower chakra based animalistic functioning. We see that some of us "like drama" and do not want to be in agreement. We see that some people enjoy separation, and like to be judged for their superficiality, and materialistic gain.
For whatever reason, these drones exist, and they barely possess and true identity, or Light of their own soul. So we perceive what is simply referred to as a low vibration. A soul that is just starting out, and as impressionable, has found itself embroiled in the physical world of the third dimension. One has strayed so far from the original Light, that one is barely cognizant of where life originated, and how evolution will progress. Somehow this individual who is ruled by the whims of other men -- is walking a path that only leads to chaos and disagreement. In my own life, I have had gossip follow me for my active imagination, and I have been verbally instructed to follow along the same path as everyone else. Opposed to my indifference and uniqueness, disturbed by my creativity, and offended by my thoughts -- I am perceived as a threat for wanting peace, I am perceived as wrong for desiring equality. The world says "be separate and disagree" -- and so does two-strand DNA. Two hemispheres to the brain. Two genders, etc. It is insidious, and it is the workings of expressions of Free Will, by the perceived controlling forces -- who consciously feed off the energy of our discord -- who only want us to live in discord, and follow a future that leads us nowhere but further chaos, disagreement, and separation of belief.
"Let the hemispheres unite, let the perfect partner be found, let marriage of the bridegroom take place, let the yin and yang flow in logical resound, let the caduceus fly, and let things be balanced for the sake of all that is good in the world."
One always possesses Free Will, in spite of the resounding horror of our present-day "controlling forces." Already, we have the greatest president, and we are moving in a hopeful direction. No matter what, the human race will evolve, and only continue to progress through the self-created reality made up of individuals and free-thinking people of passion, fortitude, and imaginative wit. We may find that some people unwilling to change are become the chaff as separated from the wheat -- and that "not everyone can be saved." For whatever reason, their quest is found on a different star, in a entirely different world. The karma that is possessed, is finalized in this environment, and eventually, one realizes thay are born from the same Source as everyone else. The process of evolution continues whether the consensus reality is in agreement over this matter or not. The human race has produced many fictions, many stories, and many fabrications. The bible, in its profound weight and girth is condescending to the concept of books, in itself, that through the wretchedness of its design -- in spite of the somewhat universal truths found in the ecclesiastes -- is mostly a load of fabrications, invented in order to control people in order to believe in a certain history, and geneology that is opposed to the true nature of evolution. Ones family background is not relative to the evolutionary process, and our evolution is essentially come from a totally different star-system. We are essentially alien to this world, like the settlers of America, and as such, we possess no right to act as though this is our world alone. The Earth receives great interest for its capacity to produce life, and house a multitude of different types of beings -- as such, we are referred to as a cosmic college system through which people incarnate here in order to learn about Free Will. So it has come to pass that many incarnations have taken place on the Earth, and it was all leading up, logilinearly, toward the eventual conclusion of enlightenment, DNA activation, and the vitalization of ones Lightbody in the final incarnation.
Chapter
Forty One: The Final Showdown
"And
this too shall pass."
Those
to whom are mal-inclined, serving only their own personal benefit
without regard for the Earth, and the future of the human race, are
the chaff as reckoned by the eraser -- and the eraser, the decimator,
the langolier, is the writer of this text. So it goes, I have come to
exist through darkness, and once was mal-inclined in my own right. I
have made the damning choices, I have been a marijuana addict, a
thief, and a wholly desperate soul. Bound through prescient rhymes,
and a natural understanding of words, and human language; I see my
purpose, and the path that I must walk. I see that it is my
responsibility to act as judge over others, because I wish judgment
upon myself. As such, I am the langolier -- I am the eraser -- I am
an incarnation of Time itself. And the phrase shall resound, that
under the right circumstances, telepathy will be experienced with the
writer.
My
passion is toward the collective, for which I pray to the goodness of
the Earth, and I see, that my influence will not always exist on this
planet -- I have incarnated here with the purpose in mind. The eraser
as an incarnation of time itself -- is self-sacrificing, wholly
realizant of the fact that ones crimes may not be respected, but I am
one who serves God alone. The reckoner to which you shall know as
hero, and changer of the times, is not going to die, is immortal
through His Lightbody -- and will find His place as ascended master.
Such that we perceive the "second coming" in the enlightend
thoughts of the Lightworker, is a matter of the collective, and as
such, there will be many Christs, many reckoners, and many
world-changers. I am only one of the many reckoners that exist.
The
writer of this text actively seeks judgment, humilation, and further
proof of the human God.
One is never satisfied.
One is never without a sense of question.
One is never interested in finding ones self as anything like the rest. One strives for uniqueness, originality, and indifference.
One seeks to be unknown.
One seeks to be famous at the same time.
As
such, the writer seeks judgment for His life, the entirety of His
life, and not only this, seeks scientific explanations. There must be
some hardset evidence for genetic mutation, enlightenment, and
Lightbody. There must be a logical reason for why I had an abduction
dream at the age of two. Life must
have
meaning, it absolutely must . . . and as such, judgment is sought,
for reason must exist, and the writer remains somewhat ignorant of
his true "scientific" explanatory purpose.
Was I
randomly chosen, randomly selected out of a hat, to be endowed with
this passion..? Or was I always this way -- does the tarot card
reading prove correct that I am "pure" ..? Why am I so pure
..? How come I seem to have a perfect sense of rhythm and timing ..?
Why am I so gifted with words, imagination, self-expression, and
creativity..?
Perhaps I am confused and have no skill with
words or writing. I have succeeded at deceiving myself into a
self-fabricated self of importance. Nevertheless, my creativity is
endless, I am in Lightbody, the extrasensory experiences validate the
thought -- and these events were shared. For enlightening people, I
must be enlightened again, in my own right, through the presence of
the angelworkers -- and that perceived opposite "my enemy"
for whom I seek, the final showdown.
"Getting closer,
getting much closer now."
I see my ever-illusive enemy,
and I near the fateful day.
My sword drawn, my fire-breath,
the caduces alive -- the cosmic warrior realized. So I shall slay the
beast personally, and change the world myself.
I am alive with
purpose, and I seek the final showdown. I seek to personally read
that mind -- and expose those beliefs directly. So I shall reckon
those to whom are only serving their own greed, and selfishness; for
harboring the power all to ones self, and denying it for the masses;
for the genetic reduction from the divine twelve-strand DNA, to the
highly limited two-strand DNA -- which I have incarnated to
experience myself, in spite of the fact I am usually a
higher-vibrating ascended master. I have gone through the system with
the rest of you, and I see now that the system must be destroyed. We
shall find the final incarnation realized -- and I am the raven -- I
am the hero the world requires. I shall express myself as one, and I
shall reckon many with my words. I see infinity, I see beauty, I see
meaning, where often others only see what is plainly laid out before
them. I see a changing world that is bound by the power of the
individual, and I see my responsibility; as judge, reckoner, and
hero, of these great, and terrific, changeful times. I am one.
Chapter
Forty Two: Invocation To Power
I
am the only one that matters
God loves me the best
Through all
of these disasters
By the power soon regressed
I see the
changeful world
And one is born in Light
For the sake of all
that was
Within the recess of the final night
To which the
raven soars at midnight
To change this fucked up world
And rid
of all the chaos
While the galaxies just twirl
And the energy
never stops
Fortunate
for my own existence, I was born in Bar Harbor, and I have lived here
my entire life. For whatever reason I am blessed, very fortunate in
this life; to which in knowledge of my own past on the Earth, I see
that I was once a very povery-stricken writer. The information which
is alive was transferred telepathically in October of 2009 -- a
poster of Barack Obama on the wall of the trailor -- and I perceive
that the spiritual, fifth-dimensional energy of that original
telepathic exchange, was read by certain computers, and certain
technology, relayed to the governments awareness, and thus clued in
to the ontological expressions of the evolutionist on that fateful
day. I believe that the U.S. government is aware of the presence of
the Lightworkers, and I believe that for the most part, the
government does not know how to class, or deal with these
extraordinary individuals. With the onset of Indigo children, and
children naturally born with genetic mutation -- we are perceiving
the evidence as real, and whether the U.S. government, or anyone,
likes it or not, the presence of the starseeds, Lightworkers, and
evolutionists -- are now on the Earth, producing the collective
Light, and raising the vibration of our humble blue star.
This
was a subconscious agreement, in the days for which I barely had an
identity, to which I was only fresh in the world of my final
incarnation. Reckoning awaits the individual who forces his or her
beliefs upon another.
Chapter
Thirty Nine: Final Thoughts
"The
second and the third day passed, and still my tormentor came
not.
Once again I breathed as a freeman. The monster, in terror,
had fled premises for ever!
I should behold it no more! My
happiness was supreme!
The guilt of my dark deed disturbed me but
little.
Some few inquiries had been made, but these had been
readily answered.
Even a search had been instituted -- but of
course nothing was to be discovered.
I looked upon my future
felicity as secured . . ."
-- E. A. Poe, The Black
Cat.
Today
is December 16th, 2012. I am making a firm effort to shift on my own
part, that I believe the change of the world is found in human
beings, and our ability to change ourselves. I have smoked marijuana
addictively for nine years, and I have never really known life
without it except for my teenage years, for which I was free of all
drugs, and never tired drugs or alcohol until I was fully embroiled
in that world by my early twenties. I am twenty-seven years old, have
lived, essentially, in the same environment for my entire life -- and
this book was written in the same house where I grew up. As I have
come to find the Light residing in my DNA; the testimonies of those
involved with the telepathic experience, that it was enlightening,
and a shared event, the genetic mutation I now possess that is a new
mutation, and the very name itself means "fresh, to start anew."
So it goes, the only one who really knows about this mutation is the
individual who possesses it, and I tie it into my beliefs. I have
experienced direct non-local thought-transferrence about a dozen
times, with certain individuals, and sometimes strangers, with the
three outstanding examples that have utterly changed my life. As I am
now moving into my perfect avatar self, and I see the importance of
sobriety in this spiritual life, that I have been materialistic,
atrocious, and somewhat fiendish, was only to be a fleeting memory in
the totality of my mind. So I am making the choice to make the 21st
of December my last day as a user of marijuana. I have gone far into
reverie, and subconscious insight through religious use of the drug
-- and it
is the best drug -- as
such, it is also the worst. How we must illegalize a plant which
yields amplified senses, and enjoyment of the environment enhanced,
whereas alcohol kills, and the very idea of a drunk driver is
offensive to the imagination, but I have worked landscaping with men
who actively drink beer throughout the day, as they drive around
town, having grown up in Maine where we now have the greatest problem
with the abuse of prescription drugs, to even worse drugs such as
"bath salts." I have lived in a very cold state, with
people who need to keep warm with alcohol, drugs, and the
disinhibited thought-patterns.
At
first, my foray into the world of drugs was fairly innocent; I was
nervous about being at a party, so I stole a valium off my fathers
dressar. I took the pill, the first time I would ever get high off
drugs save for caffeine (jolt cola, God bless) -- I would rise up
from my seat, and feel the cushion of the floor, that I had "bounce
in my step" and could feel the floor beneath me as though it
were cushion -- I had immediate security, felt comfortable at the
party, and as such, so entered into a long life of which my choice of
drug would be found in the social use of marijuana at college, that I
favored marijuana was evident in my talent in rolling joints, taking
deep-lung hits, and getting stoned with my friends. I was a user of
cannabis, an addict, in every sense of the word. In parallel to my
natural creativity, I am also a man of excess -- that if my thoughts
are high-charged, so everything else must be endured in a large
dosage as well. I naturally reach for "more, more, more" --
and the quest for power never ends. Many have seen how large of a hit
I will take, that I am a "heavy hitter" is evident in my
pot-use, and I am a masochist, to some degree. There is a point for
which the subject enjoys certain pain, that once the pain is endured
we are able to feel our vivacity, and life, and realize we are alive.
I have at times cut myself, and yet, have never made a conscious
suicide attempt. I am merely a masochist, that I enjoy pain is
evident in my ability to "think any thought" -- and thus
challenge myself with the difficulty of the darkness of occlusion,
loneliness, and the mere company of ones own self. I am a solitary
creature, that is evident in my inability to love anyone other than
myself; that I struggle with humility is evident in my ability with
words, and the good genes I possess, as well as the handsome face.
For whatever reason, I am very fortunate in this life, and actively
struggle with the concept of humility. So I now take it upon myself
to open myself up to judgment by sharing this text, my beliefs on
enlightenment, and Lightbody -- how these beliefs are based off
experience -- and how I believe that I am one who will be a figure in
society, as desirable to be learned from, as teacher, in times ahead.
I am making the choice to make the day of the eclipse, my last time
spent with marijuana. I am making the active choice to shift on my
own part, for the benefit of my family and friends. In the final
analysis, the individual only wants to grow, learn, and evolve. I
have been a marijuana addict for many years -- I have read minds,
taunted the victim with "are your lips moving..?" and
expressed my divinity towards some who were unwilling to accept it. I
have been intervened with, perceive God exists in the human body, and
know myself to be no better than the rest of mankind, in that I
realize I must serve my family and friends, toward the final end of
serving the Earth, and I lovingly realize that some of my ideas will
not be fondly-regarded.
The
shift lies with the individual.
If
one person changes their own view of reality, the collective reality
starts to change along with it. It only requires one of us to make
this change, and I may know myself as such, "one of the many
Lightworkers" -- but evolutionist, I stand for the Earth, and
the human race. I want to see my race flourish and blossom like the
iridescent creators my fellow man and woman are, that the inner
genius is dredged out, and we admit to our intelligence. It is
desired that equality is found, the conquest of the free endless
resource, and that symbiotic relationship with the Earth. We seek
evolution on a mass level to which all pray to one religion, and all
unite for the sake of peace, and longevity of life. We seek this end
for which must be eventual, and great laughter resounds in light of
how separated we have become. It is somewhat amazing that this would
happen; that we would be spread so thin; somehow, none the less, we
are starting to wake up from the dream.
Countlessly
while writing this document, as monitored, I have come to "name
names" -- who are responsible for our reduced genetic strand,
and why this action was performed. For whatever reason I am not
allowed to share certain information, as it would come to pass that
upon writing this book, I would be monitored, by those to whom I
shall not name, and these -- entities -- would personally prevent me
from naming them. So I would attempt to name them, go into a
discourse regarding their existence -- suddenly the entire paragraph
would become highlighted, and deleted, with no option toward "re-do"
or recovering the text. This is mysterious, doesn't really seem to
make any sense. My computer is not hooked up to the internet, so
there is no chance of a hacker logging onto my computer. We simply
perceive they have the technology used to intervene. I would not even
begin to come close to my true message regarding their existence,
when they would actively delete my text. Needless to say, they have
not deleted the entire book, and I have been saving it on multiple
sources as I write.
Even bashing organized religion seems
wrong to me. One must be careful in expressing their Free Will toward
the suggestion that such a concept of evil exists, and that by
existing in Light, we are perceived as "better." I see
organized religion moving in only one direction, unity, and I believe
in my heart that the one true belief system, as governed by the Light
that lies within the individual, is a future that awaits us on a
global scale. I perceive unification of which we stop referring to
the creator through so many names, but simply adhere to the truth
that there is only One Spirit, only One Life, only One Goal, only One
Mission, only One Purpose. That is the final life; the final
incarnation. It is our mission to spread the Light/information
wherever it is needed, and as we become Christed to the highest life
of value and importance to the rest of the race -- here we are found
within the highest levels of Lightbody, that we move entirely at our
own Free Will, and we operate through proactive animation. By
changing ourselves, we change the world, and the shift lies with the
individual. I am making my own personal effort by removing addiction
from my life, and replacing it with new relationships. I am shifting,
with the changeful times, as I have come to write this book in
sequence with the last days of the Mayan calendar. I will only
conclude the book with a journal entry as to what occurred that day,
and how I made my active choice to cease being a marijuana addict.
Presently, only some ten days away; I feel the fear-level is rising,
and I am struck with a certain sense of perceiving that something bad
will
happen. Terrorist attack, global communion, starseed evacuation, or
natural disaster. I am told there will be an eclipse on December
21st, 2012, and this seems perfectly synchronized. I know the Mayans
were correct in their declaration, and I know that peace will find
the Earth renewed. I offer my invocation to Light, my beliefs, and my
information, for the evolutionary benefit of your own. I willingly
sacrifice my name, my identity, and my existence, for the sake of the
Light of the collective. I work for human evolution; that is my
mission; that is my goal; and I am a real human being with a real
heart, mind, identity, and personality. As the reader and writer meet
on that fateful day to exchange fond wishes about the future -- and I
shall make my presence, as an individual, known to the reader; that I
endeavor to meet the reader, and become friend over time, is only in
due sequence with human evolution. The highest act a human can
achieve is connection with another human. That is how we learn, grow,
and evolve. Evolution is a collective matter, for some -- with DNA
activation -- it occurs spontaneously. This is my case, and I have
been fortunately gifted with the symbol of the caduceus, the symbol
for spiritual awakening, that my own DNA activation and entrance into
Lightbody was catalyzed by a universal symbol; one which can not be
denied; and the writer knows himself to be in the final incarnation.
I expect the reader to be challenged by some of this text I have
written, and as I will refer to certain sources, and make no claim
that I have drawn all of this information through my own Light, but
was found in other believers, and other evolutionists, that we all
learn together -- and I am invariably guided by the Light of the
collective. As I come to see my effect on people, the world, and all
that exists in this realm -- I have learned that I can at times be
impressive, at other times hopelessly alone. I writhe through
solitude. That I have built a life of perfection around one home, and
one environment, as evidenced through my own epiginetic process -- I
have lived, grown up, evolved, learned, and existed through the same
environment for the entirety of my life. This house I know, with my
family, books, television, computers, guitars, recording devices,
microphones, and music sampling software, to the soaking in knowledge
of a hot bath, to the deep meditations I undergo, to the revelations
I often receive, I surround myself with beauty and information, and I
take great pride in my changeful environment. You have read the text
of someone who has a genetic mutation that is new, who perceives
himself to have tri-strand, or even higher strand DNA; who has been
primed since the age of two with the thought of extraterrestrials;
who has lived a life of solitude and occlusion for the most part,
away from the world, safe on my island of Mount Desert in Bar Harbor,
Maine, able to grow and focus on himself, that by changing the self,
one changes the world, and as such, this is how evolution works. As
the shift lies with the individual, and I shall cease my addiction to
marijuana on the 21st, with only occasional religious usage with
friends afterward, to which I shall remain in a clear-headed, sober
state for the rest of my life on Earth, and never fall back into the
old ambition-shattering use of what is commonly perceived as the best
drug that there is, I see that what may happen to me is unknown -- as
I may have told myself "when the weed runs out, that's when life
gets interesting." So life will get interesting, I will probably
meet new people, form better, more high-vibrating relationships, and
plan on going back to school to study writing and psychology. I have
hated school for most of my life; but now I am truly interested in
learning. My family look at me as the scapegoat, very often, and will
place a lot of energy on me. As I have made the choice to be an
addict for nine years, to which my entire world has revolved around
the use of THC -- and I would often steal in order to get high,
reaching low into the depths of desperation, become a shoplifter,
eventually jailed, hospitalized, and hit rock bottom. I have had
times in my life when I woke up in a drunken haze, and found my
entire bedroom -- with smashed ukulele -- broken computer -- and
debris from the previous night, and I have had some experiences with
drugs that have caused me to almost veer away from them completely. I
have lost friends in this life due to my drug use, and I have had
many failed relationships by putting marijuana first, and people
second. I have prayed to the green goddess of mary jane, with
deep-lung hits, and cannabinoid receptors repeatedly activated in
daily use -- for which I have spent $300 in a single week to support
my habit at times . . . with weed broken up and laid out on the table
before me, writing poetry about heaven, and writhing through some
very grandiose thought-patterns. I have made some of the worst
choices, and most awful decisions due to my drug use. I have sold
myself to cannabis, devoted my life to the repeated use, and based my
entire existence around this self-medicating, abuse of the human
soul. Once, I would order valium off the internet -- shipped from
India -- about 100 pills for only $30, other times I would order
"herbal blends" (known as Spice, or other mixtures with
synthetic THC) -- such that I would receive my drugs by mail, and
often the drugs I received legally were more powerful than the ones
that were attained illegally. The strongest drug I have ever taken
was the chemical used in cough medicine, known as dextromethorphan.
DXM. My first use of DXM was at the age of eighteen, the first time I
ever tried a hallucinogenic drug. It was like a TV switching stations
constantly within my mind -- when I shut my eyes, my imagination
would soar, just like a TV, from one channel to the next, one
profound image, one profound symbol, one profound -- often terrifying
set of images -- to the next -- the effect of the drug lasted for two
days, and I was horrified by the experience. Needless to say, I have
now achieved drug-induced telepathy with hallucinogenics, and I no
longer "trip" when I take them. Instead,
thought-transferrence always occurs, as a result of my Lightbody.
Marijuana can be safely "vaporized" by heating the
substance to the temperature just before burning, producing a
non-carcinogenic white haze that is twice as potent as your typical
joint. Very few people know about this. There are safe ways to take
drugs, and there is such a thing as religious usage. Marijuana can be
enhancing, as well as destructive. There is always too much of a good
thing, become a bad thing through habit, and as such, we are able to
see certain individuals whose occasional, religious use of marijuana
is performed safely -- and is not addictive behavior. Just because a
drug is perceived as the best, and someone may partake in its use,
does not mean they are invariably going to become an addict.
Marijuana is
the
best, most safe drug that there is -- it would seem as though grown
to be smoked and enjoyed. Wherever it came from, it is a blessing,
but too much of a good thing exists in the life of this writer -- and
I have given much of my life away to use of the drug. Such that I am
not advocating religious usage, but I do perceive occasional drug use
as occasionally necessary for ones growth. Theoretically a patient
with psychosis can be cured by use of psilocybin, the chemical agent
found in "magic mushrooms." This which is a very natural
psychadelic, often invites revelation, but to believe a drug could
actually cure someone who is psychotic, is suggestive that there use
can be good, for some. The human race, through their misuse of so
many things, from information, to concepts of God, to the materials
that exist on the Earth -- have been working very hard to achieve
many things, with focus lost via the vast plethora of overwhelming
choices. The mis-use of drugs, especially found in the sixties, with
"mind expansion" suggested in the use of LSD, was a great
big step in "almost" the right direction. However,
marijuana became greatly criminalized, and its use became perceived
as negative; denoting the user to the many labels and stigma that
exist -- we are perceived as criminals as a result of smoking a plant
that produces a relaxing high. We have criminalized the use of an
herb, we have made the very Earth illegal -- and as such, this only
makes the problem worse. Portugal has now come to legalize almost all
drugs, and their drug-crimes are reduced, already, by 50%. Colorado
is moving in the direction for which national legalization may reach
us. Presently, the use of cannabis in cancer patients has come to
show that hunger is increased, and more confidence in the mind is
found -- that marijuana is like a natural medicine is found in the
sort of "culture" that now surrounds the drug. People who
smoke marijuana are generally more happy than people who do not. As a
matter of fact, we pray to a fleeting substance -- whereas alcohol is
based on fermentation and will always exist for as long as things rot
-- we yield marijuana by planting a seed, and watching it grow until
the harvest season. This is obviously the better drug. It would only
come to be that through the apparent opposition to hemp-based
materials, and paper, propaganda would be released in the film
"Reefer Madness" shedding a very dark light over marijuana,
and as such, ruining the experience for people who want religious,
recreational, and positive, co-creative usage. Personally, I have
"used" marijuana to inhibit revelatory states, and I have
learned much from my revelations. I see a world where marijuana is
legal, and as such, not so cool to smoke now that it has been
de-criminalized. I see a world where drugs are harnessed for their
beneficial properties, and not just used to "get fucked up."
Alcohol is probably the worst invention that exists, and I stand
firmly opposed to it -- with fond hopes that a reversion from
alcohol, to marijuana, may come with the shift of the New Age.
Now one is about to shift from sobriety, into a marijuana-induced high . . . one moment please . . .
Much
better, but this will not last . . .
As I lie back into my
thoughts, and soar through rhyme, and the natural lyricality of my
mind -- I am ambivolent -- how could I actually quit..? This whole
"New Age" thing is a whole crock of shit. And no one really
cares. So it goes, many thoughts will come to pass -- the shadow
verily seen -- and I am no better, no less, merely equal, through my
quest; my shift that was eventual, this which what would be real --
and the future, entirely unknown. I do not really know what will
happen.
I look upon the pipe and I sigh. I do not know what to
think. I am so . . . no . . . I don't know . . . I am unsure . . .
utterly unsure . . .
I do not know what will happen to me
once I stop being an addict.
I have cast myself into wonder
upon the concept of tomorrow; as I never think about tomorrow; I
absolutely never think about what will happen, I merely flow, I
merely act, animate, and exist. For whatever reason I am pure, and I
adhere to my uniqueness. I am one cell amid the plethora of cells,
and my drug-use, theft, life of crime, despair, and desperation -- is
only humbling that it all occured after
I
was intervened with, these desperate acts were committed with full
knowledge that God exists, and is watching over me. Take that,
motherfucker. So it goes, I would torture myself, and writhe through
hate and suicidality -- a profound sense of occlusion; believing
myself damned; and so it would prevail; I would damn myself; and
nothing is worse than two months of being hospitalized amid the very
act of trying to change ones life. Never share your beliefs without
knowing that it may cause others to look at you in a certain way. Be
careful in your movements, and know that God is real. The writer is
no more Godly than the reader, and pretentious the thought may seem;
we are essentially one and the same. My thoughts, yours, to which
universal genius is a realizant factor -- for which we know we are
only recycling through what already exists -- and truly -- how many
modern inventors exist in our present-day society..? It would seem
that most great inventions, however Akashic Computer, or
Psycho-Imaginarium, can be imagined, we are living in a time where it
would seem most things have already been done. Often, the individual
loses hope in their ability to reach a special place in the eyes of
the Source. Often, it may seem that the entire world is against you.
So it goes, this which shall come to pass -- and this too shall pass
-- you once said to me -- and I now relay back to you . . . as I have
been to the depths of hate and despair, and I have survived death,
three times. As I am still alive, and willing to make the better
choice toward my own evolution and that which is necessary for
humankind; my family, friends, and all that exists in this reality --
going back to school, continuing to learn, seeking a degree in a
certain speciality, and devoting myself to the consensus machine,
because I realize that may only create a future that in which I am
found, God knows, in my mid-thirties, with a profession, and a steady
flow of income.
We are alive within the perceived hologram; could imagine that we are in the holocell now; and we may shift environment; shift inhibitors; shift from one space to the next; a purpose for each room within the structure; the space which is an extension of the mind, the objects which are all in essence mere thoughts; -- we control this environment; -- we control our thoughts; --we control our evolution. So here we find the choice-point; how far do we wish to peer into the future..?
We reside in a stasis of not-knowing, that only by a possession of a certain ignorance regarding the most distant future -- knowing that end-result which is the return to the Source, we lie in-between, and find that life is more magical when we reside in the present tense. The future can be imagined, it will be imagined, but it is not set in stone. The concept of predestiny versus Free Will is a conondrum in that we chose to incarnate here, but very often little do we realize it. So it may strike the heart as profound we made a soul-choice to experience all that we have been through -- that there is only Free Will in this realm -- there was never any real limitation or duality; such was only a fabrication invented by the mind. We have set limits for ourselves, countlessly, through history, and performed self-limitation many times. Eventually we would send a rocket to the moon. Eventually we would elect a black president. Eventually we would legalize marijuana, and yet, we are still highly limited creatures. We realize our control over reality is only evident in our ability to express our Free Will -- and if we feel that we do not have Free Will, we must be under the throes of self-deception and a belief in victimization; -- the trauma of the past is too much for some to endure as a result of their own Free Will -- and the writer of this text, as through intervention, and extraterrestrial communion, has always questioned whether any of this was predecided. One does not know for sure; as we perceive the use of Free Will by one being in order to reduce the Free Will in another, is simply evidence of the truth of this reality. This is the Free Will universe, we are the fuel, and we are learned from by many of the existing races. Many are lined up for their chance to exist within a human body, and many desire the life of the indigo. We are allegedly one of the most infamous planets in the universe, and the multiverse, and many bright and unique souls have come from various places to experience human incarnation. We all chose to be here, we all chose our experiences, and the present moment -- this moment -- this living moment -- is a living matter that is always gravitating new experiences through the stasis of our present beliefs. Our belief-patterns revolving around the future will create the future manifest, and we always have Free Will, and we are always constructing the masterpiece of the future, and we are already there as we observe the ticking second-hand of the clock, the very movement of the clouds, and the wind blowing through the trees. We see time is alive; nothing is static; but everything is animate, and moves through its own machinetic grace. We see that the environment is alive, that it is entangled with thought, and we always have Free Will -- to control the environs. So we step into the field, we go from one environ to the next, we inhibit ourselves with certain information, we guide ourselves through the inner Light. We are enamored with the power of our own imaginative capacities, and we illumine the path before us through the world of expectation. We are defined by our expectations. We are defined by the things we expect to receive from life and reality, and whatever deducements, beliefs, thoughts, or ideas come result through our experience shall prove us as existentialists, as mystics, as believers, and dreamers of the future -- we see ourselves within the most desirable field, the most perfect environment for our growth to flourish.
The
Cosmic Christ
Here
we perceive the self-contained vehicle of Divine Light that is the
Cosmic Christ.
One is in union with the rhythm of the universe. One is in full contact with the primordial rhythm, and flows through a natural accord of synchronistic means. We find this person to be our own self eventually, for which the individual is fully furnished with the full arsenal of technology that shall come to pass with our endurance in the fifth octave; -- the highest levels of Lightbody. We shall employ such things as the Holocell, Akashic Computer, and Imaginarium, to other such devices. Once enlightenment has carried us to these levels, we are realizing the Christ Self -- the natural, honest, and co-evolving patterns that work toward a symbiotic relationship with all living matter that surrounds our living sphere -- we are wholly enhanced, adepts in our reality-floes, and learned as aware of the envirothoughts that come to us through time. We are to be in all the right places, doing what we are desirous of experiencing; whenever, wherever we want -- all in the final realization of that life-changing first experience with re-location. This may be possible with those in the highest levels of Lightbody, that we are able to teleport upon our own Free Will and ability to imagine our way from point A to point B. Folding the time-space continuum, perhaps through Light convergence, and as such, teleconnected; removing all need for physical transportation. These Christed ones are nye to be seen, as they are with us in the millions of whom are in Lightbody -- eventing toward the only realizable conclusive element of the final life, that is the Christed self. So we see the great artists, songwriters, and genius minds that shine so brightly in our world now -- as this would truly seem to be a very worthwhile time to be incarnated on the Earth; and it would seem that the whole concept of “one life” believed in by many, now rings true in accord with the realization of our Christed embodiment. We are living that final life; we can reverse the aging process if we so choose; our perfect avatar self is realizeable; and we are going to take our Lightbody with us. Teleconnection is the eventual supercommunative, and evolved transportation, and symbiosis, linkage of Universal Mind -- to which we are driven in service to the machinations of evolution of time, and know that our Christed self can be activated, just as our DNA has been activated.
Chapter
Thirty One: The Holocell
Here
is an imagined technology of the future, for which a subject is found
within a sphere-shaped space, hovering in the centre through an
antrigravitation field, and the surrounding walls project the
holographic imagery of the desired environment. We may find ourselves
in a beautiful flowing landscape, to the surface of Mars, to a
personally-experienced delving into various times in Earths past
through the Akashic Computer which is wired into the holocell.
As the holocell is in itself a sort of hologram encasement for which any environment can be inhibited upon the subject, much like the drug Detura, these seemingly hallucinations are tangible, can be felt, and as such, seem entirely real. We are able to move, it would seem, through the environs that are supra-physical, not real, but feel entirely real, that within this space we may bring guests and share the experience in a group setting is nothing short of divine. Many subjects will find themselves perhaps on top of a beautiful mountaintop, on a starry night, in group meditation, only to shift into the next environment, perhaps the rocky surface of the moon. The environment is continually shifted from one place to the next, and so within this envirosphere, the holocell, we are able to program ourselves with various influential environmental inhibitors. We can see, feel, experience, anything we want, and especially in the group setting when many minds work together toward a common goal of the most desirable environment, it is to be found that in this space we are telekinetic, and possess full control over the environs. Manning the switchboard, we are able to punch in any date within Earths past, personally experience the history perhaps, of the signing of the declaration of independence, or Martin Luther King’s “I have a dream” speech, to various locales within human history. In this, we are found observer -- that history is not affected by our peering into it, as we are in Lightbody, a higher vibration that can not be seen or experienced by the subjects in that specific timeline. We are able to view the past without affecting it through the holocell, as the Akashic Computer is universal -- the past is the past -- verily, it can be re-written, this we know, and so we delve into the past such as to learn more about it so as to never repeat certain things, resulting in cyclic redundancy. We must be endeavoring toward the new, so it goes, within the holocell as governed dually by the mechanism of the psycho-imaginarium, we can find ourselves within any landscape or environment that the mind projects, that the holographic depiction surrounding us is the most desirable space, whatever it may be, we see the perfect environment, we see ourselves within this field of iridescence, we may be found in a hovering cell -- a rainbow-colored sphere, or perhaps the double-tetrahedron. We are able to imagine any space around ourselves, and thus inhibit ourselves directly through the imaginative processes involved. As the environment is directly constructed by the imagination, and we find ourselves within the most desirable locale, past, future, or present, we are to be found as able to program ourselves with certain knowledge, certain information, that certain classes are taught in the recess of the holocell, and the teacher employs the imagination in order to educate the subjects. As the imagination is directly projected onto the holographic walls of the curved space, the panoramic screen, we are committed to the environment of the instructor, shown certain things, and learned of new information. Teaching will increase tenfold whence we are in the recess of harnessing the holocell, and I believe that the imagination projected directly onto the screen as such, through the imaginarium, the Akashic Computer, and all technologies of the perceived New Age -- we are able to teach in a way that is most direct -- through the imagination alone. So it goes, whence we are found in the desired space, we may learn certain things of astronomy, our relationship to the unisphere, or where our most desirable future may take us. As we all have the capacity to act as guide, and instruct the many viewing eyes, we all have some divine imagery waiting within us for which the holocell may express. This is technology of the future, what has been imagined by many science fiction films, but is a concept for which education I truly believe will come to advance like never before. I believe that through the mind projected directly onto the holographic walls producing the desired environment, we are to be found as able to teach ourselves information, through our own inner Akashic encodements, we are able to view past-lives, and experience them wholly, physically, bodily, in our higher-vibrating Lightbody -- such that we are invisible to the characters in the scene, the past is not affected by our observation, as we exist at a higher vibration, and the holocell is merely a projection of the Universal Mind, and the Akasha. Anyone can view the past and experience it directly through the holocell. We learn from the past directly, just as we may learn from the present, and view the going-ons of entirely different star-systems.
As we come to find ourselves fueled by the power to observe and learn through the holocell, and all new knowledge afforded through the power of this divine technology, it is perceived this device is already existing with many races, and as such, so is the Akashic Computer. Just as the time traveler has his time machine already constructed in the future -- “if we can imagine it; it must exist” -- so it goes, the holocell is likely a device that the human race will harness in time to come. The self-manifested, self-constructed universe of ones own, the self-created environment, the most desirable space for which our re-programming is found, we are capable of seeing anything we want, feeling anything we want, knowing anything we want . . . we can find ourselves traveling into any conceivable environ -- we shift from one environment to the next -- it is a joy to find ourselves wherever we want to be -- and we may exit the holocell at any time, to re-convene with our fellow ascendees, and share what we have learned. As the psycho-imaginarium is based upon the same principle, and the mind is hooked up to a computer for which the imagination is projected onto a screen -- we see, and the evidence shall manifest, that teaching and education as found through this medium is infinite -- the most direct forms of expression, the most powerfully manifest products of the creative mind. We all have an imagination; we are all capable of beautiful imagery, and grand sights and sounds. I perceive that as in relationship to the properties of Detura, that our senses are also available within the holocell -- we can see, touch, hear, smell, and taste, everything that is given to us through the recess of the holocell . . . that we are able to directly experience anything we want will come manifest -- and for as long as matter is infinite, we are able to witness probable futures through the mechanism of the Akashic Computer, and personally experience what the future will be like.
So it will seem that education is enhanced by the holocell, psycho-imaginarium, and Akashic Computer. These which are technologies that theoretically already exist with many races is simply produced by the thought, as suggested, “if it can be imagined, it must exist somewhere.” The infinitude of the imagination coupled with the concept of the Free Will universe, would suggest that anything is possible in this changeful reality, and these technologies very likely do exist with such races as the Pleiadians, and Zeta Reticuli, and others. The technology is being actively used, one imagines, that we are being viewed on the Akashic Computer, as suggested, and our file exists in the mainframe database of all human existence. Those in which we perceive our our original Founders, are now ascended masters, for which the technology exists with the ascended masters -- as able to view anywhere in the continuum via the infinitude of the fifth-dimensional Lightbody, and as such, intervene into certain peoples lives; once all probable futures point in the same direction of discord or loss of control, we find that the angelworkers will “step through the screen” -- alter the course of history by way of intervention, that it would come to be found that integration into certain peoples realities, once the probable future has been viewed, causes the viewer and the viewed to become One, and so we perceive the hallway of mirrors, with one planted in the center in a infinite stream of possibilities. There is one future which possesses the greatest value to the race, and the most longevity of life, for which the final incarnation is realized, and that is the future to which we are being propelled towards, in all moments of every second of every day.
We
are alive within the perceived hologram; could imagine that we are in
the holocell now;
and
we may shift environment; shift inhibitors; shift from one space to
the next; a purpose for each room within the structure; the space
which is an extension of the mind, the objects which are all in
essence mere thoughts; -- we control this environment; -- we control
our thoughts; --we control our evolution. So here we find the
choice-point; how far do we wish to peer into the future..? We reside
in a stasis of not-knowing, that only by a possession of a certain
ignorance regarding the most distant future -- knowing that
end-result which is the return to the Source, we lie in-between, and
find that life is more magical when we reside in the present tense.
The future can be imagined, it will be imagined, but it is not set in
stone. The concept of predestiny versus Free Will is a conondrum in
that we chose to incarnate here, but very often little do we realize
it. Often it may seem that our Free Will to exist at all has been the
production of other minds -- our parents -- our family -- the
pro-creation of the race -- and yet, we theoretically chose all of
this, and all that we experience is essentially at the hands of our
own Free Will. So it may strike the heart as profound we made a
soul-choice to experience all that we have been through -- that there
is only Free Will in this realm -- there was never any real
limitation or duality; such was only a fabrication invented by the
mind. We have set limits for ourselves, countlessly, through history,
and performed self-limitation many times. Eventually we would send a
rocket to the moon. Eventually we would elect a black president.
Eventually we would legalize marijuana, and yet, we are still highly
limited creatures. We realize our control over reality is only
evident in our ability to express our Free Will -- and if we feel
that we do not have Free Will, we must be under the throes of
self-deception and a belief in victimization; -- the trauma of the
past is too much for some to endure as a result of their own Free
Will -- and the writer of this text, as through intervention, and
extraterrestrial communion, has always questioned whether any of this
was predecided. One does not know for sure; as we perceive the use of
Free Will by one being in order to reduce the Free Will in another,
is simply evidence of the truth of this reality. This is
the
Free Will universe, we are the fuel, and we are learned from by many
of the existing races. Many are lined up for their chance to exist
within a human body, and many desire the life of the indigo. We are
allegedly one of the most infamous planets in the universe, and the
multiverse, and many bright and unique souls have come from various
places to experience human incarnation. We all chose to be here, we
all chose our experiences, and the present moment -- this moment --
this living moment -- is a living matter that is always gravitating
new experiences through the stasis of our present beliefs. Our
belief-patterns revolving around the future will create the future
manifest, and we always have Free Will, and we are always
constructing the masterpiece of the future, and we are already there
as we observe the ticking second-hand of the clock, the very movement
of the clouds, and the wind blowing through the trees. We see time is
alive; nothing is static; but everything is animate, and moves
through its own machinetic grace. We see that the environment is
alive, that it is entangled with thought, and we always have Free
Will -- to control the environs. So we step into the field, we go
from one environ to the next, we inhibit ourselves with certain
information, we guide ourselves through the inner Light. We are
enamored with the power of our own imaginative capacities, and we
illumine the path before us through the world of expectation. We are
defined by our expectations. We are defined by the things we expect
to receive from life and reality, and whatever deducements, beliefs,
thoughts, or ideas come result through our experience shall prove us
as existentialists, as mystics, as believers, and dreamers of the
future -- we see ourselves within the most desirable field, the most
perfect environment for our growth to flourish.
There is a
place on this Earth where we truly belong. A perfect environment that
is most beneficial to our soul-growth and self-evolution. This
location is to be found, through our ability to produce the greatest
environment, and it will be used for our learning and advancement.
There are many parts of the Earth which are focused on Earth-based,
and spiritual energy; there are many places on the Earth that are in
great support of human evolution. In America, the “promise
land” -- the greatest, most powerful country on Earth, to which
I am a citizen, and have lived through the darkness of the Bush
regime, and now take great pride in our black president. And I see
that as this power we possess has come to shape the world, that we
are the most powerful country on Earth, and the Earth is a very
important part of the universe -- and multiverse -- that this power
we possess as the most powerful country, in the universe, will
perhaps suggest that in the days of cosmic integration, and the
communique with other races -- however Mexico seems to be targeted as
the place where the landings will occur, this is not far from
America, and I perceive we will find the future realized as a place
where our country is become the vehicle for which global peace, and
planetary advocacy is found. America is the grounds for which most
people find the greatest expressions of their Free Will, because we
are simply the greatest, most powerful country on Earth.
As we are endeavoring to construct the final, most powerful space for evolution to occur -- finding our sacred space as our own sort of holocell, that the decor, feng shui, and arrangement of organizational elements will find a symmetry for which our creativity is enhanced -- here we think the most high-charged thoughts, endeavor into the deepest meditations and alpha programming, and writhe within the containing space -- music is played, books are read, art-work is produced, thoughts are written and constructed, the walls are decorated of ones own art-work, the bookcases full of ones favorite films and music, the music which is perhaps some of from the indie scene like Fredrik, Mirah, Beach House, Bon Iver, Cat Power, or Bat For Lashes -- we see many stellar souls constructing beautiful environments with their thoughts -- and we can learn from these stellar souls. Through the inhibition of information and beauty, surrounding ones self with the things we perceive as the greatest elements toward our final reality -- our self-perfected place of thought and genius thinking, it will come to pass that through “creative meditation” and all attractor-forces of thought realizing the future as the place we consciously construct, we are in the field of our own making, the self-contained uni-verse of beauty and information. Here we learn, here we grow, here we accellerate through thought and belief toward the highest-vibrating thought-patterns, and inner undulations. The frequency of the waveform of our thoughts will flow as informational Light through the given space, travel into our minds, and then back to us, infinitely interpolated into the Universal Mind, the Source Field, the Akasha, and All That Is -- our file seen on the computer, our most beneficial and evolutionary future probable, our most divine and high-charged thoughts seen whence found in the recess of the self-created universe. Just as whence we are fully ascended Lightbodies, we are able to construct our own universe, of our own rules, and our own declarations -- so let the present space be primer for what lies ahead; let the decor and feng shui work toward a common symmetry, and let the animation within the cell be organization as found able to move objects, change the decor, and consciously construct that which is an extension of the mind. The philosophy of furniture, we shall see, is that objects are placed in such a way that is geared toward the collective flow of the feng shui of the room -- we may be constantly re-organizing this space, that we know the inhibitors affect us, and by controlling the objects (which are extensions of our thoughts) reality is controlled, and find that this control is now productive of the most creative, and beneficial thought-patterns . . .
In our creative meditations,
from perhaps streaming-consciousness automatic writing, to the
channeled text of the higher self -- we may activate our guide -- we
may see that we are able to teach ourselves through the master that
lies within, and find this environment, this mind, this skull, this
brain, this thought, this synaptic connection, this primordial spark,
this illuminatory glow within the mind that radiates through all
matter within the given space -- is alive -- is attracting -- and all
is gravitated toward the centre which is our own Source Field -- and
the mind which is imagined as the center, will, through the nature
gravitational force of thought, create new relationships,
experiences, and insight. We ever-learn, and the space is always
changing. One day will pass, that the next is entirely unique unto
itself, whatever day within the continuum it may be -- and it shall
seem that the present day is all we really have. Tomorrow can be
imagined; we may plan it out, but nothing is set in stone. The future
can always be changed, and we are always capable of veering into a
new direction, when we see greater possibilities will come manifest
through the choice. Realizing certain choice-points in our evolution
will find that we either create a heaven or hell out of this reality,
and as the karma system of the final incarnation becomes active, so
it will seem the present choices we make -- through this which is the
final body -- are choices that will, we realize, alter the course of
our future, and carry us into certain experiences and relationships
that are entirely amazing, beautiful, and aggrandized through their
own magicality. We hope to meet the greatest individuals, learn from
the highest teachers, and associate with the deepest minds. We hope
to find peace where only darkness has reigned over us, via ignorance,
before, and we believe in the beauty of the future -- and we know
that we are creators of the future, writhing through proactive
animation.
So we perceive the concept of the holocell, and
relate it to the sacred space as a room for our evolutionary process.
We may be surrounded by certain media, and inhibit ourselves with
certain ideas and thoughts. We are awareized to our control over the
given space as entangled with thought, and we perceive our stance
within this space as directly in control -- we know that the
environment is alive -- we accept that we are moving into the future,
that our growth, the environment, the Earth, the universe, the
aggregate of the multiverse, is only endless. So we perceive our
place, God knows, through the Light of our DNA as found within the
recess of the New Age -- we perceive our evolution -- we perceive our
growth is real . . . and we know that the world is changing all
around us. We realize we are creators, true, but moreso than ever
before. We are to writhe through our creative meditations, and we
know that our thoughts are like electricity that flow within us
through the riverlight of the imagination -- ever-interpolated into
the datasphere of knowledge, ever-interpolated into the Akashic
Records. We are there; our file seen; our reality witnessed -- we are
there, within the holocell, in this very moment; that the third
dimension is only a hologram we lovingly realize, and so we begin to
event our way through the hallway of mirrors, and we see the apex,
the very pinnacle of all realization -- the conclusion of all human
thought -- and we know this is ours for the taking -- the conclusion
thus realized we come to the awareness of the final environment, the
now, the living moment, and here, we event our way through the
deepest most profound of cogitations.
Chapter Thirty One: Predestiny and Free Will
“How
many times have you been through lifetimes on
Earth?”
“Eighty-six.”
“Eighty-six.?”
“Yes.”
“Do
you remember them all?”
“I will, when it is important
for me to remember them.”
- Catherine and and Brian
Weiss, Many Lives, Many Masters.
Are
we here on Earth through Free Will, a predestiny of choice that
preceded incarnation, that decided we would incarnate at this
midnight hour in human existence..? The New Age..? Did we choose to
end up wherever we are now..? It would seem apparent that choice was
always involved, no matter to whom we may have been sharing our
energy with throughout this given life. We always had Free Will to
which we could see the road ahead of us was essentially at our own
choosing, and if we felt victimized, or damned by a future seemingly
the manufactura of a third-party, it shall seem that the lack of
choice was only an illusion for which was essentially, simply enough,
created through our own Free Will of self-limitation. The duality of
the double helix, two hemispheres of the brain, to genders, as such,
manufactured in such a way as to most remove
our
Free Will, we always had the primordial choice of wearing this
physical body, in the third dimension, in the New Age.
Chapter
Thirty One: The Judgement
“And
in that day hell shall enlarge herself,
And open her mouth without
measure:
And the glory, the pride and the pomp of the wicked
Shall
descend into it.
And the mean man shall be brought down
And the
might man shall be humbled,
As the fire devoureth the stubble,
And
the flame consumeth the chaff;
So their root shall be as
rottenness,
And their blossom shall go up as dust,
Because they
have cast away
The Holy Law of the Heavenly Order.”
--
The Essene Gospel of Peace, Prophecies.
The
world at present, however found within the recess of the New Age, and
all beauteous Light come from the realization of the prophecy --
there are some in this world who are in no desire toward the
collective, but work solely for their own selfish gain. As we are in
Lightbody serving the master that lies within, there is a point of
stasis wherein our existence only betters mankind through our own
personal focus -- but in the world of the power-hungry, their
selfishness is only toward their own personal wealth, and sway over
other men.
So
the concept of the reckoner is born, that super hero who personally
takes it upon himself to right the perceived darkness of this world.
As the concept of a super-hero is something our society favors, it
may come to pass that the enlightened soul, who peers through
rose-colored glasses, and sees the meaning and beauty in all things
-- will perceive, expose, and reveal the inner truth of that
mal-affective soul, and reveal, openly, their true desires. We shall
see this come to pass through telepathy; as I have been reckoned with
in my own right, no one walks the path of spirit alone -- but however
occluded, we are awareized in the minds of the humble observer. God
is aware of us, and God would have us know that we are never truly
alone.
Upon the realization of ones humility, one may realize
that ones ways have been mal-inclined, and start to “shift”
into a new Light.
Whatever vices, addictions, and personal
issues will be resolved through the final incarnation.
One
realizes the shift lies in the individual -- that we realize the
world would never change if it weren’t for one person to stand
up to the rest. It only takes one person to change the world, and
there is no requirement over who this person might be.
To
express judgment only brings judgement upon ones self.
So
it goes, whence we are found as reckoner, we must expect judgment in
our own right.
Through
occlusion, one separating ones self from the collective, and
perceiving ones self as uniquely better than the rest -- I was once
this person, and I was desperate, and I was suicidal, and my path was
darkly-illumined. I was self-destructive, and destructive toward all
those to whom I knew -- and then intervention would find me -- I
would be forever changed. Now one perceives that God exists in the
human body as the angelworker, one to whom power is seemingly
endless, and lies forever beyond my own. I calmly accept that I will
never be found as any better; but remain infinitely humbled, and I
humbly accept that my reckoning upon others will only bring judgment
upon myself.
One
seeks to be fully awareized to the presence of the human God.
Through
the concept of angelworkers, we are in the recess for which God
exists in the human body -- as reckoner -- shape-shifter, and a
standalone army of One. The reckoners are real, they exist, and I am
humbly aware of them through my own experience -- that whence my
thoughts were read by the angelworkers, and I was reduced --
humiliated to realize that I would once enlighten my fellow man
through telepathy, in a somewhat forced expression of ontological
expression, it would come to pass that I find myself within the
recess of telepathy as shared with the angelworkers. There was one
man present the night of my one and only LSD trip, for which
drug-induced telepathy occurred; his name was Steven, I am not aware
of who, where, or how, he ever came to be at the party that night --
but I believe I somewhat terrified him with my expressions. As a
result of enlightening the subject opposed to their Free Will, I
would be enlightened in my own right, through the experience with the
angelworkers. No one believes me except for a select few people, that
we are unable to accept telepathy with strangers would occur -- that
we are unable to deduce the scientific logic of such an event,
causing us to look away, and kindly repress the knowledge -- just as
I have been primed, and intervened within in my infancy with the
recurring abduction dream, it would seem that intervention from God
has always been a somewhat haunting factor in my life. The concept of
being “chosen” is awareized, but I perceive the choice
must have been random; as this is the Free Will universe, and reality
which is goal-oriented, acts through a patternless flow in spite of
the ever-logical result. So I realize that my life has been tested, I
have been humiliated, judged, and reckoned with as a result of my own
expressions of power, and I am enamored, wholly enamored with a deep
sense of pride and lasting fortitude to believe that God truly cares
about me . . .
Ones quest for suicide is absolved through
divine intervention. Knowing that God is aware of us, through
whatever expressed forms, whatever person, angel, angelworker, or
individual -- we are guided into the belief of being awareized in the
mind of God -- that our file exists boldly on the mainframe of the
computer, and the operating system -- the continuum -- only
infinitely realizes that place -- that future -- for which our
reckoning of others shall come to pass; that we become judge in our
own right; ever-expecting judgment upon ourselves through the
knowledge of the ancient truth “judge not lest ye be judged”
-- we see that by judging others we only wish judgment upon
ourselves. For some, this is willingly desired. I am one such person.
Acting as judge over others, expressions of critique and
skepticism over anothers expression of Free Will -- the interpolation
of our energy into that of another, the ontological impression left
behind once we have affected the subject -- we are inviting such
things to occur in our own lives. Through the exchange of energy
between individuals, and what capacity we possess to act as
super-hero, or reckoner, knowing that this only heightens our own
cosmic design within the mind of God -- we are inviting the final
incarnation to be that of a life for which we are producing the
greatest, most profound experiences; that we shall experience other
ascended masters is going to be fully experienced; that we realize
there are
others
who are far more powerful than we are, and as such, we see the many
gradations of power, and the hierarchy of existence, that the ladder
thus climbed only ascends into the most divine heights -- and as we
see the expressions of power in some individuals -- we are invited to
express our own. We are inspired by one anothers acts of
individuality, and reckoning toward the mal-affective soul. We take
pride in our judgments, and we humbly will it upon ourselves that we
too are judged. We accept this path is the final life; that the karma
system is active, and every thought, every action, every moment is
what will be carried with us through the infinitude of the fifth
dimension. So it goes, we evolve through our expressions and
experiences for which we humbly accept that our life will be judged,
once found in the recess of other ascended masters, the building of a
Light-based community, planetary advocacy groups, and others which
are based upon a symbiotic relationship with the Earth, that
naturally ties into human evolution. As we are to be operating
through universal principle, knowing verily that our genius thoughts
are all once cogitated by many an ascended master before us -- that
energy is simply re-worked, nothing is really new (laugher resounds)
-- and we are simply recycling matter, and what already exists. As
the future is not set in stone, but in a sense one way or the other
“probably” realized, to some future we may imagine -- our
Free Will as extended into the future, we see ourselves, there in the
form of the perfect avatar self, and here we know that any judgment
come our way will be meaningless in light of the true universality of
our soul. We are working for the collective, in every sense of the
word, and we are self-sacrificing mystics on a road for which we are
to be found unique cellular constructs of matter that is organized
into the final life, that life lived within the New Age -- we know
that this is the end of our great journey when we are telepathically
transferring thought with the angelworker. Very many are mostly
afraid to talk about these “supernatural, paranormal, spooky”
occurrences, but they are no phenomena as the hologram persists in
connecting all matter that is born from the same Source. We are
connected, thought will
travel
through its own natural accord through the life-force that it
possesses, and I know from experience that direct non-local
thought-transferrence is something that will happen under certain
circumstances, with that resounding phrase “but it did
happen.”